Digital Marketing ALL-IN-ONE Contributing Authors Ryan Deiss Stephanie Diamond Russ Henneberry John Haydon Cat Lincoln Corey Padveen Stefania Pomponi Deborah Ng Kristy Sammis Shiv Singh Sangram Vajre Jan Zimmerman Digital Marketing ALL-IN-ONE by Stephanie Diamond Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies® Published by: John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 111 River Street, Hoboken, NJ 07030-5774, www.wiley.com Copyright © 2019 by John Wiley & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey Published simultaneously in Canada No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning or otherwise, except as permitted under Sections 107 or 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act, without the prior written permission of the Publisher. Requests to the Publisher for permission should be addressed to the Permissions Department, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 111 River Street, Hoboken, NJ 07030, (201) 748-6011, fax (201) 748-6008, or online at http://www.wiley.com/go/ permissions. Trademarks: Wiley, For Dummies, the Dummies Man logo, Dummies.com, Making Everything Easier, and related trade dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of John Wiley & Sons, Inc. and may not be used without written permission. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. John Wiley & Sons, Inc. is not associated with any product or vendor mentioned in this book. LIMIT OF LIABILITY/DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY: THE PUBLISHER AND THE AUTHOR MAKE NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES WITH RESPECT TO THE ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF THE CONTENTS OF THIS WORK AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION WARRANTIES OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. NO WARRANTY MAY BE CREATED OR EXTENDED BY SALES OR PROMOTIONAL MATERIALS. THE ADVICE AND STRATEGIES CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT BE SUITABLE FOR EVERY SITUATION. THIS WORK IS SOLD WITH THE UNDERSTANDING THAT THE PUBLISHER IS NOT ENGAGED IN RENDERING LEGAL, ACCOUNTING, OR OTHER PROFESSIONAL SERVICES. IF PROFESSIONAL ASSISTANCE IS REQUIRED, THE SERVICES OF A COMPETENT PROFESSIONAL PERSON SHOULD BE SOUGHT. NEITHER THE PUBLISHER NOR THE AUTHOR SHALL BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES ARISING HEREFROM. THE FACT THAT AN ORGANIZATION OR WEBSITE IS REFERRED TO IN THIS WORK AS A CITATION AND/OR A POTENTIAL SOURCE OF FURTHER INFORMATION DOES NOT MEAN THAT THE AUTHOR OR THE PUBLISHER ENDORSES THE INFORMATION THE ORGANIZATION OR WEBSITE MAY PROVIDE OR RECOMMENDATIONS IT MAY MAKE. FURTHER, READERS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT INTERNET WEBSITES LISTED IN THIS WORK MAY HAVE CHANGED OR DISAPPEARED BETWEEN WHEN THIS WORK WAS WRITTEN AND WHEN IT IS READ. For general information on our other products and services, please contact our Customer Care Department within the U.S. at 877-762-2974, outside the U.S. at 317-572-3993, or fax 317-572-4002. For technical support, please visit https://hub.wiley.com/community/support/dummies. Wiley publishes in a variety of print and electronic formats and by print-on-demand. Some material included with standard print versions of this book may not be included in e-books or in print-on-demand. If this book refers to media such as a CD or DVD that is not included in the version you purchased, you may download this material at http://booksupport.wiley.com. For more information about Wiley products, visit www.wiley.com. Library of Congress Control Number: 2019935455 ISBN 978-1-119-56023-4 (pbk); ISBN 978-1-119-56025-8 (ebk); ISBN 978-1-119-56024-1 (ebk) Manufactured in the United States of America 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Contents at a Glance Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Book 1: Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . 5 CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Crafting Offers That Sell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Planning B2B Campaign Success. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Book 2: Uncovering the Customer Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Interacting with Customer Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uncovering Buyer Personas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Structuring the Buyer Journey. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Embracing Sales Enablement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 131 151 171 CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: Book 3: Dipping into Content Creation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Creating Your Content Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing Content Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the Customer’s Intent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating Content That Tells a Story. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 197 219 241 CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: 253 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Book 4: Reaching Your Millennial Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Figuring Out Millennials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at the Influence of Millennials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pursuing a Data Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding Millennials on Traditional Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Experimenting with the Share Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing the Brand Experience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 307 317 337 349 361 Book 5: Implementing Channel Promotions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Search Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making Content Shareable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Considering Email Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 401 425 443 CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: Book 6: Connecting with Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469 Communicating with Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collaborating to Win . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Succeeding with Influencer Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting Creative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with an Agency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 489 509 523 533 543 Book 7: Facebook Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549 Delving into Facebook Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a Facebook Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selling Products and Services Using Facebook Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uniting Facebook with Other Social Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting into Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting Advanced Customer Engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551 561 583 591 607 617 Book 8: Deploying Other Social Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641 Leveraging Social Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Twitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at YouTube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643 659 673 685 Book 9: Analyzing Data for Success. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 Looking Back at Your Business Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassessing Your Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing Ongoing Improvement for B2B Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Achieving Maximum ROI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 713 723 731 741 Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755 CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: Table of Contents INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 About This Book. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Icons Used in This Book. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Where to Go from Here . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 BOOK 1: CREATING YOUR DIGITAL MARKETING STRATEGY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 CHAPTER 1: Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Understanding the Components of a Digital Marketing Strategy . . . . . 7 Determining the company strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Uncovering the customer experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Creating quality content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Developing channel promotions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Deploying check-back analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Communicating Your Mission. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Crafting your statement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Reviewing real mission statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Establishing Your Goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Uncovering your goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Picking KPIs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Expanding Your Corporate Mindset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Creating a culture of content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Thinking about reputation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Using content to serve customers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Dipping into User Design and Habits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Recognizing the importance of UX design in your strategy . . . . . . 26 Observing product habits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 CHAPTER 2: Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer. . . . . . . . . . . 29 Focusing on Attention. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seeking the “attention web”. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at attention triggers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making Your Content Easy to Consume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reading in patterns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Considering design elements and typography. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deploying Interactive Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 30 30 35 36 36 38 42 vii CHAPTER 3: Discovering Your Business Model and Brand. . . . . . . . 45 Separating Your Business Model from Your Brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Understanding the business you’re in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Looking at some popular online business models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Considering the freemium model. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Analyzing Your Business Model. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Discovering Your Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Benefitting from attention to your brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Knowing your current brand reality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Solidifying the Look of the Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Considering design components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Using a digital asset management tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Developing Success Measures for Your Brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Producing Engaging Branded Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 CHAPTER 4: Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Establishing Marketing Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining a Digital Marketing Campaign. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the Three Major Types of Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Campaigns that generate new leads and customers. . . . . . . . . . . . Campaigns that monetize existing leads and customers . . . . . . . . Campaigns that build engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Balancing Your Marketing Campaign Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Choosing the Campaign You Need Now . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing Your Digital Marketing through the Campaign Lens. . . . . . . . CHAPTER 5: Crafting Offers That Sell. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Offering Value in Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing an Ungated Offer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing a Gated Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Zeroing in on what matters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Generating leads with educational content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Generating leads with tools. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filling out the gated offer checklist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing Deep-Discount Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using physical premiums. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Employing a book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Leveraging the webinar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selling software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Splintering a service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brainstorming “little victories” to offer your leads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filling out the deep-discount offer checklist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discovering your deep-discount offer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . viii 68 69 71 72 74 75 76 77 78 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies 80 81 82 83 85 87 89 92 92 92 93 93 93 93 95 96 Maximizing Profit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making an upsell or cross-sell offer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building bundles and kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tacking on a slack adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recurring billing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 97 98 98 99 Planning B2B Campaign Success. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Setting Key Performance Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Attributing metrics at the account level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Comparing cost per click . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Showing impressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Expanding your audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engaging accounts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing Your Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A/B creative testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trying new content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Combining your offers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knowing You Aren’t Wasting Money. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Budgeting the right amounts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Attributing advertising spend to revenue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Showing engagement in the buyer journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 102 107 108 109 110 111 111 112 113 113 114 114 115 BOOK 2: UNCOVERING THE CUSTOMER EXPERIENCE. . . . 117 CHAPTER 6: CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: Interacting with Customer Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Understanding Big Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at different kinds of big data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at problems with big data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uncovering the Role Big Data Plays in Content Marketing. . . . . . . . . Improving your content marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using real-time content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discovering the Internet of Things . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing IoT market size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Impacting content marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visualizing Big Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 120 121 122 123 123 124 125 127 129 Uncovering Buyer Personas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Reviewing Persona Development. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding how persona creation improves content. . . . . . . Taking action to understand your customers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collecting Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding different data types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deploying listening tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Conducting one-on-one interviews. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Documenting your personas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 132 134 136 136 137 140 141 Table of Contents ix Avoiding Common Mistakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at How Generations Differ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding Millennials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Meeting Gen C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying a Prospect’s Emotions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keeping Up with Trends. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 143 143 146 146 147 Structuring the Buyer Journey. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Harnessing the Customer Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at the customer experience from both sides. . . . . . . . . . Benefitting from an omni-channel approach . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uncovering Commercial Intent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defending Against Competitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Researching competitors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analyzing your competitor’s content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying the Stages of the Buyer Journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the buying process and journey map. . . . . . . . . . Benefitting from the journey map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Focusing on content for each part of the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . Personalizing Your Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 152 154 156 159 159 161 164 164 166 167 169 Embracing Sales Enablement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Discovering Sales Enablement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gaining a competitive advantage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Evaluating your current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the new role of sales reps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Training Your Salesforce. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coaching Your Reps to Become Winners. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Out Sales Enablement Blogs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 172 173 176 177 178 179 BOOK 3: DIPPING INTO CONTENT CREATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 1: x Creating Your Content Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Evaluating Your Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Benefitting from a content plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Determining content maturity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Assessing Your Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interviewing your stakeholders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Conducting a content audit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visualizing Your Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mapping your content ecosystem. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Picturing website content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 184 186 187 188 188 190 190 191 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies Creating Your Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 Focusing on Specialized Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194 Creating pillar content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Utilizing evergreen content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Using graphics and other visuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 Going viral. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: Reviewing Content Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 Dipping into Content Categories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Original Short- and Long-Form Content . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Curation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Examining five curation models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding how to curate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making Use of User-Generated Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the positives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dealing with the negatives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repurposing Content to Add Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Benefitting from repurposing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Planning goals and picking content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing Aggregated Visual Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dealing with Live Video Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Extending Business News . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Offering Online Courses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Managing Content Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 199 201 202 202 204 204 205 205 206 206 207 208 209 210 212 Understanding the Customer’s Intent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Knowing the Dynamics of Content Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding Your Path to Perfect Content Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the marketing funnel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Exploring the prospect’s intent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Providing a path to the next step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Segmenting your marketing with content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appearing everywhere your customerexpects. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Customizing your content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Executing Perfect Content Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step 1: Choosing personas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step 2: Brainstorming content assets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step 3: Choosing the vehicle and channel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Step 4: Planning for ascension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Distributing Content to Attract an Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Marketing through email . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Capturing leads through search marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using social media to drive traffic to your site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Paying for traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 221 222 230 231 232 233 234 234 235 235 236 236 236 237 237 238 239 Table of Contents xi CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: Creating Content That Tells a Story. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Storytelling to Engage Your Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seeking the science behind stories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding your product stories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Structuring Your Content Using Stories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crafting the story. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Incorporating copywriting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 241 244 249 249 250 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Organizing the Content Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Benefiting from a defined framework . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Examining the systems needed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Determining Roles and Responsibilities. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Managing the Workflow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding and assigning writers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using an editorial calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Documenting Your Policies and Procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Content managers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Editors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Writers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Content system administrator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Web administrator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 254 255 257 258 258 260 264 265 265 265 265 266 266 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience . . . . . . . . . 269 Creating a Content Library. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Storytelling and its importance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Taking a BtoB lens to your content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Producing content by industry vertical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Basing content on personas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Humanizing Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Demonstrating thought leadership . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Addressing wants, needs, and pain points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Personalizing your message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Developing a brand identity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Reaching Through Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 Employing a content strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 Delivering content on the right channel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289 Cross-promoting your content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Measuring your content’s effectiveness. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 xii Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies BOOK 4: REACHING YOUR MILLENNIAL AUDIENCE. . . . . . CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: 293 Figuring Out Millennials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Discovering Why Millennials Matter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . There is power in numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Millennials influence the economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . They’re a connected generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Leveraging Millennial Influence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying key influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Nurturing relationships . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Meeting Millennials Where They Are . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sharing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Decision-making . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 296 297 299 300 300 301 302 303 304 305 Looking at the Influence of Millennials. . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Understanding the Marketer’s Perception of Millennials . . . . . . . . . . Examining standard definitions that marketers use . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing what marketers get right. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at what marketers get wrong. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recognizing common flaws in marketing campaigns . . . . . . . . . . Finding the roots of the most common mistakes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Millennial Mindset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining the Millennial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying preferred Millennial media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grasping the importance of relationships. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 308 311 312 312 313 314 314 314 315 Pursuing a Data Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 Recognizing the Value of Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Raw data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cooked data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Social media user data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Customer lifetime engagement data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brand profile data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visualized data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Big data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Small data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Competitive data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transactional data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pinpointing Key Indicators in Your Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outliers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peaks and valleys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Correlations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Industry trends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Waste. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 318 318 318 319 319 320 320 321 322 324 325 325 326 327 327 328 Table of Contents xiii CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 5: xiv Using Your Data as the Foundation of Your Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying Data Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data from your owned media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data from social media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data from public channels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analyzing Your Data on a Regular Basis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 329 329 332 334 335 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media . . . . . . . . . . 337 Taking Advantage of Television (With or Without the Budget). . . . . . Looking at Millennial TV viewing habits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reaching viewers with the second screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Targeting Millennials with Print Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reaching Millennials in magazines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting with Millennials through the use of newspapers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The case for investing in print media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The case for abandoning print media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Incorporating Email into Your Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating messages specifically for email. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tying email into your traditional and new media strategies. . . . . Building subject lines and headings that generate opens. . . . . . . 338 338 339 341 342 343 344 344 344 345 345 346 Experimenting with the Share Economy. . . . . . . . . . . 349 Positioning Your Brand Around Sharing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . You have an active community forum. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . You have a peer-to-peer opportunity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . You can afford short-term opportunity costs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Your product or service has an online component . . . . . . . . . . . . Establishing a Voice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mapping your target audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a content strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Running a Niche Campaign for the Share Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encouraging Audience Participation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reaching out to your existing database. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Leveraging native video ads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Targeting ads to the share economy audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing incentivized adoption schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Measuring Results. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Is the goal to build a new community?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Are there secondary goals that extend beyond the share economy? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Should you place a timeline on secondary goals? . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 350 350 351 351 351 352 352 355 356 356 357 357 357 357 358 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies 358 359 CHAPTER 6: Developing the Brand Experience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Creating a Brand Experience Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 What is the ideal medium for a first interaction?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 Where will your efforts to educate switch to efforts to sell?. . . . . 363 Will you invest in establishing multiple entry points? . . . . . . . . . . 363 How does the experience differ from prospects to customers?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 An example road map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 Identifying Touchpoints for Your Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 Checking Off Elements for Each Touchpoint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366 Developing a Customer Relationship. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 Engaging users with conversational content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 Sharing useful information that highlights your expertise. . . . . . 368 Offering first-time customers specials, freebies, or deals. . . . . . . 368 Building trust by sharing third-party content that mentions your brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368 Segmenting Your Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 Creating experience-specific content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370 Unifying your content across every channel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372 Integrating the Experience for an Omni-Channel Strategy. . . . . . . . . 373 Creating an identifiable theme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Using a tracking mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Repeating the campaign title or slogan on all media. . . . . . . . . . . 374 Facilitating movement in any direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Ensuring that all assets are easily discoverable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 Tracking the Brand Experience Across Different Media . . . . . . . . . . . 375 A tag management system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 Trackable links. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 Segmentation of data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 Running Brand Experience Campaigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Increasing brand engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378 Driving brand awareness. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Building a new, segmented audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Selling more product. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Garnering customer loyalty. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 Fostering relationships. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 Launching a well-rounded campaign. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 BOOK 5: IMPLEMENTING CHANNEL PROMOTIONS. . . . . . 383 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 CHAPTER 1: Understanding Types of Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Reviewing each media type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 Determining your needs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 Table of Contents xv Utilizing Paid Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 Discovering retargeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 Dealing with native advertising. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 Considering programmatic buying. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 Finding out what you need to know from advertisers. . . . . . . . . . 391 Championing Earned Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Enhancing Shared Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 Amplifying Owned Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 Looking at the role of press releases. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 Spreading the message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395 Creating a Framework for Achieving the Right Mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 Section 1: Owned channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 Section 2: Shared media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Section 3: Paid ads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398 Section 4: Earned media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 Section 5: Evaluate and revise. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 CHAPTER 2: Using Search Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Knowing the Three Key Players in Search Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402 Understanding searchers’ needs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402 Knowing what search engines want. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402 Targeting Search Queries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 Defining a search query. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406 Choosing the right queries to target. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407 Satisfying searchers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 Optimizing Your Assets for Specific Channels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Optimizing for Google. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412 Optimizing for YouTube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Optimizing for Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Optimizing for Amazon. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 Optimizing for iTunes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 Optimizing for review sites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .420 Optimizing for search engine robots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 Earning Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 Step 1: Cross-link your own content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 Step 2: Study your competitors’ links. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 Step 3: Create generous content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 Step 4: Create content worthy of a link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 Step 5: Publish primary research . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424 Step 6: Keep up with the news . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424 CHAPTER 3: Making Content Shareable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Embracing Shareability as a Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Understanding sharing patterns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426 Sharing as a bottom-line issue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 xvi Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies CHAPTER 4: Uncovering the Five Ws and One H of Online Sharing. . . . . . . . . . . . . Knowing who shares content, and why. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Considering what they share. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discovering when they share. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Observing where they share . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at how people share content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adding Social Bookmarking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making SEO a Priority. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deploying Hashtags to Encourage Sharing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding hashtags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using hashtag tools. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429 430 431 433 433 434 435 436 438 438 439 Considering Email Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 Understanding Marketing Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promotional emails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Relational emails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transactional emails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sending Broadcast and Triggered Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Broadcast emails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Triggered emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building a Promotional Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cataloging your products and services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating an annual promotional plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing a marketing plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a 30-day calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a 90-day rolling calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating Email Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Indoctrination campaigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engagement campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ascension campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Segmentation campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reengagement campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Writing and Designing Effective Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Harvesting proven email copy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Answering four questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knowing why people buy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Writing effective email subject lines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Writing body copy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cuing the click . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting More Clicks and Opens. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ensuring Email Deliverability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitoring your reputation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Proving subscriber engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444 444 445 445 447 447 447 448 448 450 451 452 453 453 454 456 456 457 458 459 459 460 460 461 462 463 463 466 466 467 Table of Contents xvii BOOK 6: CONNECTING WITH INFLUENCERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469 Communicating with Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 CHAPTER 1: Defining Influencer Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472 Identifying the Primary Influencer Platforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473 Blogs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473 Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474 Twitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 Facebook. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 Engaging Stellar Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .477 Starting with women. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478 Finding people who create great content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478 Perfecting your pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479 Signing a contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479 Paying influencers for their time and effort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480 Measuring the right stuff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481 Making Influencer Marketing Work for You . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 If you’re an established consumer brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 If you’re a small to midsize consumer brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485 If you’re a startup brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487 CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: xviii Collaborating to Win. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489 Discovering the Evolving Role of Influencers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the six principles of persuasion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding why influencers ­matter more now . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding how to measure expert influencers . . . . . . . . . . . Recognizing Influencer Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding the Right Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discovering the influencers you need to target . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing a system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Uncovering New Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Influencing with Customer Advocacy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Enhancing Word of Mouth (WOM) with Advertising. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting with your audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Identifying factors for WOM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Paid Influencer Programs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489 490 492 494 494 496 496 499 501 501 504 504 505 505 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” . . . . . . . . 509 Communicating Like a Pro. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making your communication personal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making your offer compelling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keeping it real: Do’s and don’ts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 510 511 513 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies CHAPTER 4: Upping Your Game: Creating an Influencer Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting expectations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Controlling what you need to control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protecting yourself and your brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Compensating Influencers Fairly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding why you need to pay influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Avoiding compensation pitfalls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at the going rates for influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514 515 515 516 517 518 519 521 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 Secret #1: Set Realistic Campaign Goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 What are you trying to achieve? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524 How will you assess your achievements? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524 How will you achieve your goals? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525 When will the campaign run?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .526 Secret #2: Know Your Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 Who’s talking about you?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 Where are they talking about you?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528 Secret #3: Stay on Message. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528 Marketing plan = Rocket ship . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529 Messaging = Flight plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529 Social media = Rocket fuel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529 Secret #4: Be Agile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529 Secret #5: Recognize the Power of Emotional Stories. . . . . . . . . . . . . 530 Secret #6: You Get What You Measure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: Getting Creative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533 Getting Creative and Letting Go . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Walking the walk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Are you having fun yet? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Go for it! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . What If It All Goes Wrong? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preventing a crisis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Managing a crisis (if it happens anyway). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533 534 535 537 538 538 540 Working with an Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 So, You Want to Hire an Influencer Marketing Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . May I borrow your relationships?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How it works: Self-service versus full-service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deciding Which Type of Agency Is Right for You. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . One-Off Events versus Continuity Campaigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Making a big splash for maximum effect. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Putting in the hours for a long-term relationship. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 544 545 547 547 548 548 Table of Contents xix BOOK 7: FACEBOOK MARKETING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: 549 Delving into Facebook Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551 What Is Facebook, and Why Is It So Popular? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the Marketing Potential of Facebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . Leveraging the power of word-of-mouth marketing. . . . . . . . . . . Using marketing tools for all kinds of businesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding Why Your Business Needs a Facebook Page. . . . . . . Attracting new fans who are friends of customers . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing first-time customers into repeat customers . . . . . . . . . 552 553 554 556 557 559 559 Creating a Facebook Marketing Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 Understanding the Power of Word of Mouth on Facebook . . . . . . . . 562 Understanding Your Facebook Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563 Defining Your Marketing Goals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565 Building awareness of your brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566 Driving sales. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567 Forming a community with a Facebook Group. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568 Listening to feedback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569 Developing Your Content Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570 Encouraging Audience Engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572 Creating a rich, customer-centric experience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572 Appreciating your fans and growing your base . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573 Monitoring and Reporting Page Activity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .575 Using Insights for Pages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 576 Creating benchmarks and setting goals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 577 Keeping an eye on key metrics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578 Integrating Your Online and Offline Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579 Deciding on a media budget . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580 Hiring an online writer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581 CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: Selling Products and Services Using Facebook Offers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583 Understanding Facebook Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating an Offer for Your Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting the Most from Your Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting Your Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting your offer on your Facebook Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting your offer with Facebook Ads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting your offer through other marketing channels . . . . . . 584 585 587 588 588 589 589 Uniting Facebook with Other Social Media. . . . . . . . 591 Making Facebook Part of Your Marketing Mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592 Posting content new fans can engage with. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593 Choosing a custom Facebook username. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593 xx Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies Cross-promoting your Page. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Leveraging your Facebook presence via email, website, and blog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Promoting Your Facebook Presence Offline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Networking offline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Placing the Facebook logo on signs and in store windows. . . . . . Referencing your Page in ads and product literature . . . . . . . . . . Optimizing Your Page for Search Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using search engine optimization to drive traffic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Driving more Likes to your Page. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Integrating Instagram into Your Other Marketing Channels . . . . . . . Making a plan for Instagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Utilizing Instastories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting Inside Your Customers’ Heads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHAPTER 5: CHAPTER 6: 595 596 597 597 598 598 598 599 600 601 601 602 604 Getting into Instagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607 Promoting Your Brand on Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Your Instagram Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sharing photos. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Controlling notifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Determining What Is Photo-Worthy for Your Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Hashtags in Your Instagram Posts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding Friends and Fans on Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Instastories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608 609 609 611 612 613 614 615 Promoting Advanced Customer Engagement. . . . . 617 Using Facebook Messenger to Communicate with Customers . . . . . Benefitting from Messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding guidelines for Messenger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Enabling Messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing a Better Customer Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Providing customer service with chatbots. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Messenger chatbots. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing chatbots. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advertising with Messenger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting Started with Facebook Live . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at the benefits of live streaming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the guidelines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up Facebook Live . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating broadcasts that connect with customers. . . . . . . . . . . . . 617 618 618 619 619 620 620 628 628 630 631 631 632 638 Table of Contents xxi BOOK 8: DEPLOYING OTHER SOCIAL MEDIA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHAPTER 1: CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: 641 Leveraging Social Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643 Thinking Strategically about Social Media Integration. . . . . . . . . . . . . Integrating Social Media with E-Newsletters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gaining more subscribers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding more followers and connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding and sharing content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Integrating Social Media with Press Releases. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up an online newsroom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cultivating influencers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Distributing your news. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Emphasizing content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressing for attention. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Measuring results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Integrating Social Media with Your Website . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coupons, discounts, and freebies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Contests and games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microsites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Private membership sites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643 644 646 647 647 649 650 650 651 653 654 654 655 656 657 657 658 Working with Twitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659 Finding the Right People to Follow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Finding Out Who Is Talking about You on Twitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Responding to Tweets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Searching on Twitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tweeting Like a Pro. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Articulating in 280 characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sharing on Twitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knowing when to @reply and direct message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Retweeting and being retweeted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Blocking people. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a successful Twitter campaign. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using keywords in your tweets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Following the Twitter Rules of Etiquette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hosting a Tweet-Up. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659 660 661 662 663 664 665 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 Looking at YouTube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 673 Looking at YouTube Basics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .674 Benefitting from social media marketing on YouTube . . . . . . . . . 674 Attracting subscribers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675 Promoting on YouTube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676 Always create a customized channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676 Create custom content for YouTube . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677 Tag and categorize all your clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677 Promote your video with YouTube Email and Bulletins . . . . . . . . 678 xxii Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies Leave video responses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Include a call to action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Have some fun, too. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seeding a Viral Campaign. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advertising on YouTube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 679 680 680 680 683 Reviewing Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685 Understanding Pinterest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting Started. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigating Pinterest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up your Pinterest profile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting on Board. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Planning your initial boards. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating your first board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pinning on Pinterest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pinning an image. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tagging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Following on Pinterest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Following friends. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Following folks you don’t know. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sharing on Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sharing other people’s pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using share buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Driving Traffic with Pinterest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Being descriptive but brief. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using keywords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building Your Pinterest Community. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collaborating with group boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Commenting on pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing nice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 686 687 689 690 692 693 694 695 695 699 699 699 700 700 700 701 702 704 705 706 706 707 708 BOOK 9: ANALYZING DATA FOR SUCCESS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711 CHAPTER 4: CHAPTER 1: Looking Back at Your Business Model. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 713 Validating Business Models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking at change. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Revising your business model canvas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reexamining your brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Enhancing your business models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing Your Brand Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Refreshing Visual Branding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding what your branding means . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surveying about brand awareness. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Locating a survey company. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714 714 715 716 716 717 718 718 720 721 Table of Contents xxiii CHAPTER 2: CHAPTER 3: CHAPTER 4: INDEX xxiv Reassessing Your Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723 Allowing for Failed Experiments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Looking Back at Your Digital Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reviewing goals and KPIs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Assessing content maturity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reevaluating your ecosystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723 725 726 726 727 Reviewing Ongoing Improvement for B2B Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 731 Ongoing Account Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Delivering reports and results. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creating a review process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Executing on tasks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauging Potential Opportunities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Limiting the margin for error. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Anticipating future needs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building an engagement report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Providing Added Value. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Living up to expectations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Continuing to improve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 732 732 734 735 736 736 737 737 738 738 739 Achieving Maximum ROI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741 Understanding Split Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Following the split test guidelines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting Page Elements to Optimize. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Considering qualitative data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using qualitative tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Getting Ready to Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing an optimization hypothesis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Choosing the metrics to track . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Calculating your test timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparing to Launch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining goals in Google Analytics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking that your page renders correctly in all browsers. . . . . . Ensuring that you have no testing conflicts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keeping variation load times similar or identical. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Calling a Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knowing How a Test Performed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analyzing the Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742 744 746 746 747 748 748 749 749 750 750 750 750 751 751 751 752 752 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies Introduction A ccording to Statista, in 2018, 4.2 billion people were active Internet users and 3.4 billion were social media users. That means that no matter what business you’re in, it’s pretty likely that you can reach your audience online. You can move slowly and add digital marketing tactics and social media platforms as you go, or you can jump in and make digital marketing priority one. Either way, you can’t avoid the journey. You need to have a digital marketing plan. Your competitors have one. So where do you start? Well, first you have to create a strategy and then determine the tactics that will support it. With Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies, you can sort out all the “should dos” and “nice to dos” from the “must dos.” You need a clear path that will prevent you from spending too much time on the things that don’t matter. The most beautiful website is a great ideal, but if you don’t do essential tasks such as create great content, effectively target your audience, and collect key data, you’re not going to be successful. About This Book To make sure you have all the information you need, this book includes 9 books that cover the following major topics: »» Book 1: Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy: Examine your overall goals and determine the strategy that will help you reach them. »» Book 2: Uncovering the Customer Experience: Look at the impact that the right customer experience can have on converting prospects to loyal customers. »» Book 3: Dipping into Content Creation: Great content gives you a competitive advantage, so you look at the keys to making your brand memorable. »» Book 4: Reaching Your Millennial Audience: Millennials now make up the largest block of consumers. Find out what they want and how to deliver it in a way that gets their attention. Introduction 1 »» Book 5: Implementing Channel Promotions: See what type of promotions suits your audience and how to use search and email marketing to reach them. »» Book 6: Connecting with Influencers: Working with influencers is gaining in popularity as digital marketers find that it’s a fast way to break through the noise. See what you need to do to work with the right influencers. »» Book 7: Facebook Marketing: You can’t ignore Facebook. See how you can use its marketing capabilities to the fullest. »» Book 8: Deploying Other Social Media: Find out which other social platforms your audience uses. Is it Instagram, Pinterest, Twitter, YouTube? See what you need to do to find and engage. »» Book 9: Analyzing Data for Success: The right data makes the difference between a good campaign and a failure. See what metrics you should be tracking. Icons Used in This Book Throughout this book, you see different icons. Here’s what they mean: The Tip icon showcases information that can make doing things easier or faster. The Remember icon points out things you need to remember when searching your memory bank. The Warning icon alerts you to things that can be harmful to you or your company. Where to Go from Here Like all For Dummies books, you can read the chapters in any order you prefer. Start anywhere you like. However, if you’re new to digital marketing you’ll ­probably want to start with Book 1 to learn how to lay the foundation for your overall strategy. Then consider reading Book 2 that shows you why and how your ­customer’s experience is crucial to your success. 2 Digital Marketing All-in-One For Dummies If you want to focus on specific audiences, go to Books 4 and 6 to find out more information about targeting millennials and influencers respectively. The rest of the books (3, 5, and 7-9) focus on the mechanics of content creation, the use of social media, channel promotions, and data analytics. There’s also an online cheat sheet. Go to dummies.com and type Digital M ­ arketing All-in-One For Dummies in the Search box to find it. On the cheat sheet you will find information about resources to monitor your brand reputation, reasons to work with influences, how to track your content performance, and other useful information. Introduction 3 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy . . . . . . . . . . 7 Understanding the Components of a Digital Marketing Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Communicating Your Mission. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Establishing Your Goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Expanding Your Corporate Mindset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Dipping into User Design and Habits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 CHAPTER 2: Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer. . . . . . . . 29 Focusing on Attention. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Making Your Content Easy to Consume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Deploying Interactive Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 CHAPTER 3: Discovering Your Business Model and Brand. . . . . 45 Separating Your Business Model from Your Brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analyzing Your Business Model. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discovering Your Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solidifying the Look of the Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Developing Success Measures for Your Brand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Producing Engaging Branded Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHAPTER 4: Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Establishing Marketing Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining a Digital Marketing Campaign. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding the Three Major Types of Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . Balancing Your Marketing Campaign Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Choosing the Campaign You Need Now . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing Your Digital Marketing through the Campaign Lens. . . . . . CHAPTER 5: 68 69 71 76 77 78 Crafting Offers That Sell. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Offering Value in Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing an Ungated Offer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing a Gated Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Designing Deep-Discount Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximizing Profit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHAPTER 6: 46 56 57 60 64 65 80 81 82 92 96 Planning B2B Campaign Success . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Setting Key Performance Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Testing Your Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Knowing You Aren’t Wasting Money. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Formulating your business goals »» Picking your key performance indicators (KPIs) »» Catching customers with the Five Cs »» Serving your customers using content »» Building product habits Chapter 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy C ompanies have finally recognized what their customers have always known. If they can’t find the content that makes your product easy to use and enjoy, they are off to seek out your competitor. You’ve missed the opportunity to impress them or, in some cases, even get on their radar screen. This chapter covers what goes into creating a digital marketing strategy. Without it, you can’t get the traction you need to beat the competition. You also discover each of the “Five Cs” that must be included to make your strategy complete. Understanding the Components of a Digital Marketing Strategy To understand how the pieces of a digital marketing strategy fit together, the components are organized into a framework called the Five Cs. They are (1) ­company strategy; (2) customer experience; (3); content creation (4), channel promotions, and (5) check-back analysis. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 7 Working with the Five Cs framework helps you cover all the bases as you create your digital marketing strategy and implement your plan Determining the company strategy The first C is company strategy. To create a digital marketing strategy, you need to begin by looking at your company’s business goals. The question to ask yourself and your team is, “What do we want the company to achieve and how do we make it happen?” You should direct your attention to your goals and business case for undertaking this effort. To that end, Book 1 covers the following topics: »» Create a digital marketing strategy. Several components go into a successful marketing strategy. Keep reading this chapter to find out more as well as the subsequent chapters in this book. »» Get your customers’ attention. Marketers are fiercely competing for your customers’ attention. Find out how to capture it in Book1, Chapter 2. »» Understand your business model and your brand. Learn about a variety of business models and how to determine what “job” your product does. You look at brand components in Book 1, Chapter 3. »» Decide which marketing campaign to create. After you understand your goals, you can choose the right marketing campaign. See what to consider in Book 1, Chapter 4. »» Develop the strongest offers. You look at how to turn leads into customers by crafting winning offers in Book 1, Chapter 5. Uncovering the customer experience The second of the Five Cs is customer experience covered in Book 2. You need to learn what your prospects will think, feel, and do when interacting with your brand. The question for your marketing team to ask is, “Who are our prospects and how will we serve them as customers?” You must define your audience and analyze the customer experience. You do this with the following: »» Collect and analyze customer data. Before you define your audience, you need to evaluate the kind of data you will use. In Book 2, Chapter 1, you look 8 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy at the benefits and challenges you may face when dealing with big data to analyze your audience. »» Create personas. You define the characteristics of your perfect audience by investigating several different types of information. Find out what actions you need to takein Book 2, Chapter 2. »» Develop the buyer journey. You want to understand the journey your prospect takes from being interested in your product to sold on it. Book 2, Chapter 3 looks at the buyer’s mindset and gives you a model to help you document your customer’s touchpoints. »» Assist with sales enablement. Your sales team is facing an empowered customer. Find out in Book 2, Chapter 4 how your content can assist in making the job easier and more powerful. You can also determine where your company falls on the content maturity scale. Creating quality content The third C is content creation, which is covered in Book 3. You need to focus on creating quality content (based on your story) that you know your customers want and need. The question to ask is, “How will we create quality content, who will do it, and what will that content be?” You need to develop a strategy for content, define your messaging, and establish your systems and governance rules. The chapters in tBook 3 take you through: »» Create a content strategy. You should have both a content plan and a content marketing strategy. In Book 3, Chapter 1, you see how to take an audit of your content to determine what you have and how you can leverage it to develop a true corporate asset. »» Develop content types. You want to ensure that you take full advantage of all the types of content available to you. Book 3, Chapter 2 covers various types including long- and short-form original content, curated content, and visual content. »» Know what your customers want. You learn how marketing funnels help you reach your entire audience. See how in Book 3, Chapter 3. »» Write and storytell. You have a story to tell that will connect with your audience. How do you incorporate it into your content? See Book 3, Chapter 4 to get a feel for the science behind why stories work and how to develop your own powerful corporate stories. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 9 »» Create processes and systems. You know that without a documented workflow and procedures, your content marketing efforts fail. Book 3, Chapter 5 spells out the roles and responsibilities of your content team and shows you the benefits of using an editorial calendar. »» Target content for each audience. Your company needs to build a resource library that customers can access without contacting you. Find out what you should put in that library in Book 3, Chapter 6. Developing channel promotions The fourth C is channel promotion, which you find in Book 5. To have your content make the greatest impact, you want to decide where and by whom your content will be distributed. The question to ask is, “How will our prospects and customers find our content so that they can choose us?” You want to make your content easy to find and share. You need to know how to promote your content so that prospects can find it. »» Use paid, earned, shared, and owned media for maximum reach. Making the most of all types of media is the only way to ensure that your brand voice will be heard. Look to Book 5, Chapter 1 to learn about the value of these types of media and why earned media is gaining in importance. »» Use search marketing. Although search marketing is constantly changing, you can’t ignore its value. See Book 5, Chapter 2 to see what you need to know. »» Create sharable content. Sharing is key to any content plan. Book 5, Chapter 3 looks at why you should embrace shareability as a strategy and borrow from journalism’s five Ws and one H (who, what, why, where, when, how) as applied to sharing. »» Add an email marketing campaign. Everyone loves and hates email. But it’s still a very important tactic to use to reach customers. See what you need to do to use it effectively in Book 5, Chapter 4. Deploying check-back analysis The fifth C is check-back analysis, which is covered in Book 9. The focus here is on the metrics you choose to determine successes or failure. The question to ask is, “Have we met our goals?” 10 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy DON’T BE LEFT OUT When creating your strategy, knowing what other companies with high growth do is helpful. According to a study done by Accenture called “CMOs: Time for digital transformation or risk being left on the sidelines” a large percentage of high-growth companies: • • • Use data and analytics to improve the impact of their marketing (86 percent) Know that digital channels are of strategic importance (84 percent) Make sure that customers get a similar experience across all channels (80 percent) You want to reevaluate your plans and make revisions as necessary: »» Reassess your business model and brand value. You know that it’s important to frequently assess how things are working. Find out how you can determine whether business model changes are warranted and whether you need to revise brand plans in Book 9, Chapter 1. »» Reexamine your content marketing strategy. Obviously, a determination of how well your content marketing strategy is working is essential. See why even failing is a springboard to success in Book 9, Chapter 2. »» Measure success. If you’re tracking key accounts you need to reassess your goals for each one. See what you need to do in Book 9, Chapter 3. »» Track metrics. It’s helpful to gauge potential new opportunities as you track your metrics. See what’s involved with that in Book 9, Chapter 4. »» Optimize campaigns for return on investment (ROI). Using split testing and analyzing the speed of your pages is key to optimizing your campaigns. Find out how how do this in Book 9, Chapter 5. So that’s an overview of the Five Cs. Each of the books encompassing them includes far more information and working plans than listed here. If you do the hard work required to create and implement your plans, you can expect to be on the road to content marketing success. Communicating Your Mission When you hear the term mission statement, you probably want to skip to the next section in this chapter. Completely understandable. At some point while you were in school, you were taught about mission statements and you found it boring. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 11 But the good news is that now, when you look at communicating the reason your company exists, a mission statement becomes important and personal. Crafting your statement In his book Epic Content: How to How to Tell a Different Story, Break through the Clutter, and Win More Customers by Marketing Less (McGraw-Hill Education, 2013), Joe Pulizzi, “the godfather of content marketing” and founder of the Content Marketing Institute (see Figure 1-1), offers an easy way to craft a content marketing mission statement. FIGURE 1-1: Content ­Marketing Institute. Pulizzi says to break down the statement into three parts: »» Whom you will serve: The core audience you’re targeting »» What solution you will offer: What you will deliver to that audience »» The outcome: How it will make them better 12 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy Here’s a breakdown of what goes into each of these sections: »» The target audience: Before you determine the characteristics of your personas (Book 2, Chapter 2 covers personas in detail), you have to identify the niche(s) that work best for you. Aside from doing market research, you need to pick a very narrow group to target. When defining their niche, some companies are afraid to rule out anyone. They think that they may eliminate an important customer segment. But narrowing down the target is exactly what makes this tactic so powerful. By defining your niche carefully, you know that you’re speaking to the people who are interested in hearing your message. You can always add segments later, but remember this: When you target everyone, you don’t connect with anyone. »» Your solution: This may seem like the simple part of the formula, but it’s only deceptively simple. You know what your product does. But in your mission statement, you want to communicate the solution as a promise to meet your customer’s needs. »» Your desired effect: In this section, you want to spell out what need your product satisfies. Clearly identifying this need is key to determining whether customers believe you fulfilled your promise to them. As you look at your company’s goals, you want them to align with your content marketing strategy. If those goals don’t align with your strategy, you need to determine what revisions to make. Reviewing real mission statements Now that you’ve looked at what goes into creating a mission statement, you can see how it plays out in real life. In her article “12 Truly Inspiring Company Vision and Mission Statement Examples,” as shown in Figure 1-2, Lindsay Kolowich gives some examples to work with (http://blog.hubspot.com/marketing/ inspiring-company-mission-statements). You can deconstruct a few that hit the mark by looking at their mission statements and seeing how the formula fits. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 13 FIGURE 1-2: HubSpot blog. »» Patagonia mission statement: “Build the best product, cause no unnecessary harm, use business to inspire and implement solutions to the environmental crisis” (http://Patagonia.com; see Figure 1-3). • • • Who the company serves: People who love outdoor activities What the solution is: High quality clothing to fight the elements What the outcome is: Deliver excellent clothing under superior working conditions that do not damage the environment This is an effective one-sentence mission statement that is clear and defines Patagonia’s commitment to its customers and the environment. »» Warby Parker mission statement: “Warby Parker was founded with a rebellious spirit and a lofty objective: to offer designer eyewear at a revolutionary price, while leading the way for socially-conscious businesses” (http://warbyparker.com; see Figure 1-4). • • • 14 Who the company serves: Fashion-forward eyeglass wearers What the solution is: Designer eyewear at a revolutionary price What the outcome is: Fairly priced eyewear to customers and a program that teaches people in underdeveloped countries to prescribe free eyewear to those in need. BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy FIGURE 1-3: Patagonia. FIGURE 1-4: Warby Parker. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 15 This is another one-sentence mission statement that succinctly communicates Warby Parker’s desire to provide well-priced designer eyewear and a commitment to help fund socially-conscious businesses. »» Ikea mission statement: “At Ikea our vision is to create a better everyday life for the many people. Our business idea supports this vision by offering a wide range of well-designed, functional home furnishing products at prices so low that as many people as possible will be able to afford them.” • Who the company serves: People who want well designed products but can’t afford expensive items. • • What the solution is: Functional home products at low prices What the outcome is: Create a better everyday life for as many people as possible. With this statement Ikea clearly communicates its desire to help people afford well-designed products. These companies make crafting mission statements look easy. But they probably spent a lot of time and effort to get them just right. A mission statement can help employees serve their customers and feel pride in their organization. So for both your employees and your customers, consider adding your mission statement to your website. In her article, Kolowich quotes Simon Sinek, author of the book, Start With Why, as saying, “Customers will never love a company until the employees love it first.” Establishing Your Goals After you’ve established your mission statement, you can focus on your company goals. In Book 1, Chapter 3, you take a close look at your business model and create a business model canvas. Doing the exercises in that chapter should prepare you to articulate your goals. The following sections give you a brief look at how to formulate goals. Uncovering your goals When looking at formulating your own goals, it can be useful to see what other marketers report were their top goals achieved for B2B content marketing. According to the 2019 report by the Content Marketing Institute/Marketing Profs, (https:// www.slideshare.net/CMI/b2b-content-marketing-2019-benchmarksbudgets-and-trendsnorth-america) (see Figure 1-5), the top organizational goals achieved by B2B content marketing are the following: 16 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy »» Brand awareness: 81 percent »» Educate audiences: 73 percent »» Build credibility/trust 68 percent »» Generate demand/leads: 68 percent »» Nurture subscribers/audiences/leads: 58 percent FIGURE 1-5: 2019 ­Benchmarks, Budgets, and Trends — North America Survey. The report indicates that 2019 was the eighth year that brand awareness came in at the top spot. Next you find out how to set measures to track your goals. Picking KPIs After you establish your goals, you need to develop key performance indicators (KPIs). KPIs are the measures you choose to help you determine whether you’re reaching your business goals. You need them to keep your strategy on track. If you CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 17 don’t measure yourself against your business goals, you won’t know whether your content marketing strategy is working and supporting your larger business goals. To help you think about how to craft your KPIs in relation to your marketing goals, check out Table 1-1. You can apply the table to your marketing plan as well. List your goals and then choose some metrics. Then refer to this list when you check your progress. TABLE 1-1 Choosing KPIs CMI/Marketing Profs B2B Top Goals Suggested Metrics Increase brand awareness Social media shares, social media likes, email forwards, referral links Lead generation Lead nurturing Blog signups, blog comments, conversion rate, form completions Increase engagement Comments, page depth (how many pages consumed), downloads, page views, back links, time on site, click through rate Grow sales revenue by X percent Revenue influenced by content (which content was consumed before sale), offline sales Improve customer retention/loyalty Bounce rate, followers, retention rate Encourage customer evangelism Social media shares, comments, follower count, word of mouth Increase upsells/cross-sells Measure conversions in shopping cart and on landing pages, number of conversions Expanding Your Corporate Mindset Every company has its own culture. The culture dictates how and why tasks get done. If your culture is a positive one, you’re probably focused obsessively on serving your customers, and you’re proud of your reputation. Have you thought about how your culture, reputation, and customer service impact your content marketing strategy? You can examine that next. 18 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Does your company have a culture of content (CoC)? Content creation and marketing is front and center in today’s businesses, so it’s no surprise that it could become part of an organization’s DNA. The term CoC was popularized by the Altimeter Group’s authors Rebecca Lieb and Jessica Groopman in their study cited here: http://rebeccalieb.com/blog/2014/ 12/04/the-three-components-of-a-culture-of-content. (See Figure 1-6.) FIGURE 1-6: Rebecca Lieb. So what is a culture of content? It’s one in which: »» Content is championed. »» Content is shared throughout the organization. »» People are encouraged to be creative with content. »» Staff from every department can contribute content. »» The company has a tolerance for risk and failure with content. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 19 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy Creating a culture of content Does this sound like your organization? Or a better question might be, “Wouldn’t you like your organization to function like this?” Trying to move your organization in this direction would be worthwhile. Your organization can benefit from a CoC in several ways. It can get: »» Better quality content (and quantity): People who are encouraged to be creative and become part of a content team create better content and contribute more often. »» More content sharing: People who are proud of the content the organization (and they) are creating are more likely to share it. »» A competitive edge: A company that champions content and places a high value on its creation stands out from the crowd. »» More valuable data to analyze: More and better content provides valuable data. How can you foster a CoC? Dawn Papandrea details in her article, “How to Create a Culture of Content Marketing from the Top Down” (http://www. columnfivemedia.com/how-to-create-a-culture-of-content-marketingfrom-the-top-down; see Figure 1-7), some of successful entrepreneur Marcus Sheridan’s (https://marcussheridan.com/) steps for creating a content culture. FIGURE 1-7: Column Five Media. 20 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy Here are a few of those eight tips: »» Get buy-in from the top. Make sure to have support from your executives if you’re going to undertake a content marketing strategy. No project can survive the disinterest of management. »» Share the same vision. All good company cultures thrive because they have a shared vision of what they want to achieve. This is especially crucial for a culture that needs to rely on content contributions from staff. »» Appoint a Chief Content Officer. You need a champion to encourage content marketing efforts. Have a person dedicated to the program’s success. It’s important to show employees that you’re investing in the program. »» Support and maintain the content culture. Make sure that everyone on the team is convinced of the importance of content and keeps the culture at the forefront. Most companies that have a content culture agree on one important ingredient: training. They believe that without training their staff to recognize, create, and share content of value, they will not succeed. Thinking about reputation The importance of reputation is obvious to almost everyone. But you probably don’t think about how your company’s reputation contributes to the acceptance of your content and vice versa. When readers see your branded content, they need to make an immediate decision. They have to decide whether you’re trustworthy enough to continue reading. If they decide that you’re not, they click away. If they see a review of your business, they can be swayed by negative comments. But how much does this really matter to your bottom line? According to a press release by IC Media Direct, shown in Figure 1-8, “It has been calculated by the Harvard Business School that each star in a Yelp rating increases a business’ sales by 5 to 9%. And a bump up from 3.5 to 4 stars on Yelp typically results in a 19% increase of restaurant bookings during peak business hours.” That’s quite an impact. Yet companies are typically very lax about reputation management as part of their content marketing strategy. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 21 FIGURE 1-8: IC Media Direct. You need to monitor online content to ensure that your reputation stays intact. Here are a few habits to consider building into your content marketing strategy: »» Continually listen. The conversation about your business is going on 24 hours a day. You need to be ready to respond to anything that could affect your customer’s perception of you. Make sure to read review sites and other user-generated content about your business regularly, right along with your customers. »» Monitor your brand names and products. Set up alerts for your product and brand names. You don’t want to miss a brewing problem. »» Link to all your sites to create a wide perspective. Don’t make your customers dig for information about you. Be sure to link to all your owned media and social media sites. »» Maintain strict content governance. You should have a content governance system set up. Make sure that your system is in force so that erroneous or poor quality content doesn’t have a lasting effect on your reputation. It’s just good common sense as well as a security defense. Why open your company to lawsuits or negative press? »» Create and distribute case studies and testimonials. Blow your own horn so that others can form a positive opinion about your company. Case studies and testimonials should be a staple on your website. 22 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Get ready to hear something you won’t like: You need to make customer service a part of your content marketing strategy. Marketers tend not to like thinking this way because it’s not as sexy as creating great blog posts that get you buzz, and it requires extra effort. If your organization takes this section’s advice to heart, though, you will see ­several important benefits including: »» An increase in customer loyalty and retention »» Happier, more educated customers »» A better understanding of your customer’s problems »» An opportunity to provide real solutions All these benefits go straight to the bottom line. Tony Hsieh applied this customer service strategy to his company Zappos (http:// zappos.com), and it was acquired by Amazon for $1.2 billion. Perhaps you should consider trying it. So how should you apply your customer service strategy to your content marketing strategy? Think for a moment about how you provide customer service now. You probably provide data sheets, product documentation, email support, and, if you’re ambitious, social media platform support. But here’s the truth: This approach is wholly inadequate for the content-intensive world you live in today. You need to look at your website, your other owned sites, and your social sites to see how you can focus on adding customer service content to each one. You likely believe that customers are at the center of your strategy. However, you might have that wrong. You might be customer centric rather than customer focused, according to J-P De Clerck in his article, “Content marketing: a customercentric manifesto” (http://www.i-scoop.eu/content-marketing-customercentric; see Figure 1-9). De Clerck cites Peter Fader’s book Customer Centricity: Focus on the Right Customers for Strategic Advantage (Wharton Digital Press), which says that customer centricity means focusing on the high-value customer and marketing to that segment. This is not to say that you completely ignore your other customers. It means that you focus a great deal of effort on the customers with the highest potential ­customer lifetime value. Customer lifetime value (CLV) refers to the profit you expect to make over the lifetime of a specific customer. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 23 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy Using content to serve customers FIGURE 1-9: I-Scoop. Monetate’s infographic cited in the article is found here (https://www. monetate.com/infographic/what-does-it-mean-to-be-customer-centric). (See ­Figure 1-10.) Monetate is a customer analytics firm. So what should you do regarding customer service content after you identify these high-CLV customers? You should create content that addresses their specific needs and distribute it on the following: »» Support sites: Look at the content you provide for support sites. Is it dull and boring? Your customers want to be entertained as well as educated. Think about how you can make this content more appealing. »» Social media platforms: You may already answer support questions on these sites, but do you provide links to interesting help content? Probably not. Try to think about putting links to all the content you create for your customers. »» Guest postings: You’re probably not thinking about customer service when you send guest posts. But aiming your post toward customer service isn’t hard to do. Just make it something that is “in service” to the reader. »» Webinars: You likely have webinar content that serves customers. Repurpose it as podcasts or video to spread your message. Your strategy should include content targeted at helping your most valuable ­customers find the information they need. 24 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy FIGURE 1-10: Monetate’s I­nfographic ­showing what it means to be c­ ustomer centric. Dipping into User Design and Habits Two additional issues to be aware of when you’re constructing your content marketing plan are the user experience (UX) and your customer’s habits. Both are related to content in a very specific way: »» The UX: This UX is not about the buyer journey that the user takes on the road to making a purchase. (The buyer journey is covered in Book 2, Chapter 3.) The UX is the experience the user has while navigating your sites and reading your content. It’s about the design elements you employ to communicate your content marketing strategy. »» Habits: Your customer’s habits impact the adoption of your product. When you know how to attach the use of your product to customers’ habits, you’re more likely to persuade them to buy. The content you create to get your customers on board with your products will have a big effect and must be part of your strategy. Read on to find out how both of these issues impact your content. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 25 Recognizing the importance of UX design in your strategy When you think of developing a strategy, issues about design probably don’t immediately come to mind. Yet when you look at conducting business online, you can find evidence of design choices in everything you do. Not only is the product itself impacted by design, but the way you have customers interact with the brand is completely driven by design. This point in driven home by John Moore Williams in his article, “The New Design Process: Why Designers Should Be Shaping Business Strategy,” in the InVision blog (http://blog.invisionapp.com/why-designers-should-beshaping-business-strategy/). Williams makes a very important point that’s worth quoting in full: “Designers understand the business landscape differently than the business guys. Where an exec sees lifts in conversion rates, a designer sees a more delightful user experience. Where an exec sees increased time on site, a designer might wonder if some interactions could produce less friction. Where the business guy sees users, designers see people.” Are you guilty of the narrow vision that Williams describes? You do need to think about metrics. But the key is to keep an eye on metrics and the UX at the same time. Your user experiences content visually, and design either impedes or enhances that experience — and enhancing it makes all the difference. Observing product habits Most habits develop without you realizing it. You perform some of the same routines every day without much thought. In fact, stopping a habit is more difficult than starting one, as you’ve probably discovered. Having the topic of habits may seem strange in a chapter on strategy, but it really isn’t when you look at how habits impact your customers’ use of your product. Do you know whether using your product requires a habit change? If it does, you’re going to have an uphill battle luring customers. Conversely, if you can attach the use of your product to an existing habit, you will find fostering product adoption much easier. An interesting perspective on the benefits of habits as they relate to products was discussed by Dina Chaiffetz in her article series on the InVision blog (http://blog.invisionapp.com/how-to-build-habit-forming-productsbuilding-on-the-loop/). 26 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Doesn’t that sound good? Habits can help you develop an ongoing relationship with your customer that will be hard to break, plus you can become a part of your customers’ everyday life. So how can you add habits to your strategy? Nir Eyal tackles this question in his book Hooked: How to Form Habit-Building Products, in which he presents the four steps to product habit formation. You can find an example of this process in Nir Eyal’s SlideShare presentation that diagrams how a Pinterest habit is formed at http://www.slideshare.net/ nireyal/hooked-model (see slide #110). Here’s how the Pinterest habit is formed: »» Trigger: First, you need to have both an external and internal trigger that cause you to use the product. An external trigger might be that you’re reading your emails online, so going to another site is easy. The internal trigger could be your boredom or desire to socialize. »» Action: You log in to a social platform and look around for something entertaining. »» Variable reward: While on the platform, you’re rewarded by discovering something of interest, or sometimes you find nothing and you log off. The key to this reward is that it doesn’t happen every time; it’s on a variable interval schedule. A variable interval schedule is a concept borrowed from behavioral psychology. It refers to the fact that you’re more likely to keep going back for a reward when your reward is given intermittently, rather than each time you do something. If you’re used to getting a reward every time and then you miss one or two, you will stop going back. If you’re unsure when you will be rewarded because it’s variable, you keep trying again. Slot machines work on the same principle. »» Investment: You make an investment in the product by personalizing it. In the case of Pinterest, you might pin things and share other pins. You’re not only investing your time but also building a body of content, so you’re likely to return. So now you see how easily a product habit can be formed if it has the right ­ingredients. It helps you understand why your friends play certain games until they drop. You can find more about habit formation by looking at Stanford ­Professor BJ Fogg’s work on changing behavior: http://www.foggmethod.com/. CHAPTER 1 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy 27 Developing Your Overall Digital Strategy Chaiffetz points out two significant benefits of focusing on habits: (1) when your product establishes a habit, you establish a permanent relationship with a customer; and (2) if you know about a habit your customer already has, you can piggy-back on that to become part of the customer’s routine. IN THIS CHAPTER »» Looking at the “attention web” »» Changing the way we measure attention »» Making content easier to consume »» Using interactive content Chapter 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer D o you know the thing that all marketers desperately want? It’s customers’ attention — to what they have to say and sell. Since the advent of the “always on” culture, the competition for attention has been fierce. In fact, most of the content created by companies is never seen by its prospects. It wasn’t always hard to get people’s attention. In the previous century, when you wanted to get a customer’s attention, you would send him your marketing material and give him a call. The prospect was usually receptive because you were the keeper of all product information. Those days, however, are over. But conversations do help develop relationships, and relationships help you get and keep your customer’s attention. So what can you do to compete with other producers for consumers’ attention? There is no shortage of content from your competitors that identifies each one of them as the one to choose. Your content probably does the same. How do consumers decide? In this chapter, you look at how getting prospects’ attention involves developing the kinds of conversations that help your prospects say yes to you. You may or may not have the opportunity to meet your customers face to face, but you must engage them with quality content that addresses their needs and provides valuable information. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 29 Focusing on Attention Unsurprisingly, technology has negatively impacted attention span. The Statistic Brain Institute defines attention span as “the amount of concentrated time on a task without becoming distracted” and reports that attention span in 2000 was 12 seconds but has currently gone down to 8.25 seconds. The Statistic Brain Institute also reports that an office worker checks her email approximately thirty times per hour. That’s a shocking statistic if you multiply that by an 8-hour day. Two hundred and forty times a day! Seeking the “attention web” So why should the attention span and distractibility of the average customer ­matter to you as a digital marketer? Obviously, it matters because you want to get your prospect’s attention, and doing so becomes more difficult with each passing day. In addition, what marketers have come to believe about engagement metrics (that they consist of measures like page views or clicks) may not be true. That’s why marketers started to consider whether the time people spend engaging with content or the scrolling they do might be better ways to measure their interest. This led to what is called the “attention web” movement that involves selling ads based on attention measures rather than sheer numbers (of clicks, for example). An article on Time.com looks at the myths poeple hold about how they consume online content. Authored by Tony Haile, formerly CEO of Cheatbeat (http:// Chartbeat.com), it’s called “What You Think You Know About the Web Is Wrong” (http://time.com/12933/what-you-think-you-know-about-the-web-iswrong; see Figure 2-1). Haile derived his findings based on an investigation Chartbeat conducted by reviewing 580,000 online articles. Central to Haile’s argument is that fact that using the click as the most important measure of attention is flawed. Following are two of the four myths he presented: »» Myth: We read what we’ve clicked. This seems like a common sense assump- tion, but it may not be true. You assume that the reader clicks the article with the intention of reading it. This may be true, but it doesn’t necessarily mean that the reader actually spends time reading that article. She may glance at it and move on. The content marketer rejoices in the number of clicks he gets, but the reader may actually make no connection with the brand. The content marketer then creates more content just like it in the mistaken belief that his reader was engaged. You can see how this would negatively impact your entire content program. 30 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer FIGURE 2-1: Time.com. »» Myth: The more we share, the more we read. You would expect that a person would share only an article that he found compelling. This is another fallacy. People share for all kinds of reasons. Haile found no correlation between the amount of time spent with an article and its number of shares, once again shattering the assumption that such articles have hit their target. It may be more likely that people share articles based on their headlines and source. From these factors, they make a guess about how pertinent the content is to their audience. You probably find this information disheartening, as most serious content ­marketers do. So what can you do to deal with audience members with short attention spans? Tonya Wells provides some suggestions in her article “Micro Content: Capturing Readers with Short Attention Spans” on the Infographic World blog (http://infographicworld.com/blogs/micro-content-capturingreaders-with-short-attention-spans/; see Figure 2-2), a graphic design firm. Wells suggests using the following: »» Mini-graphics: These would be graphics that focus on only a piece of data rather than present a long infographic. This approach has value because it uses a visual to capture attention but doesn’t make the reader spend a long time figuring it out. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 31 FIGURE 2-2: An Infographic World article about short attention spans. »» Short lists: A short list appeals to someone who is on the go. You impart information in small chunks, like a bite-sized snack. »» How-to articles: Again, you can see how to make this format work for a reader with a short attention span. You can do what you did with the minigraphic and focus on learning how to do one thing. »» Tips and tricks: This is a popular format for all audiences. By limiting the content to a few items, you have captured attention but not slowed down your reader. »» Frequently asked questions (FAQs): Keep them short and answer one specific question in each one. That way, you help readers make progress and don’t slow them down with fluff. »» Social media posts: By definition, some of these posts should be short and to the point. Don’t miss an opportunity to write short content that links to a longer form post if the reader is interested. Aside from specifically developing content for short attention spans, marketers and researchers have been looking for ways to improve their metrics so that they can gauge true reader interest. One example of this effort is the work of Christoph C. Cemper, the CEO of Impactana http://impactana.com, shown in Figure 2-3. Impactana version 2 is a software tool that measures buzz versus impact. 32 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer FIGURE 2-3: Impactana. Cemper explains his approach to buzz versus impact in his article on the ­Marketing Land blog, as shown in Figure 2-4 (http://marketingland.com/ measuring-real-impact-content-marketing-131823). Cemper says that each marketer should ask herself, “Did our content resonate with the audience?” This is exactly the question content marketers must ask to ensure that their content strategy is hitting the mark. Here’s the difference between buzz and impact: »» Buzz: Buzz is something that all content marketers like to have. It highlights their brand and gets the attention of their peers. It clearly has value. But if you’re looking for true engagement, you need to go further than likes and retweets. »» Impact: Impact is measured by the amount of attention your reader gives your content. For example, comments on a blog post or downloads of content signal real interest. That’s because the reader stopped to write something in relation to the content or downloaded content that he wanted to look at later. Cemper’s prescription is to evaluate these concepts on a matrix, as shown in Figure 2-5. The original matrix can be seen on the article on Marketing Land (see Figure 2-4). The matrix shows that you obviously want to aim for both high buzz and high impact, but that average buzz can still be valuable if you have high impact. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 33 FIGURE 2-4: Marketing Land. FIGURE 2-5: Matrix of ­Christoph C. Cemper ­explaining buzz vs. impact. 34 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Looking at attention triggers Although some may treat attention as an unknowable commodity, there are actually codified ways to capture it. In his book Captivology: The Science of Capturing People’s Attention (HarperOne, 2015), Ben Parr, former Mashable editor, details seven triggers that you can employ to get attention. These triggers have been drawn from the fields of psychology and neuroscience and help you understand how and why people pay attention (sometimes without a conscious thought). Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer The triggers are »» “Automaticity”: This trigger relies on the automatic response people have to sensory cues, such as color. »» Framing: This trigger gets people to pay attention by challenging their world view. This means that when you present something in a way that is unexpected or doesn’t match people’s understanding, you get their attention. You have framed the problem in a way that doesn’t match their understanding. »» Disruption: When you use the disruption trigger, you upset a person’s expectations, which causes them to pay attention. »» Reward: By using the reward trigger, you tap into the inherent desire people have for rewards. »» Reputation: This trigger relies on the fact that people believe the words of experts and will give them their attention. »» Mystery: When people are unsure about what will happen or they don’t understand something, they pay attention until they get an answer. »» Acknowledgement: People freely give their attention to those who nurture and support them. In looking at this list, you probably think that getting attention is less mysterious than you thought. The problem you have when creating content is the fact that you have to know your audience well enough to know what constitutes a trigger. Table 2-1 lists questions you can ask yourself to determine the triggers for your audience. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 35 TABLE 2-1 Parr’s Captivology Triggers Trigger Some Questions to Ask “Automacity” Are there specific senses related to your persona that you want to tap into, such as school colors or songs? Framing How can you change your personas’ view to convince them that you are the only right choice to solve their problem? Disruption Can you challenge expectations? Shatter some myths? Reward What constitutes a real reward for your personas? For example, perhaps you can offer access to your new product in advance instead of a discount. Reputation Have you done your homework on influencers? (See Book 6 for more about influencers.) If so, you will know who your personas take advice from. Mystery Can you develop a series of stories about your topic that will keep personas coming back for more? Acknowledgement Can you provide valuable customer service that goes beyond the expected? If you have completed the development of your personas (see Book 2, Chapter 2), you will be able to ask yourself specific questions directed at each one. Using these triggers as the basis for your content should help you get more attention for your brand. Give this list of questions to your teams to help guide them. Making Your Content Easy to Consume Do you want to help readers consume your content? Then make it easy! Readers give up in frustration when an article isn’t readable. Readability isn’t just about the logical sequence or writing style, but rather to the design elements. If your article font is too small or lacks skimmable headings, you’re sending your reader away. Reading in patterns A good starting point for making your content alluring to readers is to understand how people read. Eye-tracking studies have determined that people use two eye patterns when viewing content, as follows: »» The Z pattern: Picture a Z. Using this pattern, readers’ eyes move from left to right and then down, and then left to right again. 36 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy »» The F pattern: Using an F pattern, readers’ eyes move left to right, and then back moving from right to left, and then right, and then down. Both patterns are shown in Figure 2-6. You can find the original images at Smashing magazine (https://www. smashingmagazine.com/2015/04/design-principles-compositionalflow-and-rhythm/). Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer To further clarify, three versions of the F pattern as heat maps are shown in Figure 2-7. The originals can be seen at http://www.nngroup.com/ articles/f-shaped-pattern-reading-web-content/. FIGURE 2-6: The F and Z patterns. When you’re composing your blog posts and web pages, it’s helpful to know how readers will be scanning your content. Using either an F or Z pattern, you know they will start at the top and read the headline. Then their eyes will scan down and across in some fashion. Put the most important content in the area of the page where you know they will look first. Instead of trying to force your readers to read every word, facilitate their need for speed. Your readers aren’t likely to spend a long time poring over your ­articles. According to the Nielsen Norman Group, they’ll read about 27 percent of the words on a page. Therefore, one of your jobs as a content marketer is to make your articles easy to skim. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 37 FIGURE 2-7: The F pattern on a heat map from the Nielsen Norman Group. Considering design elements and typography This chapter focuses on holding your reader’s attention by using good design. So what are some things you can do to help your readers focus their attention? Consider using the following: »» Headings and subheadings: You want to make it easy to read your headline. (For more on the importance of headlines and tools you can use to improve them, see Book 3, Chapter 4.) But after your readers’ eyes move from the headline, they’re going to be skimming your headings and subheadings. If you leave these out, your reader will have to try to pick out words or phrases that have meaning to them. You shouldn’t make them have to guess what and where those words are. If you do, you’re banking on the fact that your reader has all the time in the world to assess your content. Considering the short attention spans, that’s not likely. 38 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy »» Short paragraphs: Keeping your paragraphs short really helps readers make progress through your article. When they see a dense article with no breaks, they’re inclined to click away. It’s not a conscious choice. They make a quick assessment about how long it will take to read an article, and they either commit to give it a try or move on. »» Bullet lists: Some people are afraid to use bullets because they have seen too many bad examples. If you thoughtfully organize your material (as in this list!), bullets are a great way to help the reader quickly understand complex topics. »» Numbered lists: Everyone loves lists. It’s one of the most popular formats on Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer the web. Readers can instantly understand how the material is organized and gauge the amount of time they need to spend with it. In Figure 2-8, you can see the effective use of a list right in the blog post by Larry Kim (http://blog. hubspot.com/marketing/design-content-remarketing-campaigns). It sets up the content and provides structure to the post. FIGURE 2-8: Numbered list example on the HubSpot blog. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 39 »» Type size and font color: Designers often forget about differences in readers’ vision. Some readers can’t see tiny type. If the type is in a light color, it compounds the problem. It may look great in the design as a whole, but it can be a turn-off to many readers. Figure 2-9 shows a great example of an article by Maya Luke in the Influence & Co. blog that doesn’t require you to squint or make your text larger (http://blog.influenceandco.com/3-bulletprooftechniques-to-avoiding-writer-s-burnout).You can’t see the font color in this book, so go to the link here if you want to check it out. FIGURE 2-9: Type size and font color on the Influence & Co. blog. »» Visuals: Using visuals is a well-known way to advance understanding. If you can provide a photo, a map, a graph, or some kind of diagram, your reader will more easily connect to it. In the BarkBox blog (https://barkbox.com/), shown in Figure 2-10, you can see a wonderful example of a picture that works perfectly with the headline. It demonstrates a love for animals while displaying the “BarkGood For a Good Cause” banner. »» White space: The Contently blog is designed to make great use of white space, as shown in Figure 2-11 (http://contently.com/strategist/ 2015/09/04/13-stats-that-should-terrify-cmos/). 40 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer FIGURE 2-10: Visuals on the BarkBox blog. FIGURE 2-11: White space on the Contently blog. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 41 Deploying Interactive Content Before moving on from the topic of attention, you need to think aout how to develop your interactive content. It’s a content type that can really grab your prospects’ attention. This content type is popular because it’s easy to create with some tools. It’s popular with customers because you don’t have to require an email address. Some examples of this type of content are »» Interactive infographics »» Quizzes and assessments »» Interactive whitepapers »» Advanced calculators »» Polls »» Interactive videos »» Interactive shopping catalogs You gain several benefits from using this type of content, but two key points are »» Higher potential to develop a long-term customer: When prospects make an investment in your content by answering questions or providing their own content, this content becomes their asset. They may return to your site often and possibly purchase something. »» Knowledge about your audience: When prospects answer questions, fill in a quiz, or take an assessment, they’re providing information about themselves. This information is given to you freely, so they don’t feel coerced. Several companies can help you create this type of interactive content. Here are some examples: »» Ceros (http://ceros.com; see Figure 2-12): This company’s platform helps you create interactives for formats including infographics, lookbooks (a collection of photos showing different aspects of something), and microsites. »» SnapApp (http://snapapp.com; see Figure 2-13): SnapApp helps you create ten different types of interactive content, including contests, quizzes, and infographics. »» Ion Interactive (http://www.ioninteractive.com; see Figure 2-14): This company specifically targets content marketers and provides support or services to create interactive content. 42 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer FIGURE 2-12: Ceros. FIGURE 2-13: SnapApp. CHAPTER 2 Grabbing the Attention of Your Customer 43 FIGURE 2-14: Ion Interactive. 44 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy IN THIS CHAPTER »» Discovering the “Jobs To Be Done” concept »» Understanding what drives revenue »» Uncovering what your brand means »» Recognizing brand goals Chapter 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand Y ou may be asking yourself why a book about digital marketing strategy has a chapter about business models and brands. There’s a good reason for that. You can’t really begin to determine your content marketing strategy until you determine how your company generates revenue and retains loyal customers. After you understand that, you’ll know what your customers find valuable in terms of products and content. You’ll be able to deliver the kind of content that keeps your customers engaged and buying. Oddly enough, some companies don’t really understand the business they’re in. That may sound counterintuitive, but it’s true. Your company could be one of them. Many C-level managers fully understand what their product does, but not what “job” (or jobs) it does for their customers. If you don’t know what job your customers are hiring your product to do, you won’t fully understand what your customers want. In this chapter, you look at what you need to know about your own business model and how to present your brand effectively. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 45 Separating Your Business Model from Your Brand This section starts by defining two important concepts: business model and brand. After looking at the meaning of each of these concepts, you’ll find it easier to effectively address each one. »» Your business model: Your business model describes how you make money. This concept is inward facing, meaning that you look inside your company to see what drives your revenue. You consider operations, suppliers, and all the things that go into delivering a sound product. »» Your brand: Your brand is what your company means to your customers. Regardless of how you make your money, your brand is defined by the connections it makes in the minds of your customers. You take into account things like customer data, retention, and buying habits to determine what your brand stands for. You can declare what your brand means to your customers, but you can’t make them believe it. They tell you. On social media, this message is amplified a hundred-fold. Here’s an example of how a business model and a brand go hand in hand. Apple (http://apple.com) makes its money by selling electronic gadgets that help consumers do things, such as communicate with the world in myriad ways. ­ Apple’s current mission statement reads as follows: “Apple designs Macs, the best personal computers in the world, along with OS X, iLife, iWork and professional software. Apple leads the digital music revolution with its iPods and iTunes online store. Apple has reinvented the mobile phone with its revolutionary iPhone and App store, and is defining the future of mobile media and computing devices with iPad.” When you buy an Apple product, you find that it employs cutting-edge design and performs well. This helps you see the value of purchasing other Apple products, like an iPad or a MacBook Air. Why? Because they work seamlessly together. ­Furthermore, you see the value of using the iTunes store to buy apps that work with your products. Apple would be a successful company by virtue of the products it creates. But by making its products work together in their own “ecosystem,” Apple has created a strong business model that makes it the world’s most valuable brand, according to Forbes (https://www.forbes.com/sites/kurtbadenhausen/ 2018/05/23/the-worlds-most-valuable-brands-2018/#7aae8c14610c ). Almost no one disagrees. So what does the Apple brand mean? To understand that, you have to look at Apple customers. They are extremely loyal and see themselves as belonging to a 46 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy world-wide community of people who think differently. They have a relationship with the company that can’t easily be damaged. They stand in long lines to wait for newly released products, hoping to be able to snag the latest model. Apple clearly understands the role its products play in the life of its customers. Do you understand your company’s role? This understanding is critical to being a successful company. If you don’t understand the brand value of your company, you will have weak content marketing efforts. Understanding the business you’re in Christensen illustrates how companies can find the solution to the JTBD problem by detailing how he dealt with this problem for a fast-food company. After analyzing its customers’ demographics and asking them about their favorite milkshake ingredients, the marketing department of a fast-food company still couldn’t figure out how to increase milkshake sales. The company asked Christensen to help. He and his team proceeded to determine what customers “hired” the milkshakes to do with extensive interviews. (You can find more details at http://hbswk.hbs.edu/item/6496.html.) Christiansen’s team found that customers all had a similar purpose for buying a milkshake. They had long, boring commutes to work. On their commute, they wanted »» Something interesting to do with their free hand as they drove »» Something that would help them stave off hunger until 12 p.m., when they could eat lunch These are the jobs they hired their milkshake to do. So, they bought a milkshake to serve as both entertainment and sustenance. You can see that by framing the problem this way, the fast-food marketers could come up with unique solutions to satisfy their customer. They needed to provide a product that would do the right jobs. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 47 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand To understand the role your products play in the life of your customers, you need to grasp the concept of Jobs To Be Done (JTBD). It was developed by Clayton ­Christensen, who is well-known for his theories on corporate innovation and disruption. As his website explains, “Customers rarely make buying decisions around what the ‘average’ customer in their category may do — but they often buy things because they find themselves with a problem they would like to solve.” With this information in hand, the fast-food company proceeded to »» Create thicker milkshakes: The company needed to offer shakes that took longer to finish so that they would last during the entire commute. »» Develop more interesting milkshakes: The company added pieces of fruit to the shake that provided a chewing experience along with the fluid. The milkshake was already perfect for a customer’s free hand, so that aspect ­wasn’t changed. Christiansen’s marketing team also uncovered some information about what parents wanted in a milkshake product for their kids. Parents wanted to buy their kids a milkshake as a treat during the day. This called for thinner children’s milkshakes that wouldn’t take too long to finish. So the fast-food company needed both thicker and thinner milkshakes on its menu. You can see that by following the “what job is the product hired to do” line of exploration, the marketers arrived at very different solutions than they would have using a classic demographic analysis. Christensen classifies the reasons for customers to buy as your brand purpose. He recommends naming your product after that purpose so that customers will know that your product meets their needs. Mark W. Johnson (Clayton Christensen’s business partner) says that “you know an innovation is disruptive when a new population has access to products and services that previously were only affordable for the few or the wealthy” (http:// blogs.wsj.com/accelerators/2015/01/23/weekend-read-disruption-isnot-about-slaying-giants-but-about-serving-new-customers/). Your offering to the customer should disrupt the status quo. For example, your product could do the job in a new way, as Airbnb (http://airbnb.com) does by offering local homes to travelers who don’t want a hotel experience. Or it could be more convenient but not necessarily less expensive, such as Uber (http://uber. com), which is a service that quickly provides a taxi when and where it’s needed. Looking at some popular online business models The Internet has spawned a host of business models that couldn’t have existed before its inception. The following sections describe some of the most popular ones that don’t require a bricks-and-mortar store to support it. 48 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Affiliate model Affiliates are people who agree to sell a product (or service) online for a fee. The key to creating a successful affiliate business involves developing an audience interested in a particular topic and then finding and recommending products you think they will like. The less work that you put in on the effort, the less likely you will be able to sustain a business that relies on people trusting your recommendations. Affiliates can also promote one specific product and provide content that supports and enhances it. Discovering Your Business Model and Brand An example of a market in which you can find affiliate products is ClickBank (http://www.clickbank.com), shown in Figure 3-1. Vendors put their products on display and list their accompanying fee for a sale. FIGURE 3-1: ClickBank offers affiliate products. Membership model A membership model has two characteristics. To run it, you have to »» Charge a monthly (or annual) fee »» Supply content that keeps your members interested CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 49 The content you supply can be informal, or you can organize into specific courses. One successful example of this type of site is Lynda.com (http://lynda.com), shown in Figure 3-2. This site was purchased by LinkedIn and has different ­business courses in a variety of formats, with video being the most popular. FIGURE 3-2: Lynda.com supplies course content under the membership model. Peer-to-peer e-commerce site model (a community of makers or freelancers) A peer-to-peer e-commerce model allows people with similar skills to access a business framework to display and sell their goods or services. This framework allows people to avoid having to set up their own shopping carts and customerservice mechanisms. A successful example of this model is Etsy (http://etsy.com), shown in Figure 3-3. Etsy has thousands of vendors who hand-make their goods. Online retail model Online retailers are the model you’re most likely familiar with. A vendor offers goods available online and ships them to a buyer. The vendor may also have a group of vendors who supply his goods, which he then ships. One good example of this model is 1-800-FLOWERS.COM (http://1800flowers.com) shown in Figure 3-4, which provides flowers for all occasions. Before this type of vendor existed, you had to go to a florist and order flowers, which in turn had to be sent or referred to a local vendor. 50 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy FIGURE 3-3: Discovering Your Business Model and Brand Etsy is a thriving example of the peer-to-peer e-commerce site model. FIGURE 3-4: The online retailer 1-800FLOWERS.COM. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 51 One variation on the retail model is the “Long-tail” model introduced by Chris Anderson in his book The Long Tail: Why the Future Of Business Is Selling Less of More (Hyperion). The long tail refers to a niche audience that buys many products with low volume. For example, eBay vendors sell a large number of different products to very niche audiences. A china vendor can have many different patterns of vintage plates, teacups, bowls, and other similar items and sell them to people who collect one specific pattern. The model works because the niche audience continues to buy for its specific collection. Service model This online version of the service model is becoming very popular because it allows time-starved customers to order something they want and get it delivered quickly without having to leave their house. One example of this is Seamless (https://www.seamless.com), as shown in Figure 3-5. It’s your local take-out/ pickup restaurant on a grand scale. You go to the site, enter your zip code, and choose food from local vendors. It’s all handled from one site. Then you have it delivered or you can get it yourself. Rather than have one option, you can choose from a variety of local options. FIGURE 3-5: Seamless ­ rovides a foodp delivery service. 52 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Subscription model Discovering Your Business Model and Brand The subscription model is not new, but the advent of the web has driven it to much greater heights. With this model, you join a site that offers ongoing access to something you want, and you typically pay a monthly or annual fee. One well-known example of this model is Netflix (http://netflix.com), shown in Figure 3-6. You can access the site’s content as long as you remain a member. It’s similar to the membership model, which requires you to pay a fee to have access to a club or site, but you might not have access to content. FIGURE 3-6: You pay a monthly fee to access all the ­content on Netflix. Considering the freemium model Another business model worth noting is the freemium model, which is used for online software products. Companies who use this model provide a free version of their software with the expectation that some customers will want to pay for a premium version. Some business owners are leery of this model because it involves a risk that doesn’t apply to a standard retail model. Instead of having customers pay as they go, you need to have the strong conviction that some customers will upgrade. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 53 You should consider a freemium model if you’re convinced that »» Your product is integral to a business process. Tools that make it easy for a user to do tasks that are part of her daily routine have a good chance of succeeding. Examples of such tasks are storing and sharing files. Dropbox (http://Dropbox.com), shown in Figure 3-7, gives you a free account and charges for additional storage space. FIGURE 3-7: Dropbox offers a freemium service for storing and sharing files. »» Your paying customers will be able to support the nonpaying ones. In this case, a good example is LinkedIn (http://linkedin.com), shown in Figure 3-8, which provides a variety of career search services in addition to a free networking service. »» You can provide quality customer service to all customers, not just the premium owners. An example of this is Evernote, the information storing and organizing platform (see Figure 3-9). The Executive Chairman of Evernote, (http://evernote.com) Phil Libin, has been quoted as saying, “The easiest way to get one million people paying is to get one billion people using” (Fast Company). From the very beginning, he was prepared to give everyone who used Evernote a quality experience. Currently the company offers a free version, a Premium version, and a Business version. 54 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy FIGURE 3-8: Discovering Your Business Model and Brand LinkedIn offers free and paid services. FIGURE 3-9: Be sure to add value to ­customers’ lives with your free services, as Evernote strives to do. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 55 WHAT ABOUT FREE TRIALS? When you think of free, you can’t overlook free trials. Companies use this tactic to entice customers to try and then buy. A success story using this tactic is Beats Music, the subscription streaming music service (purchased in May of 2015 by Apple and now called Apple Music). Unlike other services, such as Spotify and Pandora, Apple Music doesn’t have a free version; members pay $9.99 a month, students pay $4.99 a month, and the family rate is $14.99 a month. According to Bloomberg Business, Apple Music was able to turn seven out of ten free trial users into paying customers without a free version. Analyzing Your Business Model Because of the availability of online tools, you have a great advantage when analyzing your business model. All sorts of visual software tools are available to help you figure things out. The most popular of all the business model tools is the one presented by Alex Osterwalder and Yves Pigneur in their book Business Model Generation. The tool is called the Business Model Canvas, from Strategyzer (see Figure 3-10). To analyze your business model, you use a visual “canvas” to lay out all the components that make up your business. What makes the tool so powerful is that it prompts you to look at each part of your business and see how it works with the other parts to bring in revenue. To learn more about the business model canvas, you can go to https://strategyzer.com/canvas?_ga=1.164112764.256400004. 1437491350. Here’s a brief look at the components you need to document on the canvas: »» Customer segments: List the clearly defined niches you serve. »» Value propositions: This term refers to what you provide to customers to solve their problems. What are the specific products and services you offer — the value you promise to exchange with your customers for their payment? »» Channels: List the communication (social platforms and so on), distribution, and sales channels you use to reach customers. »» Customer relationships: Describe what you do to maintain an ongoing relationship with each of the customer segments you serve. 56 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy FIGURE 3-10: The Business Model Canvas from Strategyzer. Discovering Your Business Model and Brand »» Revenue streams: List the ways you make money based on the products and services you offer. »» Key resources: Identify the resources you must have to run the business. »» Key activities: Name the actions you must perform to run the business. »» Key partnerships: Includes the vendors and partners you need to run the business. »» Cost structure: Includes all the money you need to spend (expenditures) to run your business. Businesses can have more than one business model at a time. In today’s marketplace, startups and small business owners in particular find having several revenue streams desirable. Discovering Your Brand At company headquarters, your brand is looked at and understood in a certain way. Often, it can be mixed up with the product itself. But your brand and your product are two distinct things. The product is created by your company. But your brand is created in the mind of your customer. It is what customers feel when CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 57 they use your product, including whether they perceive that your brand is authentic. Because prospects can’t make a face-to-face determination about your company’s truthfulness and ethics, they rely on your content. An authentic brand is one that seems truthful, transparent, and cares about its customers’ satisfaction. Want to know what Interbrand (https://www.interbrand.com/best-brands/ best-global-brands/2018/) says are the top five global brands in 2018? They are (1) Apple; (2) Google; (3) Amazon; (4) Microsoft; and (5) Coca Cola. Not too surprisingly, three out of the five are technology companies. They are cited for their ability to innovate and adopt change to become more agile. Benefitting from attention to your brand Marty Neumeier, a recognized branding expert, says that a brand is “a person’s gut feeling, because brands are defined by individuals, not companies, markets, or the public.” As much as people like to think that they choose brands for logical reasons, all the research on brand choice says that they operate on emotions. It’s these emotions that you need to identify and respond to. According to Buffer’s State of Social Media 2016 Report, (https://blog. bufferapp.com/social-media-2016), marketers using social media say that one of their key objectives is to increase brand awareness. Branding is so important because it does the following: »» Helps you differentiate yourself from your competition. For example, several tablets are on the market, but in 2018, Apple held the majority share at 26.6 percent. »» Can live on while specific products may be phased out. The goodwill that comes with loving a brand isn’t easily destroyed. »» Helps customers talk about a brand to their friends and family. You want the social media army to actively recruit others. »» Creates loyal customers. Loyal customers are “money in the bank.” »» Is an asset. Although it seems intangible, brands have equity. Brand names help products get into retail stores and attract attention. »» Creates value for employees. Popular brands make their employees proud and encourage employee retention. 58 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy IS THIS THE APPLE STORE? Want to know how to recognize a loyal customer? According to Robert Passikoff, founder of Brand Keys (http://brandkeys.com/about), a branding consultancy, loyal customers are six times more likely to: “(1) Engage with your brand; (2) Pay attention to your marketing and advertising messages; (3)Think better of you; (4) Buy (and re-buy) your products or services; (5) Resist competitive appeals (attribute, benefit or dollar-based); (6) Recommend your product or service to others; (7) Invest in your company (if it’s publicly traded); and (8) Give your product or service the benefit of the doubt in uncertain situations.” Doesn’t that sound like the customer you want to retain? Try as you might, you don’t really influence what customers experience when they use your product. You may want them to feel really excited, but the customer might reply with a yawn. Unless you can refresh the brand in some significant way, it’s locked in customers’ minds in a particular way. According to Loyalty360 (http://loyalty360.org), 72 percent of U.S. customers drop a brand if they have had three bad customer service experiences. Brand loyalty is great, but you can’t count on mistreating your customers and hoping they forget. Knowing your current brand reality Critical to understanding how to increase brand value is to understand what your customers think about your brand today. This is something you don’t want to be guessing about. You can’t improve something unless you establish a baseline. So what can you do to create a twenty-first century brand that delights customers and encourages growth? Roxana Strohmenger, Tracy Stokes, and Chelsea Hammond at Forrester Research, created what they call the TRUE Brand Compass Framework. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 59 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand An example of a company that didn’t understand its brand was J.C. Penney. In its successful past, J.C. Penney was perceived as a well-priced store where families would stock up on their clothes for the year. Unfortunately, it lagged behind the times and competitors overtook it. In 2011, in an attempt to reinvent its brand, Penney’s hired Ron Johnson, a former Target and Apple executive, to spin some magic in Penney’s retail stores. Johnson’s goal was to make the stores more like Apple retail stores. His attempt to revitalize the brand failed, and he was ousted in 2013. Several reasons were cited for his failure, but the main complaint from customers and management alike was that he just didn’t understand the brand. They continue to close stores as the brand limps along, but as of 2017 they still operate 900 stores. What makes a brand TRUE? It should be »» Trusted: Is transparent with its customers, including showing its flaws »» Remarkable: Gets people talking about the brand »» Unmistakable: Creates a category of one (no one competes with it) »» Essential: Is irreplaceable in your customers’ lives These measures can be a recipe for evaluating what your current brand reality is and how you can redirect your actions. The following table provides some questions you can ask yourself. Measure Questions to Ask Trusted Do our customers think of us as trustworthy and transparent? What evidence do we have of that? What are we doing to reinforce our brand’s authenticity? Remarkable Do our customers find us worth discussing with their friends? What evidence do we have of that? What are we doing to make it easy for customers to tell about their great experiences with us? Unmistakable How well do we differentiate ourselves from the competition? What evidence do we have of that? Can we list our competitors and describe the ways we are different? Essential Do we have a place in our customer’s everyday life? What evidence do we have of that? What can we do to make our products become part of a customer habit? Earlier in the chapter, multiple business models are described for you to be aware of. But what about managing multiple brands? You can see that managing multiple brands is a very complex problem. A major company like Proctor and Gamble has multiple brands and successfully manages all of them. If you’re a small business, you need to think carefully before you spread your resources too thinly to support more than one brand. Solidifying the Look of the Brand So far in this chapter, you’ve learned about issues surrounding what your customers and employees think about your brand. Now it’s time to look at what they see. Chances are, when you visualize a brand, you either see the product in your mind, like the iconic Coke bottle, or a logo, like the Nike swoosh. A great deal of time and effort goes into establishing the look of the brand, and companies don’t always get it right. 60 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Considering design components Design and color play a tremendously important role in the branding of a company. Every year, companies spend millions of dollars to update and refresh their brand. Here are the design elements that distinguish a brand: »» Tagline: A tagline can help your potential customer understand the essence of your brand. Think American Express’s tagline “Don’t leave home without it.” American Express wants its customers to feel that their credit card is essential to their everyday life. »» Design: Design of online properties is a critical component of branding because it can convey a sense of modernity (good) or irrelevancy (not good!). Also key nowadays is a design that allows mobile devices to display the design correctly on smaller screens. »» Logo: As you see in the sidebar about logos, a logo can be critical to a brand. Discovering Your Business Model and Brand But don’t think that it must be complex. Actually, simpler is often better. Consider the IBM logo (http://ibm.com), shown in Figure 3-11. It’s nothing fancy, but it has stood the test of time. FIGURE 3-11: The IBM logo is simple but classic. »» Icon/avatar: This is the little design that you see in the upper left of a browser page or website. Because the icon or avatar is viewed so often, it makes a lasting impression. Don’t overlook its importance. »» Graphics and photos: Visuals communicate ideas that you can’t express in words. Your graphics are very important, so stay away from stiff stock photos and clip art. »» Fonts: Fonts are the lifeblood of brands, but people don’t think about them. They just accept the feeling they convey. If you think of iconic fonts, you’ll arguably find none more iconic than Disney’s (http://disney.com), shown in Figure 3-12. No company would dare use something remotely similar for fear of confusing its customers or legally infringing on the rights of the particular brand. FIGURE 3-12: The iconic Disney font. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 61 CAN AN INEXPENSIVE LOGO SUCCEED? To answer the question in the heading, if you’re the iconic hot lips logo used by the Rolling Stones, it can. That logo has been in service for almost fifty years and counting. Major brands create logos with great care and buckets of money. If you’re a small business of any kind, your funds are generally restricted to paying vendors and meeting payroll with very little left over to pay yourself. But does the lack of funds matter? Could an inexpensive logo be just as good or better? That depends on how well your designer can capture the essence of the brand. In 1969, Mick Jagger went to the London’s Royal College of Art and asked a fledgling artist, 24-year-old John Pasche, to create some visuals for his band. Rather than use Jagger’s suggestion of a Hindu idol, he went with his own instincts. He chose what he felt was the most outstanding feature of the man in front of him — “the size of Jagger’s lips and mouth” (http://www.adweek.com/news/advertising-branding/ how-mick-jaggers-mouth-became-rolling-stones-legendary-logo-165928). Pasche got £50 ($77) for his efforts, and the rest, as they say, is history. So don’t be ­discouraged if you can’t afford an expensive, focus-grouped logo. You might be better off. »» Color: Color sets the mood for brands. Very few brands have done a better job of pairing a color with the idea of luxury than Tiffany and its little blue box (http://tiffany.com). Using a digital asset management tool Digital asset management (DAM) companies provide a tool to help you manage your brand assets online. DAMs provide a central repository for company assets such as documents, photos, and videos. If you have a small shop, you may not need a system like this. But if you have multiple assets and multiple locations, using a tool like this can be a productive way to help your employees manage their work. WebDAM (http://www.webdam.com/), owned by Bynder, shown in Figure 3-13, is a well-known digital asset management company. It has a cloud-based system that makes it easy for your employees to manage your brand assets from anywhere. IntelligenceBank helps companies manage digital assets (see Figure 3-14). The company, which is noted for its pleasing visual interface, provides a calendar and planner (http://www.intelligencebank.com/). 62 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy FIGURE 3-13: Discovering Your Business Model and Brand WebDAM. FIGURE 3-14: IntelligenceBank. CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 63 If you’re looking for major brand assets like logos needed for blog posts and other content, you can probably find them at Find Guidelines on the Web (http:// findguidelin.es), shown in Figure 3-15. This is a portal site run by Arno Di ­Nunzio, whose purpose for the site is “to ease the life of us graphic designers by creating the largest collection of brand guidelines in one convenient central location, with just the right amount of functionalities.” It’s a great resource. Rather than have to go to each site individually, you can find the assets you need in one place. FIGURE 3-15: Find Guidelines on the Web. Developing Success Measures for Your Brand Management expert Peter Drucker famously said, “What gets measured gets done.” In the case of branding, you’re dealing with a set of measurements about your brand from which you must extract conclusions. The measures that you use to evaluate your brand are tied to customer perceptions and the actions you take to fortify them. 64 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Unlike measuring the number of followers or the amount of Likes you get, these measures are a bit more complex. You have to determine whether the actions you take support, advance, and enhance your brand. Brand measurement can be a bit complex. Book 9, Chapter 1 looks at the fifth of the Five Cs (see Book 1, Chapter 1 for a list of the Five Cs), called check-back analysis. This term refers to the notion that for every measure you look at, you should look back to evaluate the data you collected and possibly revise it. With all the data available, you should mine it for information that will actually increase the likelihood of success. If you are new to digital marketing, it makes sense to develop some gross brand measures that you know are available and can be evaluated. Following are some possible measures to choose from. Many measures are available; these are just suggestions: Producing Engaging Branded Content Next you look at branded content. You want to know how to create content that solidifies your brand awareness. After you have all your brand elements in place, you need to communicate them at every customer touchpoint. Marc Blanchard, Global Head of Experience Design at Creative Agency Havas Worldwide (http://havas.com/) proposed a great framework to help analyze brand engagement. You can use this framework to figure out how to develop custom content for brand engagement. The model prompts the following questions: »» Exposure: What kind of content would you like potential customers to see when they meet your brand? Unfortunately, you can’t control how a prospect first sees your brand. With all the social platforms, landing pages, and messaging tools available, you just hope they find you. But you should give some thought to the possible touchpoints. You can look at a few basic venues to determine what your CHAPTER 3 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand 65 Discovering Your Business Model and Brand »» General company measures: Market share; ROI; gross revenue »» Brand awareness: Reach; engagement with social media »» Brand loyalty: Retention; frequency of purchases customers will see. Those venues are Google search results, your main website, and your brand pages on all the social platforms. Make sure that all the platforms are cohesively branded and convey the standards that you hold for your brand. Content suggestions: The content you create for brand exposure should introduce your potential customer to the solutions you offer. Develop content like webinars, ebooks, and thought-leader posts that clearly present the value of your product or service. Demonstrate that you have a community of satisfied customers that you would like prospective customers to join. »» Response: What customer emotion does your content trigger? What do you want your prospects to feel after they learn about you? Determine what content you need to create to get your prospect moving in your direction and away from your competitors. Content suggestions: Offerings such as comparison charts, demos, and free trials help customers invest time and effort in you. »» Experience: How do you help customers convince themselves that the experience you have makes you an expert? You know that your customers will make an emotional decision about you and convince themselves that it was a rational one. Make sure to provide anything customers might need to feed both the emotional and rational sides. (See Book 3, Chapter 4 for more details about customer motivation.) Content suggestions: Convincing content can be testimonials that speak to people’s emotional side as well as data sheets with features and benefits that assuage the needs of the logical side. »» Outcome: What action do they take? You have an intended outcome in mind. Make sure that it’s clear to your prospects what you want them to do next. Although you wish otherwise, you may not get them to buy without taking smaller steps first to get to know you. Content suggestions: Create things like free lead generators (information in exchange for something) and free newsletter subscriptions to get them to give you an email address or perform another action, such as attend a webinar. Monitor how well the content performs, and increase your use of ones that make a difference. 66 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy IN THIS CHAPTER »» Defining the goals of your digital marketing »» Utilizing the three main digital marketing campaigns »» Learning which digital marketing campaigns you should employ, and when Chapter 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create D igital marketing is a broad term that can mean anything from posting an image of your product on Facebook to crafting an email subject line to optimizing a blog post for search engine traffic. Digital marketing involves many seemingly disconnected tactics, and that’s what makes this chapter so important. This chapter helps you understand what a marketing campaign is. You learn about the three different types of campaigns and how and when to use them so that you can use these strategies effectively in your digital marketing campaigns. Every business is interested in generating leads, making sales, retaining the customers they have, and selling them more of the company’s products or services. Achieving each of these goals requires a different approach, however. In this chapter, you decide what you want your digital marketing to accomplish by identifying your business objectives, because those objectives are what should dictate the campaigns you construct and, ultimately, the tactics you employ. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 67 Establishing Marketing Objectives Before you start a blog, open a Pinterest account, or start gathering email addresses, you need to choose your business goals. When you know what you want to accomplish, you’ll be able to direct your energy into the right marketing campaigns and employ marketing tactics that move the needle on the right business metrics. Here are six common goals that your digital marketing strategy can affect: »» Increasing problem and solution awareness: Your online marketing can help prospective customers become aware of something they need, an effect called problem awareness. Your marketing can also make prospective customers aware that your company provides a solution to a problem — called solution awareness. Your objective is to help people realize that you can take them from the “Before” state, in which they have a problem, to the desired “After” state, in which they have obtained a positive solution. »» Acquiring new leads and customers: Gaining more leads and customers is a primary objective of most businesses. Without generating new leads and customers, your business will never grow beyond what it is now. You need to bring in new blood to scale your business. »» Activating leads and customers: If you’ve been in business for more than a few months, you likely have leads and customers who have yet to buy or haven’t bought in a while. You can use your digital marketing campaigns to encourage people to buy from you for the first time, as well as to remind past customers who haven’t purchased from you lately of the value you bring and why they should buy from you again. Your digital marketing campaigns can activate these dormant leads and customers and help keep your business in mind. »» Monetizing existing leads and customers: Acquiring new leads and customers is expensive and time consuming. Don’t forget to create digital campaigns intended to sell more products and services to those new leads and customers. Monetization campaigns employ upsell, cross-sell, and other types of offers to encourage more sales from your best leads and customers. »» Onboarding new leads and customers: New leads and customers deserve special treatment simply because they’re new. They need to be taught who you are and how to be successful with what they’ve purchased. To achieve this goal, create content such as welcome emails or welcome packets that tell people how to use your product or service, what they can expect, and where they can go if they need help with their purchase. »» Building community and advocacy: To move prospects, leads, and custom- ers beyond a shallow, transactional relationship, you need to build campaigns that create communities of advocates and brand promoters. One of the most 68 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy effective ways to achieve this advocacy is through social media, such as through a Facebook Group or a Twitter page. Here, people can reach out if they have praise for or questions about your product or service. By creating an outlet, you help to cultivate a sense of community for your customer base, which leads to increased satisfaction and loyalty. Find more on social media tactics in Books 7 and 8. Defining a Digital Marketing Campaign Meeting your business objectives and moving a customer through the buyer journey (discussed in Book 2, Chapter 3) from ice-cold prospect to raving fan requires actions. Those actions, if coordinated properly, are called campaigns. Digital marketing campaigns, as defined in this book, have a set of specific characteristics. Digital marketing campaigns are »» Objective based: Digital marketing campaigns are coordinated actions intended to achieve a specific business goal. »» Multiparted: Every digital marketing campaign requires assets like content and landing pages, as well as tools like email software or web forms. But those assets aren’t enough to ensure the success of your campaign; you need the ability to make those assets visible. In other words, you need traffic. Yet another part of every campaign is the measurements you track so that you can determine how it’s performing. »» Seamless and subtle: It’s worth pointing out that these multistep, multipart Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create campaigns are most successful if you walk the prospect gradually through the buyer journey. To help move people through the buyer journey, you need to include a call to action (CTA) within your campaign. A CTA is an instruction to your audience designed to provoke an immediate response. Usually, a CTA includes an imperative verb to convey urgency, such as “buy now,” “click here,” “shop today,” “watch this video,” “give us a call,” or “visit a store near you.” Next, a well-oiled marketing campaign removes the friction between the prospect and the action you want that prospect to take. An extreme example is to ask an ice-cold prospect to buy a $10,000 product or service. Such a tactic would be neither seamless nor subtle. »» In flux: While the word campaign often refers to an initiative with a short lifespan, a campaign can be something your business runs for as little as a day or as long as several years. The advantage of digital campaigns over physical ones (such as direct-mail campaigns) is that small tweaks and even wholesale pivots are much simpler in a digital environment. As a result, you can optimize digital marketing campaigns on the fly to achieve the best results. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 69 The most important takeaway from this section is that a campaign is a process, not a single event that is made up of numerous steps and parts. Digital marketing campaigns might seem complicated to you now, but rest assured that campaigns can be extremely simple. PUTTING TOGETHER A GOOD-LOOKING DIGITAL MARKETING CAMPAIGN Consider the digital marketing campaign of a company like LasikPlus, which offers the Lasik corrective surgery for eyesight. As are most companies, LasikPlus is interested in acquiring new leads and customers for the procedure. In this company’s marketing campaign, a prospect might first encounter an advertisement, such as the banner ad shown in the following figure. Clicking the ad shown in the first figure takes the prospective customer to a landing page, shown in the next figure, that explains the benefits of doing business with LasikPlus and makes a call to action to schedule a consultation. Source: http://www.lasikplus.com/lasik-affordable-250_quiz 70 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Selecting the call to action to schedule an appointment takes the prospect to a page where the prospect chooses the most convenient LasikPlus location for his or her consultation. After that location is chosen, the prospect is taken to a calendar page where a time for the consultation can be chosen, as shown in the final figure in this sidebar. The last step in setting the appointment is the entering of name, email, phone number, and birth date to confirm the appointment. Source: https://www.lasikplus.com/am/#/Austin/schedule? latitude=30.352204&longitude=-97.7504 Understanding the Three Major Types of Campaigns Although you may have many business goals that you want to affect through your digital marketing, you’ll find that you can meet most objectives with three broad categories of digital marketing campaign: Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 71 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create But it doesn’t stop there. The LasikPlus campaign continues via email. Separate emails are sent to confirm the consultation appointment, teach the prospective Lasik candidate a bit about the procedure, and to remind the prospect of his upcoming appointment. Also, notice that LasikPlus graduates the prospect from a cold lead to a consultation rather than asking the person to pay for the procedure immediately after seeing the ad. This campaign moves the prospect seamlessly and subtly toward the conversion. Each of these types of digital marketing campaign has a very specific role to play in your business, as follows: »» Acquisition campaigns acquire new prospects and customers. »» Monetization campaigns generate revenue from existing leads and customers. »» Engagement campaigns create communities of brand advocates and promoters. The following sections explain these types of campaigns in much more detail. Campaigns that generate new leads and customers If your goal is to raise awareness for the problems you solve or the solutions you provide, or if you’re just looking to acquire new leads and customers, you need an Acquisition campaign. The role of your marketing is to help move a prospect, lead, or customer from the awareness stage of the buyer journey to brand promoter. You deploy Acquisition campaigns to do the work on the front end of this journey, taking the prospect from Aware to Converted (see Figure 4-1). FIGURE 4-1: Acquisition campaigns move prospects from the Aware to ­Converted stages. The stages of the buyer journey that Acquisition campaigns complete are the following: »» Make Aware: To bring in new leads and customers, you need to reach out to what amounts to complete strangers. You should structure Acquisition campaigns to reach prospects who are completely unaware of the problem you solve or the solutions you provide. 72 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy »» Engage: The movement from Make Aware to Engage is often accomplished by providing value to the prospect, usually in the form of entertainment, inspiration, or educational content, before asking her to buy something or commit a significant amount of time. This is known as content marketing, a strategic marketing method focused on creating and distributing valuable, relevant, and consistent material designed to attract, retain, and ultimately drive a customer to a profitable action. Content marketing consists of a broad spectrum of activities and types of content, including blogging, videos, social media updates, images, and more. Content marketing is covered in more detail in Book 3. »» Subscribe: At this stage, the prospect has given you permission to market to him. At the very least, he has connected with you on social channels (Facebook, LinkedIn, and others) or, ideally, has become an email subscriber. The Subscribe state is a critical stage to reach in the relationship because you can now continue the conversation with more content and offers. »» Convert: The transformation of a prospect from being merely interested and subscribed to converted is the final stage of an Acquisition campaign. At this point, the prospect has placed trust in your organization by giving you either money or a significant amount of her time. Don’t forget that your marketing should be gradual and seamless, particularly online, where you must often build trust with someone you’ve never actually met. If this final stage of your Acquisition campaign involves a sale, it shouldn’t be a risky (think expensive or complex) purchase. The goal here is to simply transform the relationship from prospect to customer. Most of the campaigns that you create to acquire new leads and customers can also work to activate leads and buyers who have never purchased from you, or haven’t purchased from you in a while. Those are Activation campaigns. A healthy business has a large number of recent and, if applicable, frequent buyers. Deploying campaigns to activate dormant subscribers and buyers is a good use of time and effort. Book 1, Chapter 5 includes more about these the types of offers that can activate these leads and buyers. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 73 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create Note that Acquisition campaigns are not about profit. Although you might be making sales at the Convert stage, the goal of those sales is not return on investment but on acquiring leads and buyers. This idea can seem counterintuitive, but keep in mind that customer and lead acquisition is different from monetization. These two campaign types have different goals, tactics, and metrics. Campaigns that monetize existing leads and customers If your business objective is to sell more to the customers you already have or to sell high-dollar, more complex products and services and profit maximizers (as described in Book 1, Chapter 5), you need a Monetization campaign. In short, the goal of a Monetization campaign is to make profitable sales offers to the leads and customers you acquired with your Acquisition campaigns. Don’t build a Monetization campaign first if your business has no leads, subscribers, or existing customers. Monetization campaigns are meant to sell more, or more often, to those who already know, like, and trust your business. The stages of the buyer journey completed by Monetization campaigns and shown in Figure 4-2 are the following: »» Excite: You target Monetization campaigns at customers who have already spent time learning something from you, or have already purchased something from your business. Savvy digital marketers build campaigns that encourage prospects or customers to get value from the interactions they’ve already had with your business. »» Cause customers to ascend: For every group of people who purchase something, some percentage of them would have bought more, or more often, if given the chance. For example, for every buyer of a Rolex watch, some percentage would buy a second (or third or fourth!) watch, or would buy the most expensive Rolex watch if presented with the opportunity. This concept is critical not only to digital marketing but also to your business goals. Your Monetization campaigns should capitalize on this concept by making offers that increase the value of your existing leads and customers. FIGURE 4-2: Monetization campaigns ­create ­excitement and cause ­existing leads and ­customers to ascend to a higher level of purchasing. 74 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Campaigns that build engagement If your business objective is to successfully get new customers on board and move new leads and customers from being prospects to fans of your brand, or to build a community around your company, brand, or offers, you need an Engagement campaign. The most beloved companies create online opportunities for customers and prospects to interact with each other and with the brand. Companies that build engagement into their marketing enjoy the benefits of customer interactions that go beyond the simple transaction of buying goods and services. The stages of the buyer journey completed by Engagement campaigns and shown in Figure 4-3 are the following: »» Advocate: You can create marketing campaigns to give your best customers the ability to recommend your business through testimonials and customer stories. These advocates defend your brand on social media and recommend your products and services to their friends and family when prompted. »» Promote: Customers who actively seek to promote your business are worth FIGURE 4-3: Engagement campaigns create brand ­advocates and brand promoters. Creating brand advocates and promoters begins with having a superior product or service, coupled with a customer service experience to match. Word travels fast in the digital world, and if you aren’t providing value, you find that your marketing creates the exact opposite of advocates and promoters. Instead, your marketing only speeds the spread of information about the poor experiences your customers have had. Before attempting to build engagement and community, optimize the amount of value you bring to your customer. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 75 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create their weight in gold. These are the customers who create blogs and YouTube videos about your products and services. They tell the story of your brand and their success with it on social channels, and do everything they can to spread the good word about the value you provide. These people are your brand advocates. When done right, Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement campaigns ­seamlessly move people through the buyer journey. These three strategies help people go from their “Before” state in which they have a problem to their desired “After” state of having gained a positive outcome through your product or service. Figure 4-4 shows all the stages a person goes through, ideally, in the buyer journey. Use the Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement tactics discussed in this chapter to help move people down this path. FIGURE 4-4: Use Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement campaigns to move people through the buyer journey. Balancing Your Marketing Campaign Calendar You may be thinking, “Which campaign should I be using in my business?” This is the wrong question, however. The right question is, “Which campaign should I be using in my business right now?” Every business should deploy each campaign type at different times to different people. So consider a few questions: »» Do you want more leads and customers for your business? »» Do you want to sell more to the customers you have or activate customers and leads who haven’t purchased in a while? »» Do you want to turn customers into raving fans willing to buy anything you offer, and give you testimonials and referrals? 76 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy The answer, of course, is yes on all accounts. But this point is critical to understand: One campaign can’t replace or do the job of another. An Acquisition campaign can’t do the job of a Monetization campaign. Likewise, a Monetization campaign can’t do the job of an Engagement campaign. Each campaign excels at meeting one particular goal. To maintain a healthy, sustainable business, you need to allocate time on your calendar for all three major campaign types. If you run nothing but Acquisition campaigns, you’ll never be profitable. If you run nothing but Monetization campaigns, you’ll never add new leads and customers and, as a result, you won’t grow. If you run nothing but Engagement campaigns, you’ll have a loyal audience, but you’ll never convert your audience into customers. If you have no sales but do have a massive following on social media, a popular blog, or podcast with lots of subscribers or downloads, you have mastered the art of creating Engagement campaigns. The good news is that you have accomplished one of the most difficult tasks in digital marketing: building an audience. By adding Acquisition and Monetization campaigns to your marketing mix, you can transform that audience into a profitable business. Choosing the Campaign You Need Now »» If you’re starting a brand new business or have no existing leads or subscribers, build an Acquisition campaign. »» If you have existing leads and customers, but they aren’t buying as much as you would like, build a Monetization campaign. »» If you’re happy with the number of leads and subscribers and the monetization of those leads and customers, build an Engagement campaign. If you simply don’t know where to start, begin by building an Acquisition campaign, because every business needs to understand how to acquire fresh leads and convert new buyers. In the rest of this book, you can find a number of ways to develop awareness for your brand, products, and services and convert that awareness into leads and customers. CHAPTER 4 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create 77 Deciding which Marketing Campaign to Create Your business needs all three campaign types: Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement. To run a sustainable, healthy business, you need to be acquiring new leads and customers, monetizing them, and engaging customers who advocate and promote your brand. That said, if you’re new to creating digital marketing campaigns, you should focus on building a single campaign first: Viewing Your Digital Marketing through the Campaign Lens From this point forward, plan your digital marketing strategy and tactics by aligning them with the goals of the three major types of campaigns: Acquisition, Monetization, and Engagement. Never again will you decide to open a new social media account without knowing the ultimate goal behind it. Most entrepreneurs and marketers who are frustrated by digital marketing don’t see the big picture. Frustrated digital marketers don’t understand, for example, that blogging is an outstanding tactic for growing awareness but less effective for monetization. They don’t realize that posting and communicating with customers on a business Facebook page can create an engaged community, but better, more effective ways to generate leads and customers are available. As you continue on your quest to master the art and science of digital marketing, stay focused on what really matters: growing the business. 78 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy IN THIS CHAPTER »» Gaining more leads by deploying the gated offer »» Turning leads into customers »» Increasing your bottom line Chapter 5 Crafting Offers That Sell W hether you’re asking people to buy something, give you their contact information, or spend time reading your blog, you’re making an offer. The way in which you make your offers — and perhaps more important, the sequence in which you make them — will make or break you online. You should think of creating and nurturing relationships with your customers in the same way that you develop relationships with your friends and family. Your business might sell business to business (B2B) or business to consumer (B2C), but all businesses sell human to human (H2H). Real, individual people are buying your products and services. Consider how perfect strangers become a married couple. The marriage proposal is an offer that is made after a sequence of other offers are made and deemed successful by both parties. Sure, the occasional marriage proposal on the first date occurs, but most relationships begin with a series of positive interactions over a period of time. Although most people aren’t likely to propose marriage on a first date, many businesses do the equivalent of that with their prospects. They ask cold prospects to buy high-ticket, complex, and otherwise risky products and services before the relationship is ready for that offer. On the other hand, a customer who has received tremendous value from your company over a period of time is much more likely to make a high-dollar, complex, or otherwise risky purchase. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 79 This chapterhelps you to know the different types of offers you can make, the goals of those offers, and the order in which you should present them to prospective, new, and loyal customers. The offers explained in this chapter focus on Acquisition and Monetization campaigns (discussed in Book 1, Chapter 4). Offering Value in Advance Doing business online is different from doing business in person or even over the phone. In many cases, the prospective customer has no further information about your business than what is presented to her online. To acquire new leads and customers, you need to build trust and lead with value to build a relationship with your prospects or customers. A successful relationship is a two-way street. Both sides of the relationship must benefit from the relationship, and because your company wants to begin this new relationship with a prospect, it makes sense for you to provide value first. Prospects won’t become loyal customers if you don’t first provide some value that builds trust in advance of asking them to buy. The good news is that you can provide this value with something as simple as an insightful, informative blog post or podcast that helps them solve a problem. You offer this value for free and with no strings attached to begin a healthy and mutually beneficial relationship. Acquisition offers that lead with value are entry point offers, or EPOs. An EPO in a dating relationship equates to offering to buy someone a cup of coffee. This coffee offer, which has begun many healthy dating relationships, is a relatively risk-free proposition that provides value upfront. When your goal is to acquire a customer (and not a spouse), the EPO is a way of allowing large amounts of prospective customers to get to know, like, and trust your business without much risk. There are three types of EPOs: »» Ungated: You usually present this type of offer in the form of a blog post, video, or podcast, and it doesn’t require contact information or a purchase to get value. »» Gated: A gated offer requires contact information (name, email address, and so on) to get value. »» Deep discount: This offer requires a purchase but at an extreme discount, usually 50 percent or greater. 80 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy The goal of your marketing is to transform people from being completely unaware of your products or services to being raving fans who promote your products and services to anyone who will listen. The foundation of the relationships you build with your customers is built on offers that provide value in advance of the purchase. Designing an Ungated Offer Offers that require no risk on the part of prospective customers are the most powerful way to begin to cultivate strong relationships with customers. An ungated offer such as an informative article, video, or podcast gives value without asking for contact information or a purchase. That said, these are still offers. You’re offering value to prospects in exchange for their time. And for many people, no other resource is more precious than time. The value provided by the business is generally made available to prospects using content such as blog posts, social media updates, or videos. Successful digital marketers make free content available that provides one of the following values: »» Entertainment: People pay a lot of money to be entertained, and content that makes a person laugh is content that is likely to be remembered. It’s why commercials try to make you laugh (think the gecko from Geico or Flo from Progressive); they have only 30 to 60 seconds to cut through all the noise and get you to remember their product or service. Poo-Pourri’s video advertisements on YouTube and Friskies’ and Buzzfeed’s “Dear Kitten” campaigns are prime examples of marketers providing entertaining content that gets their message across. »» Inspiration: People are highly moved by content that makes them feel something. The sports and fitness industry taps into this sentiment with taglines like “Just do it,” by Nike, or Fitbit campaigns showing everyday people (as opposed to celebrities and professional athletes) achieving their goals using Fitbit. Weight-loss businesses also use inspirational content by using successful customer testimonials and “before” and “after” images. »» Education: Ever go to YouTube to watch a how-to video? From DIY projects to how to rebuild a car engine, you can easily find educational content online. People want knowledge, and providing it helps build trust. Entire blogs, sites, YouTube channels, and businesses are built around educating people, to great success. That’s why Wikipedia gets roughly 16 billion page views a month. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 81 Crafting Offers That Sell It pays to provide tremendous value to your prospective customers when you’re trying to gain their trust. This idea can seem counterintuitive to some people because they don’t see the immediate return on this investment. The first two value propositions (entertainment and inspiration) can be difficult to execute. But the third is within the grasp of every company. The production of content by brands is at an all-time high. An absolute glut of content is produced on blogs, YouTube channels, and social media sites every day. That said, an insatiable demand still exists for great ungated content. Don’t make the mistake of thinking that because this content is free, it doesn’t deserve the time and energy of your other offers. An ungated offer is, in many cases, the first transaction that a prospective customer will have with your company, and you should make it a successful one. Designing a Gated Offer To graduate someone from the stage of prospect to lead, you need a gated offer that requires prospects to submit their contact information to receive value. A gated offer provides a small chunk of value that solves a specific problem for a specific market and is offered in exchange for the prospects’ contact information. That contact information is typically an email address, at a minimum. Returning to the dating relationship analogy earlier in the chapter, a gated offer is the equivalent of a first date. A gated offer might take the form of a white paper, a case study, or a webinar. For example, Figure 5-1 shows how OpenMarket makes valuable information available in the form of a whitepaper that requires contact information. FIGURE 5-1: OpenMarket asks for contact information in exchange for this white paper. Source: https://go.openmarket.com/enterprise-sms-solutions-ebook/?utm_source=google&utm_ medium=ppc&utm_campaign=BL%7CUS%7CGeneric%7CSMS%7CBroad&infinity=ict2~net~gaw~ar~ 312516238453~kw~%2Bmobile%20%2Benterprise%20%2Bmessaging~mt~b~cmp~BL%7CUS%7CGeneric% 7CSMS%7CBroad~ag~mobile%20enterprise%20messaging&gclid=CjwKCAiAl7PgBRBWEiwAzFhmms LWMdQDCfJxov2tpmyKweQjmLETpQq_v5EHfbGrqQe9bR2A1qNbZhoC5isQAvD_BwE 82 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Revisit the definition of a gated offer (“a gated offer provides a small chunk of value that solves a specific problem for a specific market and is offered in exchange for prospects’ contact information”) — and pay particular attention to the “specific” parts. Specificity is the key to a successful gated offer because it makes your offer more relevant to your audience. A lead form that simply states “­Subscribe to our newsletter” is not a gated offer that will get you high conversions because it doesn’t solve a specific problem. You can convert your gated offer prospects by making the offer specific in terms of problem-solving, which will make your gated offer more relevant to your audience. Zeroing in on what matters But what does making the offer specific and relevant entail? High-converting gated offers include one, or a combination, of the following five aspects, in a specific form: »» A promise »» An example »» A shortcut »» A solution »» A discount Including at least one of these five items will help your conversion rates. The following sections take a look at each of these items. Making a specific promise Making a specific promise is one of the simplest things you can do to increase the number of leads you receive from a gated offer. Look at the offer that you’re delivering and think about how you can make the benefit of the offer more evident. Consider how you can speak to the specific desired end result of your prospect. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 83 Crafting Offers That Sell A gated offer is an exchange in value. No money changes hands; instead, you provide your new lead something of value in exchange for the right to contact the lead in the future. Gated offers are free, and a common notion among digital marketers is that because they’re giving the gated offer away for free, the product or service offered doesn’t have to be of high quality. That’s a mistake. Free does not mean low quality. When someone exchanges his contact information and gives you permission to follow up with him, he has given you value, and a transaction has taken place. This prospect has given you something that’s typically private, as well as some of his time and attention. You need to return that value if you hope to build the relationship that is required for lifelong customers. The end goal of a gated offer is to gain leads so that you can nurture them into customers over time. Craft a clear promise and then make sure that your promise is in the title of your gated offer. Generic or clever titles generally decrease the conversions on your gated offer. Many marketers are guilty of coming up with cutesy titles or using industry jargon in the title that your market may not understand. In your gated offer’s title, talk less about your product and more about your target audience. Specifically communicate, in the gated offer’s title, the benefit the gated offer will provide that target audience. Speak to the conversation that is going on inside the mind of your customer, not the one that you’re having around the business table. Ask yourself, what are your target audience’s concerns, fears, or desires? Think of the desired end result that your customer is seeking, and put that in the title. The gated offer shown in Figure 5-2 delivers a specific promise that resonates with its market. FIGURE 5-2: Copyblogger’s gated offer clearly states what ­people can expect when they input their ­contact information. Source: http://my.copyblogger.com/free-membership/ Giving a specific example The best way to give a specific example in your gated offer is to deliver it in the form of a case study. If you have examples of real customers and prospects who have overcome problems with your product or service, these can work well as gated offers. For instance, if your company sells surveillance cameras to universities, you might create a case study entitled “How State University Reduced Campus Crime by 73 Percent” that details how the university used surveillance camera technology 84 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Offering a specific shortcut A gated offer that can save a person time is appealing and often converts well. For example, a gated offer that delivers a list of healthy snacks a person can eat throughout the day is a useful shortcut for someone looking to eat a more nutritious diet. Answering a specific question The fourth way you can make your gated offer more specific is by raising and answering a specific question. If the answer to the question is valuable, your prospects opt in to get the answer to that specific question, and after you’ve answered the question, you will have delivered on your promise and helped to establish yourself as an authority on the subject, which in turn helps build trust and moves the prospect closer to becoming a customer. Delivering a specific discount Price discounts can be a great way to spur sales, and many companies offer coupons that slash prices in the hope of creating a buying frenzy. But instead of handing out discounts, consider asking a prospect to opt in to receive the discount. For instance, your gated offer might say, “Join our Discount Club and receive 10% off any order.” This wording is effective because it specifically tells the prospect how much she’ll save. Generating leads with educational content Your gated offer can take five different forms. These gated offers offer value by educating the lead on a particular topic related to your brand while also highlighting features of a solution, product, or service you provide. Your gated offerdoesn’t have to be the length of a Tolstoy novel. Besides being ultraspecific, gated offers should be easy to consume — they should not be a 14-day course or a 300-page book. Rapid consumption of the gated offer is important because you want to provide value to your lead as quickly as possible. The faster your gated offer provides value, the quicker a lead can become a paying customer. Because most gated offers can be sent digitally, they can be delivered instantly, which allows the lead to receive the value of the gated offer quickly. Ideally, prospects receive value from your gated offer within minutes of giving you their contact information. Speedily delivering value helps to build a positive relationship with leads, as well as to quickly move them through the buyer journey. (Turn to Book 2, Chapter 3 for more information on the buyer journey.) CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 85 Crafting Offers That Sell to reduce acts of crime on the State campus. This headline clearly states the benefit and uses an example to add specificity to the gated offer. Free reports Reports (also called guides) are among the most common types of gated offers and are usually mostly text and images. Reports usually offer facts, news, and best practices that are relevant to your industry and your target market. If you use a report as your gated offer, however, be careful. Reports can be lengthy and complex, thus they often take more time to be consumed, which means that the report will take longer to deliver on its value. Therefore, whenever possible, keep your reports as succinct and specific as possible so that they can quickly deliver their value and help to establish or reinforce a positive relationship with your lead or customer. Whitepapers As is true of a report, a whitepaper is an authoritative guide that concisely informs readers about a complex issue and aims to help leads understand an issue, solve a problem, or make a decision. Although the whitepaper helps to educate your prospects, it also helps to promote your business’s products or services. Whitepapers can often be very effective at generating business-to-business (B2B) leads. Primary research Primary research is research that you or your business collects. It can include interviews and observations. When you take the time to create new research, you’re providing a service and saving others from having to do their own primary research, which is why people opt in to a gated offer of this nature. Webinar training If you’re an expert in your field, or can partner with one, you can host an online training via a webinar that teaches or demonstrates a topic that is relevant to both your brand and to your target audience. You create a gated offer that requires prospects to fill out a registration form for the webinar, thus capturing prospects’ contact information and allowing you to follow up with them after the webinar takes place. Sales material In some cases, the most desired pieces of information for your market are pricing and descriptions of your products or services. This information helps people who are interested in buying your product or service make informed decisions. The sales material gated offer tends to be longer, in text and content examples such as images or customer testimonial videos, than the other examples in this chapter so far. However, this length is necessary because a person generally needs more information before making a purchase, especially if a big-ticket item is involved. 86 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy IKEA provides a wonderful example of the sales material gated offer. The Scandinavian chain collects contact information in exchange for its catalog, which lists all its products. Figure 5-3 demonstrates IKEA’s gated offer, and because IKEA can deliver its catalog digitally, it speeds up the delivery of value to the new lead. FIGURE 5-3: IKEA’s sales catalog is an ideal example of a sales material gated offer. Source: https://info.ikea-usa.com/catalog/ Generating leads with tools Tools make powerful gated offers because they often deliver value much faster than the educational gated offers discussed in the previous section. Although whitepapers, reports, and case studies require someone to invest time in order to receive value, a tool is often immediately useful. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 87 Crafting Offers That Sell However, this also means that anyone who opts in is more likely to be a qualified lead. A qualified lead is someone who is actively seeking more information about your products or services because he or she is interested in buying from you. (An unqualified lead may not have been nurtured enough to make a purchase yet, or isn’t sure of what your company does or even what solution he or she seeks.) Handout or cheat sheet Though similar to a free report, both handouts and cheat sheets provide a different value to prospects. A handout or cheat sheet is generally short (one page or so) and cuts straight to an ultraspecific point, making the information easily digestible. You can deliver handouts and cheat sheets as checklists, mind maps, or “blueprints,” to name a few examples. Figure 5-4 shows an example of a handout as a gated offer. FIGURE 5-4: A handout is a prime example of useful content that can be gated. Source: https://www.leadpages.net/blog/blogging-for-businesses- should-you-blog/ Resource list If people are learning to do something that you’re an expert in, chances are they’ll want to know what tools you’re using to get it done. This type of gated offer makes a list of tools or resources (be it of apps, physical products, hardware, or other items) available to the new lead or prospect. The toolkit or resource aggregates the list so that the lead doesn’t have to keep searching for more information. Template A template is the perfect example of a proven, well-tested shortcut to better results and can make a tremendous gated offer. A template contains a proven pattern for success that requires less work on the part of the person using it. It might come in the form of a spreadsheet preconfigured to calculate business expenses. Or it can be a layout for designing a custom home. Templates make powerful gated offers because the prospect can put the tool to immediate use. Software Software can work well as a gated offer. You might, for example, offer full access to a free software tool that you developed or a free trial (that lasts for 14 days, perhaps) of your software in exchange for an email address. Software companies 88 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Discount and coupon clubs Discount and coupon clubs offer exclusive savings and early access to sales. This is an effective type of offer that acquires contact information and allows you to continue the conversation by reminding members of specials and rewards available to them. Quizzes and surveys Quizzes and surveys are fun and engaging for people to take and can be a great way to generate new leads. For instance, a beauty company might offer a “What’s Your Skin Type” quiz. These types of content are intriguing to members of your market because they want to know the results of the quiz or survey. To obtain the results of the quiz or survey, the prospect must first opt in by entering an email address. If the quiz or survey results provide value to your market, this type of gated offer can be powerful. Assessment You can develop a gated offer that assesses or tests prospects on a particular subject. At the end of the assessment, offer prospects a grade and information on actions they can take to improve their grade, which would likely be a tool or service that you provide. For example, this assessment can serve as a rubric for grading a blog post. Figure 5-5 shows an assessment offer that has been generating leads for HubSpot, a company that sells marketing software, for years. Leads can use the assessment from HubSpot to grade their marketing and make it better. Filling out the gated offer checklist You can improve your overall level of success by making effective gated offers with the eight point checklist in this section. You don’t have to check off every one of the factors in the checklist, but if you find that your gated offer meets very few of these criteria, you have reason to be concerned. Point 1: Is your offer ultraspecific? The more specific the promise of your gated offer is, the better it will perform after you provide that promise. By delivering on your promise, you have given value. This, of course, assumes that the promise you’re making is compelling to CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 89 Crafting Offers That Sell often offer a free trial of their software as a gated offer. A software gated offer can turn a lead who is on the fence about purchasing the product with a risk-free means of acquiring it, while also providing the company a way to follow up with that lead. the market you’re approaching. Make sure that your gated offer isn’t vague and that it offers an ultraspecific solution to an ultraspecific market. FIGURE 5-5: HubSpot ­generates leads with its gated offer of its ­“Website Grader” assessment. Source: https://website.grader.com/ Point 2: Are you offering too much? Believe it or not, your gated offer will perform better if it delivers on “one big thing” rather than a number of things. Your prospects live in a multitasking world, so you want to be sure that your gated offer focuses on one topic or theme and provides one path for your lead to take. If you include too many paths or offers, your leads can get distracted and go off course as they try to follow all the ideas presented in your gated offer, thereby causing them to not opt in. If possible, offer a single solution to a single problem rather than numerous solutions to numerous problems. Point 3: Does the offer speak to a desired end result? The members of your market are searching for solutions. What does your market really want? If you can craft a gated offer that promises that solution, prospects will gladly give you their contact information (and their attention) in return. 90 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Your market wants a solution and wants it now. Establish and communicate how long it will take your leads to consume and derive value from your gated offer so that they know what to expect. If it takes days or weeks, your gated offer is not delivering immediate gratification — not by a long shot. Point 5: Does the offer shift the relationship? The best gated offers do more than inform; they actually change the state and mind-set of your prospects so that they’re primed to engage in business with your company. After your leads have taken advantage of your offer, determine whether the value it provides will actually teach the leads how and why they should trust and buy from you. For example, if you sell gardening tools and supplies, a checklist entitled “15 Tools You Need to Create a Successful Container Garden” educates prospects on the tools they need while simultaneously moving them closer to purchasing the products you sell. Point 6: Does the offer have a high perceived value? Just because your gated offer is free doesn’t mean that it should look free. Use good design through the use of professional graphics and imagery to create a gated offer of high perceived value in the mind of your lead. Point 7: Does the offer have a high actual value? The right information at the right time can be priceless. The gated offer that delivers something priceless will enjoy very high conversion rates, but if you’re promising value, you have to deliver on it. A gated offer has high actual value when it lives up to its promise and delivers the goods. Point 8: Does the offer allow for rapid consumption? You don’t want your gated offer to be a roadblock in the buyer journey toward becoming a customer. Before customers buy from you, they want to receive value from your gated offer. You want the gated offer to help move the lead to the next step, so ideally the gated offer should deliver value immediately. In other words, avoid long ebooks or courses that take days or months to deliver their value. Why is it important that your gated offer be quickly and easily consumable? Because after your gated offer has been consumed, you want to make the next offer whenever possible. There is (usually) no better time to make an offer than directly after someone has taken a prior offer. However, few will buy from you if CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 91 Crafting Offers That Sell Point 4: Does the offer deliver immediate gratification? they haven’t received the value from the last offer you made — your gated offer. So be sure that your gated offer quickly delivers value, allowing you to then make an offer to purchase something. Designing Deep-Discount Offers Acquiring leads is the goal of the gated offer discussed in the previous section, but how do you acquire buyers? Remember that the key to success online is the sequence of the offers you make to new leads and customers. The best way to acquire buyers is by making an offer at such a deep discount that it is difficult to refuse. A deep-discount offer is an irresistible, low-ticket offer made to convert leads and cold prospects into buyers. The goal of a deep-discount offer is not profit. In fact, selling deep-discount offers may come at a net loss to your company. Offering deep discounts may therefore seem counterintuitive, but the goal of this type of offer is to acquire buyers. Deepdiscount offers change relationships; they turn a prospect into a customer, and that’s a big deal. After a prospect makes a successful purchase with your company, she is far more likely to buy from you again. Deep-discount offers bring you one step closer to achieving your goal of converting a prospect to a repeat buyer and possibly even a raving fan. Using physical premiums As the name suggests, physical premiums are physical products. Offer something that your market desires and discount it deeply. DIY Ready, a company in the DIY and home décor space, offers a $19 bracelet kit for free. The new customer need only enter his or her credit card to pay for shipping and handling to receive the bracelet kit. This is a physical product that do-it-yourselfers find highly desirable. Employing a book A physical book can make an excellent deep-discount offer. Books have an extremely high perceived and actual value. If you need to establish authority and trust with your market before making more complex or higher-ticket offers, the book is a great deep-discount offer to employ. Consider offering the book at a steep discount, or free plus shipping and handling. A physical or digital book isn’t the best idea when you want to generate leads, but it’s a highly effective way to convert prospects and leads into customers. Remember, the objective of a deepdiscount offer is to change the relationship with a lead or prospect and turn the person into a customer. 92 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Webinars are one of the most versatile offers available to digital marketers. You can conduct free webinars to generate leads, plus you can offer a webinar as a product. Remember that when you’re charging for anything and particularly a webinar, you should deliver value beyond what you’ve charged to attend. When employing a webinar to serve as a deep-discount offer, you may not want to use the term webinar in your offer. People generally associate that term with something free. Consider calling your deep-discount-offer webinar a teleclass, online training, or boot camp instead, and it can be prerecorded or held live. Selling software Software and application plugins are effective deep-discount offers because software saves people time and energy, so these are highly sought-after commodities. When you use software as a deep-discount offer, the deep discount price is likely to cause a “buying frenzy,” resulting in a highly successful acquisition campaign. Splintering a service If your business has a high-dollar product or service, you can take a small piece of that product, also known as a splinter, and sell it à la carte. The key is to offer a piece of your service that can stand alone at an incredibly low price. An example of a company that uses this approach is Fiverr, an online marketplace that offers tasks and services starting at $5. Figure 5-6 shows one of these Fiverr services, which include creating business logos. This is an excellent example of offering part of a highly sought-after service at a deep discount that will help turn a lead into a customer and can ultimately lead to more sales. After a person has bought from you, he’s likely to buy from you again. Because you’re breaking out a part or splinter of your service, you don’t have to create a new service. Instead, you’re offering a portion of an existing product or service. Brainstorming “little victories” to offer your leads Because deep-discount offers are low priced, low risk, and highly desirable, they help your leads overcome doubt about your business or product. Less monetary risk is involved for the leads, so they’re willing to take a chance and become CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 93 Crafting Offers That Sell Leveraging the webinar customers. However, it can be harder for a marketer or a business owner to overcome the self-doubt that leads may have about themselves or their ability to reach the “After” state that your product or service promises to take them to. That’s why the best deep-discount offers lead the customer to a “little victory.” FIGURE 5-6: Through Fiverr, larger services can be splintered into smaller, single projects. Source: https://www.fiverr.com/gfx_expert2/create-retro-vintage-logo A “little victory” is something that helps inspire your leads and gives them confidence that they can accomplish whatever solution or goal you’re offering, as well as the confidence that your product or service will help to get them there. A little victory gives your prospects hope and a taste of achieving the whole thing — of making it to the other side of the tunnel, so to speak. Keep in mind that little victories are usually quick to achieve and help deliver value to your customer. For instance, if you’re in the fitness world, you can offer your seven-day juice cleanse at a deep discount as a deep-discount offer. When describing the offer to potential buyers, you state that completing this juice cleanse is the hardest part of your program — because getting started is often the hardest part. If they can get through your seven-day cleanse, they’ll know that the toughest part is behind them. As you go through your products and services to determine which will make the best deep-discount offer, ask yourself what little victory this product or service can provide your customers. Brainstorm how it will give them hope, how it will help to get them over the hump of self-doubt. Helping your customers see that success is possible not only for the smiling customers in your testimonials but also for them, personally, will help make your offer more potent and enable you to build positive relationships with your newly acquired customers. 94 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Previous sections talk about the various forms your deep-discount offers could take and the importance of little victories. Next, look over the five-point deepdiscount offer checklist, presented in the following sections, so that you can ensure that your offer can convert leads and prospects into buyers. Point 1: Does it lower the barrier to entry? To start, your deep-discount offer should be low risk. The offer shouldn’t be expensive, time consuming, or difficult to understand. The best offers at this stage are often impulse buys, like the pack of gum you grab while you wait in line at the supermarket. The price of your offer depends on your market. Leads shouldn’t have to pause to consider whether they can afford your deep-discount offer; the price should remove that barrier. Again, the purpose of this offer is not profit. A good rule is to make these offers at $20 or below. Point 2: Is the value clear? Make your deep-discount offer easy to understand. You want to be able to quickly explain the value and entice the lead into buying. Therefore, your deep-discount offer shouldn’t be complex. Impulse buys are not complicated offers. Point 3: Is it useful but incomplete? The keyword here is useful. Your deep-discount offer should not be a bait-andswitch offer. If the deep-discount offer doesn’t deliver on its promise, you’ll tarnish your relationship with that customer. You may have gained a quick sale with the deep-discount offer but lost a potential lifelong customer. This offer must be useful in its own right, but it is not the whole package. Point 4: Does it have a high perceived value? As with the gated offer before it, use good design to create a deep-discount offer with a high-quality look and feel. You don’t want your new customers to feel ripped off; instead, you want them to feel as though the deep-discount offer they just bought from you was a steal. People don’t buy products and services online, but rather buy pictures and descriptions of products and services online. If you want to sell online, you need to employ design and copywriting that communicate the value of the products and services you’re offering. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 95 Crafting Offers That Sell Filling out the deep-discount offer checklist Point 5: Does it have a high actual value? Be sure that your deep-discount offer makes good on its promise and delivers value. This situation builds trust with your new customers, and when they’re ready to buy again, they will remember the positive experience they had with you. Discovering your deep-discount offer The offer you use to acquire customers likely exists inside your core offer, which is a higher-priced or more complex product or service. Your core offer is often your flagship product or service. Look at your core offer and see what piece or pieces can stand on their own. What can you splinter off and still deliver value with that piece? Here are some questions to ask to help you discover your deep-discount offer(s): »» What’s the cool gadget that your market wants, but doesn’t necessarily need? What’s your impulse buy? What’s your stick of gum? »» What’s the one thing everyone needs, but doesn’t necessarily want? This can be a product or service that people know they need but aren’t exactly excited about. The product may not be “sexy,” but it’s critical to a process that people engage in. For instance, if someone has a candle-making hobby, the wick may not be as fun or interesting as the colored waxes or scented oils, but it’s an essential ingredient. »» What’s a valuable service that you can perform quickly and inexpen- sively, one that will deliver results in advance and get your foot in the door? This idea goes beyond giving someone a free quote or estimate; it gives customers a taste of how you can positively affect their lives. For example, a roofer could offer a deep discount on gutter cleaning as a deep-discount offer. After completing the job, the roofer could point out any necessary improvements that the roof or gutters need. That’s a deep-discount offer that provides value first and then gets your foot in the door. »» What little victory or victories does your deep-discount offer provide? How do you help the customer overcome self-doubt? Maximizing Profit As this chapter explains, you use ungated, gated, and deep-discount offers to acquire new customers and buyers. But when do you actually make a profit? The cost of acquiring new customers is often the most expensive one that 96 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy The marketing campaigns you employ to sell more, or more often, to the leads and customers you’ve acquired are called Monetization campaigns, and these campaigns have a number of different types of offers to employ. Most companies are running Monetization campaigns (making high-dollar and complex offers; see Book 1, Chapter 4) directed at ice-cold prospects and brand new leads. Although it would be fantastic to be profitable without needing to warm up a prospect with ungated, gated, and deep-discount offers, making that work is very difficult. The sequence of the offers you make to people is extremely critical to avoid being the business that is asking its prospects for too much, too soon. Making an upsell or cross-sell offer The first type of monetization offer is the immediate upsell, and it’s one you’re probably already familiar with even if you’ve never heard the term. An example of the immediate upsell is the famous “Do you want fries with that?” offer made at McDonald’s. Upsells offer customers more of what they already bought. The purchase they are currently making and the upsell should lead the customer to the same desired end result. In the McDonald’s example, adding fries to your order gets you a bigger meal. The cross-sell offer, on the other hand, makes an offer related to the first purchase. For example, a clothing retailer might offer dress shoes to a man who just purchased a suit. Amazon.com (and virtually every other successful online retailer) uses upsell and cross-sell offers to increase the number of items people purchase. Amazon’s “Frequently Bought Together” and “Customers Who Bought This Item Also Bought” sections contain immediate upsell and cross-sell offers to help ensure the sale and possibly increase the basket size. In Figure 5-7, the item being searched for is Harry Potter and the Cursed Child, and Amazon offers some related Harry Potter books that would serve as an upsell and increase the basket size from $17.98 to $44.96. But Amazon also offers cross-sells in the form of other fantasy books that may appeal to a fan of Harry Potter because they’re of the same genre. Because the cross-sell may not be as relevant to the first purchase, a cross-sell can feel like it’s coming out of left field, which can be jarring to and unwanted by the customer. That’s why you have to be careful with cross-sells, or you risk annoying your customers. Imagine buying a Mac computer and having Apple ask before you’ve even left the store whether you want to buy an iPhone or an iPad. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 97 Crafting Offers That Sell businesses incur. After you have a buyer, asking that buyer to buy from you again makes sense. You want to turn that customer you spent so much time and money acquiring into a repeat customer. That said, if the cross-sell truly complements the initial purchase, your customers will welcome the offer, and you’ll welcome the additional revenue. FIGURE 5-7: Amazon expertly uses upsells and cross-sells to increase the basket size of its customer and get the sale. Source: https://www.amazon.com Building bundles and kits Bundles and kits are other forms that your monetization offer can take. A bundle or a kit is taking one of your stand-alone products and combining it with other like items that you or one of your business partners sell. For example, if you sell men’s razors, you might bundle the razor with a shaving kit that includes all the essential items a man needs to shave with, from the brush to the after-shave. This “essential shaving kit” will cost more than an individual razor, which increases your revenue per sale. Do you have products or services that you can combine to create a new value proposition? Tacking on a slack adjuster Slack adjusters can have a dramatic impact upon the bottom line. A slack adjuster is a product or service that you offer at a price point much higher than your typical offer. The price is generally 10 to 100 times higher than your usual offers. Although this product or service will appeal to only a very small portion of your market, those that do make this high-ticket purchase will have a dramatic impact on your revenue. For example, Starbucks sells cups of tea and coffee, but the company also sells coffee makers. The coffee maker is far more expensive than the $6 cup of coffee. 98 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Recurring billing Sometimes called a continuity offer in digital marketing circles, a recurring billing offer charges the customer periodically — usually each month or year. This may take the form of a club or some other type of membership, or a subscription such as a monthly gym membership. In the latter case, the gym charges a membership fee 12 times a year. You also find recurring billing in content and publishing with subscriptions to Netflix or Cosmopolitan magazine, and in e-commerce with products like Dollar Shave Club and Birchbox. Look to your products or services and consider how you can make a sale once and get paid over and over again. Recurring billing can be a difficult sell because of the commitment that goes along with it. To overcome this issue, clearly communicate the advantage provided by the recurring billing offer and lower the perceived risk by clearly communicating the cancellation. For instance, the cooking delivery company Blue Apron often states in its offers that you can cancel anytime. In the dating analogy earlier in this chapter, a recurring billing offer is akin to a marriage proposal. Customers must decide whether they want to commit to you for an extended period. CHAPTER 5 Crafting Offers That Sell 99 Crafting Offers That Sell Most people stick to their usual beverage and ignore the coffee maker, but a few buy the coffee maker. When a product is that much more expensive than the core offer, only a small number of slack adjuster sales is needed to make an impact. IN THIS CHAPTER »» Setting goals for campaigns »» Managing your campaigns and activities »» Monitoring metrics through KPIs Chapter 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success M easuring the success of your marketing campaigns depends on your business goals and the type of campaign you’re running. Sales and marketing work for the same company and therefore need to have the same goal: generating revenue. Generating more revenue begins with creating more quality engagement within your target accounts. Your marketing team is focused on driving awareness, influence, and engagement from within your target accounts. This engagement is driven through strategic marketing campaigns and activities aimed at individual contacts in those accounts. To create this engagement, you must know what’s working. Are you seeing your accounts move to the next stage in the buyer journey? Is your marketing creating velocity and putting new opportunities in pipeline? In this chapter, you see which metrics to measure for your campaigns. You look at how to test your message, graphics, and creative content to help drive more engagement within your target list of accounts. You also see how to review your metrics to know you’re efficiently using every dollar dedicated to your campaigns. Before you can tackle the topics in this chapter, you need to set up a Customer Relationship Management (CRM) system. Your CRM serves as a centralized place to store and manage all your customers’ contact information. All your data should be stored here instead of spreadsheets, as this can cause data silos. Data silos are CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 101 a problem because they make it impossible for your team to access and update information in real time. The good news is that modern CRM platforms have a robust application programming interface (API). The API lets your systems “talk” to each other. Setting Key Performance Indicators To measure your goals. it’s important to have key performance indicators (KPIs). The KPIs let you know whether you’re on track to meet your goals and whether your sales and marketing team is focused on the things they need to do to grow more revenue. For more information about KPIs and campaign tracking, see Book 9. The most important KPI is the movement of your target accounts through the buyer journey. This is measured by using data in your CRM. Your sales and marketing teams need to define what the next meaningful stage or status that these accounts go to, with the ultimate goal of making these accounts your customers. Here is an example of the stages through with your accounts and the associated KPIs might progress. »» New/Prospect: The number of accounts that were qualified as a best-fit with your ideal customer profile and persona criteria. »» Qualified: The number of accounts generated by marketing that went through a discovery call or demo to become a revenue opportunity. »» Opportunity: The number of accounts that became revenue-generating customers. The number of opportunities added to pipeline through marketing activities is called marketing-sourced pipeline. »» Customer Upsell/Cross-sell: Customer accounts that will purchase more from your company, or purchase a better/upgraded version of your offering. »» Customer Advocate: The number of customers who serve as advocates for your brand, refer new business, or collaborate for marketing. Attributing metrics at the account level Account-level attribution means you can see the activity at each of the accounts you’re targeting. You must know which content and marketing activities are creating velocity and advancing accounts to the next stage of the buyer’s journey. 102 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Because there will be different activities at each stage of the buyer journey for accounts (versus an individual customer), you need to examine all of the touchpoints that influence an account. You can’t say “This account closed because they came to this event,” but it’s a combination of all the activities that lead to revenue. If marketing tried to report which leads turned into customers, there were many missing pieces. That’s because marketing was focused on an individual lead or contact, not on all the contacts in the account. With lead-based marketing, it was a hope that one of the leads that came in became a customer. But leads don’t pay your company money. Your accounts that became customers are what keeps the lights on at your office. This is why, as a marketer, you need to look at the activities that helped generate new customer accounts. Lead-based attribution reporting doesn’t give marketers enough credit for all their activities. If a lead came through from downloading an ebook two years ago, but the lead’s company just became a customer, how do you know which touchpoint to credit with a deal? You wouldn’t. The initial lead may have downloaded an ebook, but you wouldn’t know that one ebook download started the journey to becoming a customer. What marketing wants to know from account-level attribution is how the contact’s action impacted this deal being closed? Account-level attribution is about getting more insight into all the account’s activities. Part of this influence is getting your message in front of the right contacts in the account. One of the C-level executives you’re targeting is much less likely to click an ad to download an ebook or fill out a form. This is why account-level attribution is so important. You need to examine the activities of all the contacts in the account to find what’s driving them to progress to the next stage and purchase from your company. Account-level attribution should recognize any and all of your sales and marketing efforts. Your efforts include the activities and content that are used to create velocity and accelerate an account through the buyer journey to generate new revenue. When starting with your first account-level campaigns, revenue won’t come immediately. It takes time to grow your business by developing opportunities in your best-fit accounts. CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 103 Planning B2B Campaign Success Before marketers were able to report on account-level metrics. B2B marketers were used to lead-based metrics. This caused a lot of friction with the sales ­department. Sales didn’t report on what happened with the leads they got from marketing. The sales team reported on accounts that became customers. Account-based sales and marketing is about identifying the path your best-fit customers take, and replicating it again and again. There’s good news: other KPIs determine whether you’re on track to meet or exceed your revenue goal. Using metrics and KPIs, you can track the success of all your activities and campaigns. These metrics show you what’s working to generate velocity in accounts. KPIs also help demonstrate where campaigns can be refined for success in the future. Here are the smaller KPIs to check: »» Timeline of stage-progression: From the first touch as a prospect, the amount of time for the account to become an opportunity »» Engagement in accounts: Showing an uptick in the account’s score in your marketing automation system »» Expanded engagement in accounts: More contacts from a targeted account coming to your site and engaging with your content It’s important to watch the progression of accounts. This information can be found using reporting in your CRM. However your CRM is organized, you need to set progression rules. Progression rules are a specific type of feature in the CRM. Your sales database administrator or marketing operations manager would need to set up a workflow rule or automation rule. These progression rules will let you know whether accounts are moving from one stage to the next. When you’re running a targeted advertising campaign at qualified accounts who have completed the first discovery call or demo, then your KPI will be how many of those accounts turned into opportunities. The results of your marketing activities and campaigns will be different for every B2B organization. There’s no right or wrong answer. The question to ask is how do you measure influence? What are you doing to drive awareness and engagement in accounts? Whatever phase or stage you’re looking at, the KPI you need to monitor is the time it typically takes to move to the next stage. This is part of the calculation of sales velocity. The formula is distance/time=sales velocity. The sales velocity is what marketing wants to create to progress the account to a revenue-generating customer. All of marketing’s daily activities should increase the number of appointments or demos sales can set. Your marketing is running an advertising campaign in conjunction with sales activities such as calls and emails. 104 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy The efforts from marketing include monitoring web engagement with your advertisements and contacts downloading content. The “sales and marketing” efforts all come together to impact the movement of that account from one stage to the next of the buyer journey to becoming a customer. In your CRM, you can run reports to see how many accounts are in which stage. Because your sales team should be updating the CRM every time an account moves to the next stage in the purchase decision, you can run a report on this progression. Every week, the reports your team runs should include »» Content downloads »» Demo request forms completed »» Inbound demos scheduled »» Inbound demos completed »» Inbound opportunities created »» Inbound closed/won opportunities The goal is to monitor and report on the progression of accounts, and illustrate how marketing activities are contributing to this progression. You can consolidate these metrics into a single Excel spreadsheet to show your sales and marketing team. Table 6-1 is an example of the weekly sales and marketing metrics report for the number of accounts and their stage-based progression. TABLE 6-1 Example Report of Inbound Marketing Activity for Account Progression Week Ending In Week 1 Week 2 Week 3 Week 4 Week 5 Content Downloads 19 22 10 9 30 Demo Request Form Completions 8 4 7 5 5 Inbound Demos Scheduled 8 5 2 6 14 Inbound Demos Completed 5 7 7 2 0 Inbound Opportunities Created 3 2 6 1 0 Inbound Closed/Won Opportunities 5 3 1 1 1 CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 105 Planning B2B Campaign Success Run weekly reports in your CRM to show how marketing is working to progress your target accounts to the next stages. All your account-based marketing campaigns should be focused on progression from one stage to another. The goals for your campaigns include »» Generating demand within your target prospect accounts »» Increasing number of accounts moving into qualification, such as marketing qualified accounts (MQA) or sales qualified accounts (SQA) »» Increasing the number of opportunities in your qualified accounts »» Increasing Closed/Won deal size »» Increasing revenue or increasing contract length »» Decreasing in time from initial contact to Closed/Won, resulting in a shorter sales cycle »» Decreasing churn (the number of customers who came on board, then didn’t renew or continue doing business with your company) »» Increasing the number of customers who successfully adopt and implement your solution »» Creating new customer advocates Attributing metrics at the campaign level Each campaign will have metrics you need to monitor. When you’re running an advertising campaign targeted at your accounts, you look at these two main metrics: »» Impressions: The number of times your ad appeared to a contact in your target account. Every time your message appears, it’s counted towards the impressions. »» Clicks: The number of times contacts you’re targeting clicked on the CTA (call to action) in your ad. It’s all about getting your message in front of the right people. The success of your advertising campaigns should be measured by impressions, not clicks. What you need to show is how a targeted advertising campaign provided an uptick in engagement. It’s this engagement that will help progress the account further in the purchase decision. You’re running targeted advertising campaigns, according to the stage in the buyer journey for the account. By showing how many impressions you had for a certain campaign, you can correlate this to a progression of the account. Here is an example: You’re running an advertising campaign that targets accounts in the opportunity stage. These are high-priority opportunities targeted to close 106 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy The campaign runs for a full month. You set the campaign to run for one month because you want to close these accounts in 30 days. At the beginning of the campaign, you check how many accounts are in the opportunity stage. At the end of the campaign, you check how many of those accounts turned into Closed/Won customers. This helps show whether the advertising campaign worked to create velocity and progress the opportunity to closed/won. Because you’re running this campaign from an account-based marketing platform, when the deal comes in it becomes a Closed/Won customer. The contacts in that account will need to be removed from the campaign. Your B2B campaign is synced with your CRM. Because the stage of the account has been updated in your CRM, and your campaign is running based on the stage, the account will be removed from an opportunity accelerator campaign. However your data is organized in your CRM, set this as a progression rule. You can target these companies with advertising for a certain amount of time (such as 30 days for accounts that a high priority to close). In 30 days, you want to progress those high-priority accounts from the SQA or opportunity stage to becoming a customers. At the end of 30 days, examine how many of these accounts have moved to a ­progressed stage. Comparing cost per click Every marketing team has a budget. The budget is set by the Chief Financial Officer (CFO) of your company. The CFO wants to see a retrun on investment from the amount of money the company has invested in marketing initiatives. One of the big questions B2B marketers always get is “How many leads did you generate this quarter?” But that’s a vanity metric, because the number of leads generated doesn’t correlate to the amount of new revenue the company brought in. Your CFO should be delighted that you’re going to cut costs by taking an accountbased approach. An B2B approach to your digital campaigns means rethinking your metrics. If you’ve run search engine marketing or other digital advertising campaigns before, you know the two big metrics are »» Cost-per-click (CPC): How much you spent to get a person to click the advertisement. »» Cost-per-thousand impressions (CPM): How much you spent to get your advertisement to appear 1,000 times. CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 107 Planning B2B Campaign Success within the next 30 days. Because these accounts are associated with a revenue opportunity in your CRM, you can pull this account list and run an advertising campaign to accelerate these accounts. This is called an opportunity accelerator campaign. These metrics worked for a lead-based approach, but they weren’t targeted. If you were running an SEM campaign, there were many wasted marketing dollars. ­Marketing must bid on each click and impression, and you can’t get accountlevel attribution with most SEM campaigns. This is because the campaigns are run through search engines. It doesn’t make sense to continue investing marketing budget in clicks and impressions, especially when marketing can’t tie that investment back to an account they’re trying to nurture for sales. What makes more sense is to run a targeted advertising campaign through your account-based marketing platform. Because the B2B platform is synced with your CRM, you know exactly who you want to target. You can get in front of the decision maker with an impression, even when he doesn’t click your ad. Marketers, especially those familiar with SEM, know this isn’t typically what they’re used to doing with advertising and retargeting. The account is more important than getting a lower CPC or CPM. Because you aren’t running advertisements to anyone who searches your keywords, the overall cost will be much lower. In 2018, the average click-through rate for standard image ads was 0.05 percent, according to Smart Insights (https://www. smartinsights.com/internet-advertising/internet-advertising-analytics/ display-advertising-clickthrough-rates/). This means that you get 5 clicks per 10,000 impressions. Talk about a waste of money when you look at how much you spent on CPC for leads that ultimately would never turn into customers. Showing impressions Dynamic CPM is another option that is far less expensive for targeting at the account level. The dynamic CPM is based on the value of each impression. Using your account-based marketing platform, you can bid for a flat CPM at the beginning of a campaign. This dynamic CPM is based on impressions (not clicks) for the individual contacts you want to target in the account. You’re running targeted advertising campaigns according to your account’s industry, the job roles of contacts in the account, and the stage of the buyer’s journey. The key metric here is the number of impressions within your target accounts: How many times your message appeared throughout your account-based advertising campaign. The reporting you’ll need to show includes: »» Number of accounts you actively targeted »» Number of contacts reached »» Total number of impressions from your campaign 108 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy Planning B2B Campaign Success This reporting will show how your campaign surrounded your account with your message to achieve a halo effect and keep your company top of mind throughout the purchase decision. Figure 6-1 is an example of a campaign report showing the number of targeted accounts, contacts reached, and impressions achieved. FIGURE 6-1: Report of ­impressions from a campaign. Traditional lead-based success metrics were such numbers as clicks, click-through rates, and form completions. These generated more leads. But it’s truly about what’s business-centric: increasing revenue by bringing on the right accounts. These accounts fit your personas and are the best fit for your business. Expanding your audience With account-based marketing, you don’t go after just one contact in the account. You must get in front of as many stakeholders as possible. You can expand your audience by using an account-based marketing platform that pulls in data on your accounts and personas. The power of an account-based platform for advertising is the ability to sync with your CRM. You plug in the company names you want to target. This is accomplished by syncing the contact information in your database with cookie- or IPbased targeting of all the devices that meet the criteria and expand on what you have in your CRM. This will give you the capability to show account-level attribution across digital channels because your platform is integrated with your CRM. If you only have one contact for the account in your CRM, you don’t have enough information to proceed. You need to reach more than one person at the c ­ ontact’s company to move the purchase decision forward. You may be reaching the right person, but you need to also expand your audience to connect with all the CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 109 decision-makers involved. It’s about reaching all the contacts in the account on their own terms. Engaging accounts You only have a few seconds to engage a contact and keep their attention, so more than one activity is needed to grab their attention for the entire journey. For a full view of engagement in an account, you must marry the data in your CRM and marketing platform with your automation system. That system is tracking all the activities for the contacts in your accounts. The data from your marketing platform and automation system can also be transferred into your CRM to see an account score. Your reporting needs to show whether a specific activity or interaction triggered a stage progression of the account. At the account level, you need to see whether marketing created the halo effect to influence individuals. Everything is truly focused on progression of accounts. The faster you can progress your accounts, the quicker you can accelerate your accounts through the sales pipeline to generate more revenue. Engaging accounts continues after you have landed accounts as your new customers. Marketing must continue to nurture them and develop them into customer advocates. Advocate marketing helps you to retain your existing customers. By developing your customers into advocates, they become “champion” users of your business. Customer advocates also help you create awareness in more new accounts through word-of-mouth referrals. MEASURING ENGAGEMENT IN MINUTES Founded by Marketo co-founder Jon Miller, Engagio is an account-based outbound marketing platform for B2B companies with complex, enterprise sales. Engagio’s ABM platform complements marketing automation platforms (such as Marketo), with account-centric capabilities. It helps companies engage target accounts, expand customer relationships, and deepen sales and marketing alignment. The company’s first solution integrates with marketing automation and Salesforce to streamline account-based reporting and analytics. By matching leads to accounts, the solution helps companies know which marketing investments work best to reach target accounts and accelerate deals, understand which accounts have the best engagement and opportunity for growth, and measure the impact and ROI of your ABM programs — all without spending tons of time in Excel. 110 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy To know whether you’re effectively engaging your customer accounts, you need to see an increase in moving your customers through the their journies. It’s all about the increase in revenue within an account, or creating a new sales opportunity in your customer account. These types of customer engagement metrics can include Testing Your Campaigns Marketing is a science. Before starting a marketing campaign, you have a hypothesis about it you think will work. There’s a goal you want to achieve. You’ll test the marketing message and creative, like a scientist would test a hypothesis, then modify them as needed. When you plan your account-based marketing campaign, you likely already know which group of companies you want to target, and the roles within those companies. The next step is to develop a persona with the needs, wants, and desires of the target roles. A/B creative testing Many traditional marketing strategies don’t allow you to optimize until after a campaign has run its course. But advertising at the account level lets you optimize your campaigns on the fly through A/B testing. You can see which advertising creative and marketing messages are falling flat with your target audience as the campaign runs, then replace copy or ads that aren’t having much success. The success is measured by the number of clicks on your advertisement that take the contact to your landing page. A/B testing is a common capability in marketing automation platforms. It allows you to test two versions of an email or landing page to see which one delivers better engagement. You can do A/B testing with your account-based marketing campaigns to see how your advertisements are performing. CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 111 Planning B2B Campaign Success »» New sales opportunity, such as an upsell for a new product »» Cross-selling the same product to a different business unit in the account To make sure switches are seamless, have alternate messaging and creative ready to go for your advertisements. In your account-based advertising platform, you can load two variations of the same advertisement. These variations include simple changes, such as »» Slight revisions in the copy, or the message on your content »» Graphics, such as design, images, color, and font »» CTA (the call to action, such as “Read More” and “Learn More”) Figure 6-2 shows A/B testing of an advertisement in an ABM platform. FIGURE 6-2: Example of A/B testing your advertising creatives. Trying new content Content marketing is a much softer way of selling. With content that educates your prospects and contacts about your thought leadership position, your brand stays top-of-mind when it’s time for a purchase decision. In a non-pushy way, this content helps educate your contacts about your business. The marketing campaigns you’re running should be linked to a piece of content. You can replace the content in the campaign by changing the link. When you’re running an advertising campaign, the CTA will be linked to a piece of content. When you’re running an email campaign, a CTA to download content will be included, too. After you’ve performed A/B testing to find which graphics, message, and creative content works best for your targeted audience, you can test which content resonates the most. When you’re running an advertising campaign designed to progress qualified accounts into opportunities, you can test different pieces of 112 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy content; for example, comparing a .pdf customer case study to a customer video testimonial. Combining your offers A comprehensive marketing strategy means you’re offering lots of different content and activities to the contacts in the account. When you need to build awareness in a new account, you have the sales department sending emails, marketing running advertising campaigns, and the account may be on a nurturing drip, too. You’re driving your message and your name brand in multiple places. How do you know what’s working in this combination of activities? It comes back to the time required for the account to move to the next stage of the buyer journey. Because you’re running campaigns and emailing content, and sales reps are calling and emailing accounts, you know that one activity doesn’t necessarily mean that’s what triggered the account to progress to the next stage. Account-based marketing has many activities and efforts that make up a comprehensive strategy. Knowing You Aren’t Wasting Money There’s a famous quote from advertising legend John Wanamaker: “Half the money I spend on advertising is wasted. The trouble is, I don’t know which half.” The allocation and attribution of advertising spend are hot topics for marketers. The incredible part of account-based marketing is that you can be laser-focused on where your advertising dollars are going, and directly connect this amount with engagement metrics for each account. You need to show a return on investment to prove to your executive and leadership and finance team why account-based marketing works to drive business, not leads. Lead generation was an easy sell, because it gave marketers the ability to demonstrate tangible, quick results. “Look, we generated 1,000 new leads this quarter.” But, according to Forrester Research, less than 1 percent of leads actually close. That’s a lot of wasted money. Marketing to only the right accounts will have a much more significant impact on revenue. You won’t be wasting 99 percent of your money. CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 113 Planning B2B Campaign Success From your test group, which subset of accounts saw more progression to the opportunity stage? Did the accounts who received the CTA to watch the video testimonial progress to opportunities faster than the accounts who downloaded the case study? Testing different pieces of content in the same campaign can provide you with these types of insights. At the same time, you’re likely facing greater pressure to show return on investment from your ad spend. Simply put, your ad campaign success is important. Here’s how to look like a hero. Budgeting the right amounts Account-based targeting doesn’t require nearly as much of an investment as other types of digital advertising, such as search engine marketing. You’re focusing only on the contacts in accounts you want to get your message in front of, so you can be more conservative with your advertising spend. When you’re preparing a budget for how much you want to invest in your account-based advertising campaigns, consider the following factors: »» The number of accounts you’re targeting. »» The stage of the accounts you’re targeting (MQA, SQA, opportunity, or customer). »» The industry (or number of industries, if you’re targeting one type of job role, such as a CMO). »» The number of job roles, if you’re targeting one type of industry. For example, if you’re targeting marketing managers, directors, and CMOs of marketing technology companies. From here, you will set a daily budget for your advertising campaigns. The daily budget is the maximum amount you want to spend to get your advertisement to appear to those contacts in your target accounts. Test a smaller group to determine how much budget was needed, then scale from there. Attributing advertising spend to revenue With your targeted advertising campaigns, you can show a direct correlation to how much you spent at the account level and whether the account became a customer. This is a significant proof point for account-based marketing. If your company is currently making any type of search engine marketing or CPC investment, you know you can’t attribute how much you spent on digital advertising to grow revenue. You don’t have enough visibility into targeting accounts. Using an accountbased marketing platform for targeted advertising, you can run reports to see 114 BOOK 1 Creating Your Digital Marketing Strategy the performance of your campaigns. These reports will show you the following metrics: »» How much you invested (dollars spent) »» The number of impressions (how many times your advertisement reached one of your targeted contacts) »» The number of clicks (how many times a contact clicked your advertisement to Using your CRM platform, you can see how many accounts in these campaigns progressed to becoming your customers, ultimately tying back your advertising dollars to new revenue generated. Showing engagement in the buyer journey Gathering feedback from your sales team is an important part of the optimization process. It should happen continuously as you run your campaigns. The goal of your campaigns is to move accounts faster through the buyer journey. To know just how fast accounts are moving through your pipeline, you can use reports in your CRM to see the number of days an account moved to the next stage. At the account level, you want to demonstrate how your advertising campaigns created a halo effect. A halo effect describes how a contact in an account is surrounded by your message. This increased messaging helps to keep your brand top-of-mind and progress the account through the various stages of the buyer journey to close a deal. CHAPTER 6 Planning B2B Campaign Success 115 Planning B2B Campaign Success go to a landing page) 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Interacting with Customer Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Understanding Big Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Uncovering the Role Big Data Plays in Content Marketing. . . . . . . 122 Discovering the Internet of Things . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Visualizing Big Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 CHAPTER 2: Uncovering Buyer Personas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Reviewing Persona Development. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Collecting Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Avoiding Common Mistakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Looking at How Generations Differ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Identifying a Prospect’s Emotions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Keeping Up with Trends. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 CHAPTER 3: Structuring the Buyer Journey. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Harnessing the Customer Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Uncovering Commercial Intent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Defending Against Competitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Identifying the Stages of the Buyer Journey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Personalizing Your Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 CHAPTER 4: Embracing Sales Enablement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Discovering Sales Enablement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Training Your Salesforce. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Coaching Your Reps to Become Winners. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Checking Out Sales Enablement Blogs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Looking at big data problems »» Recognizing why data is crucial to digital marketing »» Discovering different types of data Chapter 1 Interacting with Customer Data A re you drowning in data but don’t have enough useful information? Most companies today are encountering big data problems. (Big data is the term used to describe all the analytical information collected from digital content.) A book on digital marketing would not be complete without a discussion of data. But before you look at specific content measurements, you need to understand the impact technology has had on data and the opportunities and problems it presents. In today’s marketplace, data plays a key role in every part of your online business and is critical to your success. The good news is that both small and large companies can collect the data they need to make smart decisions. The bad news is that so much data gets collected that making sense of it can be hard. In this chapter, you look at the types of data that are available to you to gather, and the problems you may run into when trying to harness their value. Understanding Big Data To expand on the brief definition of big data from the introduction, it’s really a massive digital collection of structured and unstructured data. (Both types are defined a little later in this chapter.) CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 119 Thanks to technology, reams of customer data available from customer relationship management systems (CRMs), and even more is being collected on social media platforms and generated by users in the form of ratings and reviews. The first instance of the use of the phrase big data was said to have been used in a paper written by the National Aeronautics and Space Administration (NASA) in 1997. Big data is a valuable commodity for marketing. It lets you see data patterns that you may have missed and allows you to make predictions about the content your customers want. But you need to ask yourself a question before you launch a big data effort. That is, what are the business goals for the data you are collecting? Your content needs to tie in to your overall business goals — and your big data effort needs to tie in as well. You want to be sure that the questions you want your data to answer are crucial to the success of the business itself. Big data collection and analysis can be expensive. Your company will quickly sour on the effort if it doesn’t deliver on its promise to increase revenue and satisfy customers. Looking at different kinds of big data Marketers have always been able to extract some form of data for marketing efforts. You could get such things as a customer list with locations or a list of purchases by amount. So why is data collection an issue now? The answer is that there is more data now than ever before. Smartphones, social networks, websites, and factories with data sensors on machinery, and more all have data. All of it must be useful — but how to harness its value? To understand some of the basic concepts that underlie big data, you can start by looking at the kind of data you can extract. Table 1-1 shows the model that IBM follows. TABLE 1-1 Types of Data Data Types Description Examples Descriptive “Who” data Geo-demographics, attributes, characteristics Behavioral “What” data Transactions, payments history, and orders Interaction “How” data Emails, web clicks, chat transcripts Attitudinal “Why” data Market research, social media 120 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience You can look further at how to understand the who, what, how, and why designations by looking at descriptive data, behavioral data interaction data, and attitudinal data as follows: »» Descriptive data: This is your “who” data. You analyze it to find out who your customers are. »» Behavioral data: This is your “what” data. You analyze it to find out what interactions your customer has had with your company. »» Interaction data: This is your “how” data. You analyze it to find out how your customers interact with your company. It helps you understand their reasoning for interacting with your brand. »» Attitudinal data: This is your “why” data. It tells you why your customers are interested in your brand. Aside from the types of messages that can be extracted from big data, you also need to recognize that you are dealing with two different categories of data — structured and unstructured. Structured data has been around a long time, but unstructured data has become available with the advent of social media. Here’s how they differ from one another: »» Structured data: In previous years, all the data that companies collected was structured. The data fit into neat categories and could be presented on a spreadsheet. For example, think about a list of customer deliveries. Each cell in the database had predictable information — location, date of delivery, and so on. Computers were programmed to collect this data, and everything was very straightforward. When data scientists received this data, they knew what to expect and how it would be analyzed. This is still true. »» Unstructured data: With the advent of social networks and user-generated content, you now have a mountain of data that isn’t structured. You have reviews, comments, and ratings. You also have a variety of formats — photos, live streaming data, and video. This data is more complex and requires different ways of analyzing and extracting meaning from it. In addition to the structure, businesses have other problems to confront. Marketers have dubbed these problems “the Four Vs” of big data. CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 121 Interacting with Customer Data Looking at problems with big data The problems are related to the following: »» Volume: Information scientists believe that 90 percent of the world’s data has been created in the last few years. Dealing with all of it in an effective way has been difficult for both large and small companies. »» Variety: Smartphones, tablets, computers, networks, and even watches generate data. Some is structured and some is not. None of it fits into a neat little package that can be easily analyzed. »» Velocity: Data is coming at an incredible rate. Not only are there vast amounts of it, but the problems are compounded by how fast new data is created. »» Veracity: Can the data be trusted? Do managers want to stake their reputa- tions on the fact that all the data that is flowing in is accurate? Common sense suggests that not everything collected can be used to predict customer behavior. How do you separate the wheat from the chaff? According to Paul Theriot, president of Alesco Data, a data management services company, a McKinsey analysis found that “. . . companies that put data at the center of their marketing and sales decisions improve their marketing return on investment (ROI) by 15 to 20%” (https://www.dmnews.com/data/article/13036917/ when-big-data-and-small-data-work-together). Uncovering the Role Big Data Plays in Content Marketing When you think about your content, you probably focus on what topic to write about and where you will distribute it. Those are important questions. The way you answer those questions, and many others, is by analyzing your data. When content marketing was in its infancy, many companies flew by the seat of their pants. They believed that they instinctively knew what kind of information their customers wanted. They proceeded to send steady streams of content, only to find that much of it was greeted without enthusiasm. That’s when managers decided that big data really did matter. Now they know that they need to use data to tell them how to beat the competition and get customers’ attention. There’s no time to waste sending content that doesn’t hit its mark. 122 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Improving your content marketing So, as a marketer, you want to know how using big data will improve your content marketing efforts. You should be happy to know that it enhances your effort in several ways. It helps you: »» Be more effective against your competition. By analyzing a variety of data, you can understand your competitors in ways that you couldn’t before. This understanding helps you create content with quality that surpasses that of your competition. »» Find new ways to compete. New data may allow you to find and explore new business models and niches. This exploration helps you create content that expands your customer base and creates new revenue streams. »» Zero in on your targeted audience. With more data telling you about channels, you know how and where to communicate with your customers. You can create the content that customers value and distribute it to the places they will look. »» Interact with your community. By knowing where your customers congregate, you can create a community of like-minded people who will help guide your content marketing efforts by providing feedback. »» Analyze your wins and losses. By quickly showing you what tactics are Interacting with Customer Data succeeding and failing, you can make revisions to content that improve website traffic and customer satisfaction. For more information about analyzing data, see Book 9. Using real-time content Obviously, the desire by marketers to provide customers with exciting real-time content is strong. It’s a way to capture attention and customers have come to expect it. The key to using this content effectively is to keep your customers at the center of all your efforts. The focus of this book is the idea of creating content that speaks to specific personas on the buyer journey. Don’t get sidetracked by providing real-time content that doesn’t speak directly to your customers. Customers have grown used to having their smartphones and other devices with them so that they can communicate as needed. Companies should expand their content messages as much as possible to take advantage of real-time content. (See Book 3 for more information about content types.) CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 123 Here are some other ideas that can expand your real-time reach: »» Use Facebook Live (https://live.fb.com/). Facebook Live makes it very easy to set up live streaming. You can interact with your customers and learn exactly what they care about. (See more about Facebook in Book 7.) »» Stream YouTube Live (https://www.youtube.com/live). You can set reminders to catch YouTube sports, music, and games. (See more about YouTube in Book 8, Chapter 1.) »» Create Instastories (https://help.instagram.com/899271546851408). Instastories have become very popular and are featured at the top of your Instagram feed. They are photos or videos that tell a quick story or show users something you’re doing. They disappear from the site after 24 hours. (See more about Instagram in Book 7, Chapter 5.) »» Conduct Twitter chats. Don’t only rely on tweets. Twitter chats are available in real time to all interested parties. You may be able to interest new users in your company by appealing to them from this channel. In addition, the transcript (content) will be available to them after the live chat. (See more about Twitter in Book 8, Chapter 1). »» Host Google Hangouts: Developing a webinar (an online seminar) for Google Hangouts is a quick and easy way to target customers on Google, the web’s most popular search platform. It also lets you create content that can be viewed later. »» Newsjack: Newsjacking is defined as the art of using news stories and celebrities to create timely content for your customers. You’ve probably seen content with titles like “What [insert rock star name] can teach you about [insert concept].” The trick with this content is to actually make the information valuable, as opposed to just using a celebrity name to get attention. Some marketers argue that getting attention is what newsjacking is about, but your audience will tire of it if you keep providing content attached to famous names and events that’s just not useful. Discovering the Internet of Things Are you curious about the Internet of Things (IoT) and how it relates to data? You’re going to hear more about the IoT as time goes on. The IoT is a network of items that communicate their data to people and things without the need for human interaction. Included are such things as sensors in machines, appliances, and electronics. 124 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Reviewing IoT market size Interacting with Customer Data Technology writer Walt Mossberg of Recode, shown in Figure 1-1, describes the IoT as “a whole constellation of inanimate objects [that] is being designed with builtin wireless connectivity so that they can be monitored, controlled, and linked over the Internet via a mobile app.” Mossberg says that users can install these objects in the home “without changing wiring or hiring a professional” (http://recode. net/2014/01/28/smartthings-automates-your-house-via-sensors-app/). FIGURE 1-1: Recode. What are examples of how the IoT benefits both business and consumers? »» Business: In the enterprise space, your factory floor can have machines that tell your managers when they need maintenance or need to have parts replaced. »» Consumer: As a consumer, you can be alerted when someone comes to your front door or when your appliance is out of warranty. So how big a market will the IoT be? Annual revenue from IoT sales is forecast to hit $1.6 trillion by 2025 (from just $200 billion in 2018) as shown in Figure 1-2. CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 125 FIGURE 1-2: IoT sales ­projections from Priceonomics. (https://priceonomics.com/the-iot-data-explosion-how-big-is-the-iotdata/) Does that get your attention? In addition, Intel projects that in 2020, the IoT will have two billion objects (see Intel’s infographic, shown in Figure 1-3 and found at http://www.intel.com/ content/www/us/en/internet-of-things/infographics/guide-to-iot.html). FIGURE 1-3: The Intel ­infographic on IoT. 126 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Clearly, you should not ignore this trend. What you need to know is how it will impact your customers. Impacting content marketing To help you understand how the IoT will affect your customer’s experience, here’s an example to consider. Your customer can receive your content in a myriad of places. She is no longer confined to gadgets such as her laptop and iPhone. For example, her refrigerator can alert her to problems with food temperature. This capability affects your touchpoints (points of contact between the customer and the company) and the customer journey, and requires you to develop new messages for customer consumption based on the device customers are coming from. Interacting with Customer Data Following are some specific ways in which the IoT impacts content marketing and the customer experience. In March of 2015, Altimeter produced an excellent report called “Customer Experience in the Internet of Things: Five Ways Brands Can Use Sensors to Build Better Customer Relationships” by Jessica Groopman (https://iot.do/new-research-customer-experience-in-the-internet-ofthings-2015-03; see Figure 1-4). This report discusses a variety of ways the ­customer can be affected by the IoT, including providing support and rewards. Four in particular have a direct impact on content marketing. FIGURE 1-4: ­Altimeter’s ­Customer ­Experience Report. CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 127 Following are ways to provide consumers with information and affect their decision-making: »» Environment and proximity data: You can send consumers your product messages based on factors like location, weather, and product interaction. Retailers, for example, can send targeted messages about what to wear or eat to beat the heat. »» Location-based information: Another way to use location data is to determine the customer’s proximity to the product itself. Companies can guide shoppers to find nearby products and to choose the specific product when they are in the retail store itself. »» Monitoring data: The product can monitor and send a variety of data from the device itself. An example is a health device that reports current heart rate to the user. »» Breaking news: Companies can alert users to important announcements and emergencies right from their devices in real time. Such alerts provide a public service as well as benefits to the user. IT’S MAGIC A great example of a company utilizing the IoT with big data to impact the customer experience was reported by Conner Forrest on ZDNet (http://www.zdnet.com/ article/ten-examples-of-iot-and-big-data-working-well-together). Disney created a wristband called MagicBand for use at Disney World. It has an RFID (radio frequency ID) chip inside it and connects a visitor and his family to all the services at Disney World. After you check in with your MagicBand, much of the annoyance associated with traveling and getting around is alleviated. You can enter the park, make restaurant reservations, track your luggage, and make purchases. All your activities are recorded for you by your MagicBand. In addition, it provides people with experiences personalized just for them. Disney made a considerable investment in developing the technology. It’s one of the first forays that Disney has made in the IoT, but the company is betting that customers will be delighted by the seamless customer experience and will return often. 128 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Visualizing Big Data One of the ways in which companies are coping with the influx of big data is to create visual displays that help them make sense of the data. For example, you’ve probably seen infographics that attempt to simplify the data. You can also use tools to create dashboards, mock-ups, and simulations. So how do you decide whether your data would lend itself to one of these visualization types? One way is to ask yourself the purpose of your visualization. Jim Stikeleather writing for the Harvard Business Review, laid out three reasons to visualize data. Stikeleather recommends data visualization for »» Confirmation: If your purpose is to confirm your assumptions, you want to display visuals (possibly on a dashboard) that help you determine whether you are correct. Visualization also helps you to look at how your present model works and whether you need to make changes. »» Education: If your goal is to educate, you can take one of two routes: simply report on your findings, or gather new insights about what you are seeing. »» Exploration: If your purpose is to explore new relationships and processes, Use this list as a guideline when you are deciding whether visualization will enhance your data. After you understand your purpose for creating visuals, you can help others understand your findings. CHAPTER 1 Interacting with Customer Data 129 Interacting with Customer Data you should create visuals to predict and manage the data. IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding how personas enhance marketing efforts »» Uncovering data types to investigate »» Collecting the right information Chapter 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas N othing is more important for you as a digital marketer than understanding your customers. Without such understanding, you can’t develop content or make your product indispensable. Enter the use of buyer personas. Marketers have a love-hate relationship with them. They know that they need to create and use them, but they find personas difficult to develop. Creating personas can be tricky. You can’t treat them like lifeless customer profiles that are created once and pulled out only for quarterly meetings. Buyer personas represent who your customers are. You have to understand who they are and what they care about. When you create persona documents, you should realize that they change as your company changes. In this chapter, you look at how to develop personas that play a critical role in your content marketing efforts. You also see how to avoid making common mistakes. Reviewing Persona Development The persona concept is not a new one. It was first mentioned by Alan Cooper in his 1999 book The Inmates Are Running the Asylum (SAMS). In the book, Cooper talks about how one needs to discover customer personas rather than create them from CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 131 untested assumptions. When you create a persona, you mix your own customer data with your understanding of the marketplace to represent your ideal buyer. This is key because if you make assumptions without having real data to back them up, you risk derailing your marketing efforts. If you’re like many marketers, the concept of personas makes you uneasy. Chief among the reasons for this uneasiness is that personas aren’t easy to create or maintain. Your customer constantly changes her opinions, likes, and behaviors. You therefore have to keep abreast of her needs and wishes. According to a 2015 joint study done by Quantcast and Forbes, 54 percent of companies agree that for audience targeting, identifying the proper personas is their biggest challenge. So you’re not alone in your quest to get personas done right. They are complex and can’t be tossed off quickly. You can’t sell to everyone, of course, so understanding your niche is crucial before you create your personas. You’ve probably heard the term niche used all the time, but what does it actually mean? Your niche is the special corner of the marketplace that is interested in your products and services. When you understand your niche, you help your company reach its most interested buyers. It’s important to recognize that customer profiles and personas are not the same thing. You can easily create a standard customer profile and think that the job is done. A customer profile will get you only so far, however. You can know a ­person’s age or gender but still not know what truly entices that person to buy your product. To know that, you need to dig deeper. There is some controversy of late about the value of personas for content marketing. Some marketers argue that your creativity is stifled because you’re essentially using cookie-cutter descriptions. That’s exactly why you should look at the bigger picture of your marketplace and the potential to find new niches and customers. This effort won’t be wasted. Understanding how persona creation improves content The work of developing personas involves a combination of art and science. You need hard data to justify your conclusions. You also need a sense of how that data translates into customer emotions and actions. If you have a poorly constructed set of personas, you may do more harm than good. The first question you may have as a marketer is whether your content benefits from using buyer personas. Does it really matter if you haven’t developed 132 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience personas for your teams to focus on? The good news is that developing personas greatly improves the content you create. Read on to see how. When you use personas, you can: »» Tap into feelings and emotions in your copy. After you understand how your buyers want to feel when they use your product, you can evoke those feelings with your content. »» Use buying triggers in emails and real-time messaging. If you know your personas’ buying triggers, you can send your emails and messages at the right time to interest buyers. You can also make sure that the same content is on your website and anywhere else where your buyers find you. »» Directly address problems customers are experiencing. Solving problems for your customers is key to revenue generation. Your content, in all appropriate formats, should focus on problem solving. »» Use influencers to persuade customers. Obviously, knowing who your customers respect and listen to is an important piece of the content puzzle. You want to include influencer endorsements in your content when possible. Want a great way to find out which influencers resonate with your content? Onalytica (http://www.onalytica.com), shown in Figure 2-1, lets you upload a file or add a link to your content and then sends back a roster of influencers who would be interested in that content. It’s also great for finding influencers and new Twitter followers. Onalytica has lots of interesting uses and is free to try. »» Rank content priorities. Personas can tell you what is most important to your customers. This is helpful when you have to create an editorial calendar that reflects true customer interest. Some content topics can be categorized as “nice to have” and others a “top priority.” For more information on editorial calendars see Book 3, Chapter 5. goals drive customer behavior. If your product can be linked to those goals, you will have attention-getting content. »» Focus on what your customers want instead of what they say they want. When you understand persona motivations, you can focus your content on what they really care about rather than what customers say they want. Customers don’t always know what they want until they see it. By focusing on content that fits buyer personas, you won’t waste time. Initially execuatives may laugh at the notion of creating personas. But their attitude changes when they realize that personas can help them stay laser focused on real customer needs. It helps prevent them from wandering off when someone suggests a tactic that doesn’t relate to the people they want to serve. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 133 Uncovering Buyer Personas »» Speak to life goals that customers care about. Personas tell you what life FIGURE 2-1: Onalytica. Taking action to understand your customers One of the main reasons that personas are hard to create is that you just can’t sit quietly in your office and look at data. You need to take action to gather everything you want to know. Here are some actions you need to take: »» Meet actual customers on a regular basis. Customer feedback is crucial. You need to know what they think, how they view your company, and how and why they use your products. Meeting real customers can be frightening to some. You don’t want to say anything that might upset them. But if you can be regularly in touch with some of your clients, you can learn almost everything you need to know about how to make your products better. »» Dig for special data. You need to look at the data that is currently being collected by your company. Unfortunately, you may not find what you need. For this reason, you must be proactive and request the type of data that you require. Don’t assume that it doesn’t exist. The more likely scenario is that no one has ever requested it before. 134 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience »» Look at content consumption. One key piece of data for every piece of content that you own is what the prospect has done with it. For example, if it’s a video, was it watched to the end? More than once? Was it forwarded to a colleague? When you see how the content was consumed, you can get a better handle on whether it hit the mark and how interested the prospect is in receiving more. »» Review sentiment analysis. What is sentiment data? It’s user-generated content about your company and its services. This is also called opinion mining. You can set up a formal system to analyze this data, or if you are working on a smaller scale, you can look at actual customer comments. For example, you may have lots of comments about your customer service on Twitter. If you see that the majority are complaints about how long your company takes to get back to customers, the sentiment is negative. On social platforms, not all publicity is good publicity. »» Do what you ask your customers to do. This should be a hard-and-fast rule. You may think it’s only tangentially related to content creation, but if so, think again. You and your team should use your websites, landing pages, and blogs in the exact way you ask your customers to use them. Although this seems like common sense, you’d be surprised at how little most marketers know about the actual workings of their own sites. For example, if something is hard to understand, you want to add content right in that spot online that makes it easier. If you haven’t used the site, you don’t know what you need to add to make it better. »» Make sure that content creators know your keywords, and keep content creators updated about any revisions you make. It’s important that all your content creators know what keywords you’re using. It helps them shape the content they create and makes them aware of what you’re trying to accomplish. Also make sure to keep them abreast of changes. This may seem like a small detail, but it will help them generate new ideas suited to your audience. »» Make support people and sales your front line for feedback. When Uncovering Buyer Personas you get your customer service people and sales reps to give you constant feedback, you’re giving yourself a competitive advantage. You want to continually create content that solves problems. By knowing what people are struggling with and by providing answers, you are directly affecting customer satisfaction. »» Talk to all your company stakeholders. The last thing you want to do is miss out on the wisdom that other departments can provide about your customers. Engage them and let them know what you’re doing. You will also establish some good will around the company by seeking out others’ advice. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 135 Collecting Information What types of data should you mine to gather information for your personas? The list goes well beyond the usual prescription to conduct one-on-one ­interviews. If you take the time to collect different types of data (see the upcoming Table 2-1), you gain the added insight you need to serve your customers. TABLE 2-1 Data for Persona Development Data Type Examples Suggested Places to Find It Demographic/ socioeconomic Age, gender, education, income, standing in the community Customer surveys, government data, Quantcast, comScore, Nielsen, Experian Simmons Psychographic Habits, values, hobbies One-on-one interviews, social media platforms, customer surveys, buying patterns, forums, blog comments, Google Analytics Trend information Popular culture TrendSpottr, Trend Hunter, BuzzSumo, magazines, online news sites, TV shows, Google trends, customer surveys Questions/ pain points Questions customers are asking/jargon they are using Quora, Yahoo Answers, Stack Exchange, Wiki answers, blog comments, internal customer support, Google Analytics, customer events, conferences, sales team and other internal departments Social media content Twitter, Facebook, others Social Mention, Google Alerts, TweetReach, Internal customer records Buying patterns, product usage Internal company reports, CRM systems Search Keywords Google Analytics, Google Autocomplete, Ubersuggest Gated content Lead generators Top-ten lists, tool lists, ebooks, PDFs Finding different data types Table 2-1 shows some recommended types of data that you should seek out when creating your personas. Table 2-1 contains a reference, in the last row, to gated content. That is content that requires an email address in exchange for viewing it. This type of content is being used for a variety of content. According to MarketingCharts, shown in Figure 2-2, data from KoMarketing, Huff Industrial Marketing, and BuyerZone indicated that customers are willing to complete a form to get the 136 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience following type of gated content (http://www.marketingcharts.com/online/ b2b-vendor-websites-whats-important-and-whats-lacking-53697/): »» Trial offers »» Product demos »» Product evaluations »» Research »» Brochures and data sheets FIGURE 2-2: To find persona information on some of the top brands, you can search YouGovProfiles (https://yougov.co.uk/find-solutions/profiles/). If you think that your company has a similar type of user, you may learn some interesting things. Deploying listening tools Smart content marketers know that listening to their customers is crucial. That’s why good listening tools are available online. A listening tool is a tool that helps you find out what your customers are saying online about you and your brand. For example, if someone mentions your brand in a tweet, you want to know about it. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 137 Uncovering Buyer Personas MarketingCharts data from ­KoMarketing, Huff Industrial Marketing, and Buyer Zone. These tools help you find those mentions and comments. Here are a few tools that will help you stay in touch with what your customers are talking about: »» Social Mention (http://www.socialmention.com): Shown in Figure 2-3, this is a great, free, real-time tool that monitors the web and social media. Type your topic and you get back information on sentiment, top keywords, top users, top hashtags, and sources of content. »» Google Alerts (http://alerts.google.com): This tool, shown in Figure 2-4, is very easy to use. Put in the names or product brands you are interested in, and you’ll be notified when they show up. »» TweetReach (https://tweetreach.com): This tool helps you monitor everything happening on Twitter related to your search (see Figure 2-5). It includes your topics, hashtags, competitors, and accounts. »» Quora (http://quora.com): This is a different kind of listening tool (see Figure 2-6). Use it to see what people are asking about your topic. It gives you a good perspective on how people approach a topic and what really concerns them. You will also find interesting answers to these questions from other users. FIGURE 2-3: Social Mention. 138 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience FIGURE 2-4: Uncovering Buyer Personas Google Alerts. FIGURE 2-5: TweetReach. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 139 FIGURE 2-6: Quora. Conducting one-on-one interviews Interviews with your customers can be the cornerstone of great persona creation. If your company has the time and inclination to approve this activity, don’t hesitate to jump in. Meeting and asking your customers for their thoughts and opinions will help solidify your understanding of how your products are bought and used. The wrinkle in your plans may come from other departments, such as sales. Sales may welcome an opportunity to introduce you to customers — or that department may be less than enthusiastic. If you’re in a small company without a sales force, this may not be an issue. Marketing and management may be one and the same. Obviously, the best thing to do is to follow the guidelines your company sets. If prohibited from interviewing customers directly, you can still create personas that can be useful by using some of the tools listed previously in Table 2-1. When you’re conducting an interview with your customers, you want to ask them questions that will put them at ease and capitalize on their experience with buying and using your product. Make sure to probe for the meaning behind the answers. You also want to make sure that you collect all the pertinent demographic data such as age, job title, income, and other information. You can then move on to questions that pertain to your products. Of course, your specific questions relate 140 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience to whether you’re speaking to a B2B customer or a B2C customer. Typically, you will want to know your customers’ questions about the following: »» Life goals and personal motivators »» Goals for using the product »» Things they don’t like about the product or your company »» People who influence their buying behavior »» Triggers that cause them to buy »» Where they consume their information and how they find new products »» What other products they tried before choosing yours Make sure to capture real customer quotes so that you can add them to your persona documents. This helps give the staff using the documents the feeling that your personas represent how real customers think. Key to the development of your personas is to look at behavior patterns. It’s just as helpful to know what your personas don’t like or wouldn’t do as it is to know what they would. Documenting your personas If you have a skeptical audience that resists the idea of using personas, you may want to start with a document that doesn’t use the word persona and gives a generic style title and no picture. For example, you call it a customer profile and give it a name that reflects their characteristics, such as Anxious Parent. This would not be your preferred method, but getting acceptance is key to moving forward. Unfortunately, some people do strongly resist using personas, so you’ll want to move slowly. You’ll know pretty quickly if you’re dealing with this kind of audience. If you’re just getting started documenting your personas, you may want to start with a helpful tool like Make My Persona from HubSpot, shown in Figure 2-7, which walks you through the process. You can find this tool at https://www. hubspot.com/make-my-persona. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 141 Uncovering Buyer Personas The way you present your personas will go a long way toward getting internal acceptance. If you have a receptive audience, you can use a typical template that includes a name, a picture, and details. FIGURE 2-7: HubSpot’s Make My Persona tool. Avoiding Common Mistakes As mentioned previously, creating personas is not easy. You and your team can make several mistakes along the way. Here are six common ones that you can make when creating your buyer personas: »» Mistaking yourself for the customer. You begin telling your manager or colleague about a solution to your customer’s problem. You have researched the data and the marketplace and believe that this information should be added to your persona. Your manager shoots down your idea because he doesn’t believe that you’re right. He bases his opinion on the fact that it’s not how he thinks about the problem. He forgets that he’s not the customer. This is a very common problem. People who work closely with products begin to think that they are the customers. In reality, they would never be a purchaser of the product. »» Listening to what someone’s relative thinks is a good idea. Someone’s relative has a strong feeling about something, and your colleague is swayed by their opinion and wants to make it part of the persona. But your “favorite” features should not be based on what your colleague’s cousin likes. 142 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience »» Forgetting to collect data about the customers who didn’t complete their purchase. You can often learn just as much from customers who didn’t complete the purchase of your product as you can from those who did. You need to know why your customers abandoned their shopping cart in mid-buy. This is extremely helpful because you want to know where you’re falling short and what you can do to plug that leak. This data should be included in persona information. »» Thinking that understanding the features and benefits that personas prefer is the whole picture. Most product managers love their products. That’s a good thing. But customers unknowingly want you to appeal to their emotions. When you don’t understand how the product makes them feel, you miss an opportunity to grab their imagination and create a customer for life. »» Not understanding what entertains your customer. You spend time collecting information, but you don’t find out what your customer finds entertaining. If you know more about this, you can create great content pieces that will engage your prospects. You also need to know where they consume information and in what format. »» Ignoring what people don’t like about your product. Obviously, you focus on what they do like so that you can appeal to prospect. But you also want to know what they don’t like so that you can fix it and retain customers. According to Adele Revella, the founder of Buyer Persona Institute (http:// buyerpersonainstitute.com), a study from ITSMA says that 44 percent of marketers surveyed say that they have personas but 85 percent of them don’t believe they’re using them effectively (http://www.itsma.com/research/increasingrelevance-with-buyer-personas-and-b2i-marketing/). It’s important that you take the time to integrate your buyer personas into your content marketing efforts. Every generation puts its definitive stamp on society. In this section, you look at two groups that have a major impact on your content marketing efforts — Millennials and Generation C. Understanding Millennials According to a Pew Research Center study, shown in Figure 2-8, 2015 was the year that Millennials became the largest generational group in the United States, CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 143 Uncovering Buyer Personas Looking at How Generations Differ surpassing baby boomers (http://www.pewresearch.org/fact-tank/2015/01/ 16/this-year-millennials-will-overtake-baby-boomers/). Millennials are defined as those who were ages 18 to 34 in 2015. The oldest millennial was born in 1981. FIGURE 2-8: Pew Research Center study. Much has been reported about how Millennials differ in their attitude toward marketing and technology. They have grown up with digital gadgets and aren’t intimidated by them. They can easily spot hype and are resistant to it in marketing messages. They like to be asked to participate by companies and are more likely to take the advice of another millennial they don’t know rather than be influenced by a popular brand. According to a 2016 eMarketer article about Ipsos research, Millennials spend an average of 53 hours per week online, more than any other generation (https://www.emarketer.com/Article/Among-Affluents-MillennialsSpend-Most-Time-Online/101461). In an attempt to understand how Millennials view content, NewsCred conducted an important study called “The Millennial Mind: How Content Drives Brand ­Loyalty” (https://www.newscred.com/wp-content/themes/newscred/assets/ downloads/guide/NewsCred_Millennial_Mind.pdf); see Figure 2-9). 144 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience FIGURE 2-9: The NewsCred Millennial study. Here are some of the study’s key findings: »» A majority of the Millennials surveyed favor content that is tailored to their »» Thirty percent don’t read content unless it educates or entertains them. »» Forty-one percent abandon content that is too long. »» Seventy percent share content that makes them laugh. »» Google and Facebook are the top platforms they use to find content. »» Fifty percent share content about a cause they believe in. »» More than 50 percent prefer to engage with brands on their company websites or social media. So what does this mean for your content efforts if you’re targeting Millennials? Obviously, they’re a discerning group. They want the content they engage with to be age appropriate and to have some intrinsic value. They won’t normally sit through long content, but you can catch their attention when you discuss their favorite causes. One interesting finding is that they will engage brands on their websites, not just on social media networks. This is an opportunity for you to beef up content on your website. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 145 Uncovering Buyer Personas age, location, and cultural interests. Meeting Gen C An offshoot of the Millennials is a group called Gen C. Unlike Millennials, Gen C isn’t really a generation in the true sense of the term, but rather a construct made up of people who live their lives connected to their devices. They could be from any age group, but they have distinct characteristics. Sixty-five percent of them are under 35 but the rest are spread among the other generations. Google identifies Gen C as consumers who care about the following: »» Creation: They like the act of creating content — taking pictures, giving their opinions, and sharing them online. »» Curation: They like gathering others’ interesting ideas, photos, and articles and sharing them with their friends. »» Connection: They want to stay connected, and 76 percent watch YouTube videos every day. »» Community: They want to belong to groups that do things they support and admire. Surprisingly, Gen Cers interact directly with brands. If you’re a content marketer, you want to make sure that you engage these prospects by asking them to participate and take action. Identifying a Prospect’s Emotions The shift in control from marketers to prospects has created a strong need for marketers to figure out what a prospect needs at every stage of the buyer journey. (See the next chapter for more about the buyer’s journey.) One of the things that is central to your investigation of buyer personas is how your customers feel when they buy and use your products. It’s imperative to use emotional language in your content — that is, language that evokes feelings. Moods and emotions impact buying habits. People joke about shopping — dubbed retail therapy — as a way to soothe themselves. That’s proof that customers are influenced by their feelings. Both B2B customers and B2C customers are influenced by emotions even though business buyers would like to think otherwise. An awareness of emotions that affect your buyers can help you seek them out in your customers. Here are some common emotions that influence buyers: »» Fear: You want to know what concerns and fears your customer may have so that when you write your content, you can show how your 146 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience product would impact that fear. Will it help alleviate it? That’s a great motivator to buy. »» Guilt: Customers don’t always buy your product for positive reasons. Sometimes it will be bought to assuage someone or make up for the lack of something. Your content could highlight that emotion. »» Concerns about status: Of course, this is a big motivator. If you’re selling a luxury product, you want to make sure that you tap into the notion that the purchase of your product will elevate a buyer’s status. Conversely, if you’re aiming at a frugal buyer, you want to ensure that your content targets that mentality. »» Desire to mitigate risk: Whenever someone makes a purchase, they worry about taking a bad risk. If the product cost is small, the concern is lower, but it’s always there. If you can mitigate that risk in some way, such as by adding a money-back guarantee to your content, you can help your customer say yes. »» Desire for instant gratification: If this motivation is present, your content should focus on it. Every marketer loves an impulse buyer. »» Fear of Missing Out (FOMO): This is a relatively new addition (or addiction). People who are plugged into their devices have a fear that if they aren’t paying attention to online activity 24/7, they’re missing out on what’s happening. They want to know about the latest products, trends, events, and gossip. They want to know what their friends are doing and how they themselves compare. To capitalize on this phenomenon, your marketing can provoke users to feel that they have to have your product or risk being left behind. Keeping your eye on trends is an important part of a marketer’s job. You want to know what your customers are seeing, hearing, and thinking about in the wider culture. Sometimes trends come in with a huge flourish. Other times, they sneak up on you. Keeping yourself in touch with popular culture helps you know what your customers might want next or what they will reject. Here are a few sources in addition to the listening tools discussed earlier in the chapter, in “Deploying listening tools,” to help you plug in to what’s happening around you: »» Google Trends (https://www.google.com/trends): This is a free tool that lets you know what’s popular on Google, which is a sure way to know what CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 147 Uncovering Buyer Personas Keeping Up with Trends people are interested in. Here’s a look at the term content marketing (https://www.google.com/trends/explore#q=content%20marketing). As you can see the trend spikes upward starting in 2011, as shown in Figure 2-10. »» Trendspottr (http://trendspottr.com): Shown in Figure 2-11, this tool allows you to create alerts for the topics you care about. It’s a real-time tool that keeps you on top of trends by monitoring web content, including that of Facebook and Twitter. »» Trend Hunter (http://www.trendhunter.com): Shown in Figure 2-12, Trend Hunter is a community of people who report on the latest trends. The site has lots of interesting information on what’s trending and why. »» BuzzSumo Trends: BuzzSumo has added a trends section to its search capabilities, as shown in Figure 2-13. It shows you content that is trending for major topics or the specific topics you set up. To create your own trend search, go to https://app.buzzsumo.com/trending and set up the topic of your choice. You can see what’s trending in 2, 4, 8, 12, or 24 hours. FIGURE 2-10: Google Trends for content marketing. 148 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience FIGURE 2-11: Uncovering Buyer Personas Trendspottr. FIGURE 2-12: Trend Hunter. CHAPTER 2 Uncovering Buyer Personas 149 FIGURE 2-13: BuzzSumo Trends for content marketing. If you want to learn about how to uncover trends, check out Non-Obvious: How To Think Different, Curate Ideas & Predict The Future, by Rohit Bhargava (Ideapress Publishing, 2015). 150 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding the buyer’s mindset »» Unearthing your touchpoints »» Using an omni-channel approach »» Creating the right content to influence a purchase Chapter 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey T he guidelines for the best customer experience continually change. The only aspect that remains constant is that buyers are empowered and define their own journeys, and you need to accommodate them. Some customers like to check prices on mobile devices in retail stores; others spend hours online collecting information before making a decision. Your job is to make sure that your customer has all the information she needs to choose your product without becoming confused or annoyed. As you begin to create your buyer journey, understand that no book or article can tell you how to map your buyers’ exact journey — so don’t be frustrated. Your customers are unique and will take the journey that makes sense to them. You can look at what your customers are doing now and extrapolate from that. However, you can’t ensure that they will take the path you choose for them. In addition, your business is unique and has its own unique way of delivering your products and services. That’s a good thing. But it makes defining the optimal experience for your customers harder. In Book 2, Chapter 2, you take the first step in mapping your buyer journey by creating personas. In this chapter, you integrate those personas into the buyer journey. You look at the ins and outs of mapping that journey and see what content is required for each of the touchpoints along the way. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 151 Touchpoints, also called contact points, are the places where customers interact with a brand while researching, learning, and entertaining themselves. These contact points are where you need to observe what the customer does and thinks. You can’t treat a touchpoint as an isolated moment in time. You need to understand the context and what the customer wants to achieve. In this chapter, you find the concepts and tools you need to create a buyer journey map. But the real effort begins when you take the time to look at every step in your customer’s nonlinear path and analyze the content you need to provide. It won’t happen overnight, but if you take the time to do a thorough job, the effort will be well worth it. Harnessing the Customer Experience In today’s marketplace, buyers want to be able to explore information on all their devices from any location. They explore retail stores, the web, print and broadcast outlets, customer events, and so on, and all in a nonlinear process. What you need to do is to anticipate the potential contact points and provide content for each one. But even more important than a focus on touchpoints alone is an understanding of the journey your customers take. You need to walk in their shoes to understand their behavior and what they need. This is where your personas come into play. Of course, mapping the journey using a host of procedures, systems, personas, and touchpoints can be complex. But the payoff is worth it. According to an article called “The Truth About The Customer Experience” in the Harvard Business Review, Alex Rawson, Ewan Duncan, and Conor Jones from ­McKinsey found that a focus on the buyer journey is “30% to 40% more strongly correlated with customer satisfaction than performance on touchpoints” (https://hbr.org/2013/09/the-truth-about-customer-experience). This is a key finding. If you focus only on individual touchpoints but miss the bigger ­picture of the buyer journey, you’ll find the mistake costly. Looking at the customer experience from both sides When you and your team meet to discuss the ways you’re going to interact with your audience, you believe that you know where to engage them. Or do you? 152 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience The survey’s goal was to show how both senior executive and customer groups viewed service delivery to customers (http://www.economistinsights.com/sites/ default/files/Creating%20a%20seamless%20customer%20experience.pdf). A customer group was shown a list and asked, “Thinking of the ideal customer experience, which of the following elements are most important to you?” The top five elements chosen were as follows: »» Fast response to inquiries and complaints »» A simple purchasing process »» Ability to track orders in real time »» Clarity and simplicity of product information across channels »» The ability to interact with the company via multiple channels 24/7 As you can see, the customers wanted fast, simple, always-on interactions. No friction, no delay. Nothing listed here is an unreasonable request for a twenty-first-century ­company. If your company were rated on these criteria, how well would it do? The same survey asked the executive group and the customer group similar ­questions. It asked executives, “Which of the following channels does your organization currently use to interact with customers (companies)?” It asked the customer group, “Which of the following channels do you use to learn about and compare products?” The executives focused on a few channels that were popular with customers, but for the most part, the differences between the channels executives thought were important and those that customers chose as important were significant.The five channels that were the most at odds were: »» Search engines: Twenty-five percent of executives say their company uses search engines to interact with their customers; 69 percent of the customers say they use this channel. Missed content opportunity: Search engines are most often used in the early stages of the buyer journey. If customers are searching and your contentisn’t optimized for search engines, you won’t even be on their radar. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 153 Structuring the Buyer Journey The Economist Intelligence Unit, sponsored by Panasonic, did an interesting worldwide survey in 2014 called “Creating a Seamless Customer Experience.” »» Friends and family: Zero percent of executives say their company communicates with customers through their family and friends; 51 percent of customers say they consult family and friends. Missed content opportunity: Obviously, this is a big misstep. Recommendations from trusted friends and family are a big factor when deciding to make a purchase. These executives have made no attempt to reach the customer’s influencers on social networks. »» Independent websites: Nineteen percent of executives say they use independent websites to interact with customers; 46 percent of customers say they use these sites. Missed content opportunity: This mistake is a hard one to understand when you think about all the guest posting and cross promotions available to most marketers. »» Email: Sixty-seven percent of executives say they use email to interact with customers; 38 percent of customers say they use this channel. Missed content opportunity: This one requires some understanding of what kind of emails executives are referring to. If executives use personalized emails to send targeted content to buyers, they have a good chance of getting the buyers’ attention. Obviously, buyers would have given their email address with the expectation that they would receive emails. If the executives are sending what you would consider spam, that is, content that was neither requested nor desired, these emails would rank very low among customers. »» Phone: Fifty-five percent of executives say they use the phone to interact with customers; 24 percent of customers say they use this channel. Missed content opportunity: Obviously, this is a tactic that should most often be used in the later stages of a buyer journey and only if the buyer has given permission. Cold calling (that is, without permission) just doesn’t fit with marketing tactics. Benefitting from an omni-channel approach One key benefit of mapping your buyer’s journey is that it helps you understand where to put your greatest effort. So how do you go about putting your plan together? Start with an omni-channel mindset. This means that you have to think of all the different customer touchpoints as one integrated journey. No more multi-channel approach; instead, all the channels are connected. 154 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Marketers make the common mistake of thinking about their buyer journey as a discrete set of linear steps. For example, marketers create a content plan for their social media channels and another for their website. They forget that consumers are jumping from one channel to another, from different locations and on different devices. They aren’t giving any thought as to how they fit together. That’s your job. According to an article from the readwrite blog (https://readwrite.com/ 2018/12/12/why-omnichannel-is-important-for-customer-experience ) omni-channel strategies allow users to create a personalized experience for themselves. They can access information they need at their own pace and from the channels they frequent. You need to provide prospects with a frictionless journey that doesn’t require an online road map to traverse. If buyers want to look at your Facebook page on their mobile, or look at your website in your bricks and mortar store, you need to make sure they’re viewing a consistent message that ties all their activity together. This idea probably makes sense to you because that’s how you buy products, regardless of whether you’re making a B2B purchase or buying a sofa for your home. In fact, according to Outerbox (https://www.outerboxdesign.com/webdesign-articles/mobile-ecommerce-statistics) more than half of all Internet shopping is conducted on a mobile device. When shoppers decide to buy, where they are or which channel they use doesn’t matter. Here’s an example: Imagine that your customers are looking at your website and see something they’re considering purchasing. They want to look at it in your store to make sure that it’s exactly what they want. When they walk into your store, you can trigger a discount coupon on their smartphone. Then they can buy using that coupon. When they return home, they can check your website to look at the shipping arrangements. If you don’t have a bricks-and-mortar store, your customer will still want to shop where and when it’s convenient for them, so you have to create a buyer’s journey that supports that path, too. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 155 Structuring the Buyer Journey A multi-channel experience is not the same as an omni-channel experience. You likely already have a presence on several channels. But if the customer experience on all these channels is not consistent and integrated, you aren’t an omnichannel marketer. THIS IS REWARDING Want to hear how one savvy marketer is using omni-channel marketing to the fullest? Starbucks has a mobile rewards app that uses omni-channel marketing to its fullest potential. When a user downloads the Starbucks app, he can use it to find stores, redeem reward points, and purchase in-store coffee from the app itself, then pick it up in the store. The user can also view his account from his phone or the web, and it’s updated automatically on all his channels. Starbucks understands that helping users buy coffee and get rewards is a smart way to keep the revenue (and the coffee) flowing. Uncovering Commercial Intent Given all the concepts you have to deal with for the buyer journey, you probably don’t want to hear about keywords, too. But it’s important to understand how they fit in when you’re constructing your buyer’s journey. When you think about your keywords, you probably choose ones that provide your users with the information they’re looking for. Before you do that, however, you should consider the ones you need when focusing on the buyer journey. The keywords that people use tell you their intent — that is, what they’re trying to accomplish. When you create your keyword list, you should consider buyers’ commercial intent. That means that you want to focus on keywords people use when they intend to buy things. Here’s how this works. People undertake basically three types of searches: »» Informational searches: Users perform this type of search when they’re primarily looking for information. Their searches contain such words as “how do I” or “where can I.” For example, the results of a Google search for “how do I create content” is shown in Figure 3-1. »» Navigational searches: Users conduct this kind of search when they know exactly what they’re looking for. For example, if they want to read articles on Ian Cleary’s blog, they type razorsocial, as shown in Figure 3-2. »» Transactional searches: User intent here is to buy something. This is the type of keyword that you want to focus on. You want to ensure that the people who want to buy can find you. Along with words such as buy, the category of product appears. For example, you see searches such as “buy organic baby food online” or “ship organic baby food.” The results for a search on Google for “buy organic baby food online” are shown in Figure 3-3. 156 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Structuring the Buyer Journey FIGURE 3-1: Google results for “how do I create content.” FIGURE 3-2: RazorSocial. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 157 FIGURE 3-3: Google results for “buy organic baby food online.” Make sure to use transactional keywords when constructing your content for your buyer journey. WANT TO BUY IT NOW? In an interesting contrast, Instagram and Pinterest both rolled out their new buying mechanisms at the same time in 2015. Adweek’s Christopher Heine reported on the ­different way they approached harnessing their customers’ buying intent (http:// www.adweek.com/news/technology/instagram-offers-big-data-pinteresthas-purchase-intent-165168). One chose to sell directly from its site; the other chose to use ads to target customers. Pinterest added a Buyable Pins button that allows users to search by price and buy the items that interest them. Users can purchase directly from major retailers such as Macy’s and Nordstrom right on Pinterest. Pinterest is capitalizing on the fact that a great many Pinterest users go on to buy the items they pin. In a different take on buyer’s intent, Instagram created an ad business that will allow advertisers to target ads based on Facebook profiles. (Facebook bought Instagram in 2012.) Facebook is capitalizing on its big data asset. 158 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Closely following your competitor’s efforts is key to understanding what your prospects will encounter in their research. If you know that your competitors have provided comparison charts and data sheets, you should do so, too. You want to make sure to do a good job of demonstrating how choosing you is the better option. You need to cover all aspects of the buyer’s journey to win the sale. Researching competitors You’ve spent time learning about what your competitors are doing. But you can’t effectively compete if you don’t know what your customers know about your competitors. You want to know what they do well and how they fall short. Your job is to surpass their marketing efforts and win the sale. Your most effective way of winning the sale is to look at your competitors through your customer’s eyes. Your customers don’t care how much your competitors spend on advertising, syndication, and content creation. All they know is how well their needs are met. In the past, doing competitive analysis was a costly endeavor. Corporate spies, focus groups, and lots of wining and dining of staff went into getting information. Nowadays, you can do a host of things online to understand your competitors’ strategy. The information is digital and ready to be scooped up. Here are some things you can do: »» Analyze your competitors’ website. Your staff probably looks at your competition’s media properties on a regular basis. And they probably know more than a company’s customers do when the competitor redesigns the website or changes product features. »» You don’t want to overdo this analysis. Keeping too close a watch on competitors can prevent you from focusing on your actual customer’s desires. One mistake companies make is to try to clone their competitor’s site design and approach everything in a similar way. They do this in the mistaken belief that the customer will choose them because their product is simply better. Unfortunately, that’s not how people think. They take into account the whole brand experience. Someone may pick your competitor for reasons that have nothing to do with the actual functioning of the product. Remember to tell your customer what’s unique about your brand. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 159 Structuring the Buyer Journey Defending Against Competitors To look at actual data about your competitors, you can check out tools like these: • SimilarWeb (http://www.similarweb.com): See Figure 3-4. You can put in competitor domains and see traffic statistics, referring sites, bounce rate, and more. • Ahrefs (https://ahrefs.com): See Figure 3-5. This tool not only has lots of great data but also lists the top ten competitors for the domain you enter. Put in your competitor’s domain and see what you find. FIGURE 3-4: SimilarWeb. »» See what their customers say on social media platforms. You can do this at both a high level and a granular level. You can look directly at competitors’ social media sites to see what their customers are saying. Then you can use data analysis tools to compare your sites. 160 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Structuring the Buyer Journey FIGURE 3-5: Ahrefs. »» Analyze their content offerings: See the next section for how to analyze competitors’ content. (You can also use SEMrush and MozBar, again in the next section, to get competitive data.) »» Download their product specifications and online resources: Obviously, you can go to a company’s website and download anything that any user can. The key to doing a good job with competitive research is to focus on what your customers care about. Next, you consider how to analyze competitive content so that you can improve your own. Analyzing your competitor’s content To understand what your competitors are offering, you need a reliable way to analyze their content. In his article “An Epic Guide To Creating Epic Content,” (http://robwormley.com/how-to-create-epic-content; see Figure 3-6), Rob Wormley recommends three effective tools that you can use to learn about your competitor’s content. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 161 FIGURE 3-6: Rob Wormley’s blog. The tools are »» BuzzSumo: Go to BuzzSumo (http://buzzsumo.com) and type your competitor’s domain. You see a list of the most popular posts for the date range that you specify. Analyze as many as you need to make a solid determination of what content is resonating with that audience. »» MozBar: To see the title and meta description for the post, use the MozBar for your browser, as shown in Figure 3-7 (https://moz.com/tools/seo-toolbar). »» SEMrush: To see the top keywords that the content ranks for your competitor, go to SEMrush (http://semrush.com), shown in Figure 3-8. Put in the competitor URL and scroll down the page to see the top organic keywords. You can also see a lot of other key information. Go through and evaluate the content for completeness and novelty. This evaluation should give you a good start on analyzing your competitor’s content. After you have evaluated your top competitors, evaluate your own content to compare it. You can use the compare function in the settings in BuzzSumo in Tools➪ domain vs. domain. 162 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Structuring the Buyer Journey FIGURE 3-7: MozBar. FIGURE 3-8: SEMrush. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 163 WOULD YOU RECOMMEND ME? Finding exactly the right measures to determine how well you’re doing against your competitors can be difficult. You have so many measures to consider. One quick way to see how your company is doing is to use the Net Promoter Score (http://www. netpromoter.com/why-net-promoter/know) to measure your customer’s overall experience with your company. To deploy it, you survey your customers using a 0–10 scale. You ask them, “How likely are you to recommend our brand to a friend or colleague?” Then you score it as follows: • • • Promoters (score 9–10): People who love your brand Passives (score 7–8): People who are neutral and could move to the competition Detractors (score 0–6): People who are unhappy with your brand and could damage it with negative comments Subtract the detractor score from the promoter score and you get a number from –100 to +100. Based on this score, you can evaluate what immediate actions you need to take. Not all marketers believe you should use the NPS. Some detractors believe that the NPS is too simple. They say it only tells you want a customer says they will do, not what they actually do. Jared Spool, a well-respected user experience designer, believes that it’s not useful as a statistical measure. For more about his opinion, see https://blog. usejournal.com/net-promoter-score-considered-harmful-and-what-uxprofessionals-can-do-about-it-fe7a132f4430. Identifying the Stages of the Buyer Journey To reach your prospects, you need to understand what content they need to purchase your product. Rather than send generic content and hope for the best, you need to create content that targets the buying stages your prospects pass through. Understanding the buying process and journey map The typical buying process is divided into three stages: awareness, consideration, and decision. Because your job is never really done, you may find two more useful: purchase satisfaction and ongoing use. If you don’t support your customers, you will lose them. 164 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Structuring the Buyer Journey Here are the five stages of the buyer journey: »» Awareness: The prospect acknowledges a problem and begins to research a solution. »» Consideration: The prospect looks at options and competitors and narrows down her choices. »» Decision: The prospect chooses your product and looks at your specific buying details to determine customer support, shipping, and any other follow-up. »» Satisfaction (post purchase): Buyers want to feel that they made the right choice, and they want information that confirms that choice. This information can include usage tips and other ways to use the purchase that they didn’t know about. »» Ongoing use: Buyers want to feel supported in their continued use of the product and may become advocates if their relationship with the seller is nurtured correctly. So now that you know the stages that buyers pass through, you need to figure out where they go to get the information they need. For this purpose, you create a journey map. Journey maps come in all sizes and styles. You can make them highly detailed or just cover the basics. What most journey maps lack is the marriage of your personas with your expected journey. As the buyer journey has evolved, marketers have been realizing that creating generic content for prospects in each stage is a waste of time and money. You need to speak to your specific buyer. The customer is expecting something more personalized, geared to her tastes and sensibility. You have done the hard work of creating personas (or see Book 2, Chapter 2 if you haven’t). Now it’s time to use them. Perhaps when you first got started marketing your content, you created a bunch of blog articles that you thought your audience would like. Many times, you guessed wrong, and your traffic numbers indicated that. Then you got a bit savvier and started to look at what content actually drove engagement, whereupon you created more of that kind of content. By creating personas, you took the next step in giving your audience the content they really need. Now, by applying those personas to the buyer journey, you’re accelerating the buying process. CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 165 If you’re just getting started with developing your map, it’s best to go slowly. The main work is to identify each stage, pair it with a persona, and then lay out all the touchpoints. Benefitting from the journey map If you wonder whether creating a journey map is worth the time and effort, think about the fact that it keeps you and your organization focused on the specific needs of your customer. That’s critical. Some other key benefits of journey maps are that they »» Help you determine what your priorities should be. You know that you will never meet every customer need, create every piece of desirable content, or always make the sale. There’s just an overwhelming amount of work that needs to be done. But you are going to try. To get a handle on your priorities, a journey map shows you the actions that will have the most impact on the customer experience. »» Get everyone on the same page. A visual map lets everyone know what the goals are and why they exist. Everyone can see how everything fits together, and team members can agree or disagree right up front so that buy-in can be established. »» Let you see where your customer experience is broken. An interesting thing can happen as you map your buyer journey. You can see where your path breaks down. If you don’t have sufficient content for each stage, that lack will become apparent and you can remedy it. »» Show you what each department needs to do to collaborate effectively with one another. A visual map of the buyer journey helps staff members move out of their silos and collaborate effectively. It’s hard to stay isolated when you know what the rest of the team is trying to accomplish. »» Help you determine the content needed for each stage of the journey. Obviously, you need to match content to each point in the journey. See the next section to find out how. So, what are the key items you want on your journey map? »» Buyer’s stage/goal: The possible stages that your customer may go through are in the section “Understanding the buying process and journey map,” earlier in this chapter. You can add those to your map if they fit your products. Also include the specific goal statement for your product or service. »» Persona: If you followed along in Book 1, Chapter 2, which covers creating personas, you have them ready to go. If you haven’t created your personas yet, doing so is important because you need to identify on the map the persona you’re targeting. 166 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience »» Touchpoints: See the next section to determine how to apply touchpoints to the map. Make sure to identify all the stakeholders who are part of the process to ensure that you do a thorough job of mapping everything. Focusing on content for each part of the journey As mentioned previously, beginning your journey map is a complex undertaking. Table 3-1 lists possible choices. TABLE 3-1 Content for the Buyer Journey Buyer Stages Personas Potential Touchpoints Suggested Content Types by Stage 1. Awareness: Identifies a problem and does a broad search Example: Jane Brown Search engines on mobile and computer, brand websites, blogs, landing pages, social media platforms, ads, influencers WOM, ebooks, reports, photos, infographics, blogs, articles, recommendations, video, influencer content, testimonials, PR 2. Consideration: Narrows options and looks at specific products and pricing Personas Brand websites, blogs, landing pages, social media, rating and review sites, ads, influencers, email Product tour, demos, free trials, free samples, interviews, testimonials, pr, webinars, videos, white papers, case studies, pricing, webinars, recommendations 3. Decision: Makes final comparisons and chooses your product Personas Customer service on social media and website or in store, mobile, salesperson, email Product specifications sheets, buyer’s guides, comparison charts, webinars, a look at the checkout process, shipping info, payment options, online customer support options 4. Satisfaction: Felt immediately after purchase Personas Customer service, social media, website, mobile, email Email follow-up, tech support, community, social media, webinars, online training 5. Ongoing Use: Uses product and could become a potential advocate Personas Customer service, social media, website, mobile, email Free tips, online training, conferences, webinars, video, support, in-person meetings CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 167 Structuring the Buyer Journey When you complete your persona research, you should be able to note what special concerns and needs your persona has right on your map. To create a journey map with content, follow these steps: 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose the buyer stage. List the specific persona you’re targeting. List the touchpoints by thinking through the path you think this persona would take. List the type of content you need to create to support that path. Another helpful way to understand how your prospect thinks about content in each stage of his buying journey was presented by Mathew Sweezey from Salesforce. He states that when a prospect begins his search for product information, he thinks about the following: »» In the first phase (the awareness stage), he considers himself and how to do his job better. He looks at content such as blogs, articles, and industry blogs. »» In the second phase of his research (the consideration stage), he looks for social proof — that is, how others benefited. This includes content like case studies, interviews, and videos. »» In the final phase (the decision stage), he looks at content about your com- pany to help him decide whether you’re the right choice. This includes content such as buyers’ guides, comparisons, and sales sheets. As you’re creating your content, think about whether customers are thinking about how the product impacts them (what they think), social proof (what others say), or you (what you say). ASK THE EXPERTS Daniel Newman of Broadsuite reported in Forbes on a study by Nielsen that was designed to figure out which type of content had the most impact in each of the buying stages Nielsen tested three categories of content: (1) expert third-party content (influencers and subject matter experts); (2) branded content (marketing content); and (3) user-generated content (reviews, ratings, and so on). The study found that expert content won in all the buying stages. This is an important finding. It doesn’t negate the need for all the content types listed in Table 3-1, earlier in the chapter. It does tell you that you need to pay special attention to your earned media, as discussed in Book 5, Chapter 1. People want to reassure themselves that they are making the best decision and will look for experts to confirm it. 168 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Forbes Magazine has named personalization one of the top trends and said that “Personalization is not a trend. It is a marketing tsunami.” Are you ready for the onslaught? Can you provide the type of personalized experience that your customers expect? Personalizing content is a tricky business. Customers want to have a personalized experience but also want to feel that their privacy is being respected. This is a fine line to walk. But walk it you will, because consumers no longer tolerate content that isn’t matched to their needs. One of the most common examples of personalization is Amazon’s ability to recommend products and prime videos (if you’re a Prime member) that most Amazon subscribers feel is very accurate. Target has also created algorithms that can predict users needs even before they know them. For an interesting example of this, see (https://blog.hubspot.com/marketing/marketingpersonalization-examples). This statement is not an exaggeration. A study conducted by Janrain, a company that uses proprietary technology to help companies find new users on social media (https://www.janrain.com/), found out that when they asked respondents how they would respond to content that wasn’t relevant to them. Seventy-five percent of the respondents said that they would leave a website if they were shown ads or content that didn’t align with their interests. Fifty-seven percent said they would be willing to give some personal information if it was used responsibly for their benefit. Additional findings indicated that consumers are unwavering in their desire to see content personalized for them and wouldn’t hesitate to leave a site that didn’t cater to their needs. Larry Drebes, founder of Janrain, said that “[c]onsumers have reached the tipping point when it comes to being shown content that isn’t relevant to them. It’s a wake-up call for brands to fix this problem or risk losing customers and prospects.” As you can see, your customers will only get more insistent about personalized content. If you work for a company that doesn’t use personalization technology, that’s not surprising. According to a study done by Econsultancy and Monetate, a company that provides personalization services to organizations, more than half (56 percent) of companies don’t use it on their websites. In fact, 72 percent of the respondents said they know it’s important but that they “don’t know how to do it” (http://info.monetate.com/CROnlinePersonalisationUS_Research. html?utm_source=M-W-Blog&utm_campaign=R-Personlisation). CHAPTER 3 Structuring the Buyer Journey 169 Structuring the Buyer Journey Personalizing Your Content So if you’re interested in getting started with personalization, what should you consider? »» Your organization’s state of readiness: Is your organization prepared to do the work and allocate the budget necessary to do a good job of personalizing your owned media? Does management believe it’s a good idea? »» The strength of your personas: Do you have confidence that you can use your personas as the framework for your personalization efforts? If you don’t have personas or have given them short shrift, you’re not ready to put a personalization program into practice. »» Your data collection efforts: Do you have a customer relationship manage- ment (CRM) system or other data collection management tools to ensure that you have the data you need? Will you be able to assess the effectiveness of your efforts? »» Your email capabilities: Can you send personalized emails with your current system and track the results? »» Your mobile messaging efforts: Will you be able to reach consumers with your offers via their mobile devices? For more information about personalization, see Book 2, Chapter 3. 170 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience IN THIS CHAPTER »» Learning where your company fits on the maturity scale »» Considering the evolving role of sales reps »» Accommodating the needs of salespeople »» Improving the sales coaching process Chapter 4 Embracing Sales Enablement S ales Enablement (SE) focuses on the processes, tools, and techniques companies use to increase the effectiveness of their salesforce and includes marketing automation, digital asset management, CRM systems, and social media monitoring tools. Of course, the idea of creating sales content to improve sales is not new. Companies have struggled with getting their products into the hands of their customers for centuries. In the early 1900s, the Jell-O Company had its salespeople distribute free Jell-O recipe cookbooks to customers to show how to use Jell-O with their favorite dishes. It’s recorded that more than 15 million cookbooks were distributed in some years and the sales of Jell-O doubled over time. What is new is the use of the web to assist salespeople in getting the right information to the customer at the right time from anywhere in the world. This chapterlooks at the adoption of SE and the ways in which you can deploy it to help your sales reps hit a home run every time. CHAPTER 4 Embracing Sales Enablement 171 Discovering Sales Enablement When you look at the world of SE, you quickly discover that it means different things to different companies. And some companies take an informal approach whereas others set up rigorous systems that impact every part of their organization. It depends on the size and needs of each company. The definition of SE that fits the largest possible audience is Doug Winter’s definition in the Business Journals. He writes, “. . . sales enablement is the ability, by any sales rep, to systematically deliver a personalized, one-on-one customer experience.” Just as in the Jell-O selling days, salespeople need to deliver targeted sales information right into the hands of the buyers. Today, companies reach those buyers via their mobile phones, tablets, or laptops. But the problem remains the same: “One size fits all” never does. The key to effective selling is the ability to present a personalized experience directly to each buyer. So what essential elements must be present to make an SE system effective? Although several features make up a world-class system, three components are critical: »» Data analytics: These analytics collect and use data to make decisions about what the customer wants so that the sales cycle can be completed quickly. Your SE system must give you the ability to see what customers download, look at, and ask about so that you know what they care about. »» A CRM system: This system provides integration with current customer information to help speed the sales response at each point during the buyer journey. »» A cloud-based content database: Both sales reps and customers need to have the latest content and product updates available to them from anywhere. Your competitors will. Gaining a competitive advantage Managers who are presented with the concept of SE need to be convinced that making the effort to implement a new strategy is worth the time and money that’s required. Will it actually improve the win rate? Can it provide a competitive advantage? Answering these questions is key. 172 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience So what are the reasons to implement a sales enablement strategy? Some benefits include: »» Making sales reps more responsive to the specific needs of the customer, giving the company a competitive advantage »» Increasing demand by strategically deploying the type of content that potential customers are looking for before engaging a salesperson »» Speeding up the time to complete a sale by answering all the questions customers have whenever they have them »» Keeping all the salespeople up-to-date and aware of changes to products and services Embracing Sales Enablement »» Assisting sales coaches to meet the individual needs of all sales reps by analyzing their data »» Helping reps gain traction early in their tenure by giving them access to the training they require when and where they need it These are very desirable outcomes of a sales enablement system. Any manager would love to be able to show results like these to his company’s executives. Unfortunately, making them happen takes a lot of strategizing and experimenting, which is covered in Book 2, Chapter 3. Evaluating your current status To begin considering your own SE, it’s helpful to determine where your organization stands on the SE continuum. Demand Metric, a marketing and research firm (see Figure 4-1), uses a model it developed called the “Sales Enablement Maturity Model.” You can download it at http://www.demandmetric.com/content/ sales-enablement-maturity-model. Look at the descriptions of the stages of maturity to determine where your company is right now. Note that the relationship of sales to marketing is an important component. Table 4-1 describes the levels. Do you recognize your company in one of these descriptions? You’re unlikely to be at the world-class level. Don’t feel frustrated; so few companies are. It’s a slow process. You can, however, move the process forward by identifying your company’s stage of maturity to help focus your efforts and learn what is possible. You also want to consider what goes into making your organization world class in SE. CHAPTER 4 Embracing Sales Enablement 173 FIGURE 4-1: The Sales Enablement Maturity Model by Demand Metric. TABLE 4-1 The Stages of Maturity in Sales Enablement Strategy Maturity Level What’s Happening Undefined No sales enablement activity or perceived need. No structure or operational tools in place. Sales and marketing departments are siloed with no collaboration. Win rate is less than ten percent. (When a company is organized into silos, it means that each department is independent and does not know what the other departments are doing. There is no collaboration.) Progressive You’re in the early days of a loose system (fewer than two years). Requests are made for sales enablement function. Some light response has been received. Sales and marketing departments are aware of each other’s activities and have some coordination. Win rate is 10 to 20 percent. Mature A system has been in place for more than three years. A budget and staff are allocated. There is integration of both automation and a CRM system. Sales and marketing have mutual goals. Win rate is 20 percent. World Class The system has been in place for more than five years. A strategic plan is in place, and sales and marketing work hand in hand with shared revenue responsibilities. Win rate is more than 25 percent. Tamara Schenk is Research Director of the MHI Research Institute. Her blog is shown in Figure 4-2 (http://blog.tamaraschenk.com/). In her SlideShare presentation, she says that four pillars drive world-class sales enablement (http:// bit.ly/1JeWFG7). 174 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Embracing Sales Enablement FIGURE 4-2: Tamara Schenk’s blog. Consider whether your company can implement these pillars. The four sales enablement success pillars are as follows: »» Design: Have the customer at the core of your strategy. In today’s market- place you need the customer at the center of all your marketing efforts. This includes the design of all your owned media like websites and blogs. If your website is hard to navigate or find something, then you need a redesign. Customers aren’t as forgiving about this as they were when the web was new. Their expectations are high, and you need to meet them. »» Scope: Integrate frontline sales managers. This means that your frontline sales managers need to have a way to get feedback from every customerfacing employee. They need to know what’s going on in real time. »» Foundation: Have a foundation in sales operations. All your sales content and training need to support the sales structure as a whole. This framework will ensure that your salesforce gets the right type of training when salespeople need it. »» Collaboration: Collaborate to integrate your company services. If you have siloed departments, you know that you’re preventing people from doing their best work. Interaction and shared responsibilities make your teams successful. CHAPTER 4 Embracing Sales Enablement 175 Understanding the new role of sales reps The role of the sales rep continues to evolve. All the positive value that the web provides also brings with it some obvious negatives — with the main one being that the salesperson is no longer in control of the sales process. In contrast to previous years, salespeople don’t control the narrative these days. According to SiriusDecisions (https://www.siriusdecisions.com), a research and consulting company, salespeople typically come into the conversation when the buyer has completed more than half of the buying process. (The buyer journey is discussed in depth in Book 2, Chapter 3.) This means that being proactive and catching the buyer earlier in the cycle would be an excellent way to decrease the time it takes to complete the sales cycle. That’s what a real SE system can help you do. It helps you empower the salesperson to find those buyers who are searching your solutions and related topics. Today’s purchasing teams are larger and spread across departments. Salespeople rarely get to sit across from the ultimate decision maker. By providing cloudbased content to anyone in the company who is interested, reps can help speed up the buying cycle. In his book The Frugalnomics Survival Guide (Alinean Press), sales expert Tom Pisello defines the current selling environment as a place where corporate “buyers have become more empowered, skeptical and economic-focused” and expect to know the monetary value of a company’s solution before making a decision. Your sales reps would agree. Mobility is another one of the critical factors that an SE system must have to accommodate the changing role of sales reps. First and foremost, a mobile SE system provides the content that customers want anytime, and anywhere. But it also is a great boon to salespeople who can’t tie themselves down to a desk in an office. Salespeople have been known to prepare for presentations on subways, in coffee shops, and at their kids’ soccer games, so mobility is a must. You need to supply devices to present from the cloud. The Tech Republic blog (https://www.techrepublic.com/article/internetof-things-in-2019-five-predictions/) predicts that more and more things will be connected at the enterprise level. Shouldn’t all your sales content be connected? 176 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Training Your Salesforce Every manager knows that a well-trained salesforce is the key to success. Yet many organizations fail to take the simplest actions to empower their salespeople, such as neglecting to make sales information easy to find and forgetting to update everyone when changes are made to sales software. In addition, many companies still labor under the delusion that a typical “sales personality” exists that you must hire. In its blog, HubSpot reported that according to Dave Kurlan from Kurlan & Associates and founder of the Objective ­Management Group, several sales myths still exist among people who hire sales reps (http://blog.hubspot.com/opinion/study-3-of-4-sales-repsineffective). They include the following: »» Your sales rep needs to be an extrovert. Recent findings have shown that introverts can also make great salespeople. They tend to be empathetic and caring. You need to look among both types for your best reps. »» Your hire should be a driven person. This one assumes that your sales rep is driven in all areas of his or her life. In reality, you need to choose someone who is really motivated to be a great sales rep. Being driven in other areas doesn’t translate into sales prowess. »» It’s preferable for your salesperson to be an athlete. Do athletes win at everything they try? Clearly not. It’s great if your sales reps have good training habits as long as they can translate those habits to sales performance. If not, they’re irrelevant. Do you still believe these myths? If so, it’s time to shake them off and look carefully at the person you’re going to hire for the skills that actually matter. So what should your sales training include? You should consider three types of training: »» Structured training sessions: The classic sales training that you’re likely most familiar with is structured training. Just as in any college course, structured training has a syllabus, and the salesperson is expected to learn in a specific sequence. Typically, a salesperson goes through this type of training when first joining the company. But using this kind of training alone is outmoded. By combining it with all the devices and technology available, companies create a much more valuable learning environment. CHAPTER 4 Embracing Sales Enablement 177 Embracing Sales Enablement A Dell study indicated that 52 percent of Dell’s salespeople believed that they didn’t have access to the most current compliant content. »» Learning on the go: Cloud-based training is ideal for salespeople on the go. They can get whatever they need no matter where they are. They can send the right content for every step of the buyer’s journey. (See Book 2, Chapter 3 for more on the buyer journey.) »» Interactive sales meetings: Face-to-face sales meetings or video conferencing are still indispensable. That’s because it’s still important for members of a sales team to share their wisdom and trade success stories. Coaching Your Reps to Become Winners One of the key functions of an SE system is the use of sales coaches. But are all sales coaches created equal? Your experience tells you they’re not. Some salespeople are born coaches who can spot and solve problems; others just can’t cut it. When evaluating your company’s coaching capabilities, you want to consider these four aspects: »» Determine whether your coaches are up to the task. Typically, sales coaches come from the ranks of the salesforce. They get promoted upward based on the quality of the job they have done, not the one into which they’re being promoted. The better the sales rep, the more likely he will be elevated to the status of manager or coach — his skills notwithstanding. For this reason, it’s important to assess whether your coach can impart the skills necessary to train an effective salesperson. »» Evaluate your coach’s overall management skills. This is a key component, although many companies overlook it. If the coach is a bad manager, she won’t be able to spend the time doing the most important tasks. She needs to assess how much time she should spend with each sales rep to make a difference. If the coach can’t manage her own time, she’s likely to be an ineffective coach. »» Assess whether you’re giving your coaches the materials they need to be effective trainers. As you know, training materials must be available to sales reps at all times. The key question becomes, do coaches have the training materials they need? If you ask your coaches to create training on the fly, you’re hampering their ability to be efficient. »» Look at the metrics used to evaluate a sales rep. An SE system must have built-in metrics to help coaches determine what and when the rep is learning. Without these measures, coaches will have to guess what they have accomplished, or take their rep’s word for it. 178 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience Checking Out Sales Enablement Blogs Because sales enablement is a relatively new topic, you may not be aware of blogs that focus specifically on this topic. If you want to regularly follow SE, here are three major blogs that merit your attention: »» Salesforce, the premier provider of sales software in the industry. You can find a wealth of information about sales enablement at this link: https:// www.salesforce.com/blog/. »» Forrester (https://www.forrester.com/B2B-Marketing), shown in »» Association for Talent Development (https://www.td.org/Publications/ Blogs/Sales-Enablement-Blog), shown in Figure 4-4. The Association for Talent Development is a professional organization that supports sales trainers around the globe. FIGURE 4-3: The Forrester blog. CHAPTER 4 Embracing Sales Enablement 179 Embracing Sales Enablement Figure 4-3. Forrester is a well-respected research and consulting firm that provides up-to-the minute information. FIGURE 4-4: The Sales ­ nablement blog E of the A ­ ssociation for Talent Development. 180 BOOK 2 Uncovering the Customer Experience 3 Dipping into Content Creation Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Creating Your Content Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Evaluating Your Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Assessing Your Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Visualizing Your Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Creating Your Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 Focusing on Specialized Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 CHAPTER 2: Reviewing Content Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 Dipping into Content Categories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 Working with Original Short- and Long-Form Content . . . . . . . . . . 199 Using Curation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Making Use of User-Generated Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Repurposing Content to Add Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Viewing Aggregated Visual Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Dealing with Live Video Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Extending Business News . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Offering Online Courses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Managing Content Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 CHAPTER 3: Understanding the Customer’s Intent. . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Knowing the Dynamics of Content Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Finding Your Path to Perfect Content Marketing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Executing Perfect Content Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Distributing Content to Attract an Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 CHAPTER 4: Creating Content That Tells a Story. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Storytelling to Engage Your Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Structuring Your Content Using Stories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 CHAPTER 5: Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Organizing the Content Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Determining Roles and Responsibilities. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Managing the Workflow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Documenting Your Policies and Procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 CHAPTER 6: Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience. . . . . . . 269 Creating a Content Library. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Humanizing Content. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Reaching Through Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Knowing the value of your current content »» Understanding the needs of stakeholders »» Identifying gaps in content Chapter 1 Creating Your Content Plan I f you don’t have a content plan in 2019, you’re seriously jeopardizing your company’s chances for success. Everyone from “boring” companies like machinery manufacturers to red-hot companies like BuzzFeed have one. As you begin creating your content plan, you need to remember that your content marketing strategy is different from your content plan. A content marketing strategy determines how your company goals will be met by marketing your c ­ ontent. A content plan details specifically how your content will be created, managed, and distributed to meet the goals you identified in your content marketing strategy. In this chapter, you look at the current state of your content and what it takes to put a content plan together. Evaluating Your Content Your content can be one of your company’s greatest assets if you give it careful thought and attention. Some companies have been slow to get on the bandwagon, but they were quickly convinced when their competitors developed engaging ­content that attracted their customers. CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 183 If you’re wondering whether custom content matters to your customers, ask the Chief Marketing Officer Council World Wide (https://cmocouncil.org). This organization’s research indicates that 78 percent of customers believe that companies that create custom content are interested in creating relationships with them. You engender goodwill by spending the time and money to create quality content. Benefitting from a content plan If your company has a digital marketing strategy, you may wonder if you need a content strategy as well. If you’re skeptical as to why you should create a content plan, take a look at some ways it can benefit you. When you have a cohesive content plan, you can »» Increase brand awareness and brand loyalty by being in the right place with quality content »» More effectively evaluate content performance and revise as necessary »» Save time and money and avoid duplicating efforts »» Meet customer needs during every part of the buyer’s journey »» Ensure that you deliver quality content that has been through an effective editorial process »» Deliver a consistent message on all your distribution channels According to the infographic by Demand Metric, shown in Figure 1-1, “80 percent of people appreciate learning about a company through custom content and 60 percent are inspired to seek out a product after reading content about it.” You can find the infographic at http://www.demandmetric.com/content/ content-marketing-infographic. If you now grasp the value of having a content plan, you probably want to know how to make your content superior to that of your competitors. First off, the name of the game is quality, not quantity. Doug Kessler, creative director and cofounder of Velocity Partners (http://www. velocitypartners.co.uk), outlined some interesting ways to get noticed in his article “5 Ways to Stand Out in a Sea of Content.” The article appeared in the CMS Wire blog, shown in Figure 1-2 and found at http://www.cmswire.com/ digital-marketing/5-ways-to-stand-out-in-a-sea-of-content/. 184 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 1-1: Creating Your Content Plan Demand Metric Infographic. FIGURE 1-2: CMS Wire. CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 185 Kessler suggests the following five tactics: »» Stay in your sweet spot. He defines your sweet spot as the overlap between your company’s knowledge and the things your customers care about. If you stay in that area, you’re sure to create quality content. »» Use psychographic targeting. Know what specifically resonates with your customers, and provide them with content that addresses their concerns. »» Harness emotion, not just the facts. As described in more detail in the later section called “Going viral” you’re most likely to get people to like and share your content when it evokes strong emotions. »» Practice insane honesty. This is an important concept. Kessler says that when you highlight your faults, people appreciate your honesty and are more likely to do business with you. »» Create confident content. This is content written by great writers who know their stuff and are convinced that what they have to share will be of value to you. Also be sure to check out the Velocity Partners SlideShare called “Insane Honesty in Content Marketing” (http://www.slideshare.net/dougkessler/insanehonesty-in-content-marketing). It’s a great example of the idea behind the saying “Total honesty is the best ruse ever invented.” Determining content maturity Are you just getting started creating your content or is your company an old hand at it? Knowing where you stand is helpful when you begin creating your ­content plan. To determine your status, you can use a content maturity model. Todd Cameron has written an article about Kapost’s “The Content Operation Maturity Model,” shown in Figure 1-3 (http://marketeer.kapost.com/contentoperation-maturity-model/#axzz). You can use it to assess where your company falls on the content maturity continuum between novice and practitioner. Here are the status designations: »» Novice: This group is just getting started. Members may have siloed departments and don’t have an established process to create content. »» Practitioner: If you fall into this group, you’re starting to create processes and beginning to establish some visibility. »» Intermediate: This group is starting to establish a strategy and develop workflows. 186 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 1-3: The Kapost ­Content ­Operation ­ aturity Model. M »» Advanced: If you’re in this group, you’re really moving forward. You are »» Expert: This group has mastered content creation. You’re doing everything right. You’re optimizing your content and focusing on leads and revenue. So where does your company fall on this continuum? Determine where you are now and what you need to do to get to the next level. Then let all the staff know your designation and what people can do as a team to move forward. This is a great way to motivate teams because they can see how collaboration will be rewarded. Assessing Your Content It’s time to look at your content so that you can learn what needs to be added or revised going forward. To assess your content, you need to do several things in the following order: »» Talk to your stakeholders »» Conduct a content audit and determine whether you have gaps in your content »» Create visual maps of key sites CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 187 Creating Your Content Plan revenue focused and developing sound channel plans. The following sections consider each of these actions in turn. Interviewing your stakeholders Internal stakeholders play a very important role in your content plan. Their importance is often overlooked because listening to them takes time and effort. They are the keepers of important information and understand the history behind the content that’s been created. One-on-one interviews are preferable, but you can do group interviews if you have very large groups of stakeholders. Prepare interviewees by giving them the questions beforehand. You want them to be ready to give their perspective on the company’s content and procedures. Making the effort to speak to them will help you »» Find out about sites, landing pages, and other pages that were created and forgotten »» Understand why particular sets of content were created and how they performed »» Discover content needs that aren’t being met »» Learn about systems and procedures that are working well or need improvement »» Understand how internal stakeholders work together and what the challenges are in collaborating »» Get buy-in for your content plan when you have completed it You can see that you will miss important insights if you avoid talking to all your stakeholders. Jump in and get it done. Your stakeholders will appreciate being consulted. Conducting a content audit Are you ready to conduct your content audit? It’s the step in the process that tells you exactly what content you have. If you work for a large enterprise, pockets of content may or may not have been documented. If you work in a small business, you may have a full audit or none at all. The key to doing an effective content audit is deciding beforehand how comprehensive in scope you will get. You can determine the scope based on your specific goals, the volume of content, and the resources you have to accomplish the task. 188 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Ask yourself the following questions to clarify your thinking: »» How do I define the goals of this project? Is this project being done for an imminent campaign or does it have to encompass all your content? Make sure that you can articulate the goals you have for each project. »» Are there specific priorities that I can apply? Based on what you’re trying to accomplish, can you limit your investigation to certain channels or types of content? »» Will it help me to know about every piece of content that exists? Decide how much depth you need to go to. Can you take a middle ground that collects representative content, or must it be all inclusive? »» How deeply should I go into the specifications for each piece of content? Do you want to take the time to document all characteristics for each piece of content? Do you want to know everything about a piece of content or can you be selective? Now that you have determined the scope of your audit, look at what a content audit worksheet might include: »» Title: The exact title of the content piece. You may have several pieces with similar titles. »» Location: The URL where the content is located. It’s very important to note Creating Your Content Plan this location when doing the audit. Don’t duplicate efforts by requiring a producer to go and locate it every time it’s needed. »» Persona: The persona name for whom you created this content. »» Buyer’s journey step: The step in the buyer’s journey for which you created this content, such as “Consideration.” (See Book 2, Chapter 3 for more on the buyer journey.) »» Format: Describe the specific format the content is in. Is it an ebook, a blog post, something else? This information will help you determine how you can repurpose it. »» Topic/keywords: Put in the known keywords that were used and, if possible, the specific topic under which this content was categorized. »» Call to action (CTA): Identify the CTA for the content piece. Knowing the CTA is very useful when you’re determining a content sequence, such as a link to a landing page. »» Metrics: List any metrics you have that let you know how well the content performed. CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 189 As mentioned previously, you might not choose to include all the preceding items. Modify your worksheet based on the type of content audit you’re doing. You also have to determine whether you can collect some of the items in a reasonable amount of time. It’s important to do a content audit to help you determine the gaps in your content. You do this when you’re putting your content plan together. Visualizing Your Sites When planning your content, consider visually mapping it to see the big picture. One way to do this is to create a map of your content ecosystem. Mapping your content ecosystem Your content ecosystem shows how your content fits together. Your map can be as detailed as you like. You can document every site, social media account, and landing page you have, or you can list only the most important ones. It’s up to you. The goal is to create an easy way to see how and where your content is distributed. To create this kind of map, you can reference the PESO model in Book 5, Chapter 1. An example of this kind of mind map template is shown in Figure 1-4. FIGURE 1-4: Suggested mind map for ­documenting your ecosystem. 190 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation As you can see in the figure, you can document your ecosystem by category: »» Owned media: List all your branded sites, including your website, blog, micro sites, and user-generated content (UGC). »» Shared media: Include your social platform accounts and any places you guest post, embed infographics, or upload slide shows. »» Paid media: Here you list media that you pay for, such as Facebook Ads and traditional and native advertising. »» Earned media: Examples of earned media are influencer reviews, traditional PR, and media relations. »» Syndication: Add sites in this category if you’re distributing your site via syndication. A map of your content ecosystem helps you see the big picture of your content distribution. If you keep this updated, it can be a valuable tool for you and your team. Picturing website content Creating Your Content Plan Another map that you should consider creating is one of your website’s and or blog’s home page content and subpages. It serves several important contentrelated purposes. Mapping your website in this way helps you do the following: »» See exactly what content your company thinks is important. By seeing what content is displayed on the main pages, you instantly see the content that is highlighted. You can then ask stakeholders whether they believe it reflects current business goals. »» Compare maps of competitor websites. You can create and compare maps of your competitors’ sites to see how your content presentation differs from theirs and whether you need to make revisions. »» Learn about content that is buried. You will see content that is not featured and should be brought up to a higher level on the site. »» Determine whether there is content you should immediately create or repurpose. Seeing what’s featured will show you where your gaps are and how they can be remedied. »» Use the map to determine whether a redesign is needed. Mapping website content almost always ignites a conversation about whether you’re focusing on current business goals. You may choose not to do a redesign immediately, but you may want to budget for one in the future. CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 191 »» Use the map to get changes made to content navigation. When you look at navigation, you may find that your priorities have changed and a revision would be useful. As you can see, mapping your website and other important sites can facilitate a lot of discussion and insights. Figure 1-5 shows an example of a map template that you can use as a model. FIGURE 1-5: Model of a ­website map. Creating Your Plan It’s time to create your content plan. In Table 1-1, you see the components that go into developing it. The following list describes how each of the components in Table 1-1 helps you determine what goes in your content plan: »» The business case for content: If you created your content marketing strategy), you have made a business case for your content. Use the business case you created (or will create) for your content to inform your plan. »» Stakeholder interviews: Your stakeholders will provide you with a wealth of knowledge and insights about what has been done and why. Using this knowledge will ensure that your content plan with be better defined and executed. 192 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation TABLE 1-1 Components of Content Strategy Component Why It’s Needed How to Prepare Stakeholders To ensure that you have information from all those who can make or break the project Conduct one-on-one interviews. Content audit To determine existing content Do a content audit. Personas To know who is the target of your content Use the information about personas in Book 2, Chapter 2. Buyer journey To know what the customer needs to see on his journey to buy Use the information about the buyer journey in Book 2, Chapter 3. Story To create a context for your prospect’s choice and establish your “why” Use the information you develop from the section “Crafting the story” in Book 3, Chapter 4. Governance, systems, and editorial calendar To determine how content is judged, assigned, and moved through to completion See Book 3, Chapter 5 for more on this topic. Metrics To be able to determine metrics that tie to your KPIs Choose metrics (see the bullet about key success metrics in the list that follows). Hold group meetings. »» A completed content audit: After you have completed your content audit Creating Your Content Plan you will know what content you currently have and what you need to create going forward. Obviously, this is crucial to your plan’s success. »» Defined personas for your market niche: Your personas will tell you who you’re targeting with your content. If you don’t have personas you won’t be able to create content that resonates with your customers. It will be generic content that won’t engage anyone to pay attention to you. (See Book 2, Chapter 2 for more about personas.) »» A map of your buyer journey: By determining your touchpoints along the customer journey you can now see the content you need for each stage and persona. (See Book 2, Chapter 3 for more about the buyer journey.) »» Your business story: Obviously, your business story will determine the themes you choose to write about. Storytelling is a key way to engage your prospects. »» Key success metrics: Choosing your success metrics is a very important part of your content plan. They will tie back to the key performance indicators (KPIs) that you determined were important when you developed your digital marketing strategy. (See Book 1, Chapter 1 for suggested metrics.) CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 193 With this information, you can begin to outline your content using a content plan worksheet. Note that you should complete a separate sheet for each persona. Focusing on Specialized Content Before you leave the topic of content planning, you should know about several kinds of content that should be on your radar screen. These include pillar content, evergreen content, visual content, and viral content. Read on to see why you should keep them in mind when developing your content plan. Creating pillar content Do you know what pillar content is? You’re probably using it even if you don’t know the term. Pillar content is quality foundational content that you create to represent your brand. This content can be ebooks, tutorials, or other substantial content pieces that provide value. From this content, you create a variety of other pieces of content that function as a pillar “supporting” a topic. This means that you can take the tutorial you created and turn it into a »» Video »» Podcast »» Mind map »» Google Hangout »» Guest post »» Webinar You really have no limit to the amount of pillar content you can create. Utilizing evergreen content Evergreen is an important concept that you should consider when you’re creating content. Evergreen content is content that can be enjoyed without regard to when it was created. For example, a blog post about “how to be a productive entrepreneur” can be read any time of the year in any recent year. It’s timeless and can keep readers interested whenever they come upon it. 194 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Some examples of evergreen content include: »» Tutorials »» Support content and FAQs »» Ebooks »» Online tools lists »» Favorite resources »» Company stories So what should you keep in mind when creating this type of content? You should »» Make it easy to consume: Visitors appreciate content that doesn’t take a long time to read and isn’t overly complex. »» Create only high-quality assets: If the content is going to be around for a while and represent your brand, you want to ensure that it can delight and engage customers. »» Include visuals: Visuals are key to creating great content. Make sure that all evergreen content has graphics, photos, and so on. »» Create a series: It’s helpful to create evergreen content that is in series form. An interesting article by Julia McCoy, CEO of Express Writers called “Why You Need to Start Creating Long, Evergreen Content Today” was published in the Search Engine Journal. In the article, she discusses why small business owners specifically benefit from long evergreen content. She lists several reasons that could also apply to any size business: »» Google rewards more in-depth content, and places you higher in search results. »» Your visitors appreciate content that is not overly complex but is instructive and useful. »» You can get leads over a sustained period of time with less effort. »» Evergreen content keeps you relevant and provides quality content whenever visitors find it. CHAPTER 1 Creating Your Content Plan 195 Creating Your Content Plan Readers look for the other articles in a series after they find one of them. Using graphics and other visuals Throughout this book, you see how visuals enhance your content marketing efforts. To emphasize that point, here are just a few stats that show how using visuals powers up your content: »» When you include an image with a tweet, you get 18 percent more clicks than those without images, and you get 150 percent more retweets (Buffer). »» Eighty-six percent of buyers want interactive/visual content on demand (Demand Gen Report). Your customers respond to visuals, and taking advantage of this responsiveness is imperative. A wide variety of choices are available to you, such as infographics, memes, comics, doodles, sketches, photos, wireframes, custom graphics, and more. Going viral What about viral content? Everybody wants to create it, but do you really know how? Some research done by Jonah Berger and Katherine L. Milkman suggests some of the components that make up viral content. Berger and Milkman published an article in the Journal of Marketing Research called, “What Makes Online Content Viral?” (To download the PDF, use this link: https://marketing.wharton.upenn.edu/files/?whdmsaction=public:main. file&fileID=3461.) They analyzed New York Times articles and determined that emotion played a large part in creating sharing behavior. Specifically, they found that: »» Positive content is more likely to go viral than negative content. »» High psychological arousal fuels viral content. Content that evoked such strong emotions as awe, anger, anxiety, and sadness was more likely to go viral than weaker emotions. This research can help you when you’re creating content with an eye toward going viral, but it can’t ensure your success. One sure-fire way to get some power from viral content is not to write it, but to curate it. After you know that a piece of content has gone viral you can ride its coattails by creating an article that uses the viral content in it. You may not get a huge reaction, but at least you know that people will be interested in viewing and sharing it. 196 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation IN THIS CHAPTER »» Considering original content creation »» Working with curated articles »» Uncovering content to repurpose Chapter 2 Reviewing Content Types A t the heart of your content marketing strategy is, of course, your content. A strong collection of content is a company asset. Building this asset takes time and effort. But with the right strategy, you can create valuable content from several different content types. In this chapter, you find out how working with a variety of content types helps you effectively reach your customers and win the sale. You have numerous categories to choose from, and when you combine them, you get even greater results. Dipping into Content Categories Eight different content categories are available to you. Rather than write everything from scratch, you can create unique content by taking one of the eight content categories shown in Table 2-1 and turning it into a custom piece that has value to you and your customer. By paying attention to your audience personas, you can develop exactly what your personas need for each stage of the buyer’s journey. (See Book 2, Chapter 3 for details about the buyer journey.) Here’s a look at each type mentioned in Table 2-1: »» Original content: Content that you write to inform, attract, and sell to your customers. This is always your most valuable content. Unfortunately, it’s costly to create all original content. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 197 TABLE 2-1 Content Categories Technique Description Examples Original content Content written for your owned media, such as a website or blog Blog post; ebook for lead generation Curated content Other people’s content with your opinions and recommendations; articles must be credited to the original writer Round-up article; guest post User-generated content (UGC) Content your customers create about your company Pictures on Instagram of customers using your product; video sent in by users Repurposed content Content that is refreshed to republish Webinar repurposed for SlideShare; podcast audio repurposed as an article Aggregated visual content Graphics and images published on sites like Pinterest and Instagram Pin boards on Pinterest; photos on Instagram Streaming video content Live streaming to an audience using an app for iOS or Android Facebook Live, YouTube, Instastories Press releases and business news Original content developed by your company specifically for the purpose of promoting your business A press release about a new product launch submitted on a PR site and articles written to put on your website about charitable endeavors Online courses Content that is either new or repurposed to create a training course Udemy, Skillshare (A round-up article is one in which the author interviews subjects, collects information, and puts it into an article that contains the latest information on the topic.) »» Curated content: Other people’s content to which you add value. You add your own opinions and recommendations to personalize the content for your audience. The key is to make sure to add enough new ideas and opinions to make it more than just a rehash of other people’s work. There is no point in plagiarising someone else’s work. You will often be chastised and it obviously doesn’t improve your reputation as a thought leader. Make sure to give credit to anyone whose work you curate. »» User-generated content (UGC): Content that your customers and others create. This is valuable to you and your customers because it’s unique and cannot be duplicated by your competitors. In addition, it gets your audience members engaged and interacting with one another. 198 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Repurposed content: Content that you have already published is reworked to become a new asset. Repurposing your content helps you make it more cost effective. You take something that has already been seen by your audience and update it. You can also change the format so that in your audience’s mind, it’s new. For example, if you take a popular blog post and turn it into a video, you have a new asset. Just make sure to refresh the text so that it fits with your current audience’s needs. »» Aggregated visual content: This is a category that has recently been added. It refers to content you aggregate on visual sites like Pinterest and Instagram. Examples include a Pinboard with your company’s products displayed and an Instagram collection with user content. These tactics can have great value now that Pinterest and Instagram have added “buy” mechanisms. As you know, visual content is a key component of your content strategy. »» Streaming video content: This type of content is relatively new. It allows you to live-stream directly to your audience. Platforms like YouTube Live and Facebook Live allow you to live-stream directly to your audience. (For more about live-streaming on Facebook see Book 7, Chapter 6.) »» Press release and business news: This is original content developed by your company specifically for the purpose of promoting your business. »» Online courses: This type of content can be collected from all your training materials to create a cohesive online course for customers that you can sell or give away. Working with Original Short- and Long-Form Content Creating original content isn’t easy, but it can deliver the greatest punch. However, the companies who have gained the most traction have figured out how to distinguish their content from that of their competitors, regardless of length by using visuals with both styles of content. According to the latest Social Media Examiner’s marketing industry report, original content using visual images is considered the most effective (https:// www.socialmediaexaminer.com/social-media-marketing-industryreport-2018). CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 199 Reviewing Content Types Read on to see how you can benefit from including each of these categories. See whether these comments sound familiar to you: “You should create only short-form content because people don’t have the time to spend reading long articles” or “Your audience wants long, thoughtful pieces and expects you to spend the time and money to create them.” Directly contradictory, right? Well, which statement is right? The content community continues to debate whether long- or short-form content is preferable. Although some claim to know the answer, it really depends on what your specific audience prefers. For example, it may like long-form how-to blog posts but prefer short list posts. You can find the answer by looking at your own data. In addition, some content is determined by its platform. Tweets are short, content on Pinterest is visual, and posts on the blogging platform Medium (https://medium.com) tend to be longer. You need original content in all these spaces. People generally agree that long-form content comes in at about 2,000 words and short-form content is approximately 800 words or fewer. You won’t have trouble recognizing which is which. The following lists highlight the benefits of each type. Using long-form content can be a benefit because »» Google has declared that it values this type of content, and its algorithm supports it. »» Your audience will reward you highly for this content. It not only informs them but also demonstrates that you’re a credible expert who cares about the audience. »» It provides greater online visibility from backlinks and shares. »» It causes readers to stay on your site longer and perhaps look at more of your content. »» You can turn some of the longest content into lead-generation pieces to help you determine what your audience values. »» You can take older content and combine it into long-form content to get more value from pieces that have already been created. Short-form content is valuable because »» It’s quick and can be published on a regular basis. »» It’s less expensive to write. 200 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» It attracts readers who want to have a quick read and move on. »» It lends itself to multipart posts that get readers coming back for the rest of the series. You can see that each type of content has value regardless of the current fads. Experiment with both types to ensure that all parts of your audience are satisfied and that you have data to analyze. Using Curation Content curation can seem complicated, but it is really very straightforward. What can actually be complicated is the delivery of a curated article that adds value. Although you can take an article you like and share it on social media, that’s sharing, not curating. Curating takes more effort than mere sharing. You and your audience benefit when you curate content because it allows you to »» Demonstrate your ability to analyze and add value to content topics »» Organize the information to make it easier to understand »» Provide a new viewpoint on an old idea to make it usable »» Inspire trust in you as a thought leader »» Put the information in a different format — such as an infographic — to make it more digestible »» Create content that can supplement your original content, thus providing quantity and quality Reviewing Content Types So what exactly is curated content? Here are some examples. You can »» Round up information and package it together with your comments. This helps your readers find information they might miss. »» Collect media from a variety of articles in formats like slides, videos, and podcasts and create a slide show on a topic. »» Develop a visual timeline that shows the development of a topic based on historical content. »» Uncover a new trend and create a report about it using the content of others. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 201 Examining five curation models Rohit Bhargava laid out a framework for content curation in his article, “The 5 Models of Content Curation.” You can use these models as prompts when you’re considering what kind of article you want to create: »» Aggregation: When you aggregate content to curate, you’re gathering what you consider to be excellent material about a topic. You then add your own opinion and give the reader a new way to think about the content you’ve presented. »» Distillation: The word distill means to reduce something to its essential components. When you use distillation to curate, you boil down all the material and keep only the most important points. »» Elevation: When you use elevation to curate, you look for the bigger picture or expose a trend. This is a very valuable form of curation because it offers the reader a fuller understanding of a topic. »» Mashups: Mashup is a term that is often used by software vendors to describe a new functioning app that’s derived from two already existing programs. In relation to curating, a mashup takes different types of material and brings them together with a new way to provide a new way to think about the topic. »» Chronology: When you use chronology to curate content, you’re using a timeline of events to explain a topic. Understanding how to curate Curation is not a new concept. For example, curators have been employed by museums to look at their holdings and pick out the most representative pieces to tell a larger story. You do the same with web content. You use other people’s content as the foundation of a new story you want to tell. You can use the following list as a checklist of the 11 actions you need to take to ensure a quality curated post: »» Give credit to the writers of the content you choose. You must give attribution to the writers of the content you curate. There should be no mistaking which content is theirs and which is yours. »» Use quality content as the basis for your new content. Choosing poor-quality content as the basis for your new content doesn’t make sense. 202 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation You have so many quality sources to choose from that you never have a good reason to use badly written material. »» Develop a new headline. You are creating a new piece of content. This means that you need a new title that reflects your point of view. »» Use a new image. Just as you should use a new title, you also need a new image that sets your content apart from the content you’re curating. »» Reduce the articles you’re curating to their essence. This item is especially important. Don’t think that you need to include a lot of content from each article you have chosen. You will have links to the full article right in the piece. What you want to include are the few sentences that represent the most important part of the content. »» Remember to do your keyword research. Using the right keywords for your audience is just as important for curated articles as it is for original content. Remember that keywords are used to find your content, so they need to be present whenever you publish. »» Don’t choose only the low-hanging fruit. You and everyone else in your field can find the most popular content. That’s great when you want to know what topics would make good original posts. But if you stop at the most popular content for your curated articles, you’re not adding much value. Make an effort to find some good content that hasn’t already been read by your audience. »» Include your branding to ensure brand recognition and awareness. Any content your company creates or curates should have your branding visible. Both types of content are of value and should let people know they’re from you. »» Include a call to action (CTA). As you know, whenever you publish content, »» Decide which channel you will be publishing on ahead of time. Pick the channels you plan to publish on before you write. Be sure to determine that it will satisfy that specific audience. »» Be clear about how the content will be measured before it’s published. The only way you can judge whether your content is successful is to choose some metrics to evaluate it. Those metrics can also help you determine whether you should create more content just like it. Even though curating content seems to take a lot of effort, remember that it’s still faster than creating an original article of similar length. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 203 Reviewing Content Types you want to tell your audience what to do next. A CTA lets your audience know what that next action should be. For example, you may want people to go to a landing page or subscribe to your blog. Making Use of User-Generated Content Next in the list of content types is user-generated content (UGC). For better or worse, this is not content created by you but rather your audience. UGC is any content that is published to an online site by an end user to be seen by other users. If you’ve ever asked your customers to submit pictures of themselves using your product or to send photos using a specific hashtag, you’ve dealt with UCG. UGC can be positive or negative, depending on the mindset of the user. By its very nature, it’s uncontrollable. You will get UGC whether you want it or not. It’s the voice of the customer weighting in on you and your brand. It includes such content as user reviews, videos, photos, and ratings. UGC can be your greatest sales driver or your worst nightmare. If you launch a specific campaign and you tap into some major customer dissatisfaction, it can be a recipe for disaster. A great example of positive UGC would be a tutorial on YouTube from a user who loves your product. In many cases, users are excited by the product and feel that they have something to contribute. This lends credibility to the product and engages your customers. Understanding the positives Some online influencers believe that UGC can be a great tool for brands. An op-ed by Aliza Freud on DIGIDAY recommends that “brands should use more UGC.” Freud cites the following three reasons. UGC is »» Plentiful: Social media followers of brands are a ready-and-waiting audience who are eager to share their thoughts and opinions. »» Compelling: Users value the opinions of other users over that of a brand. Reviews of products are sought after and read by people who are interested in learning about a product. »» Scalable: Friends will tell friends. You can get your message shared by people in groups on social networks in ways that you never could get on your own. You can see that major benefits can accrue to any brand that generates positive UGC. Brands establish strong relationships with their customers by constantly monitoring what is being said on their sites and on social media. In this way, they know where the bumps may be. You should make sure that you have customer service reps reporting problems on a daily basis. Things can go badly fast on social media. 204 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Dealing with the negatives The pain of failed UGC campaigns has been well-documented. Sometimes companies launch a new UGC campaign and get a barrage of nasty comments and images. Could the companies have avoided them? Maybe. It depends on how connected the brand is with its customer. What should you do before you launch a UGC campaign? Here are some things to consider: »» Take your time. You can’t take back a failed campaign. Think carefully about your goals for the project. Make sure that everyone is clear about it and that you have buy in from management. »» Look at other UGC campaigns. See what has already succeeded and failed. Have competitors tried something similar? Were they successful? »» Experiment. Try something small that can give you a feel for your user’s sentiment. »» Listen to your users on a daily basis. If you’re constantly listening and engaging with your audience, you should already know about any sore spots. If you think you aren’t sufficiently plugged in to your audience, don’t go forward with a UGC campaign. »» Go in with your eyes wide open: No matter how well you plan, you can still encounter a problem. Keep a close watch on your launch and respond immediately if things get out of hand. Be transparent and open. If you act in a heavy-handed manner, it will make things worse. Your collection of content is a company asset. When you consider other company assets, such as hardware, do you ignore them and let them fall into disrepair? Not likely. So why do you treat your valuable content this way? When you repurpose content, you can change the format, update the material, or both. Doing both is wise so that your content always feels up-to-date. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 205 Reviewing Content Types Repurposing Content to Add Value Benefitting from repurposing Repurposing your content makes sense for many reasons. It helps you: »» Spread ideas: It extends the reach of your ideas by giving new audiences the chance to see it. »» Extend content life: It demonstrates a breadth of knowledge over the lifetime of the content. »» Provide a variety of formats: It enhances the value of content by changing the format to reach people who prefer that format. »» Make content more cost effective: Obviously, when you use content several times, you get back the cost of creating it. To do a first-rate job with your repurposing efforts, you need to go about it systematically. First consider which content will be repurposed and then deal with how it gets done and who does it. Planning goals and picking content The first step in repurposing your content is to decide what your goals are. Next, choose the content you want to work with. You should have the following information when you start: »» A list of the content available to repurpose organized into topic categories: You should have this list from your content audit. (See Book 3, Chapter 1 for how to perform this audit.) The list should include the topic, format, keywords, and other pertinent facts. If you have not done a content audit, your choices are limited. You can sort the content you have at hand, but you will surely overlook some of your best material buried in your database. »» Your editorial calendar and a list of upcoming campaigns: Make topic choices based on what you need immediately. Look at your editorial calendar and upcoming campaigns that require content. »» Pick the content that suits the business goal you have for this content: You use your repurposed content most effectively when you tie it to actual goals you have. Sometimes you may repurpose something because it lends itself to a format change. But the best way to do it is to match the current asset to a real need. »» Determine the resources you need and the implementation cost to determine the best fit: After you get rolling, you see all kinds of things you want to do to repurpose the content. Make sure your choices reflect your resources and current budget. 206 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Make sure that the person making editorial decisions about content repurposing use a reference chart. If you start with a ready-made list, you can develop your own “best format” chart for your audience. If you want to use one of the ultimate content guides, check out Robin Good’s “The Ultimate Guide to Editorial Content Types and Formats” (http://www. masternewmedia.org/guide-editorial-content-types-formats) shown in Figure 2-1. What makes this guide so useful is its inclusion of almost every format available. It’s also good to use when you’re creating original content. FIGURE 2-1: Viewing Aggregated Visual Content How did you satisfy your need to share and stare at visual content before Pinterest, Instagram, Tumblr, and others? Surprisingly, only nine years have passed since the first of these visual aggregation sites was launched (Pinterest in 2010). As you know, organizing photos and images on a board is not a new idea. People kept their tools organized on peg boards and displayed photos of their collections on their home bulletin boards. Obviously, when this activity became available in digital form for all the world to see, the concept exploded. Now everyone can see your collection! CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 207 Reviewing Content Types Robin Good’s “Ultimate Guide.” I SEE YOUR FUTURE Millward Brown Digital and Pinterest collaborated on a study to see whether they could determine the process people use when they plan for upcoming events. They made an interesting finding: Forty-seven percent of people began pinning items for a major life event in the six months before the event. During that time, those people were on the site actively researching new ideas and brands on a regular basis. This should encourage you as a marketer to build branded collections of images specifically labeled for major life events. You can include events such as having a baby, buying a house, or taking a trip. You will have active pinners at all times of the year. The good news is that many products can come under this major-life-event umbrella if you think expansively about what might be needed There’s a lot of value in encouraging users to share their visual content (see the earlier section, “Making Use of User-Generated Content”). But what about creating your own branded visual content for these sites? Will it engage your users? According to Nate Elliott, previously of Forrester, a study was done to analyze customer engagement on seven social networks. The study found that Instagram was the clear winner: “. . . Instagram delivered these brands 58 times more engagement per follower than Facebook, and 120 times more engagement per follower than Twitter.” Dealing with Live Video Content Now, live from anywhere — you can reach your audience using one of several live-streaming apps like Facebook Live and YouTube. These marketing tools add a real-time dimension to anything you promote or share. But, as with any tactic, you need to think about how to integrate it into your larger content strategy. Consider the emotional value of live video. As you know, when you can tap into customer emotions, you can accelerate your ability to win new customers. With live video, you can evoke the »» Element of surprise: Live video definitely has the element of surprise. Your audience doesn’t know what will happen. »» Ability to create excitement: You can generate enthusiasm for a new product or feature you’re launching, akin to hosting a physical event. »» Opportunity to demonstrate that you care: Customers can ask you questions, and you can help solve their problems. 208 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Belief that you have skills: You can provide information, training, or demos to show your credibility as a thought leader. »» Feeling of camaraderie: Viewers can comment and respond to one another and you. Although you broadcast live, the broadcasts can be replayed on tools like YouTube. Replaying gives you the opportunity to create some great word-of-mouth exposure and possibly even wind up with a viral video. So what kind of things can you do with these real-time tools? Here are some suggestions: »» Document a live event. When you launch your latest new product or feature, get your prospect’s attention by creating a live video event and give discounts or gifts to the audience. »» Develop user-generated content. Others might use a replay of your video and promote you. This is the best kind of sharing because you’re being recommended by someone else, but you get to deliver the actual message via your original video. »» Take a look behind the scenes. Several TV shows have used these tools to take viewers behind the scenes with their favorite actors. This gets a viewer’s attention and enhances the value of the show. »» Interview someone at a conference. Interviews can be a really fun way to generate excitement for your prospects. You can show viewers what is happening at the conference and interview top speakers. »» Provide training or demos. Your prospects are hungry for valuable training Extending Business News Content that is created specifically to promote your business is not like other original content. Of course, all the content you create will have some value to your company. But specific content that you write for press releases, stockholders, potential investors, and others with goals are different from all your other content. This type of content is important because it can have additional uses and is often overlooked. After you’ve created this content, you can feed it back to your editorial group to repurpose it. For example, you might want to take the written content on the charitable causes you support and add it into a video you’re creating for your CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 209 Reviewing Content Types opportunities. Provide a live demo or special training to develop trust with your audience. blog. The key is to document everything you create so that you can consider other places to use it. If you think that PR content is not suitable to be repurposed, you’re not creating the right type of content. No audience wants to read stodgy paragraphs of corporate speak to find out what your company does. If you’re relying on that oldschool content, you’re wasting your money. Press releases now have multimedia components that you can use in a variety of ways. Don’t forget to include this content in your repurposing efforts. Offering Online Courses When Lynda.com (http://lynda.com; see Figure 2-2), a company that offers online training, was sold in 2015 to LinkedIn for $1.5 billion, every online marketer took notice. Online training is big business. People are willing to pay to enhance their skills because the market is competitive and employees look for ways to set themselves apart. FIGURE 2-2: Lynda.com. 210 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Several major learning platforms have sprung up in recent years, including Udemy, shown in Figure 2-3. Udemy has courses for all sorts of business and personal skills. One of the interesting aspects of the company is that both individuals and companies use the platform to provide customer training. FIGURE 2-3: Udemy. So how can you as a content marketer benefit from creating online training? You can use it for a variety of marketing efforts, including the following: »» Revenue generation: You can sell the training as well as have affiliates sell for you to widen your audience. »» Development of customer relationships: You can distribute the training to special customers as a perk. »» Lead generation: You can use the training as gated content to grow your list. That is content that requires an email address in exchange for viewing it. »» Customer retention and loyalty: You can give some of your training away to show customers that you care about them. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 211 Reviewing Content Types One great thing about online courses is that they can be created by repurposing content along with some original content. After you examine your content for its ability to teach and inform, you’ll likely be amazed at what you can repurpose. Managing Content Formats Whereas the previous sections explore content categories, this section points out popular formats that you should deploy. Table 2-2 shows seven of these formats along with distribution channels that you can use to promote them. TABLE 2-2 Content Formats Format Distribution Channels Video YouTube, Vimeo Slide shows SlideShare, Slideboom Infographics Cool Infographics, Visually Webinars GoToWebinar, Eventbrite Audio/podcasts iTunes, Blog Talk Radio Mind Maps Biggerplate Presentations Prezi Here’s a look at the formats discussed in the table in more detail: »» Video: As you know, video is wildly popular with customers, only second to articles. With the addition of the live video tools, it will remain so. Some helpful tools to create videos include Camtasia (http://camtasia.com), shown in Figure 2-4, and Brainshark (http://brainshark.com). »» Slide shows: This format has become much more popular with the advent of sites like SlideShare (http://slideshare.net), shown in Figure 2-5, and Authorstream (https://www.authorstream.com/), which allow you to post a presentation for wider distribution. »» Infographics: This is another very popular category for content. Audiences find infographics easy to understand and fun to share. If done right, the visuals can be repurposed and used in a variety of ways. Some helpful tools you can use to create them include Canva (http://canva.com), shown in Figure 2-6, and Piktochart (http://piktochart.com). »» Webinars: Webinars have been popular for some time because they allow companies to interact with their customers and provide valuable training. Major tools to deliver webinars include GoToWebinar (http://gotowebinar. com), shown in Figure 2-7, and Eventbrite (http://eventbrite.com). 212 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Audio: Podcasts have been regaining popularity again in 2019 after an earlier downturn in interest. One reason for the renewed popularity is that the technology is easier to use and the distribution is very wide on places like iTunes (https://itunes.apple.com/us/genre/podcasts/id26?mt=2), shown in Figure 2-8, and Blog Talk Radio (http://blogtalkradio.com). »» Mind maps: Mind maps have been around a long time and have been gaining in favor in recent years to help marketers explain their ideas to prospects. Some helpful tools to create them include iMindMap (http://imindmap. com), shown in Figure 2-9, and bubble.us https://bubbl.us. To distribute your mind maps, you can upload them to an innovative company called Biggerplate (http://biggerplate.com) run by Liam Hughes, shown in Figure 2-10. It has a large community of mind mappers who share their own maps and promote the use of mind maps around the world. If you’re interested in finding out about mind maps, this is one great place to go. »» Presentations: Presentation tools such as PowerPoint have been around for Reviewing Content Types a long time. Newer tools bring a new dimension to the average presentation. These are tools such as Prezi (http://prezi.com; see Figure 2-11), which offers zooming and movement, and Zoho Show, a cloud-based tool (https:// www.zoho.com/docs/presentation/features.html) that lets you present from anywhere on any device. FIGURE 2-4: Camtasia. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 213 FIGURE 2-5: SlideShare. FIGURE 2-6: Canva. 214 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 2-7: Reviewing Content Types GoToWebinar. FIGURE 2-8: iTunes podcast directory. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 215 FIGURE 2-9: iMindMap. FIGURE 2-10: Biggerplate. 216 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 2-11: Reviewing Content Types Prezi. CHAPTER 2 Reviewing Content Types 217 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Creating content that generates leads and sales »» Spreading brand awareness to cold prospects »» Planning content marketing campaigns »» Using the four major content distribution methods Chapter 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent C ontent is at the heart and soul of any digital marketing campaign — the foundation on which your search, social, email, and paid traffic campaigns are built. Without content, Google has nothing to discover on your website, Facebook Fans have nothing to share, newsletters have no news, and paid traffic campaigns become one-dimensional sales pitches. Content goes beyond blogging; content includes YouTube videos, product and pricing pages on e-commerce sites, social media updates, and much more. Each piece of content acts as a stepping stone on the path from lead to customer, and from customer to engaged, frequent buyer. This book is about generating fans, followers, and customers using content. This begins by outlining the often-misunderstood strategy behind content marketing. You then look at the many different forms that content marketing takes and its uses throughout a prospect’s journey toward becoming a loyal customer. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 219 Knowing the Dynamics of Content Marketing At its core, the Internet is a place where people gather to discover, interact with, and share content. Whether that content is a funny cat video that gives you a much-needed laugh, an inspiring podcast about a single mom surviving cancer, or an article teaching you how to fix a leaky faucet, content is what people crave. Engaging with valuable content is a natural, or native, experience on the Internet. People are drawn to content that teaches them something, inspires them, or makes them laugh or cry, and people share and talk about content that has ­provided them some form of value. With the low-cost (or no cost) of publishing platforms such as WordPress, YouTube, and iTunes, even the smallest of brands can produce content for the web. This ease of publishing, however, is a double-edged sword because the constantly changing nature of the Internet requires the rapid production of content. Although your brand stands to reap the enormous rewards associated with content publishing, doing so without a plan can lead to frustration. People have a nearly insatiable demand for content on the Internet. According to the most conservative estimates, 300 hours of new video are uploaded to YouTube every minute. This glut of content underscores the importance of proceeding with content marketing only after you have made a plan, because you must create quality content to cut through the noise. And quality demands a plan. Without a plan, you won’t know whether the goals you set are being met. A plan helps to ensure the success of your digital marketing campaign. Marketers often confuse the term blogging with content marketing. Although blogging is a powerful and versatile content marketing channel, it’s only one part of a well-balanced content strategy. If you’re among the many marketers who blog with no clear direction, you should commit a few hours to designing a content plan before writing another blog post. Well-executed content marketing includes planning what content you will produce, for what audience, and for what purpose. Many companies and personal brands that are frustrated with digital marketing can trace that frustration back to the time-consuming act of creating content with no clear audience or objective. You’ll find the entire process much easier and much more lucrative when you have a good sense of your direction. 220 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Although “perfect” content marketing may sound like hype, it’s actually obtainable. When you gain an understanding of the true principles of this critical ­discipline and content marketing’s connection to all other facets of your digital marketing mix, you can quickly see the path to content marketing perfection. Content marketing is about anticipating the needs of your customers and ­prospects, and building content assets that satisfy those needs. For example, the cloud-based software company Freshbooks anticipated a prospective customer’s need for pricing information. The web page shown in Figure 3-1 represents perfect content marketing in this scenario: The content succinctly and clearly communicates the differences in its plans and the varying price levels, provides contact information for those who may have more questions and want to talk to a ­representative, and offers a free trial. The content on this page completely satisfies the need for pricing information. FIGURE 3-1: This content on Freshbooks is designed to meet a prospective customer’s needs when looking for pricing. Source: https://www.freshbooks.com/pricing For a prospective customer of Freshbooks to make an informed buying decision, the pricing page is necessary. Before they commit, people want to know what they’re buying and how much it will cost. Failure to conveniently provide that information for the prospect will result in lost sales. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 221 Understanding the Customer’s Intent Finding Your Path to Perfect Content Marketing Understanding the marketing funnel The path from stranger to buyer is often conveyed using the metaphor of a funnel. Ice-cold prospects enter the wide top of the funnel and some, you hope, exit through the much narrower bottom of the funnel as customers. Content can, and should, assist the prospect in graduating from one stage of the marketing funnel to the next. A basic marketing funnel has three stages that take a prospect from stranger to buyer: »» Awareness: The prospect must first become aware that he has a problem and that you or your organization can provide a solution. Raising problem and solution awareness is where your blog will shine. Use your blog to educate, inspire, or entertain prospects and existing customers. »» Evaluation: Those who move through the awareness stage must now evaluate the various choices available to them, including your competitor’s solutions and, of course, taking no action to solve the problem at all. People can, after all, decide to live with the problem and not purchase the product or service that could solve that problem. »» Conversion: Those who move through the evaluation stage are at the moment of truth — purchase. The goal at this stage is to convert leads into frequent and high-ticket buyers. See Book 2, Chapter 3 for a more detailed look at the buyer journey. These three stages of awareness, evaluation, and conversion form what is known as a marketing funnel. Figure 3-2 conceptualizes the marketing funnel. FIGURE 3-2: The three-step marketing funnel. Source: http://www.digitalmarketer.com/ content-marketing/ 222 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Content at the top of the funnel (TOFU) that facilitates awareness. »» Content at the middle of the funnel (MOFU) that facilitates evaluation. »» Content at the bottom of the funnel (BOFU) that facilitates conversion. Blogs are fantastic facilitators of awareness (top of funnel) — but they do a poor job of facilitating evaluation (middle of funnel) and conversion (bottom of f­ unnel). Also, at the risk of pointing out the obvious, evaluation and conversion are super critical to your business. To move prospects through the middle and bottom of the funnel, you need other content types, as shown in Figure 3-3 and explained in detail in the following sections. FIGURE 3-3: You need ­different content types at each stage of the ­marketing funnel. Source: http://www.digitalmarketer.com/ content-marketing/ CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 223 Understanding the Customer’s Intent Cold prospects can’t evaluate your solution until they’re first aware of the problem and of your solution. If prospects are unaware of the problem or the solution that you offer through your product or service, they obviously won’t buy. Therefore, conversions are impossible until prospects have first evaluated the possible courses of action they can take, which include buying your product, buying a competitor’s product rather than yours, or doing nothing and living with the problem. To move prospects through a marketing funnel, you need to provide content designed to satisfy their needs at each of the three stages: Top of funnel content marketing The prospects entering the top of your funnel (TOFU) are unaware of your solution and often unaware that they even have a problem that needs to be solved. As a result, you need content that people can freely access, as opposed to content that requires prospects to give you their contact information or make a purchase. After all, you have yet to prove your value to them. At the top of the funnel, make free ungated (no password or email address required) content available that entertains, educates, or inspires. Choose two to three of the following content types to deliver TOFU content that will raise awareness about the solutions you provide through your products or services: »» Blog posts: Arguably the most recognized form of online content, blogs are an excellent way of raising awareness. For example, the fashion company J. Crew raises awareness of the products it sells by creating blog posts about fashion styles and tips for accessorizing. The J. Crew blog reader (and potential customer) gets inspiration and solutions to the problem of what to wear and how to look fashionable; the post also alludes to the fact that J. Crew carries the clothing needed to pull off the look. »» Social media updates: As with blogs, social media platforms (such as Facebook) are fantastic at creating awareness. Whether it’s a Pinterest board by Dreyer’s Ice Cream that lists every flavor of ice cream the company sells, or a tweet by Airbnb about the ten perfect Paris food experiences, these social media updates give their followers free, valuable information while also bringing the solutions their company provides to the forefront. »» Infographics: Infographics are an interesting and engaging way to display content. Typically, infographics contain fun images with contrasting, eyecatching colors, and the way infographics break up text makes this form of content easily consumable by the viewer. Infographics are highly effective at delivering content that is both entertaining and educational, quickly. Whether it’s an infographic by IMDb about the best of the year in movie entertainment, or an infographic by Casper Mattress providing tips on better sleeping habits, this type of content delivers value that a consumer wants, and it raises brand awareness effectively as well. Creating infographics are a great way to repurpose content. People love them and they can help you reach more of your audience. »» Photographs: Pictures are powerful because they can explain a lot in a single image. Photographs also help break up blocks of text in a piece of content, which keeps that content from becoming boring or intimidating to read. With a photograph, a kitchen design company can show completed projects that 224 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Digital magazines and books: Digital magazines and books are popular, and are another way to distribute content and raise brand awareness. Therefore, you can look to your blog to inspire your content for an ebook or e-magazine. »» Audio and video podcasts: Another form of content that you can use at the top of the funnel is a podcast. With a podcast, you package and distribute your content differently from textual content. A podcast delivers consumable content on the go. Subscribers can listen to the podcast on their commute to work or during their workout, or any other time they choose. They have a more flexible way to consume the content, in contrast to a blog post or a social media update that is less conducive to multitasking. Also, you can use podcasts to effectively promote your product or service while providing value to your prospects. If you sell outdoor equipment, for example, each episode of your podcast can give tips and tricks about hunting, fishing, camping, and other outdoor activities while also subtly reminding your listener of the outdoor equipment available at your store. »» Microsites: A microsite is essentially an auxiliary blog about a specific topic that is put on a different site with its own links and address; a microsite is accessed mainly from a larger site. For instance, DadsDivorce.com is a separate domain of the men’s family law firm Cordell & Cordell. DadsDivorce. com provides free content for divorcing fathers and is designed to raise awareness about the services and solutions Cordell & Cordell can provide. »» Print magazines and newsletters: This type of content can require a bigger budget than digital content, but if going this route falls within your budget, print magazines and newsletters are still a great way to raise awareness. For example, the Lego Club Magazine contains plenty of entertaining comic book style content for Lego’s target customer. Magazines and newsletters help sales by inspiring shoppers based on what they see in print. »» Primary research: This is research you go out and collect yourself, such as surveys, interviews, and observations. Although this data can be difficult and time consuming to gather, primary research is powerful because only a finite amount of primary research exists. Specifically, when you take the time to create research, you’re providing a service and saving people from having to do their own primary research. For this reason, primary research can stir a good deal of awareness among your prospects. Do you need all these content types at the top of the funnel? Heck, no. Most businesses focus on posting content to a blog and to social media channels such as Facebook, Twitter, LinkedIn, and Pinterest. After you’ve mastered blogging and social media updates, you might want to add more top-of-funnel content to the mix, such as a podcast or a print newsletter. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 225 Understanding the Customer’s Intent effectively demonstrate what the company does while raising awareness of what the company can do for another customer’s kitchen. The big goal at the top of the funnel is to make prospects “problem aware” and “solution aware.” In Figure 3-4, notice how Whole Foods uses its Whole Story blog to raise awareness for the seafood the grocery store sells. In this way, Whole Foods is reminding its audience of the products it sells, making its audience “solution aware” while providing people with recipes they find valuable. FIGURE 3-4: Whole Foods raises ­awareness of products it sells while ­providing value to its blog audience. Source: http://www.wholefoodsmarket.com/blog/my-favorite-new- recipes-tilapia-equals-easy-weeknight-dinners-0 Unfortunately, the top of the funnel is where most organizations begin and end their content marketing efforts. Smart content marketers know that, with a bit more effort, they can move prospects from awareness to evaluation at the middle of the funnel. Middle of funnel content marketing The big goal for content you use at the middle of the funnel (MOFU) is to convert “problem aware” and “solution aware” prospects into leads. You’re looking to grow your email lists and gain more leads at this point of the funnel. At DigitalMarketer, they use free content to incentivize prospects to submit their contact information (such as their email address) and opt in to receive future marketing in exchange for valuable content. This type of content is a gated offer, which you can find out more about in Book 1, Chapter 5. A gated offer is a small “chunk” of value that solves a specific problem for a specific market and is offered in exchange for prospects’ contact information. 226 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Educational resources: Educational resources for gated offers often exist in the form of free reports, white papers, primary research, webinar training, and sales material. These types of content resources educate the consumer on a particular topic related to your brand while highlighting features of a solution, product, or service you provide. An educational resource can include a case study packed with professional tips and a detailed breakdown of some of your strategies. Educational resources (and all forms of MOFU content, for that matter) must be of high quality or the consumer is likely to feel cheated. Also, if prospects feel that the content you gave them in exchange for their contact information is subpar, your brand awareness suffers. Keep in mind that the point of the MOFU is to help people evaluate your company and entice them to make a purchase. You entice with quality, not garbage. »» Useful resources: Useful resources are tools such as • Handouts or cheat sheets • Resource lists • Templates • Software • Surveys • Assessments • Discount and coupon clubs • Quizzes and surveys These useful tools, which serve as powerful content for MOFU, are covered more in Book 1, Chapter 5. Instead of using a consumer’s time (such as an ebook that may take an hour or more to read), useful resources promise that they will not only educate your prospects but also save them time. These resources save them time because the content is easy to consume and the resource is complete; it doesn’t depend on another resource to deliver its value but can stand alone. For example, a company that sells vegetable gardening tools can create a resource called the “Seed Starting Cheat Sheet” that allows people with an interest in gardening to quickly determine the best time to plant popular vegetables in the garden. Don’t pin all your lead-generation hopes to a passive gated offer on your home page or the sidebar of your blog, because the gated offer can get lost among the many elements of your site. A missed gated offer won’t capture leads. Be sure to also create a dedicated landing page for every gated offer (some call this a squeeze page) and drive traffic directly to that page using social media, email marketing, search CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 227 Understanding the Customer’s Intent Gated offers often take the form of content such as the following: engine optimization (SEO), and paid traffic. A dedicated landing page increases opt-ins. See Figure 3-5 for an example of a landing page. FIGURE 3-5: Rideshare company Lyft uses a landing page to start its driver application process. Source: https://www.lyft.com/drive-with-lyft?ref=ROB055729. The goal at the middle of the funnel is to convert prospects who were unaware of your product or service into people with whom you can now follow up. As they say, however, you can’t deposit leads in the bank. To generate revenue, you need content that assists your prospects in making decisions at the point of sale. Bottom of funnel content marketing At the bottom of the funnel (BOFU), you’re looking to convert leads into customers and customers into higher-ticket customers. What types of content will your new lead need to make an informed purchase decision? Your leads may be reading your blog and downloading your gated offers (all of which helps to convert them), but to move them on through to the point of making a purchase, you also need to offer content that helps them decide whether to buy. Here are examples of content types that work well at the bottom of the funnel: »» Demos: The downside of buying a product online is that customers can’t hold the product in their hands — they have only an image (or two) and a description to base their purchasing decisions on, which can make people hesitate to buy. Offering a demo can help with this problem. A demo shows the product 228 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Customer stories: Customer stories are customer testimonials and reviews. Customer stories are fantastic at the bottom of the funnel because they allow a prospect to see how someone else experienced success with your product or service. You provide your prospects with peer reviews, which have a powerful effect on decision making. As shown in Figure 3-6, Salesforce.com supplies leads who are at the BOFU with plenty of customer success stories to prove that its product can take care of their needs. FIGURE 3-6: Salesforce ­creates content that converts at the BOFU by telling customer success stories. Source: http://www.salesforce.com/customers/ »» Comparison/spec sheets: When someone at the BOFU is debating over different products, comparisons and spec sheets are handy resources that people use to compare products side by side (whether the comparison is between similar products that you offer or between your product and your competitor’s product). For example, the tax preparation software company TurboTax might show a side-by-side comparison to the features and pricing of its competitor, TaxAct. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 229 Understanding the Customer’s Intent or service you offer in action, so that consumers can see how it works. It’s as close to touching the product as they can get from their screen. So find a way to demonstrate your product or service through content such as video, screen shots, webinars, or schematic drawings. »» Webinars/events: You can use webinars and events at the middle of the funnel to gather leads, but you can also use them at the bottom of the funnel to convert those leads. At the bottom of the funnel, a webinar can be used to gather prospective customers in one place to ask questions about a complex, risky, or high-ticket product or service. »» Mini-classes: A mini-class is a type of event that you set up to teach a relevant topic to your target audience. At the end of the short class, you make your pitch for your product or service. You need to provide quality educational resources with the mini-class, but in the end, the purpose of the class is to pitch a higher-dollar product related to the class you just held. Is creating content that drives awareness at the top of the funnel important? Absolutely. That said, particularly for existing brands, the place to start building content is usually at the bottom of the funnel. Your prospects need information such as pricing or how you compare to a competitor, so build content that satisfies those basic questions before you start writing blog posts or uploading podcasts. Exploring the prospect’s intent The key to perfect content marketing is to understand your prospects’ existing intent so that you can anticipate their future intent and predict which path or paths they will take. In foreseeing this, you can create the content assets needed to address that intent 24 hours a day, seven days a week. For example, Freshbooks (an online accounting company) customer in the evaluation or conversion stage of the funnel might intend to compare Freshbooks to QuickBooks. The web page shown in Figure 3-7 satisfies that intent at both the middle and the bottom of the funnel. Freshbooks gives the prospect a comparison sheet that allows the customer to see the differences between Freshbooks and its competition, QuickBooks. The company knows that prospective customers want to see how it stacks up against QuickBooks. Satisfying that intent in the evaluation stage helps prospects move into the conversion stage. If you’re having difficulty brainstorming ideas for content that will satisfy your prospects’ intent, gather a group of people in your organization who have contact with your customers and prospects. Salespeople, customer service representatives, trade-show workers, and others who hear the voice of the customer and prospect should be present. These members of your team can help you discover holes in your content that would satisfy a prospect’s intent. Brainstorm lists of intent at the top, middle, and bottom of the funnel. Then decide what content assets need to be built to satisfy that intent from awareness through conversion. 230 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Understanding the Customer’s Intent FIGURE 3-7: Freshbooks uses a comparison sheet to move a prospect closer to conversion. Source: https://www.freshbooks.com/compare/quickbooks-alternative Providing a path to the next step As a marketer, you need to provide a path from one piece of content to the next. People are busy and don’t have the time or the patience to go digging through your site for the proper piece of content. They need to be able to find what they’re looking for fast. Failing to provide an easy-to-follow path to the next step isn’t just bad marketing, it’s a bad user experience, one that will cause people to click the Back button on thier browsers and leave your site. Smart content marketers anticipate the next logical intent and remove as much “friction” as possible to create a clear path to conversion. The goal of every piece of content is to get the prospect to ascend to the next logical step in the buyer journey. In the Freshbooks pricing page example shown in Figure 3-8, notice that Freshbooks has created a clear ascension path to a “RiskFree Trial” of the software. Creating an ascension path is good marketing and results in a good user experience. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 231 FIGURE 3-8: Freshbooks ­anticipates the next logical intent of a visitor who needs to obtain pricing information. Source: https://www.freshbooks.com/pricing How well an ascension offer performs depends on the relevance of the offer. Take time to anticipate the next logical step in the buyer journey and create offers that are applicable to the piece of content they’re currently consuming. For example, asking a visitor to listen to a podcast episode (a top-of-funnel content type) would be neither logical nor relevant from the Freshbooks pricing page in Figure 3-8. This person is visiting the pricing page because she is interested in buying, and the smart marketer anticipates that intent and makes the next logical offer — a free trial. Segmenting your marketing with content You won’t truly understand your audience and what people really want until they have given you one of two things: their time or their money. They may answer survey questions and make comments that they’re interested in this or that, but until they have committed a precious resource — time or money — you don’t know for sure what interests them. This is good news for anyone creating content online, because when people spend time with content, they’re showing interest. For example, imagine that you own a company that sells healthy and nutritious meals to busy professionals, and you’ve been creating blog content about nourishing recipes. Your content falls into three main categories of recipes: vegan, vegetarian, and gluten free. What do you know about someone who visits a blog post about vegan recipes? Likewise for someone visiting a blog post about vegetarian recipes. It’s pretty clear, right? These people have “raised their hands” and told you that they are (or are interested in becoming) vegan or vegetarian. 232 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Retargeting is the process of advertising to people based on their prior behavior. For example, you can configure retargeting ads so that they appear only to customers who bought a particular product or visited (showed interest) a particular product page or blog post. This approach allows you to show a very specific piece of content that is more likely to resonate with the segmented audience. Turn to Book 5, Chapter 1 for more information on ad retargeting strategies. Appearing everywhere your customerexpects Marketers who want to create perfect content need to publish where their customers are. That means publishing content that meets prospects’ intent in any channel, and at every stage of the funnel where groups of prospects are searching for and sharing content. These channels include but are certainly not limited to the following: »» A website or blog »» Facebook »» Twitter »» LinkedIn »» Pinterest »» Instagram »» YouTube You can publish a single content asset across numerous channels to maximize exposure. For instance, at DigitalMarketer (http://digitalmarketer.com), they turned a presentation about how to launch a podcast into a webinar, and then into a podcast episode, and finally into a blog post. Because their audience responded so enthusiastically to this content, they saw the value and the need to repurpose it and distribute it throughout their channels. Consider what content from your company has resonated with your audience. For example, can that video demo of your product be republished on your YouTube channel? Can you repurpose an article from your blog into a webinar, or a podcast episode into an article for LinkedIn Pulse? The opportunities to repurpose content are virtually limitless. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 233 Understanding the Customer’s Intent When people spend their valuable time consuming content, they’re segmenting themselves. They’re telling you what interests them. And thanks to the magic of ad retargeting, you can follow up with these prospects by using a relevant ascension offer without having to acquire their contact information. Customizing your content You produce content marketing materials to satisfy the intent of your customer persona (also known as target audience). But not all personas are the same; they, like their real-life counterparts, don’t all want or need the same solution. That’s why customizing and then segmenting your content is essential. A particular piece of content can satisfy the intent of multiple personas, or you can use it to target a single persona. See Book 2, Chapter 2 for more details about personas. For example, Digital Marketer produced a blog article called “6 Trending Digital Marketing Skills to Put on a Resume” to raise awareness (top of the funnel) for their marketing certification programs. This post probably wouldn’t interest small business owners, but that was fine — they weren’t targeting them. This article was specifically targeted to their “employee” persona whose intent is to acquire skills that will land her a better job. Included in the post are two calls to action, which is an instruction to your audience designed to convey urgency and provoke an immediate response. In the case of the trending skills blog post, the calls to action were customized to appeal to the “employee” persona. Executing Perfect Content Marketing As discussed earlier in this chapter, to execute perfect content marketing, you need a plan. Each offer you make often requires the creation of different pieces of content. As a result, the ideal is to make a content plan for each of your major offers using a resource the DigitalMarketer calls the Content Campaign Plan. The Content Campaign Plan aligns your content marketing with business objectives such as generating leads and sales. You can see the Content Campaign Plan template in Figure 3-9 and can fill out your own by visiting www.digitalmarketer. com/content-campaign. Following are the steps to create a Content Campaign Plan: 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose personas. Brainstorm content assets. Choose the vehicle and channel. Plan for ascension. Read on to find out more about each of these steps. 234 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Understanding the Customer’s Intent FIGURE 3-9: The Content Campaign Plan organizes your content ­strategy for each ­individual ­product or ­service offer. Source: https://docs.google.com/spreadsheets/d/1Z29wImPl7PgJwQMv2TFr-RyOu_ THBu1pXlOxJgjUtEw/edit#gid=0 If you want to create content that converts prospects at all stages of the funnel, create a Content Campaign Plan and execute it. It works. Step 1: Choosing personas Decide which personas this content targets. Because each persona has different intents, motivations, and problems he responds to, each persona requires different content to move him through the awareness, evaluation, and conversion stages. You therefore need to determine which existing content to use or what new content to create to move the persona through the top, middle, and bottom of the funnel. For example, a wealth management firm attempting to sell financial planning should approach a young professional much differently than a near retiree. Some content will appeal to both, but the most effective content will speak directly to a specific persona. Step 2: Brainstorming content assets Use what you know about your customer persona to create descriptions for content that you can create to reach that persona. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 235 Plan to create content at all three stages of the marketing funnel: awareness, evaluation, and conversion. In the wealth management firm example, what content could the firm produce at the top of the funnel to increase awareness for the young professional persona? What could it produce to move the retiree persona through the conversion stage? Step 3: Choosing the vehicle and channel The vehicle of the content refers to the form the content will take. Will it be text, an image, a video, or an audio asset? The channel refers to where the asset will be published — such as your blog, a Facebook Page, or a YouTube channel. The vehicle can sometimes determine the channel, and vice versa. For example, a video asset often gets published on YouTube, Facebook, and your blog, whereas an image asset is more likely to be on Pinterest. Step 4: Planning for ascension In the final step of the Content Campaign Plan, you connect your content to your business goals. Build offers into each piece of content that allow prospects to get more value, either by consuming more content, giving you their contact information for follow-up, or buying a product or service. Any call to action is better than none at all, but the highest-converting ascension offers are relevant to the content the prospect is consuming. For example, a blog post entitled “10 Ways to Grow More Nutritious Organic Tomatoes” would do well to make an offer like “50% Off and Free Shipping on Organic Tomato Seeds” rather than an offer for carrot seeds. Distributing Content to Attract an Audience Today, content plays an important role in all major forms of traffic generation. Convincing cold (and even warm) prospects to visit your website is difficult without first leading with valuable content. The processes you develop to distribute content, and thus generate traffic to it, are as important as the processes surrounding the creation of that content. 236 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Marketing through email Email is still the best method for making offers and sending more content, so growing and maintaining your email lists are critical tasks, which is why growing your email list is built into your content strategy. After you’ve produced a content asset, such as a blog post or a podcast episode, use your email list(s) to drive traffic to that piece. To write the email for your new piece of content, first create the subject line of the email message. Often the subject is the same as the title of the content, but there are other strategies to naming your email subject line, such as scarcity headings like “FINAL notice (Just hours left . . .)” or by piquing curiosity with subject lines like “THIS is why I do what I do . . ..” Next, open your email with a short, punchy introduction that pulls people into the main body of your email, where you pique the email subscriber’s interest and describe what he can expect from the content. Explain this email’s relevance to the reader and what he has to gain from it (also known as the benefit). Also, be sure to include a call to action that instructs the subscriber to click the hyperlink to your content. Use two to three hyperlinked calls to action to make clicking them as convenient as possible. Capturing leads through search marketing Search engines, such as Google and Bing, are important content distribution channels to leverage. When prospects reach your site by querying a search engine (they might be searching for “dslr camera reviews” or “crepe recipes” in Google or Bing) but haven’t selected an ad, they’re using search marketing. The traffic driven to that content wasn’t paid for but was found naturally by the users. Today, search marketing is simple. The search engines, particularly Google, have become adept at sending traffic to the content that is most likely to satisfy the intent of the searcher. If you’re committed to creating content assets that satisfy the intent of your various customer personas, you’ll get plenty of love from Google and other search engines. You can learn more about search marketing in Book 5, Chapter 2. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 237 Understanding the Customer’s Intent Entire chapters of this book are devoted to the nuances of traffic generation using the methods of email marketing, search, social media, and paid traffic. However, it’s worth mentioning how each of these major traffic generation methods interact with the content you produce. Using social media to drive traffic to your site After you have created a piece of content, use the social media platform(s) that your business participates in to drive traffic to that content. Books 7 and 8 go more in depth about how to use social media sites, but for now, be aware that driving traffic on social media may take several forms, such as a tweet on Twitter or an update on Facebook or LinkedIn. This update announces the new content and provides a hyperlink to it. When you write text for a social media update, your brand’s personality should determine how you announce this new content. For instance, if your brand is a refined jewelry store, you may want to use a formal tone in your copy. The length of the copy depends on restrictions (such as on Twitter) and the complexity of the offer. Simple offers don’t require the same amount of description as complex offers do. Regardless of the length of the copy, be sure that the social media update piques the viewer’s curiosity, describes the benefit of the content, and has a clear call to action, such as the home improvement store Lowe’s Facebook post shown in Figure 3-10. This social media update meets all three of these requirements effectively. FIGURE 3-10: On ­Facebook, Lowe’s ­establishes the benefit of the content and gives a clear call to action for the viewer to click. Source: https://www.facebook.com/lowes/posts/10153827254486231:0 238 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation As the name suggests, paid traffic takes the form of ads that promote your content and helps your content gain reach, or exposure. You can display ads on many different platforms, including search engines and social media. Paid traffic can be highly effective at generating leads because it helps you to segment your visitors and make use of retargeting. When a prospect visits a piece of content, she places herself into a particular segment of your potential buyers. She’s indicating an interest in the offer, topic, problem, or solution found on that page, and you can take advantage of ad retargeting networks such as Google and Facebook to show ads to this prospect based on the content she has visited. Although many marketers may be reluctant to pay to send traffic to content, such as blog posts and podcasts, paid traffic has a major advantage: It’s predictable. When you cut a check to Facebook, for example, to promote a piece of content, you will get traffic. This is why, at all times but especially when buying ads for your content, you must ensure the exceptional quality of your content. The last thing you want to do is spend money to send traffic to poor-quality content. Use paid traffic to promote quality content that gives value to the consumer and aligns with your business goals. This will help you move people from one part of the funnel to the next, progressing from ice-cold prospect to a lead to customer to repeat customer and, ideally, to raving fan. To learn more about paid traffic, see Book 5, Chapter 1. CHAPTER 3 Understanding the Customer’s Intent 239 Understanding the Customer’s Intent Paying for traffic IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding the science of storytelling »» Constructing product stories »» Writing great headlines Chapter 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story M ost great content marketers know that storytelling is their secret weapon. They know that stories engage us; they have for centuries. Stories can be motivating and give us heroes to emulate. They can teach us how to act and how to cope. They also perform a critical function for the content marketer — persuasion. In this chapter, you consider the value of storytelling, how to develop a compelling product story, and how to write headlines that capture attention. Storytelling to Engage Your Audience Now that the web helps everyone share stories, you need to create brand stories that others can tell for you. A great story can capture your customer’s attention as no other feature or benefits package can. Seeking the science behind stories People are hard-wired to love stories, but why is this so? A brief look at neuroscience holds the answer. More has been learned about the brain in the last ten years CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 241 than the one hundred years before that. Scientist can analyze what happens to the chemicals in people’s brains as they respond to different stimuli. The brain has three main “parts:” (1) the neocortex, where thinking, imagination, and problem-solving happen; (2) the limbic brain, where people retain memories, experience emotions, and form value judgments (consciously and unconsciously), among other things; and (3) the reptilian or “lizard” brain, which controls automatic physical functions and signals a “fight or flight" response in an attempt to keep them safe. The lizard brain relates to how the stories you tell influences your customers. Consider this: The lizard brain responds when your customer perceives a threat. Even though the threat is not a stampeding animal herd, as it may have been in your ancestors’ day, customers may still perceive a kind of danger. In this case, it could be a high price or an assault on their time. They need to decide whether to stay or retreat. As a content marketer, your job is to mitigate that fear long enough to get your customer interested in your brand. So how do stories do that? In his article in the Harvard Business Review, “Why Your Brain Loves Good ­Storytelling” (https://hbr.org/2014/10/why-your-brain-loves-good-story telling/; see Figure 4-1), neuroscientist Paul J. Zak talks about the effect of the brain chemical oxytocin. He calls it the “it’s safe to approach others” brain signal that engenders empathy and cooperation. In the lab, Zak found that characterdriven stories produce this effect. FIGURE 4-1: Harvard Business Review. 242 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Creating Content That Tells a Story Another study by Zak is reported in Jeremy Dean’s PsyBlog, shown in Figure 4-2. The blog quotes Zak as saying that “results show why puppies and babies are in toilet paper commercials. This research suggests that advertisers use images that cause our brains to release oxytocin to build trust in a product or brand, and hence increase sales” (http://www.spring.org.uk/2014/01/the-psychologyof-storytelling-and-empathy-animated.php). FIGURE 4-2: PsyBlog. The lizard brain is quieted by stories that help build trust. Such stories actually cause a chemical reaction. Every content marketer knows that trust is the key to building a lasting customer relationship. The screenwriter and teacher Robert McKee says that for business communication, you need to “unite an idea with an emotion.” So when you see long, boring articles about a product, you know they’re missing the mark. So what are some keys to help you recognize good business stories? They include the following characteristics. They should: »» Be simple and straightforward. Have you ever stopped reading a novel because the action was hopelessly confusing? You probably decided that you didn’t want to waste your time trying to follow the plot. People have even less patience for a business story — they need a simple plot. That doesn’t mean CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 243 that the story can’t be complex, but if you confuse your prospect, you’ve lost him. »» Evoke emotions. Attention is affected by brain chemistry. If you don’t provide some suspense, mystery, or conflict, you have no story. »» Use visuals. Web stories should have visuals to support them. An abundance of free, online sources of visual materials are available. Many social media studies show that content with visuals are understood and shared at a much higher rate than content without visuals. Imagery powerfully affects limbic brains. Also, although some people are much more visually inclined than others, not just in words but by imagery as well, so you need to show and tell. »» Connect directly to the customer. Customers seek advice when they learn about your products. They want to know whether your products are a good fit for them. Telling stories about how great the company is doesn’t create the emotional connection. The connection comes when you tell customers how great they can be using your product. The point is really very simple. Customers are moved to spend money on your product when they believe that it will make them feel better, look better, or be better in the eyes of those around them. Think about that fact when you write your content. »» Have a beginning, middle, and end. As with any good story, you need to have the three story components. Leave something out and you’ve got some details, but not a cohesive story. »» Be authentic. Okay, you’ve probably heard this time and time again, but authenticity is critical to business storytelling. Telling a phony story is anathema to everything you know about engaging customers and building relationships. You can’t win. In addition, millennials are particularly captivated by stories about company values and giving. If you lie, you are lost. Finding your product stories This section begins with a basic rule. The product stories you tell should have the customer as the hero of the story. You can make your product the hero, but then you lose the interest of the customer. The customer’s focus is on himself, not you. Your company has many stories to tell. Key among them are the messages that are derived from your mission and goals. (See Book 1, Chapter 1 for help with defining those goals.) These messages tell your customers how you will serve them. This section focuses on the stories you post every day on blogs, in articles, and on guest sites — the ones that keep your audience loyal and engaged. These stories are the bread and butter of content marketers. 244 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation “PUPPY LOVE” Several marketers are using the valuable information about brain chemistry to enhance their ability to capture your attention and your emotions. An article by Alyssa Hertig called “Is Neuroscience the Future of Content Marketing Measurement?” reports that Budweiser used knowledge of brain chemistry to enhance its hit Super Bowl commercial “Puppy Love” (http://contently.com/strategist/2014/10/08/is-neuro science-the-future-of-content-marketing-measurement/?goal=0_855c f0c201-2da44d4e63-315209537). Budweiser marketers determined when people Creating Content That Tells a Story were likely to want to cut away from the commercial and enhanced it to prevent that outcome. Advertisers will use any tools available to them to give themselves a ­competitive edge. Major bloggers focus their blogs on you. How you can be better, how you can serve your audience, and how you can make a difference. When people read Seth Godin’s blog (http://sethgodin.typepad.com/), for example, they often come away feeling inspired. This is how you want your readers to feel about you and your brand. CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 245 So where can you find material for these company stories? You can get them from »» Loyal customers: Make sure that you and your team regularly interact with your best customers. They will always give you feedback about what you’re doing right. The stories about how they’re succeeding with your product are crucial to capture. They can also let you know what you can do better. »» Customer support staff: These people are on the front lines with your customers. They solve problems and know where the fault lines are. Make sure that they know you want to hear their stories. »» Other employees around the company: Don’t assume that only support people have stories to share. People throughout the company gain knowledge about customers that will help you create your messages. »» Vendors and colleagues: Your company is being talked about by customers and everyone who does business with you. Capture the good stories and try to fix the bad ones. In short, stories are lurking everywhere. You just need to listen for them. These stories are the raw material that you use to make your content come to life. Another way to find stories is to look at what your data says. You can gather lots of great insights from your analytics that can be told as a story. When you marry data with a story, it’s easier to remember. Jennifer Aaker of the Future of Storytelling organization (http://www.futureof storytelling.org) talks about this concept in her YouTube video, ­“Persuasion and the Power of Story: (Future of StoryTelling 2013)” (https://youtu.be/ AL-PAzrpqUQ; see Figure 4-3). Aaker says that because customers are overloaded with information, stories cut through the noise and help them to decide “what to believe in.” According to Aaker, three major characteristics of stories are what can make them so powerful. Stories can be (1) memorable, (2) impactful, and (3) personal. You can convince people by using statistics. But statistics alone don’t have an emotional impact. If you conjoin statistics with a story, the listener connects with the storyteller as well as the story, and persuasion becomes possible. Keep these characteristics in mind when you’re putting together your next product presentation. Straight statistics and facts will not be as persuasive as a good story to go with them. If you’re looking for an interesting way to share a curated collection of stories, you might want to check out Roojoom (http://roojoom.com), shown in Figure 4-4. Roojoom provides an easy-to-use platform that lets you select and display a collection of posts around a topic to tell a story. 246 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Creating Content That Tells a Story FIGURE 4-3: Jennifer Aaker. FIGURE 4-4: Roojoom. CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 247 STORYTELLING POSTS Here’s an example of an article that successfully blends storytelling with facts. The article, “11 Examples of Killer B2B Content Marketing Campaigns Including ROI,” was written by popular blogger Lee Odden on his TopRank Blog (http://www. toprankblog.com/2013/05/11-examples-killer-b2b-content-marketing/). Odden begins with a statistic that sets the tone: “According to a CMI and MarketingProfs study, 91% of B2B Marketers are using content marketing and that means a few things.” He then goes on to tell about his presentation at a DemandGen conference. Next, he discusses the awards made at the conference and shares brief stories about the winners. At the time of this writing, his article had been shared 1,700 times. It demonstrates the power of blending storytelling with facts to make the post memorable. Check it out! It’s well-writtten and instructional. 248 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Structuring Your Content Using Stories So, how can you develop your own stories? If you’ve tried in the past but were less than successful, you likely didn’t use a tried-and-true storytelling structure. There’s no need to reinvent the wheel. Storytelling has been codified since Aristotle’s time (the fourth century). A great many story templates are available to you, and they can help you construct your brand story. They are all a variation on the hero’s journey, articulated by Joseph Campbell in his book The Hero with a Thousand Faces. If you aren’t familiar with the hero’s journey framework, you can download a PDF from the Mythology Teacher website that gives you a good overview: http:// mythologyteacher.com/documents/TheHeroJourney.pdf. In brief, the framework involves a hero who will be taking a journey and will come out the other side a changed person. Here are the components and how they relate to a product story: »» Start with a look at the current reality. You start the story by telling the audience about the marketplace or give them some information to set the stage. »» The hero has a problem. You introduce the hero, which in this case would be one of your customer personas. You want your prospects to make the connection to the hero as themselves and relate to his struggle. You talk about the problems and the feelings the hero is experiencing. These are the problems and feelings your customer has. For example, the hero could be short on time, overwhelmed by work, or be focused on some other problem. You’re telling this story to evoke emotions as well as recognition of the problem. »» A mentor is introduced. The hero meets a guide who understands his fears and can help him with his struggle. The guide is your product or brand that has the answer to his problem. »» At first, the hero doesn’t want to accept the journey. This element adds drama to the story and reflects your customer’s indecision. »» Eventually, he takes action. The hero accepts the challenge to solve his problem using the guide’s advice, or he fails to take his advice and proceeds on his own. This is your call to action and the struggle itself. CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 249 Creating Content That Tells a Story Crafting the story »» He succeeds or fails. As a result of his actions, the hero succeeds or fails. This result is determined by his execution of the guide’s advice. He can fail miserably if he doesn’t take his advice, or succeed if he does. You can tell an unlimited amount of brand stories using this framework. As you work with it, you will recognize how common it is. Incorporating copywriting Okay, it’s time for some more definitions. Book 3, Chapter 1 discusses the difference between content marketing strategy and content strategy. Copywriting and content marketing have the same kind of difference. They are not one and the same; instead, they complement each other. Here’s a comparison of the two: »» Content marketing: You’re marketing your content to achieve business goals. The content you write is determined by what you want to accomplish from a macro perspective. »» Copywriting: You look at copywriting from a micro perspective. When you focus on copywriting, you consider the words and other devices, such as visuals, that you choose to compel your reader to do something specific. You’re enticing her to give you her email address, buy your product, or sign up for your newsletter. To this end, you use copywriting tactics such as great headlines or metaphors (and stories) to persuade her. Because the use of great headlines is one of the most important copywriting techniques for content writers to employ — and do it well — here are some detail on headlines. Why do headlines matter? Some people never get past them — maybe as few as only two in ten people will go past the headline to read the article. You need all the help you can get to create compelling headlines so that you entice people to read further. When you create headlines, you want to: »» Evoke emotion. As you’ve seen, emotions trigger attention and persuasion. If your headline is bland, the reader will pass it by on the way to something juicier. »» Attract the right reader. Your headline should make it clear who the article is targeted at — CEOs, small business owners, or others. »» Assist with search engine optimization (SEO). All this means is that if you use a keyword in your headline, you will help your customers find you. 250 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Make a meaningful promise. Readers always want to know what they will get from reading your article. Make that clear. »» Do the work of the entire article. As you know, some readers never get past the headline, so create a headline that has impact. When you’re crafting your headlines, you don’t need to reinvent the wheel. Several good, free tools are available to assist you: »» CoSchedule’s Headline Analyzer (http://coschedule.com/headlineanalyzer): This tool gives you an overall score and breaks down your Creating Content That Tells a Story headline into several measures to help you improve it. »» Headlinr (http://headlinr.com/): This tool is unique because it provides you with proven headlines that match your keyword or topic. You can invoke it right from your browser, so it’s always there. »» Hemingway App (http://www.hemingwayapp.com): You can use this tool to test both your headline or your entire post. It makes suggestions about improving your content to make it clear. »» The Readability Test Tool (http://read-able.com/): This tool helps you determine whether your writing is appropriate for the targeted audience. It will help you simplify and make your content more readable. CHAPTER 4 Creating Content That Tells a Story 251 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding the content workflow »» Solidifying roles and responsibilities »» Using an editorial calendar »» Finding content writers Chapter 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems A chapter about systems and processes? You may be thinking that this content is reserved for people who love to talk about workflow. Well, it is. But it’s also important for everyone else who has to participate in getting his or her content to market. So that must include you, too. In this chapter, you get into the nuts and bolts of your content framework. After your digital marketing strategy is in place and you know what kind of content you need, you’ll want to create a system that you can rely on to get the job done. This chapter also delves into how content systems and documented procedures make everything easier. Organizing the Content Process Why should you care about developing a system for your content efforts? The best answer is that everyone benefits, even those who are not directly involved in the process. You would probably not consider mounting any other kind of project in CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 253 your organization without detailing how things will work. The same should be said for your content system. Of course, if you’re a solopreneur who doesn’t use freelancers, you can probably get away without documenting anything. But the moment you bring on another person, you need to let her know how things are done so that she doesn’t reinvent the wheel. Benefiting from a defined framework When you implement a documented content marketing process, you provide ­everyone in the organization with clear expectations about »» Who is in charge (and responsible) for each part of the process »» How long your different campaigns and tasks take to complete »» How to avoid bottlenecks and mistakes »» What the budget will provide for and what resources are needed »» Whether you’re meeting your content and business goals »» Whether you’re meeting your legal requirements »» How security is implemented and preserved On the opposite side of the coin, here’s a brief look at what can happen if you don’t have your content systems in place. You could have the following: »» Violations of copyright laws: Copyrighted images or content is published without permission. »» Dissemination of inaccurate information: Angry customers see inaccurate information that was not vetted by a content manager or editor. »» Sloppy design: No approvals were obtained for design consistency, making your brand look amateurish. »» Poorly written articles: Without editorial guidance, your posts could have misspellings and typos that will turn your audience off. Obviously, people make mistakes. Even with a content system in place, you will still incur errors. A content framework simply helps you eliminate as many nasty errors as possible. 254 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Enumerating these issues is often a good way to get managers on your side. Talking about corporate exposure always gets people’s attention. Examining the systems needed You can begin by focusing on what’s involved in putting your content system together. No magic is involved. As with any project you create, you need to know what the tasks are, how to get them done, and what your budget constraints are. It’s important to make sure that everyone on the team understands how you deliver quality content using the highest standards. You should have a documented process that everyone can follow. According to the Content Marketing Institute, research shows that those companies that have a documented framework believe that it helps them be more successful content marketers. You should also watch out for office politics related to your project. Big projects usually engender big emotions. Make sure that everyone is heard. Also be aware that not everyone will want your project to succeed, for reasons known only to them. So, now you’re tasked with getting the system in gear. You have buy in and you need to get to work. What needs to happen next? The next paragraphs consider just a few of the tasks ahead of you. If your company has a formal Content Management System (CMS), that system should have specific guidelines about the ways in which you have to input and manage your content. Here, you’re dealing with the general tasks needed to put procedures in place. You need to »» Assign roles and responsibilities. Everyone must know what he or she is responsible for and in what time frame. »» Establish governance rules to be followed. Governance rules need to be created so that people know how to make decisions. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 255 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems It’s also critical to give all team members the opportunity to make suggestions and improve procedures. In fact, even those who are not actual team members can benefit from understanding the content process. You should welcome anyone who is interested in learning how he can assist or support your efforts. »» Put editorial guidelines in place. Editors need rules, too. Don’t forget to create these for everyone to follow so that your content will have quality and consistency. »» Develop a writer’s resource system. You need to identify where to get writers (if they are not in-house), how to assign them to specific tasks, and what and how to pay them. (Same goes for any other contracts; for example, designers and other technology workers.) »» Select and use an editorial calendar. Everyone needs to see what is being created. A calendar is also used to assign other project tasks that complete the content process. (See “Using an editorial calendar,” later in this chapter.) »» Create content guidelines for authors. Writers need to know what is expected of them in terms of style and content. »» Ensure that you have visual guidelines for designers. Your content much be visually appealing and conform to all guidelines that have been documented in your brand guidelines. »» Make sure that your taxonomy is in good order. This is just a fancy way of saying that your keywords and other data classifiers should be kept up-todate so that they can be tagged correctly and people can easily find you. »» Develop the workflow to revise and approve content. After content is written and has gone through the editorial process, you need to make sure that people know who is responsible for approving the content. »» Publish content to multiple channels. Have channel guidelines in place for each social platform to which you publish. You don’t want to go through all that effort to create content and then fail to publish it correctly. »» Ensure that training is in place. If new people join the process, you want to be sure that they can get up and running quickly. You also need to evaluate and measure the results of your efforts, as covered in Book 9. How’s that for a list of tasks? Now that you understand the magnitude of the project, you can work on getting your systems in place. When you think about content writing and publishing, you probably don’t think about governance. In reality, though, governance is crucial to your content strategy. Governance refers to the rules of the road that guide your decision-making throughout the content lifecycle. After you determine the scope of your project, you have to create the rules that guide you. 256 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation For example, if you, as the editor, intend to publish a controversial article on the company blog, how will you go about reviewing it and getting approval? When everything goes smoothly, the topic of governance seems unnecessary or heavyhanded. When you run into a conflict, however, either internal or external, you’ll be glad you have them. So what goes into preparing for governance? You need to »» Develop roles and responsibilities »» Establish workflow »» Create documentation You also need to ensure that there is adequate training for all involved. The following sections look at each of these governance roles in turn. When it comes to the average workplace, sometimes it’s hard to know who is in charge. People often assume the mantle of authority even when they have no real power. But before you determine who is in charge, it’s important to know how decisions about the project will get made. Governance models are typically one of three types: »» Centralized: In this model, all decisions are made by a central committee that has the authority to consult anyone in the hierarchy to make decisions. This committee could include the legal department, advertising, and other departments. This model works best in small companies with a localized editorial team. »» Hub-and-spoke: This model allows different teams to take responsibility for their own decisions. These teams may be spread across the globe, thereby making a central model impractical. Obviously, the model makes having a high standard of consistency less likely unless guidelines are strictly enforced. »» Hybrid: As you might guess, this model is the most popular. It’s more informal and allows teams to use the best of both models. It does require that some matters, such as legal aspects, be controlled centrally. After your organization has decided on the method of making decisions, several roles must be assigned in a content management system, as described in Table 5-1. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 257 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems Determining Roles and Responsibilities TABLE 5-1 Roles Needed for a Content System Role Description Project Leader Corporate leader who approves the overall budget and goals and is ultimately responsible for the overall success or failure of the project Project Manager Manages budget, staffing, guidelines, and so on Content Managers Determine what topics are written about and what formats are used Editors Assign and schedule writers; evaluate writing; supervise revisions; approve for publication Contributors Write articles, ebooks, and other content Designers Create images and design page layouts Content System Administrators Evaluate content to ensure that it will render correctly; create pages; check links Web Administrators Ensure that content is formatted for publication and meets all web standards Managing the Workflow Developing an efficient workflow is a vital part of the content system. When you document your systems, you help yourself and others learn the process. You also make it easy for others to spot mistakes. Here are several tasks to consider in your workflow process: »» How contributors are found and assigned »» How contributions are scheduled »» How the content gets reviewed and approved »» How the content is published The following sections explain each of these tasks. Workflow documents should include visual elements. If you can capture screen shots, that’s great. Flow charts are also helpful. Keeping the use of visual elements in mind will be valuable when you are trying to streamline the process. Finding and assigning writers Your content is only as good as the people who create it. If, like IBM (http:// IBM.com), you have subject matter experts (SME) in almost all technical and 258 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation business fields, your problem is solved. You can have your in-house writers interview an SME and create great content. But what if you have only a few people who can write, or worse yet, no one who can produce content? You need to look outside of your organization to engage writers and editors to do the job. Doing so requires a budget and an understanding about what constitutes great content specifically for you. To assemble a team of content creators, you have several options that vary in the amount of time and money you have to spend. Here are some options that you can try: »» Harness your own in-house talent and create a content writing team. If you choose this path, you will have to take on a great deal of the management yourself. You will have to determine how much time and effort you need and figure out how to use your resources. One major disadvantage is that you’re stuck with the writing talent you have. If your writers are very good, you’re lucky. If not, you may have weak content and nowhere to go to improve it. manage. This path gives you the potential to find good writers. You’ll still have to manage their time, but only in the sense that you assign work and expect to get work returned in a timely manner. The major disadvantage here is that you may have to test and audition several writers before you find the ones who suit you. Also, as freelancers, they can move on and you’ll have to replace them. Some sources for freelance writers are • • • Contently (http://contently.com) WriterAccess (http://www.writeraccess.com/); see Figure 5-1 Zerys (http://www.zerys.com/) »» Hire a writing service. When you hire a writing service, you’re getting some- one else to manage your writers. The service fulfills your requests by finding a suitable writer among its stable of contributors and getting the content written. Using such a service can save you time and effort, and you’ll typically pay a premium for that fact. However, if you’re looking to save time, perhaps you should consider this. Here are several writing services to get you started: • • • Internet Marketing Ninjas (http://www.internetmarketingninjas.com) Express Writers (https://expresswriters.com) Brafton (http://www.brafton.com/); see Figure 5-2. »» Contact influencers who will create guest posts for you. To supplement your content, you may want to have guest posts done by your industry’s influencers. Book 6 has everything you need to know about working with influencers. These people may want a byline credit, and they will be happy to have the exposure. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 259 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems »» Hire individual contractors and create an external writing team that you »» Pay a premium for special writers. You may know of professional writers who would provide exactly what you need. If so, you can offer to pay them a premium rate. FIGURE 5-1: WriterAccess. Of course, you can mix up all these options and build a system that’s perfect for you. As you experiment, you’ll find the best combination of services for your needs. Using an editorial calendar Would you schedule a trip without looking at a calendar? Probably not. So why not use an editorial calendar when scheduling your content? If you wonder whether a calendar is necessary, you’re not alone. Some content marketers don’t want to be bothered with establishing one and keeping it current. If you’re a solo business operator or have a very small team, you might think that a calendar is overkill. Think again. Would you prefer to keep the schedule in your head and have everyone ask you about it? And could you even keep everything straight in your mind? Why take the chance of missing deadlines? If you work in a large corporation, you probably already see the need for a robust organizational tool and may be looking for a good editorial calendar. 260 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 5-2: Take a look at the tasks that a calendar helps you perform. When you have a calendar, you can »» See the big picture of how your content is distributed throughout the months. A calendar gives you an at-a-glance view of the content that is in the pipeline and that has already been published, helping you avoid redundancies. »» Ensure that you will have the people and resources that you need when you need them. To avoid long gaps in the schedule, you want to get writers lined up in advance. If someone drops out or you want to add something special, you can prepare ahead of time. Also, Google loves consistency, and you don’t want to disappoint Google! »» Develop content for specific promotions and campaigns. Product managers, marketers, and sales managers want to get their campaigns put at the head of the line. A calendar can help to control the potential chaos of conflicting demands. »» Assign people to specific content tasks and then follow up with them. A documented schedule allows you to follow up with the people to which you assign tasks. You can see whether a deadline is fast approaching with no word from your contributor. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 261 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems Brafton. »» Prevent the problem of not knowing what to write about with a deadline looming. A calendar will allow you to schedule topics in advance so that you’re never wondering what your people should be writing about. It is critical that you keep a steady stream of content ideas so that you can plug them in and get them written. Keep a growing list of ideas for content in online tools like Evernote (http://evernote.com), a content organizing tool. Or you might use Trello (http://Trello.com), a collaboration tool. If your group already has a collaboration tool, use that. The key is to make sure that you capture ideas as you think of them so that you’re never at a loss for a juicy topic to write about. »» Make sure to vary your content formats so that you delight everyone in your audience. Scheduling ahead of time allows you to look at content formats. You will want to have a variety — lists, videos, and audio — to entertain your audience. »» Help your team be more productive because they know what to work on when they’re ready to work. People are more productive when they manage their own time. Not waiting for the last minute ensures that project members turn in their assignments on time. Or at least they will know that they’re going to miss a deadline and inform you! Using a calendar makes it easy to show your manager what you’re doing when it’s performance review time. It also allows you to review your strategy at given intervals. When you’re ready to revise and optimize, you’ll have all the information you need in your calendar, along with supporting documents. So what calendar tool should you choose? That depends on what’s available to you. Here are some options to consider: »» If you use a formal content management software platform (CMS), you may already have a calendar tool built right in. An example of a CMS with a built-in calendar is the Kudani Cloud (http://Kudani.com) content platform. It has all the built-in features you need for finding content and publishing it to your blog or website — all without leaving the application. »» If you want to use a standalone calendar, you might try the one from CoSchedule (http://coschedule.com). »» If you use WordPress for your blog, several plug-ins are available. (https:// wordpress.org/plugins/editorial-calendar/). Figure 5-3 shows one. 262 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 5-3: CAN YOUR EDITORIAL CALENDAR INCREASE YOUR NUMBER OF FOLLOWERS? You know that using an editorial calendar can help you with your scheduling, but can it actually get you more attention and Facebook followers? According to the co-founders Dechay Watts and Debbie Williams of SPROUT Content (https://www.sprout content.com/), a content and inbound marketing services firm acquired by Gorilla Group, it can. They detail how they were able to help a regional restaurant group in Florida with several locations get into social media and create excitement for its brand. One of the first things Watts and Williams did for this client was to create a three-month blog editorial calendar for each restaurant. Within a two-year time frame, the company accrued more than 23,000 Facebook fans, a metric it could never have obtained if it didn’t use its editorial calendar to apply longterm thinking to their content creation. Perhaps you thought that using an editorial calendar wasn’t valuable. Now you see that it can be. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 263 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems WordPress Calendar. Documenting Your Policies and Procedures Documentation isn’t considered a very exciting topic, but it’s certainly a very ­necessary one. Documenting your content strategy can mean the difference between the success and failure of your project. This is also true of documentation for your systems and procedures. You need to ask several key questions about your documentation on an ongoing basis. These questions include: »» Does everyone know where to find documentation? It’s great to have documentation, but if no one knows where it is, it’s useless. A central repository should exist on the company server to house all your documentation regarding content processes. »» Is there a method to let everyone know about changes made to docu- mentation? Having a way to keep everyone in the loop concerning changes is key, because tracking changes can be a bit complex. You want to figure out the best way to let people know who care about the changes and not annoy those who aren’t. Some companies issue alerts to specific teams when guidelines have changed. Make sure that you know who is on each team, for example, editorial versus technical, so that the right alerts go to the right people. »» Are you guarding against “walking documentation?” Walking documenta- tion refers to the information that is known only to specific employees, who walk out the door each night. You need to ensure that everything that should be known by the group is written down and kept in an accessible place, rather than existing just in the mind of a few employees. Table 5-2 lists the kind of documentation you need for each of the content system areas. In the upcoming sections, I explain each of these areas. TABLE 5-2 264 Documentation Needed for a Content System Who Uses It Documentation Content managers Taxonomy Editors Editorial guidelines Writers Style guides Designers Visual and branding guides Content system administrators Social platform requirements, CMS Web administrators Systems and security BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Content managers In larger organizations content managers are different from the editor, who ensures that the content meets its goals and doesn’t violate any company ­policies. A content manager has a more strategic role. She is responsible for knowing about the personas and the data collected about customers. With that knowledge she maintains the taxonomy and determines what topics and formats of content should be created. Editors Editorial guidelines are critical for any publisher. They explain to everyone concerned what your goals are for publishing. The guidelines tell your contributors who your audience is and what you want them to get from reading your content. It also explains the approval process so that writers know how their work will be evaluated. Obviously, documenting what authors need to know about writing content for you should be available in a style guide for authors. The type of style guide you provide for your in-house writers will be extensive and will also include specific information about your CMS, if you have one. HubSpot provides a free style template (see Figure 5-4) that can be helpful if you need to create guidelines from scratch. Go to http://blog.hubspot.com/blog/ tabid/6307/bid/31247/The-Simple-Template-for-a-Thorough-ContentStyle-Guide.aspx. Blogs that use outside contributors normally have a document available on the blog’s website that informs contributors about what is acceptable and desirable in a post they submit for publication. Designers Designers rely on the visual guidelines that have been created for the website properties. They can also refer to brand guidelines if issues arise. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 265 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems Writers FIGURE 5-4: HubSpot content style template. Content system administrator The content system administrator makes sure that the CMS is functioning and will refer to the CMS documentation when necessary. He also keeps social platform guidelines with the details about formatting content for other channels. Web administrator The web administrator is the keeper of the important security guidelines for the company’s web properties. She’s also responsible for system maintenance documentation. Of course you know that getting all the systems in place is only half the job. People must be trained to effectively use the systems. Some of the training occurs by using the systems and getting comfortable with how they work. The technology you put together for your system may include software tools for writing, designing, and editing. This means that you expect your team members to be well-versed in the software skills needed for their work 266 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation YOUR CONTENT COULD BE INTELLIGENT Recently, content marketers have been hearing about “intelligent content.” This term doesn’t refer to content that is written for power users. Rather, it’s content that is ­structured to make it more useful. Scott Abel, the Content Wrangler (https:// thecontentwrangler.com/#), calls it “content that can be read by people and machines.” The value of making your content intelligent is that by providing a structure, the content can be found and used throughout the organization. Robert Rose of the Content Marketing Institute is quoted in Scott Abel’s SlideShare presentation as saying, “Intelligent content is an approach. A way of thinking about how we structure and ­manage content” (http://www.slideshare.net/abelsp/intelligent-contentin-the-experience-age-49565442). Intelligent content is content that is broken out into its components (such as metadata) so that it can be structured into the output that’s needed. Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems Is intelligent content something that you need to consider for your company? It depends. If you’re a small company with a limited amount of content, the answer is, not right now. If you have a big organization and lots of different forms of content, developing intelligent content will help you deliver the best content to all your customers. You want to be able to get the right content to the right customers at the right time. CHAPTER 5 Defining Your Content Framework Using Processes and Systems 267 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Building a resource library of content »» Writing for the right audience »» Creative a narrative for your brand’s story »» Tracking success metrics Chapter 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience T he content marketing revolution transformed the B2B marketing world. The birth of marketing automation platforms launched in the mid-2000s also launched the digital content marketing industry. Content marketing is all about telling the story of your company’s product or service in an unbiased way and demonstrating thought leadership. Establishing a thought leadership position is accomplished through creating meaningful content that leaves an impression on your targeted accounts. Marketing automation systems need content to fuel demand generation. Without content, there’s nothing to link to from your calls to action (CTAs) on landing pages. Demonstrating thought leadership would be impossible. Your company needs content to demonstrate its knowledge of industry subject matter. Content has become the lifeblood of a successful marketing program. You have to get the content engine revved up and keep it full throughout your marketing campaigns. A comprehensive strategy is paired with content for each stage of the buyer journey. Content should be engaging, entertaining, and based on the stage of the relationship. All throughout the buyer journey, you’ll use marketing technology to help deliver content at the right stage, at the right time, and to the right contacts. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 269 In this chapter, you see how to drive a response from your various types of content, giving you a framework to start your own content marketing program. Also outlined are the best practices for measuring the success of your content marketing programs. Creating a Content Library According to the Content Marketing Institute, 80 percent of business decision makers want their company information in a series of articles, not in advertisements. The buyer journey is a comprehensive lifecycle, from the time a prospect first connects with your company. Your potential buyers want to read and digest information at their own pace instead of being spoon-fed by a salesperson. By having a library full of content, your prospects can select the content they want to read or the videos they want to watch. This content informs them about the value of your company’s product or service without a sales pitch. Host your company’s content library on your website, labeled “Resources,” “Resource Library,” or “Knowledge Center.” A content library will have gated content protected by a form. This way, you ­capture a contact’s information before they download content. Content is used to draw inbound activity to your website to discover new contacts and nurture existing contacts. Lots of different content is needed, as it will serve a different purpose in the buyer journey. When brainstorming ideas for content, think of people outside of your company you need to interview. To remove any bias from your content, interview at least three thought leaders outside your industry, then send them quotes to review before including them in your content. Your content library should showcase your company’s expertise and thought leadership position in the industry. All the different pieces of content should inform your prospect, educate them on best practices, and guide them through the buyer journey. These tools work in all stages of marketing: »» Whitepapers: This long-form content is created in .pdf and should be served up early in the buyer journey. A whitepaper is a great way to demonstrate thought leadership in your area of subject matter expertise. Across all industries, producing and distributing whitepapers to your prospects is considered a best practice for moving prospects through the sales 270 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation process. Whitepapers can be as short as six pages to make the information easy to read. »» Ebooks: An ebook is an even longer version of a whitepaper. Ebooks are used to incorporate even more quotes and content from other thought leaders and industry insights. These should also be served up early in the buyer journey. The difference between a whitepaper and an ebook is both the length and design. An ebook is a longer work, averaging at least 20 pages or more. Whitepapers usually are around ten pages, and they got their name because of all the white space included in the design to make the text easier to digest. An ebook should incorporate more color and graphic design elements. Figure 6-1 shows a sample of an ebook. FIGURE 6-1: Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Example of an ebook. Include a table of contents in your ebooks and whitepapers over ten pages. This helps the reader to find the content they want to read. Figure 6-2 shows a sample table of contents from an ebook. »» Infographics: When you only have eight seconds to capture the attention of your prospect, an infographic helps keep you top of mind. These graphics should also be served up early in the buyer journey to help increase the awareness of your product or service. Figure 6-3 shows a sample infographic. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 271 FIGURE 6-2: Example of a table of contents. FIGURE 6-3: Example of an infographic. With ebooks, infographics, and whitepapers, the goal is education of the problem your company solves, not about your company. Don’t include detailed information about your product or service in this early-stage content. Save it for later in the buyer journey. »» Case studies: Letting your customers share their success stories in case studies is good for you (prospects will hear about authentic results from real clients) and good for your clients (their stories promote awareness of their businesses, too). This content should be presented by the sales team after the qualification process, when you’re trying to progress the account into an opportunity or Closed/Won deal. Two ways to develop case studies into content include 272 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation • Document: Designed in a .pdf covering the problem your customer was experiencing and how your company provided a solution. • Video: Short recorded interviews with your customers, where prospects can hear from customers in their own words about why they do business with your company. »» Webinars: In the early stage of the buyer journey, webinars are a great tool to drive awareness and engagement in your target, qualified accounts. The goal of producing webinars is to create more interest with the contacts in your account and move them further through the sales process. With your prospect webinars, you need a panel of presenters. When you have three presenters, these roles are the ones you should have: • • One thought leader or industry influencer from outside your team • One of your executive team members or a leader in your company A customer “champion” who can be an advocate for your product or service and can speak eloquently to your audience Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Edit your recorded webinars into shorter segments, such as a 15-minute video. Short video recordings are easy to digest, and can be replayed at your contact’s convenience. Figure 6-4 shows a sample webinar. FIGURE 6-4: Example of a webinar replay. Have a quarterly plan for your webinars. Hosting at least one webinar per month is a great way to create velocity for the sales team. They should create a promotion plan to share this new content. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 273 Because you’re going through the effort to create a content library, you need to have a plan to share this content with your target audience. When you spend this time, money, and effort to create content, it needs to be shared with the contacts in your accounts. You need to create content that doesn’t live in your “Resources” section, as other content and communications are needed to serve other purposes to drive awareness. This content can be strategically used in campaigns to target accounts that are in the early stage of the buyer journey. Here are other types of content you need to develop: »» Blog posts: Your company’s blog is a key component of your marketing website. Your prospects and influencers will check out your blog for the latest topics your company is writing about. New content should be published to your blog at least once a week. Make it current and topical. »» Press releases: This is how your company will distribute major news. These news announcements can include a strategic round of funding, a new customer acquisition, merger, partnership, or hosting an event. The benefit of distributing a press release on a web-based platform, such as PR Newswire (www.prnewswire.com), MarketWired (www.marketwired.com), or PRWeb (http://service.prweb.com/home), is that it’s an official press release, which you can then link to from other sources. »» Social media: The content you publish to social media platforms, (such as Twitter, LinkedIn, and Facebook) should be fresh and timely. Social media content should be created specifically for the channel you’re publishing it on. Every time you post a link to Twitter, use a platform like Bit.ly (https:// bitly.com) or Snip.ly (https://snip.ly) to track how many times the link is clicked. When you’re sharing the same piece of content on multiple social media channels, such as sharing the same case study on both Twitter and LinkedIn, create different tracking links to attribute it to different channels. Many marketing automation systems can also generate tracked links or integrate with tools that track social media engagement. »» Direct mail: Content for direct mailing includes physical objects. You need to have stationary printed with your company’s logo for your team members to write notes to accounts thanking them for their time. Consider printing postcards to include with “swag” or other items you will physically mail to prospects 274 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Create an editorial calendar for the new content you’ll publish to your library, blog, press releases, sending direct mail, and other content. This calendar will help your marketing team manage when and what you’re publishing across various channels. Having an editorial calendar also provides transparency across your sales team so everyone knows about new content and upcoming campaigns. Send an email or communicate during your weekly sales meeting to your sales leaders about when new content will be available and how they can use it. Storytelling and its importance As discussed in Book 3, Chapter 4, the whole point of developing and sharing content is to tell a story. The importance of storytelling for modern B2B marketers can’t be overstated. Your prospects don’t want to watch a commercial or hear a product pitch. Buyers today want to be informed and educated, so they can arrive at a decision independently. The content your company produces should help tell a story to your buyers, so they can be guided down a path that leads to becoming customers. Adapting the narrative to fit the buyer journey means everyone will discover a slightly different version of the same story. A story always has three components: a beginning, a middle, and an end. The same is true for the buyer journey. You need to tell a story to the contacts in the account using your content. Here’s how to think of your content as a story: »» Beginning: The start of the buyer journey with your company. It’s about awareness for the early-stage prospects. At this stage, the prospect is becoming educated about the problem and potential solutions. The relevant content at the early stage includes blog posts, ebooks, infographics, and whitepapers. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 275 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience The content in your library should be used in campaigns throughout the buyer journey. Throughout the sales process, there’s an underlying story. This is called the narrative. The narrative tells a story problem you’re trying to solve and builds to a conclusion at the end, which is how your company answers the solution. When you think about storytelling, the story should be consistent. No matter who you tell the story, it shouldn’t change. However, you might tell the story from a different point of view, depending on the type of contact you want to reach. For example, the angle from which a story is told to an IT manager is very different from a CMO. »» Middle: The account has been qualified and the sales team is trying to create an opportunity. At this stage, the contacts in your account are becoming educated about why they should buy from your company. The relevant content at the middle stage includes case studies, video testimonials, webinars, and engaging on social media. (Sales account executives should personally connect with accounts on LinkedIn.) »» End: The sales team is trying to close the opportunity and win a new cus- tomer. At this stage, the contacts in your account need to see how your company will continue to support them after the deal is done. The relevant content in the final stages of the buyer journey includes “how to” content (such as checklists and implementation guides) showing them how they can easily adopt your company’s product or service. If there’s competition here, a competitive analysis or brief document outlining the return on investment (ROI) can be provided. When you have a lousy product, no good story can sell it. You must have a good product or service, or no amount of marketing will help your company in the long term. To win the deal, you need a solid product offering, but it’s so much more than that. The account will choose to do business with your company because of the relationship built with the sales representative and the content that was ­produced and shared throughout the buyer journey. The storytelling process helps your sales team to tell the right story and sell the dream to close the deal. It’s part of the psychology of sales. Now, the content that supports the overall narrative can be different depending on the particular problem they’re trying to solve. The story needs to tailor to that angle and may require a change in focus on which portion of the story based on the stage in the buyer journey. Every quarter, your sales team should get together to determine what type of content marketing needs to produce for sales enablement. They should also meet with customer success to discover which content will be needed for customer accounts to support adoption and provide training. Taking a BtoB lens to your content Imagine you walk into a store. The shopkeeper knows your size, the colors you like, your fashion sense, and your price range — all the information about the types of clothes you like. They select items to present clothing options that they know 276 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation you’ll be likely to purchase. B2B marketers need to think more like the storekeeper who treats all clients like they’re VIPs with tailor-made clothing; you’re tailoring your message to contacts in an account. These contacts should match your personas (the type of people who are the best fit for your product or service). Keeping the accounts and contacts in mind when developing your content will make sure it resonates. FIVE OUTSTANDING CONTENT TIPS FROM JOE CHERNOV • Think about all the content your company has published and could publish as a “Total Address Content Market.” Everything you published includes internal content (such as presentations and reports) and external content (such as blog posts, resources on your website, and advertising). Next, think about everything you could publish, such as stories and anecdotes, plugging your readers into the thoughts and minds of your company’s leadership. • The value of having a content library begins with identifying what you have and what you need. Catalog all your existing content, everything you have published internally and externally, and then identify areas needing collateral. • Marketing needs to interview sales leaders for questions they’re frequently asked. Salespeople are on the frontline between your business and future customers. Which topics or subjects regularly come up on sales calls? Match these questions to existing content, or brainstorm new content that needs to be developed to answer these questions. • After talking to sales, marketing needs to talk to the customer success team. These are the folks on the front line of customer service for implementation, adoption, and usage. Use them to generate ideas for content to support customers with training and successfully using your company’s product or service. They have the pulse on customer needs. • Resist the temptation to create content that speaks to you and your boss. Reduce your own role, and replace it with your prospect or customer. This sounds obvious, but not everyone loves the product like you do. . .at least, not yet. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 277 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Joe Chernov (@jchernov) is one of the content marketing gurus in the B2B world, ­ aving run marketing teams at HubSpot, Kinvey, Eloqua, and now Robin (https:// h robinpowered.com/). He was kind enough to share these tips for developing content: To think about your content from a BtoB perspective: »» Know your audience. Remember that your audience is extremely important as you’re taking a targeted account approach. »» Deliver content meaningfully. Don’t just blast an email to thousands of people every time you publish a new infographic or whitepaper. Your content was designed with your audience in mind. Producing content by industry vertical Your content should be specific to the industries and segments of the market identified in your buyer persona. When you start planning your first marketing strategy, you’ll work with your sales team to identify a persona that includes both company size (based on the number of employees and the amount of revenue) and the type of industry. Verticals refer to the market. A vertical market is the type of industry. Examples of vertical markets include financial services, commercial real estate, fashion merchandising, retail stores, and gaming. You must create an persona for the types of accounts you want to target before producing content. Writing content without basing it on an industry is like speaking a foreign ­language to someone who isn’t fluent. Publish a case study for each industry vertical you’re targeting. When you’re ­targeting that industry, you must provide proof of how your solution works for their peers. Figure 6-5 shows a sample case study tailored to target accounts in a specified industry. Basing content on personas For your content, consider the stage of the buyer journey and who is in the account. Your marketing team needs to both educate one person or contact, and also all the contacts within the account who have a stake in the purchase decision. The content should be as specific as possible for each individual decision maker, ensuring they’re engaged in the process. 278 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation FIGURE 6-5: Example of a case study for one industry. You must consider who your audience is for each individual piece of content, and how they will obtain this content. Every piece of content should be created and tailored with your personas in mind. The personas are based on job role, responsibility, and seniority in an organization. This is why it’s essential to have your personas created before you start developing content. You can read more about building your personas in Book 2, Chapter 2. When you’re developing persona-based content, write the content targeted toward the persona’s role and business needs. Think about how your solution focuses on supporting the needs of the individual role. The personas for your contacts in your target accounts will range across all levels of the organization. The way a C-level executive wants to consume content is different from a marketing manager, because they’re different people who are focused on specific business needs. Your content should provide answers for all the personas in your ICP. Each person wants to hear why your solution will work for him or her, in addition to the company as a whole. Here are considerations for creating content based on seniority: »» Individual contributor: This person is tasked with finding the right solution for his or her own role. They’re the most engaged during the buying process, even when they aren’t the ultimate decision makers. For content, this individual CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 279 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience The story you’re telling with all your content must align to a narrative. What is the problem, and how is your company the solution? contributor needs to see “how to” guides. The questions your content should answer for this persona include • What can your product do to deliver features, functionality, and ease of use? • • Which integrations does your platform support? How easily can you pull reports or show metrics? Metrics are essential. The individual contributor must show why your product is useful. »» Manager or Director: The department manager needs to know your company actually can do what the individual contributor says you can. In most sales situations, your sales account executive will begin by talking to an individual contributor who will be the end user. Content will need to be created for this person’s manager. A manager wants to see these types of content: • • Positive product reviews on the Internet Case studies, customer use cases, and video testimonials The manager is verifying that your company is solid, and that going with your company is the right thing to do. »» Executive: The sponsor of the project who is a stakeholder for the success. He or she is the ultimate decision maker who is conscious of the budget and investment required to use your company’s product or service. The types of content this person wants to see includes • • Financial proof: A brief or spreadsheet showing an estimated ROI • References: Connecting with your customers to confirm you truly have a solution • Reporting examples or screenshots of sample dashboards Competitive analysis: How your company is better than other vendors in the marketplace »» Influencers within the company: Outside of your end user and his boss, you need to remember that there are influencers in the account who may not directly use your product or service. These influencers can include people in other departments; for example, when you’re selling to marketers, an influencer could be the VP of Sales. While this VP role isn’t part of the marketing team, because of the leadership position they influence the whole purchasing process. The influencer wants to look at complementary solutions, talk to their peers who have heard of your company, and show their 280 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation colleagues on the executive team that they did a background check on your business. »» Beneficiaries: When the VP of another department is an influencer, then the beneficiaries in his or her department are asking “what’s in it for me?” For example, marketing looks at technology solutions, and salespeople benefit from them, but marketing decides which tools to purchase. Content should be created for the individuals who will benefit from your solution, even when they don’t have a say in the purchase decision. They need to know whether the solution is working, and how they will benefit. Across the entire account, the end users want to see more tactical examples of how your solution works, whereas the higher you go up the organization more strategic. The higher you go up the food chain, the more your personas care about how your solution fits into the account’s vision and strategic objectives. The executive team in your target account wants to know how doing business with your company will help them reach larger business goals. Think about how your content aligns with providing answers to all of your personas. Your personas should align with each of the contacts in the account. The story should guide your contacts in the account by what they want to know about your product or solution. The goal is to get content to the right persona. You need to make sure everyone in the account, all the contacts who can impact the purchase decision, know what your company offers and the benefit it can provide. Here is one example using the different personas in an IT department: wants to know how your solution works from an integration standpoint. He or she wants to see how it collaborates with the other tools and software that exist in the organization’s technology stack. The question to answer here is “Does this new technology play well with what I already have?” »» Chief Financial Officer (CFO): He or she wants to know the return on investment after making this purchase from your company. VisualizeROI (www.visualize-roi.com) is one tool that helps you create an ROI calculator plugging in different variables to demonstrate how using your company’s product or service will save time, money, or both. Gartner’s Magic Quadrant is another proof of investment. You can leverage the renowned analyst team at Gartner to show your product isn’t just smoke and mirrors, but verified by industry analysts. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 281 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience »» Chief Information Officer (CIO): The technology leader for an IT department »» IT Director: The department head who will have firsthand knowledge of how his or her direct reports are using your product or service. When something isn’t working for one of the director’s team members, your customer success manager will hear about it. »» IT Manager or Specialist: The end user of your technology. He or she is the persona who ultimately can turn into a “power user” or “champion” for advocate marketing. You need to empower this person from Day 1, the time they first connect with your company or download a piece of content. Humanizing Content The entire marketing industry is evolving. Instead of business-to-business (B2B) or business-to-consumer (B2C) marketing, it’s often referred to as human-tohuman (H2H). Humans want to buy from each other, and establish relationships. It’s those relationships and personal connections that build trust. Trust makes humans feel more confident in the purchase decision. Demonstrating thought leadership Thought leadership is one of the strongest influences in B2B marketing. A thought leader is someone in your industry perceived to be a subject matter expert. Thought leadership is presented through your content. Demonstrating thought leadership in your content is very different than traditional marketing or advertising. Instead of saying “Here’s why you should buy my product!,” it’s “Here’s a problem; in your position, here is how we helped other people in your industry solve it.” Being a thought leader means sharing the limelight with other industry leaders, giving them the stage. People look to thought leaders when they’re bringing the industry’s best. SHOW YOUR PASSION Think about showing your passion as you start to demonstrate thought leadership in your content. Whatever topic is your subject matter expertise, own it. Assume the position of being a knowledgeable person about this topic because you actually are! Become a hero for supporting this cause, whether it’s chicken tenders or making a case for content marketing. This needs to be a bigger problem you’re trying to solve across industry, and show how people can look to you and your company for guidance. 282 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation You can use these channels and activities to demonstrate your thought leadership position: »» Content: In your ebooks, whitepapers, case studies, and blog posts. Focus on one topic that aligns with your product. If you were writing content about five ways to use content marketing to support sales, you could highlight methods for working with your account executives. You could also link to quotes from other thought leaders. »» Videos: In all your video content, from high-level product overviews to detailed demos and customer testimonials, the language used in these videos reinforces your thought leadership. »» Press releases: In your communications to the media, cite industry sources that support your go-to market claims. »» Social media: Regularly post content about your subject matter on Twitter, Facebook, and LinkedIn. If you were a thought leader about IT solutions, you might post content about the latest technology, then find and follow other thought leaders on social media who talk about the same topic to engage them in a discussion. »» Webinars and in-person events: When you’re putting together an event, decide on a central theme and topic. Then find other thought leaders to join your event as a panelist, presenter, or sponsor. Having multiple thought leaders participate in your digital and in-person events reinforces your position as a leading influencer in your industry. Your content should present a solution but not in a sales-y way. The content and messaging your company creates needs to address the wants, needs, and pain points of your personas. Your personas have different motivations, and your content needs to speak to these driving forces. When a contact first lands on your website or reads and email, they don’t have a vested interest in your company. They may not even know they have a problem, which your company can provide a solution for. What your contacts know is their own personal motivations. Set up a meeting with your sales team to examine your personas and discuss their wants, needs, and pain points. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 283 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Addressing wants, needs, and pain points Because your sales team is on the front line, interacting with prospects and opportunities, they’re the best source to provide insight into what’s motivating the contacts in your target accounts. Here are the questions to ask: »» What does this persona want? Think about it from the context of their role. When the contact is an individual contributor, like a marketing coordinator or an IT specialist, they want their manager or director to recognize the work they’re doing. When you’re targeting a manager or director, they want to streamline processes and operational efficiency to achieve more results without spending more money. »» What does this persona need? This motivation most likely will be tied to a strategic business objective or a company goal. When your persona is someone in the sales department, he or she needs to hit a revenue goal each month or quarter. Consider how your content speaks to helping with this need. »» Which pain or stress does this persona have? When your persona is a marketing director, you know that the pain they’re feeling can stem from needing to contribute to revenue growth. When you’re targeting an IT director, their pain can come from too many systems that aren’t integrated. When it’s a CFO at an early-stage technology company, his or her pain may come from not having enough financial resources to grow the organization. Before writing your content, make an outline that asks these questions. List your persona, these three questions, and how your content will address each point to help demonstrate your company’s solution. Personalizing your message There’s so much you can do differently in your content to make it personal. The ultimate goal is to communicate on an individual level with all the contacts who can influence the purchase decision. While this may seem impossible to do on a massive scale, your content depends on personas, so you can address the motivations of the contacts in your target accounts. Developing a brand identity The content you create will reinforce an identity for your company. You want your content to demonstrate thought leadership and answer any questions your prospects may have, as this reinforces your position as an expert. This also helps create a brand identity. But building a brand identity is a process. You can’t become a thought leader overnight, but you need your prospects and other influencers to recognize your brand. 284 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation TEN CONTENT PERSONALIZATION STATISTICS FROM TRIBLIO • Marketers see an average increase of 20 percent in sales when using personalized web experiences (Monetate). • Personalized CTAs resulted in a 42 percent higher conversion rate than generic CTAs (HubSpot). • 76 percent of marketers define real-time marketing as personalizing content in response to customer interactions (Direct Marketing News). • 84 percent of marketing executives plan on developing a process to map content assets to buyer journey stage (Aberdeen). • 78 percent of CMOs think custom content is the future of marketing (Demand Metric). • 81 percent of marketers perceive increases in customer engagement as the main benefit of real-time marketing (DemandGen Report). • 60 percent say that they struggle to personalize content in real-time, yet 77 percent believe real-time personalization is crucial (Neolane and DMA). • 82 percent of prospects say content targeted to their industry is more valuable (MarketingSherpa). • 73 percent of B2B content marketers are producing more content than they did one year ago (Content Marketing Institute). • 46 percent of marketers cited lack of time as the biggest hurdle to content marketing personalization (The Realtime Report). When you think about a brand, the first things that come to mind are probably design elements: the brand’s name, logo, color, and text. While these design elements are essential, when it comes to developing a brand identity with your content, you must think about the words you select. Your brand identity is developed through the content you publish, the events you attend, the advertising campaigns you run that link to content, and every interaction you have with your accounts. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 285 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Are you ready to start personalizing your customer’s experience along their buyer ­journey? The web influences every marketing program. For the first time, marketers can target accounts with web campaigns as easily as they can with email campaigns. Jason Jue (@jasondjue), CMO at Triblio (www.triblio.com) compiled these content personalization tips. Triblio’s platform empowers marketers to dynamically personalize messaging and CTAs to specific accounts and personas. With Triblio web campaigns, each visitor can view customized websites, overlay cards, microsites, or content hubs that match their interests. Here are statistics to make the case for content personalization: Your brand is what other people say about your company. Any negative interaction or detracting comment from a prospect can damage your brand. There needs to be a plan for your brand’s identity. Consider the key adjectives, phrases, and descriptions your prospects would use to describe your company. Ask your customers questions about how they perceive your brand in surveys. This will provide insight into the type of content and activities to build and develop your brand. (See Book 1, Chapter 3 for more about branding.) Reaching Through Technology Technology, such as marketing automation platforms and CRM systems, has allowed more precise BtoB marketing to be possible. The majority of your content is distributed using digital channels. As you’re thinking about the type of content you’ll develop for your BtoB campaigns, consider how the content will be delivered to the contacts in your target accounts. The pieces of content you’re producing, such as webinars and whitepapers, will be hosted in a central hub (your marketing automation platform) for all the gated content requiring a form to download. Host your original content files on your marketing automation platform. It’s synced with your CRM. It’s your marketing automation platform that monitors who from your CRM is engaging with the content. Employing a content strategy According to the Content Marketing Institute, less than 44 percent of B2B marketers meet daily or weekly (in person or virtually) to discuss the progress of their content marketing program. To succeed with targeted marketing, you need a strategy for distributing your content. Having a strategy will help you effectively use technology to ensure that your content is reaching the right contacts in your account. Think about your strategy with this formula: Strategy = Content + Context + Channel »» Content: The marketing piece you’re sending. It’s a blog post, whitepaper, case study, handwritten note, infographic, video, or whatever medium that you’ve selected for your message and creative graphics. »» Context: The time and situation when you send content. The context depends on the stage of the buyer journey. Your content will change according to who you’re talking to, where they are in the purchase decision, and the context around the account. 286 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation »» Channel: All the ways you can distribute content and connect with your accounts. The channels include digital methods (such as email, social media, downloading content from forms, and advertisements) and more traditional channels (such as direct mail and phone calls). You will use a strategy to surround an account with your content, at different times, and across various channels. Surrounding all the right contacts in an account with your message creates a halo effect. To engage all the influencers in the purchase decision, you run different campaigns across multiple channels. Here are a few technology platforms that help with employing your content strategy: »» Uberflip (www.uberflip.com): Uberflip’s software helps marketers create, manage, and optimize content at every stage of the buyer journey. The platform lets you aggregate all your content for specific buyer personas, topics, events, and prospects. There are features that help you automate curation and publishing to serve up the right content experience to your contacts. »» SnapApp (www.snapapp.com): SnapApp’s interactive content marketing platform helps you create, publish, manage, and measure audience experiences. SnapApp gives you the flexibility to create on-brand custom content experiences. Features can give you complete brand control and speed your time-to-market. »» Triblio (http://triblio.com): Triblio’s platform helps marketers personalize messaging and CTAs to specific accounts and personas. With Triblio web campaigns, each visitor can view customized websites, overlay cards, microsites, or content hubs that match their interests. What does equal more revenue? How can you scale and do more personalization with the same content? The call to action (CTA) must be different. Don’t serve up a demo advertisement when they’re in the negotiation stage. When you’re doing personalization, it doesn’t have to be based on one technology. Within each of these strategies, you will use different tools to help create velocity and drive awareness, interest, and engagement with the contacts in your target accounts. Throughout the process, your job is to make sure you’re distributing content to the right people in the account. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 287 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience If you’re asking for budget approval to invest in technology to develop marketing content, make sure your executive stakeholders recognize that publishing more content will not automatically generate more revenue. It helps with nurturing contacts throughout the buyer journey. Content needs to be packaged and delivered to contacts in accounts based on stage. Keep your strategy simple. You can’t control how people will find you. When you think about the status of an account, you’re thinking about the context. Many interesting things can happen when you think about context. Because you have accounts that are all in different parts of the purchase decision, there is a different context, or event(s) that impact the status, for each account. Your contacts in the account can have different context, especially when it’s a larger company. There is always a context around the account. In a perfect world, your contacts in the account would say, “We want to do business with you!” But that’s just a dream. A specific event will trigger the progression to the next stage of the buyer journey. The context is important for communicating with your business prospect. Your marketing communications, content, and activities shouldn’t just be general, or “blanket,” messaging. It should be highly personalized, based on the context. Here are types of situations to consider for the context. »» Qualification: The content you send to a new account who matches your persona for the right company size and industry. »» Big news: When one of your targeted accounts publishes a fundraising announcement or other press release with a major announcement. »» Events: In-person (such as conferences and tradeshows) or online events (such as webinars and virtual summits). Depending on the timing, there will be different contexts, such as an attender who came to the event, pre-event registered, or post-event (they registered, but they didn’t attend or you didn’t have the opportunity to meet them). »» Event sponsor: They may be sponsoring an event that’s in your ecosystem (the industry or vertical with accounts you’re targeting). You sponsor the event for the chance to get in front of your targeted contacts. »» Job change: Alert from LinkedIn that a contact in your account has been promoted. »» Article: You saw one of your accounts in an interview or profile. Setting up a Google Alert (www.google.com/alerts) can alert you of any news or media pertaining to your target account. When the company publishes a press release or is featured in a publication, it appears in your Google Alert. Whenever there’s news, the salesperson who owns the account should reach out. 288 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation Delivering content on the right channel A combination of content and activities will be needed to create velocity for accounts. By publishing content across various channels, and running multiple campaigns, you can create energy and awareness for your targeted contacts. But it’s important to know whether these are the right channels to use for connecting with your contacts. Your content is only as good as the people who read it. Find new ways to repurpose your content or to redistribute it on new channels. Cross-promoting your content You invest a ton of work in creating valuable content. One way to expand the reach of getting your content in front of the right people is to have a cross-promotion strategy. Think about it this way: If you’re hosting a fancy party, you’ll invite a group of people with a formal invitation, but then you will follow up with them individually. When you see Bob at work, you’ll ask him whether he’s coming to your party, and he’ll reply with “Oh, right, I need to RSVP.” A cross-promotion strategy works the same way. When you’re trying to engage a new contact in an account, and you invited them to attend an event and they didn’t respond, you follow up with an email. Or, when you just published a blog post, you can’t just hope people will read it. Hope isn’t a strategy. Your content can reach a wider audience by cross promoting across multiple channels. Here are ways you can cross promote your content. new whitepaper or blog. When you’ve just published new content, you should post a link to this content on social media channels, such as Facebook, Twitter, and LinkedIn, for your followers to see and read. Also, the “feeds” from Twitter can be integrated into your company’s blog through plugins for WordPress. »» Blog posts: When you publish a new case study, whitepaper, or ebook, write a blog post with an excerpt of this content. Include a CTA on your blog post to download the longer piece of content. »» Ask customers to share: When you’ve interviewed a customer for a case study or video testimonial, and you’ve just published it to your website, send the link to the customer you interviewed. Ask him or her to share it on social media, or internally with their company. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 289 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience »» Social media: You can use social media to share your latest content, such as a »» Ask thought leaders to share: When you interview a thought leader or industry analyst for your latest whitepaper, ebook, or blog post, send them a link to the content and ask them to share it on social media. If they have a blog, ask whether you can publish an excerpt on their blog as well and cross promote that link. »» Webinar replays: After a webinar, turn the recording into a video, and publish the webinar’s slides on a landing page to download, or on a publicfacing site, such as SlideShare (www.slideshare.net). Send an email to your webinar registrants and attendees to download the slides and replay the recording. Also, post links to these assets on social media. »» Infographic: Copy the images from your infographics into Microsoft PowerPoint to create a slide deck. These slides can be used for a webinar, a presentation for a sales account executive, or uploaded to SlideShare for people to download. You can also link to the original infographic. so your contacts can see it in different versions. »» Monthly newsletter: Every month, send an email newsletter, featuring multiple pieces of content. Include a recent blog post, your newest piece of long-form content, or a link to replay a webinar. This is a great way to aggregate all of your latest content and email it to contacts in your targeted accounts. Measuring your content’s effectiveness The formula for a successful content strategy is Context + Content + Channel. To determine whether your content is effective, you must measure the results. You must measure the success of your content and activities across the different stages of the buyer journey. Based on the content, here are questions to ask to determine whether your content was effective: »» Did the whitepaper, ebook, or case study you sent to a prospect advance the account to the next stage (getting the account on a demo or creating an opportunity)? »» If you sent a direct mail campaign, did they receive your mailing and acknowledge it (replying to your follow up call or email)? »» If you launched an advertising campaign, did you reach contacts in your targeted accounts? If so, how many impressions did you get? How many clicks did you receive from your contacts? For more information about measuring your content’s effectiveness, see Book 9. 290 BOOK 3 Dipping into Content Creation DID YOU END UP ON A BLACKLIST? Every quarter, check your mail server IP address to determine whether you’re on any blacklists. You can check with a tool like MX Lookup (http://mxtoolbox.com/ blacklists.aspx) or EmailOnAcid (www.emailonacid.com/spam-testing). You can prevent being on a blacklist by setting up a sender policy framework (SPF) and domain-keys identified mail (DKIM). Your SPF and DKIM may be fine, but if a company thinks your emails are unsolicited, phishy, or spammy, they may report you as spam to a company-wide or public email service provider. Ask your IT network administrator to make this change in your DNS record. Also, email opt-in and smart cadences in your marketing automation system are tools to help prevent you from getting blacklisted. Who you’re talking to matters. The whole point of cross-promoting your content is to reach your targeted audience. Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience Think about how your core content can be delivered in different ways for ­consumption. You’ll discover which platforms are most effective for distributing content, based on the number of downloads (tracked in your CRM) and the number of clicks. CHAPTER 6 Targeting Content for Your B2B Audience 291 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Figuring Out Millennials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Discovering Why Millennials Matter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Leveraging Millennial Influence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 Meeting Millennials Where They Are . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 CHAPTER 2: Looking at the Influence of Millennials . . . . . . . . . . 307 Understanding the Marketer’s Perception of Millennials . . . . . . . . 307 The Millennial Mindset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 CHAPTER 3: Pursuing a Data Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 Recognizing the Value of Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 Pinpointing Key Indicators in Your Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 Using Your Data as the Foundation of Your Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Identifying Data Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Analyzing Your Data on a Regular Basis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 CHAPTER 4: Finding Millennials on Traditional Media . . . . . . . . 337 Taking Advantage of Television (With or Without the Budget). . . . 338 Targeting Millennials with Print Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Incorporating Email into Your Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 CHAPTER 5: Experimenting with the Share Economy. . . . . . . . . 349 Positioning Your Brand Around Sharing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Establishing a Voice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 Running a Niche Campaign for the Share Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 Encouraging Audience Participation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 Measuring Results. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 CHAPTER 6: Developing the Brand Experience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Creating a Brand Experience Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Identifying Touchpoints for Your Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 Checking Off Elements for Each Touchpoint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366 Developing a Customer Relationship. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 Segmenting Your Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 Integrating the Experience for an Omni-Channel Strategy. . . . . . . 373 Tracking the Brand Experience Across Different Media . . . . . . . . . 375 Running Brand Experience Campaigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding the Millennial market »» Grasping the importance of relationships »» Reaching Millennials where they are Chapter 1 Figuring Out Millennials F amiliarizing oneself with the intricacies of Millennials is one of the most crucial steps a marketer can take. Today, personalization is the name of the game. The tailored experience that you want to create starts with getting to know the Millennial mind: how they operate and why they matter so much to your business. In this chapter, you discover the short and long-term value Millennials bring to your organization. You see how they interact with brands across various media. You also find out ways you can connect with them. Millennials are consumers, just like the generations that have come before them. However, circumstances, technology, and a changing global landscape have created a unique Millennial mindset. Discovering Why Millennials Matter Millennials are valuable because they now make up a major part of the global economy. Therefore, marketers need to focus on this group to develop effective, successful strategies that reach, engage, and convert Millennial consumers. For your purposes, the term Millennial refers to consumers born between 1980 to 2000. The term Millennial can extend far beyond those age barriers, though, as discussed in more detail in Book 4, Chapter 2. CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 295 When creating a marketing plan, it can be quite effective to not define Millennials strictly by age. However, you’ll want to make this distinction when analyzing the physical size of the market. There is power in numbers In 2015, Millennials edged out Baby Boomers as the largest demographic in the United States. Immediately, without any additional information about the demographic, they become important to your business. Volume alone makes them a highly coveted group. They’re all independent consumers, and the vast majority have a steady income. Very few brands wouldn’t be interested in marketing to the largest group of consumers in the country. The Millennial cohort provides plenty of opportunities for marketers. Millennials currently have tremendous buying power and over time will become wealthier. Here are several reasons why the size of the market is a particularly important consideration: »» Economic influence: As older generations shrink, Millennials have a growing share of the consumer base. This results in the transfer of wealth. If you don’t develop products that appeal to them today, then you risk your business becoming obsolete. »» Trend setting: Some trends are set intentionally, such as popular challenges that pop up on social media. One example is the Ice Bucket Challenge of 2014, which asked individuals to pour a bucket of ice over their heads to raise awareness for Amyotrophic Lateral Sclerosis (ALS). Other trends occur because of the sheer size of this demographic. Thanks to the availability of web data on Millennials, marketers can spot naturally occurring trends. (For more information on the analysis and implementation of data, see Book 4, Chapter 3.) »» Fast sharing: The volume of data available and the rate at which it’s shared creates a changing landscape for marketers. You can currently find more online data about Millennials than any poll, questionnaire, survey, or census could collect. Therefore, marketers need to be ready to adapt to the information revealed by thousands of data points. »» Brand advocacy: The Millennial market has the power to make or break a brand overnight. The power of the people has never been stronger than it is now. Brands need to be transparent and respond to the demands of activist Millennial consumers. You can’t ignore Millennials who work together to aid or defeat a brand. One such example took place in 2016 during the original 296 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Millennials influence the economy Millennials have a tremendous influence over the national and global economy. According to estimates from Standard & Poor’s, Millennials could account for 30 percent of retail sales, which is about $1.4 trillion per year (https://www. forbes.com/sites/laurashin/2015/04/30/how-the-millennial-generationcould-affect-the-economy-over-the-next-five-years/#17e2485932e1). Millennials are poised to receive the greatest transfer of wealth in economic ­history. Estimates from major American financial institutions, like Morgan ­Stanley, and research firms suggest that over the next several decades, ­Millennials will receive somewhere near $30 trillion from the generations that preceded them. That is a startling figure, and one that undoubtedly whets the appetite of marketers in any field. To determine where that money is likely going to go, marketers should become aware of the spending habits of Millennials. This knowledge will help them build effectively targeted campaigns. Goldman Sachs has provided key information about Millennials’ traits that you can see at (https://www.goldmansachs.com/insights/archive/millennials/ index.html) Some of the factors that affect their behavior are as follows: »» Money is coming in, but it isn’t necessarily going out. Mean income for young Millennials has gone down over the last decade. Millennials are working, but the cost of living has significantly increased. Income indicators such as average national minimum wage have gone down. So, while Millennials are currently a significant portion of the national population, their disposable income isn’t significant. This may have a big impact on buying behaviors, even after the transfer of wealth. »» Millennials carry a huge amount of debt. The cost of education is a big one for Millennials and has a major impact on what they’re willing to spend. In the last decade, according to the Federal Reserve, mean student loan balance has more than doubled for young Millennials. This counts as a form of long-term debt. (That is, debt that is not set to be repaid over the next five years.) This CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 297 Figuring Out Millennials Pokémon Go craze, where a small ice cream shop in Washington state was set to close its doors for good. Millennial players stumbled upon the shop, thanks to the game, and then began campaigning online to save the business. These efforts drove enough foot traffic to triple sales and keep the business alive. has a significant impact on Millennials’ decision-making processes. Because of this debt, buying decisions are methodical and based largely on utility. A significant part of that utility is rooted in the extraneous benefits of a purchase. For example, on top of the usefulness of a product or service, is there more to be gained from the brand or ownership in the long- term? This is one of the reasons why creating relationships with Millennials and establishing yourself as a trusted brand are so important to both acquiring new customers from this market and keeping them committed over the course of their consumption lifetime. »» Ownership is not a priority. Major, long-term financial commitments are not as important to Millennials as they were to previous generations. In a world where the share economy and on-demand services have exploded, ownership is less important than access. The share economy (see Book 4, Chapter 5) plays a major role in the Millennial consumer cycle. The share economy, is the market for shared goods and services, giving participants in the economy access over ownership. Millennials have gone through the stages of consumer maturation during a recession era, which has led to significant financial conservatism. Companies or products that fall into the share economy, such as Uber or Airbnb, allow Millennials to access the goods and services they need, when they need them, without requiring them to pay the price of ownership. »» Millennials are willing to play the waiting game. Just because ownership is not as important to Millennials doesn’t mean that it isn’t part of their futures. Millennials are more patient and willing to wait for the right time to buy. This, once again, is because of the accessibility granted by both the sharing economy and on-demand services. Almost everything is accessible at the touch of a virtual button, so the necessity to own isn’t quite what it used to be. »» Brand loyalty goes deep. Previously, when making a sale, recognition and a strong brand were all that mattered. Now, it’s the relationship between the Millennial and the brand. Also, referrals matter more than ever. Millennials care what their friends and family say. Customers trust referrals more than traditional advertising. »» Quality matters more than price. Millennials are a particularly price- sensitive bunch primarily because they became consumers during the Great Recession of 2008. Price sensitivity combined with a heavy education debt load means that they’re cautious spenders. When they do decide to make a purchase, the focus is much less on price than it is on quality. Millennials want a product that lasts as well as a long-term relationship with the brand in question. 298 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Millennials are the most connected generation ever, and they use that connectedness as a tool in the buying process. If you don’t find a way to leverage that characteristic in your communications, your chances of long-run survival are slim. You need to be aware of certain characteristics to take advantage of Millennials’ communications habits: »» Millennials are over-sharers. Millennials share everything they do, want, or think, which is great for marketers. It provides a wealth of data and information that you can use to construct highly targeted, personalized marketing messages and campaigns. »» You learn more by studying Millennials than you do from asking them. Thanks to the over-sharing nature of Millennial consumers, you can find answers to any questions you have or didn’t know you had by analyzing your data. (For information on effectively analyzing your data, see Book 4, Chapter 3.) »» They trust each other more than they trust you. Every year, worldwide public relations and consulting firm Edelman releases the Trust Barometer, indicating consumer trust levels in different groups. For the past several years (after the Great Recession), the highest level of trust is placed in peers, friends and family, and industry experts. That means that brand is not on top of the list of resources consumers look to when they need a trustworthy answer. This statement is particularly true of Millennials. They want to hear unbiased, honest opinions from people in their inner circles, likely on social media. »» The buying cycle isn’t linear. The buying cycle has an endless number of touchpoints. You have control over some of them while the audience creates others. The key is to note where your prospects connect with your brand so that you can plan to be there. Touchpoints refer to the various interactions that a consumer has with a brand throughout the buying cycle. Touchpoints can vary by medium, creative design, and content type, such as images or video. In traditional media, such as television or print, far fewer touchpoints are in the buyer journey. When you consider new media, like social networks, mobile, and other digital platforms, the number of touchpoints can skyrocket over the course of the buyer journey. For more information about the buyer journey and touchpoints, see Book 2, Chapter 3. »» Mobile matters most. Mobile is where Millennials spend the majority of their time. They connect with each other and connect with brands. If you don’t have a mobile strategy, you’ll lose out on the tremendous potential it provides and likely face extinction in the near future. The generation that dictates how markets operate is telling you to think mobile first, and you need to listen. CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 299 Figuring Out Millennials They’re a connected generation Leveraging Millennial Influence Influencers play an important role in every demographic. The connectedness of the Millennial market may require you to create more complex, interwoven communications strategies than you’re used to. It also means that you have a new marketing tool at your disposal — the consumers themselves. Taking advantage of influencers and using your brand advocates is a powerful strategy. The 2016 Edelman Trust Barometer reveals that Millennials trust “a person like yourself” and industry or academic experts over virtually any organizational operator, such as the CEO of a company. This kind of influence is crucial in making buying decisions, and it’s something that marketers need to be both aware of and ready to use. Influencers are consumers who have amassed large, loyal followings on various social platforms. High star power actors are one form of influencer, but for ­Millennials, those that hold the most power are consumers who have built organic followings by sharing great content. An example of a modern Millennial influencer would be a consumer who has built a YouTube following by sharing reviews of a particular line of products. The influencer gains trust above the brand because of the implicit honesty and integrity of these reviews. Identifying key influencers Consumers aren’t as interested in traditional advertising messages as they once were. Of course, paid campaigns still serve a major role in the consumer buying cycle, but identifying influencers within your existing audience is more important. The following sections offer a few helpful tactics for finding influencers for your Millennial audience. Creating a loyalty program Loyalty can’t be bought, but it can be encouraged. Establishing a loyalty program is an excellent way to »» Encourage repeat business »» Increase customer lifetime value (CLV) »» Build a relationship with your Millennial audience Because relationships are crucial to the survival of your brand, a loyalty program will help build those relationships. Hopefully, those relationships will lead to the 300 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Customer lifetime value is defined as the net profit generated by your brand based on the entire relationship of transactions with a customer. Implementing an employee advocacy program Employees are consumers, too, and marketers often forget about the power of activating their Millennial employees. They relay positive experiences with your products and share them with their social circles. This word-of-mouth marketing helps you take advantage of the massive social reach existing right within your organization. Encouraging and perhaps incentivizing employees to share content is a powerful way to build your presence, foster brand awareness, and prompt adoption from a new user base. Communicating with your detractors It’s all too easy to brush off criticism and focus on new customer acquisition. But communicating with detractors shows that you care. Often, when customers complain, their goal is to be heard rather than to remedy a bad situation. Attempting to improve these transactions goes a long way toward creating new brand advocates and defenders. In addition, addressing an issue quickly and effectively can prevent it from spiraling out of control and becoming a costly mistake. It also gives you the opportunity to develop a better relationship with that customer. Nurturing relationships Millennials see relationships as a significant part of the buying process. The irony of this is that this demographic is more price sensitive than its predecessors, yet Millennial consumers are willing to pay a slightly higher price if they have a relationship with the higher-priced brand. This mindset isn’t one that marketers are familiar with. However, marketing to Millennials doesn’t require a completely new paradigm. It simply requires marketers to dig much deeper into the mind of the Millennial consumer. Brand familiarity isn’t the driving force behind a Millennial consumer’s decision to purchase; quality matters considerably more than the brand name or logo. Reaching Millennials requires careful planning. CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 301 Figuring Out Millennials cultivation of brand advocates. Those advocates can then help build your brand by introducing it to new circles of consumers. Here are several ways to nurture a relationship with a Millennial consumer: »» Personalization: The key to successful relationships with Millennials is personalization. (For more on relationship building, see Book 4, Chapter 2.) The modern product and service market seems to endlessly expand, which means that there’s virtually no product on the market for which there isn’t an alternative. Therefore, after you have the attention of your wider audience, tailoring your content to the tastes and preferences of the individual will help build loyalty. »» Brand experience: What kind of brand do you want to be? Are you authorita- tive or neighborly? Is your content factual or conversational? Building a brand persona is an important step in the process because it helps you shape the consumer’s experience with your brand. That experience is a driving force behind establishing a relationship and works toward building loyalty with your target Millennial audience. »» Cause alignment: Millennial consumers connect deeply with brands that associate themselves with causes. Just because Millennials possess this consumer trait doesn’t mean that you should exploit causes for the purpose of building relationships with Millennials. However, if your brand does support a cause, it’s certainly a means of connecting more deeply with certain segments of your Millennial audience. »» Responsiveness: Traditionally, a curtain has been in front of the big, powerful brand. Now that curtain has been lifted, thanks in large part to social media. Communication with a brand is easier than ever before. A certain sense of satisfaction comes from receiving a response from a brand. Therefore, responding to your audience members when they reach out can go a very long way toward nurturing budding relationships. Meeting Millennials Where They Are Billions of interactions and engagements take place online every single day. Joining a conversation in progress is always going to be much easier than trying to create your own. Millennials are engaged on various platforms with content, brands, and each other. Your responsibility as a marketer is to find new and creative ways to become a part of those exchanges. To reach these individuals, you need to understand 302 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Figuring Out Millennials »» How they communicate »» How they share content »» How they decide to make purchases Communication It may seem like the only way for brands to reach Millennial consumers is via social media. But the reality is that Millennials use a broad number of communication platforms, including traditional media. Familiarizing yourself with these media is going to play a crucial role in communicating with your audience. (Book 4, Chapter 4 covers the use of traditional media.) Traditional means of advertising, such as television and print, were once restricted to brands willing to spend the big bucks. Now new methods that meld the digital world with the offline world allow virtually any brand to connect with Millennial consumers. Organic initiatives and strategies are those that don’t rely on paid advertising to reach a specific audience segment. Organic engagement is powerful and a key component to the success of a marketing program. However, building these kinds of audiences takes significantly longer. A well-thought-out mix of the two — ­traditional and organic — will be useful in helping you build your brand on both traditional and new media. While Millennials aren’t a monolithic group, many Millennials have certain traits in common: »» They use various media to communicate. Millennials don’t confine themselves to one particular medium. The average Millennial is active on multiple social accounts, messaging platforms, and devices. You don’t necessarily need to plan to be active or even discoverable on every one of these media. That would be too costly. But you should get to know your audience and familiarize yourself with their preferred means of communicating. Then you can identify those media that stand to generate the greatest return for your brand. »» Mobile is the primary communications tool. Whatever Millennials do, they prefer to do it on mobile. The explosive growth of mobile is unprecedented. Marketers have had to make a dramatic shift in the way they do business. Millennials are on the go and wherever they go, their mobile devices go with them. Essentially, ignoring mobile means ignoring your audience, and that is a recipe for disaster. CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 303 »» Personalities differ from one platform to another. The average Millennial may be active on four or five kinds of digital media. If they’re active on several media, it doesn’t mean that your brand will necessarily find success marketing to them in the same way on each platform. Millennials use different media in unique ways. To communicate effectively, analyze your audience on each platform. Sharing Sharing means a lot more than it used to, thanks in large part to media like ­Facebook and Twitter, and companies like Airbnb. You can look at the concept of sharing from two perspectives. First is the content and information approach. Millennials share more with each other and with brands than any generation that came before them. Unlike Baby Boomers, Millennials have indicated that they’re willing to share personal ­information with brands. This willingness to share has led to the explosion of data-gathering methods, such as social sign-in. Social sign-in allows users to sign in with a single click via Google or Facebook. Thanks to social sign-in, your brand can collect a significant amount of data without having to directly question your audience. The desire for simplicity and convenience on the part of the Millennial consumers means that they’ll likely use this option. It’s less cumbersome than creating standalone profiles for each platform and limiting the information they share with brands. Data is crucial to the creation and improvement of your Millennial marketing strategy. The willingness of Millennials to share via social sign-in means that those processes are made significantly easier. Privacy concerns cause some consumers to prefer not to use a social sign-in. ­Consider offering other forms of sign-in beyond social media accounts. The second concept of sharing relates to the rise of the sharing economy (covered in detail in Book 4, Chapter 5). Millennial consumers agree that access to goods and services is more important than ownership. Brands like Airbnb (https:// airbnb.com) and Uber (https://uber.com) recognized this fact and built ­multibillion-dollar businesses to capitalize on it. The priorities and measurements of success have changed for Millennials. The sharing economy has ­facilitated this transformation. 304 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Impulsivity and ownership are no longer the names of the game when it comes to making purchasing decisions. Millennials have access to a wealth of information that can help them make informed, educated, and trusted decisions, and they don’t hurry the process. The Edelman Trust Barometer showed that industry and academic experts and peers rank above brands as trusted advisors. Review sites like Yelp, shown in ­Figure 1-1, make peer reviews readily available for virtually any type of product or service. Millennials use these kinds of sites when making a buying decision. FIGURE 1-1: Yelp allows consumers to provide reviews. As the availability of trustworthy, verifiable information, such as reviews, has increased, their impact has been noticeable across all markets. A study by Forbes found that only about 1 percent of Millennial consumers would trust a brand more as a result of traditional advertising. Roughly, a third of Millennials review blogs and review sites before making a purchase. Authenticity is what matters most to these prospects, and that outweighs even the quality of content. This trend has leveled the playing field for smaller brands. Of course, big budgets open doors and opportunities not available to smaller companies, but now they have the opportunity to compete for the same business as larger organizations. CHAPTER 1 Figuring Out Millennials 305 Figuring Out Millennials Decision-making IN THIS CHAPTER »» Defining the Millennial consumer »» Recognizing common errors marketers make with Millennials »» Understanding the Millennial mindset and its implications Chapter 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials B uilding an effective strategy for Millennial consumers begins with a clear understanding of their unique characteristics. Some marketers miss the basics. Millennials, like any generation, are defined as a group of consumers that fall into a certain age bracket. But, in some cases marketing to Millennials requires you to look beyond age. For this reason, you need to develop a deep understanding of this market so that you don’t misunderstand its complex nature. In this chapter, you start thinking about Millennials as prototypes for the next generation of consumers. They’re not simply soon-to-be-wealthy 20-somethings that are difficult to reach. They represent a seismic shift in the world of marketing. Understanding the Marketer’s Perception of Millennials If you ask the average marketer to define the term Millennial, he or she would almost certainly start by stating that Millennials are consumers born between the years 1980 and 2000. While, demographically this is a fact, the reality is that the term Millennial embodies so much more. That said, marketers still hold certain prevailing notions when it comes to defining this important group. CHAPTER 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials 307 Examining standard definitions that marketers use The date ranges vary from one demographer to the next, but for the sake of simplicity, the generally accepted starting point for the Millennial generation is 1980. While the latter point of the date range varies considerably, it’s safe to say that an accepted cutoff point would be 2000. Some demographers are interested in only designating those who reach the end of high school age by 2000 as Millennials. Others define the generation as reaching consumer maturity in the mid-2010s. Whichever range you choose to use, Millennials are the largest, most influential group of consumers in the world (see Book 4, Chapter 1). To gain some insight about Millennials, the Pew Research Center asked Millennials to describe themselves, as shown in Figure 2-1. It shows that Millennials have a very particular perception of themselves that sometimes conflicts with other people’s perceptions. Forty-nine percent of respondents indicate that they feel Millennials are wasteful, while 40 percent believe that Millennials are environmentally conscious. You may also find it a little hard to imagine someone being both cynical and idealistic, yet 39 percent of the Millennials who answered this survey felt that the general demographic is idealistic, while 31 percent believe that the generation is cynical. Clearly, you need to understand your particular niche audience so that you target the right characteristics. Millennials do have a few personality traits on which the majority of marketers agree. The following sections outline the assumptions that marketers most often make when it comes to Millennial consumers. Some of these are correct, and some are misguided, as discussed later in the chapter. A better understanding of them will help you develop content and advertising strategies that appeal to the true nature of Millennials. Tech savvy Millennials have been born into the digital age. They have grown up not knowing a world without extensive connectivity. Smartphones are standard equipment, and nearly the entire Millennial population of the United States has access to the web. Millennials have been instrumental in the expansion of such services as social networking and helped simplify web and application development tools. If marketers can assign one characteristic to Millennials and be right, it’s that Millennials are the most technologically advanced demographic in the world. 308 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Looking at the Influence of Millennials FIGURE 2-1: Terms Millennials use to describe themselves. http://www.pewresearch.org/fact-tank/2015/03/19/howmillennials-compare-with-their-grandparents/ft_ millennials-education_031715. Mobile In addition to being the most populous generation in the United States, Millennials are also the most mobile. The number of connected mobile devices associated with Millennials almost exactly matches the size of the generation. The way Millennials use mobile devices and their dependence on them tells a much more important story. Millennials don’t separate from their mobile devices. In fact, most Millennials admit to never allowing their smartphone to leave their side. Self-absorbed You may or may not have heard of Millennials referred to as the Selfie Generation. High definition, front-facing mobile phone cameras and mobile applications such as Snapchat (https://www.snapchat.com) have normalized the self-portraits known as selfies. Marketers associate this behavior with self-absorption. Time author Joel Stein called Millennials the ‘The Me Me Me Generation.” But he clarified to say that while Millennials may be self-assured, determined, and, in some cases, even selfish, there is much more to them than that. CHAPTER 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials 309 Lazy Marketers have watched the rise of the on-demand economy and assumed that its success has come from the inherent laziness of the Millennial generation. The rationalization for that assumption is that Millennials would rather use a mobile application to order what they need than go out and run errands. Antisocial Millennials love using social media and sharing their thoughts with the world from behind a screen. Traditional marketers see Millennials walking down the street with their heads buried in a phone and assume that they’re antisocial. Educated Marketers know better than to try to dupe Millennials with dated, cunning advertising tactics. That is because they recognize that Millennials are smarter than that. Entitled Millennials are viewed as a group that demands a lot from previous generations without offering much in return. This perception is rooted largely in their experience that there is a vast online availability of content, resources, information, and necessities. Since the launch of social networking sites and share-based resources (see Book 4, Chapter 5), marketers assume that Millennials feel they deserve a lot because they have gotten so much free. Informed When it comes to making buying decisions, Millennials have access to a plethora of information that previous generations didn’t have. The buying process used to rely largely on the word of the brand via traditional advertising channels. Now Millennials talk to one another and receive honest reviews about a product, service, or brand before making a purchasing decision. Trust in brands, executives, and even government has significantly decreased in recent years, which has coincided with a rise in the trust consumers put in experts and peers. This increased reliance on others means that marketers need to recognize the importance of relationships and the brand experience. Lacking in loyalty At one time, the name of a brand would guarantee a certain amount of loyalty. Now, marketers see Millennials chasing something that can be difficult to pinpoint. Whatever it is, marketers assume that brand loyalty has gone out the window. They believe that Millennials prioritize budgets over brands. 310 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Price sensitive Marketers believe that the lack of loyalty Millennials display is due to price sensitivity. There is irony in the fact that Millennials seem to insist on getting what they want, when they want it, but are apparently willing to wait to make any purchase until a price is found that meets a certain criteria. With hacks, data breaches, and the fear of Big Brother monitoring their every move, Millennials want to keep their information private. Even with their high degree of oversharing on social media, marketers assume that Millennials don’t want to share with brands for fear of exploitation. Reviewing what marketers get right Some of the assumptions marketers make about Millennials are accurate, with the data and research to back them up: »» Educated and informed consumers: The majority of Millennial consumers review blogs and review sites before making a purchase. According to a report by Medalia Institute (http://go.medallia.com/rs/669-VLQ-276/images/ Medallia-Millennials-Your-Most-Powerful-Brand.pdf), Millennials say that user-generated content has an influence on what they buy. The brand experience is extremely important to Millennials. They believe that they can find good information in the unbiased accounts of other consumers. Tailoring the experience to the Millennial audience segment is crucial. This connected consumer base has more power than even the most rich and powerful brands. »» Price sensitive, but will spend: Millennials became consumers during the greatest economic downfall that the United States experienced in nearly a century. Combine that with a high amount of student debt, and you have a generation of consumers that thinks before it buys. The important thing to note is that Millennials will buy. Quality matters more than price, so if they find value in a product or service, they will spend more. Also, don’t be fooled by their cautious approach to spending; Millennials are impulsive. This impulsiveness may be attributable to the fast-paced nature of buying online. »» Highly tech-savvy and living mobile-first: Millennials live online and, more importantly, on their mobile devices. They’re constantly connecting and communicating. Any brand that doesn’t take this particular trait into account and recognize that mobile is the new norm won’t survive in an increasingly competitive marketplace. CHAPTER 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials 311 Looking at the Influence of Millennials Private Looking at what marketers get wrong When you make assumptions about an entire demographic, you risk getting some things wrong. Here are some of the false assumptions marketers make: »» Millennials are not loyal. Millennials are, in fact, very loyal. The difference with Millennial loyalty is that it relies much more on the relationship rather than brand recognition. Identifying the traits of audience segments, developing content that caters specifically to those traits, and building lasting relationships are what drive Millennials to be loyal. »» Millennials protect their privacy. In reality, millennials are willing to share more than any other generation. It may appear that they’re very private, but less than half of Millennials set strict online privacy settings. »» The group is lazy and entitled. Millennials are quite the opposite of lazy. In fact, many Millennials work more than one job to pay bills and debts. What marketers miss is that on-demand services provide access and convenience, not laziness or self-entitlement. Millennials don’t want to interrupt their work to run errands; they can have things like food delivered to them. This change signals a shift in consumer norms rather than providing evidence of a negative trait. »» Millennials are antisocial and self-absorbed. Self-absorption is actually a byproduct of shifting communications practices. Millennials receive a constant stream of personalized messages. Marketers know that personalized messages are more likely to catch a Millennial’s attention, so they become the norm. Therefore, Millennials aren’t so much self-absorbed as they’re used to responding to messages that specifically cater to their needs. Recognizing common flaws in marketing campaigns When you apply certain false assumptions to the strategy behind a campaign, the results can be underwhelming. To avoid getting disappointing results, don’t make these common marketing mistakes: »» Provide generalized, umbrella content with no specific target audience. You need to analyze your audience segments and develop tailored, personalized content to deliver to specific targeted groups. Sending generic content without the customization that Millennials look for leads to failed campaigns. »» Target Millennials by age and age alone. Millennials are more than an age range; they’re the new generation of consumers. When you think about 312 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Millennials as a mindset as opposed to a group of consumers restricted by an age range, you expand your potential audience and position yourself for long-term success. »» Duplicate content across all media. All consumers vary their use of media, so you can’t apply the same strategy to each of them and hope to be successful. You need to understand your audience on each of the platforms you frequent. Then you can develop effective strategies for each audience and media type. »» Make assumptions without analyzing data to back it up. Data needs to be Looking at the Influence of Millennials at the core of everything you do. So much of it is readily available to fuel your success, so make sure that you use it. (For more about the analysis and applications of data, see Book 4, Chapter 3.) Finding the roots of the most common mistakes The mistakes listed in the previous section are common for one reason: They generally come from the same four roots. These roots are »» Inattention to data: Data needs to be the driving force behind your deci- sions. If you’re developing strategies that don’t rely on data, you’ll likely be disappointed with the results. You have no reason to rely on gut instinct. Data insights are simply too accessible. »» Broad generalizations applied to your audience: With so much information about Millennials, it doesn’t make sense to run on assumptions alone. Take some time to analyze and get to know your audience so that you can develop content and campaigns that really resonate with them. »» A lack of testing: Everything you do should be tested. One of the greatest powers of new media is the ability to test, analyze, optimize, and implement all in a matter of hours. The ability to react in real time is powerful and should not be ignored. The term new media describes primarily digital, social, or mobile media. Traditional media, such as print, radio, and even television, have seen declines in consumer use, marketing value, and adoption. »» Refusing to adapt to changing audiences: The audience you’ve cultivated and analyzed for today’s campaign may not be the same audience you’ll find when you’re ready to run your next initiative. Auditing and analyzing your audience can be a tedious process, but it’s an important one if you want to maintain relationships and find long-term success. CHAPTER 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials 313 The Millennial Mindset If you think about your Millennial audience without the constraints of age, you begin to understand that in some ways the term Millennial is becoming synonymous with consumer. The traits exhibited by Millennials, the largest and most influential demographic of consumers in the United States, are traits that marketers can apply to individuals across a multitude of demographics. Understanding and adapting to a new age of consumer habits and traits will set you up for longterm success. Defining the Millennial If you look beyond the scope of age, how would you define Millennial consumers? Giving them a singular definition would be dangerous because it significantly limits the audience. You need two definitions when discussing Millennials so that you can properly analyze them: »» Age: The first definition of Millennial consumers has to do with age range. Use this definition when discussing data about the consumers. Demographers, sociologists, social anthropologists, and marketers use age to conduct studies and collect data. (Most hard data collected applies age restrictions to this group.) »» Interests and behaviors: The second definition for the Millennial consumer is much more broad. Instead of focusing on age range data, you need to turn your attention to interests and behaviors. In these audience segments, the definition of Millennial extends far beyond age restrictions. Here, you look at like-minded consumers that fit a series of behavioral criteria. You can broadly define this category of Millennials as being tech-savvy, price-sensitive consumers who place their trust in peers and experts over brands. They digest information at a rapid rate and look for tailored, personalized brand experiences. Brand familiarity is less important to these consumers than relationships. When they form these relationships, they’re fiercely loyal. Identifying preferred Millennial media When compared to a generation ago, you can have a presence on an endless array of media. Ideally, having such a vast presence also means you have a strategy and a budget. To maximize your budget, you need to find and target the specific platforms your audience uses. Here are some points to keep in mind, when you begin to identify your audience’s preferred media: 314 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience »» Start with Facebook. The majority of online Millennials say they’re active on Facebook. This means that you’re almost certain to find some of your Millennial audience on Facebook. Despite what marketers and news outlets have said, Facebook is far from being irrelevant to Millennials. In fact, Facebook and its products have become so commonplace that Millennials don’t even realize how inextricably linked to it they are. Facebook is a great place to begin the process of analyzing your audience. »» Match email lists before building strategies. Before you begin building Looking at the Influence of Millennials a strategy for a particular channel, you should either run an email match audience analysis or extract data using an ad platform. This step will help you determine whether a channel is worth investing in for the purpose of acquiring and retaining Millennial consumers. Running an email match audience analysis is the process of uploading an owned email database to match emails with users on a given network and then analyzing aggregated data to identify marketing opportunities within a network or audience. »» Identify top interests in your audience analysis. When conducting your audience analysis, you should pay close attention to topics of specific interest to Millennials. Certain content makes some media more attractive for investment than others. »» Evaluate content requirements and access. If your brand isn’t built for specific channels like Instagram (https://instagram.com) or Snapchat (https://snapchat.com), which are predominantly visual and entirely mobile, then making the investment to use them may not be worth it. Finding a way to be relevant on these kinds of media is ideal, but if you don’t fit, your investment will go to waste. It makes more sense to focus on platforms that are ideally suited for your brand and content. Grasping the importance of relationships One of the overarching themes of Millennial engagement is the value placed on relationships. The importance of relationships is something that transcends media, brand recognition, and even quality of some products or services. Millennials engage primarily in impersonal spaces, so when a real, genuine connection is felt with an organization, it lasts a long time and can lead to loyalty and even brand advocacy. One long-term goal of any organization should be to cultivate brand advocates from within their Millennial market. Brand advocates help promote your brand and expand your horizons. Advocates decrease marketing costs and open new doors for marketing and advertising. CHAPTER 2 Looking at the Influence of Millennials 315 To begin cultivating brand advocates, you need to find common ground and nurture these relationships. Over time, that common ground leads to personalized communications that ultimately lead to new customer acquisition. The retention of these new Millennial customers, however, is where the real value lies. Retaining and reactivating existing customers is far less expensive than acquiring new ones. With the help of brand advocates or pseudo-sales agents, keeping and acquiring customers becomes much less burdensome and much more affordable. 316 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience IN THIS CHAPTER »» Sourcing and mining for valuable data »» Identifying the hidden opportunities in your data »» Analyzing data on an ongoing basis for improved campaign performance Chapter 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy D ata is all around you. With the advent of social media and broadcast platforms like Facebook and Twitter, data has become more powerful than ever, especially for Millennials. The amount of data that exists about them is unprecedented. In this chapter, you develop a better understanding of the many forms in which you can extract, manipulate, and analyze data. Recognizing the Value of Data Data is everywhere, and as such, it’s extremely important. While the data may be overwhelming at times, when used correctly, it’s a valuable source of information that you can use in your marketing efforts. Keep in mind that data can often be industry and audience agnostic. By agnostic, it’s meant that raw data can apply to any or all situations and demographics and isn’t necessarily limited by a particular group or scenario. This means that the lessons, tips, and processes covered in this chapter may not be limited to Millennials. In the following sections, you can read about several different types of data that you can use in your marketing efforts. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 317 Raw data Raw data is information in its purest form. Raw data is data extracted at the source but not yet processed. While raw data can be daunting when you first come across it, it’s completely malleable, which makes it one of the most valuable data types. An example of raw data sorted in a Microsoft Excel spreadsheet is shown in Figure 3-1. FIGURE 3-1: An example of raw data in Microsoft Excel. Cooked data The industry reference to cooked data relates directly to raw data. Cooked data is what marketers get when raw data has been manipulated in some way to highlight a particular segment, finding, or aspect of the unadulterated information. Figure 3-2 shows an example of cooked data. FIGURE 3-2: Cooked data is the result of some ­manipulation of raw information. Social media user data When it comes to social media, you can leverage a treasure trove of user information to create your marketing strategy. For example, Millennials may share answers to questions on their social feed that you never thought to ask. 318 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Analyzing your social audience user data can be as simple as reviewing your Facebook Insights data, as shown in Figure 3-3. This data can lead to some ­significant breakthroughs. For more information about Facebook Insights see Book 7, Chapter 2. FIGURE 3-3: Customer lifetime engagement data When a customer engages with your brand across multiple channels, a story is being told. At every touchpoint, or chapter of the story, data is collected, and you can analyze it to improve your marketing efforts. Millennials have a preference for a single sign-in, where they have the ability to use a Facebook or Google profile to sign into all accounts, tools, websites, or online stores. With that single sign-in, information about the customer journey is collected at every step of the way, and that data is hugely valuable for improving the customer experience. Brand profile data You can usually find the jackpot of user data in the brand profile. This user data relates specifically to your organization. Every bit of information you extract directly informs how you might shift your marketing efforts, your sales tactics, or even some of your internal operations to improve efficiency. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 319 Pursuing a Data Strategy You can find free social user data using Facebook Insights. Figure 3-4 shows you an example of Amazon’s recommendations. Tracking user profiles and searches and using advanced algorithms that learn about user tastes and preferences, Amazon can make customized recommendations to its customers. Over time, this robust profile data provides a company like Amazon with the ability to build a well-rounded view of each customer at every stage of the buying process. FIGURE 3-4: Amazon r­ ecommends a series of tailored products to its customers based on their profile. Visualized data Just as with cooked data, visualized information is a representation of some sort of manipulated data in a visual framework. Plenty of tools exist to help users analyze and manipulate data to depict it in visual form. Tableau (www.tableau.com), shown in Figure 3-5, is one such tool. Big data Big data means exactly what you might think it does. It’s a large amount of data collected from a variety of sources. You can analyze this data to make predictions, identify trends, improve pricing, optimize customer buying paths, and optimize products. While you can find plenty of other areas where big data may be of use, these are some of the most popular cases. For more information on big data, see Book 2, Chapter 1. Showcasing only big data is a disservice to small and medium business marketing teams. The real value for marketers rests on how you can segment and use this data on a smaller scale. 320 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience FIGURE 3-5: Tableau helps users visualize their data. Small data »» Message targeting: Creating tailored messages for small groups of your Millennial audience leads to much higher engagement and conversion. Small data presents opportunities for improved targeting. »» Content and creative split testing and optimization: When you dive into your small data, you can identify minute details that allow you to optimize your campaign. This again can lead to some pretty dramatic improvements in your results. »» Rolling ad budget optimization: Improving the performance of your budget means making your ad dollars go further. When you analyze your small data, you can identify new information that leads you to change small details. These details include such things as maximum bids or placements of your ads, and they impact the performance of your campaign as a whole. The opportunities with small data extend even further when you consider the fact that data is always full of surprises. Keep an open mind and analyze every possible angle of your small data subsets. Doing so can lead to major improvements in your campaigns. If you have a strategy, a target audience, content, and a series of objectives, the small data you analyze may present findings that would have otherwise gone unnoticed. This can lead to a significant expansion and improvement of your strategies and the overall growth of your business both on and offline. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 321 Pursuing a Data Strategy Small data results when you conduct an in-depth analysis of smaller segments of your complete data sets. When your data is condensed into smaller groups, it becomes significantly easier to analyze and more opportunities can be discovered. Diving into your small data can help improve your efforts with such things as Competitive data You can learn quite a bit when you analyze publicly available competitive data. Your competitors are most likely trying to achieve the same objectives you are. Taking cues and learning lessons from both their successes and missteps will serve you well. What you learn from this process will help you achieve your objectives in a shorter time frame and avoid some pitfalls that were costly for your competitors. Several tools exist for the purposes of competitive data analysis and tracking. The following three are easy to use: »» Alexa (an Amazon company) (https://www.alexa.com): Figure 3-6 shows some of the data that Alexa pulls from a competitor’s website and digital presence when using the Pro version. The product provides users with insights into the online performance of sites across the web. »» BuzzSumo (https://buzzsumo.com): When it comes to tracking your competitors’ social presence, you have dozens of additional options. Figure 3-7 showcases BuzzSumo, which provides insights into the performance of content on social media and assists with the development of effective content strategies. »» TrackMaven (https://trackmaven.com): TrackMaven, shown in Figure 3-8, has some great features like content optimization capabilities, integrated social networks including paid ad optimization, and some pretty extensive insights into the performance of your marketing efforts. FIGURE 3-6: Alexa. 322 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience FIGURE 3-7: Pursuing a Data Strategy BuzzSumo. FIGURE 3-8: TrackMaven. Other good products are SimilarWeb (www.similarweb.com), Rival IQ (www.rivaliq. com), and SEM Rush (www.semrush.com). All of the preceding tools can help you »» Identify responsive audiences: Identify audiences that have been most responsive to your competitors’ content on both websites and social channels. »» Create effective content strategies: Craft content strategies that have a higher likelihood of driving engagement from your intended audience based on content that has succeeded in your competitors’ campaigns. »» Discover pain points: Pinpoint missteps and pitfalls that your competitors have suffered or are currently dealing with so that you can avoid facing the same issues. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 323 »» Uncover industry insights: You can use several tools to discover industry insights. Another, more advanced example of a product that highlights industry insights is Crimson Hexagon (www.crimsonhexagon.com), which is shown in Figure 3-9. (In 2018, Brandwatch.com merged with Crimson Hexagon. At the time of this writing, they’re continuing to operate as separate brands.) FIGURE 3-9: Crimson Hexagon is an advanced, enterprise-grade industry analysis tool. You can also achieve the following objectives with the strategic use of industry insights: »» Development of a new or expanded content strategy »» Expansion into new media and new platforms based on engagement from your target audiences »» Development of new short- and long-term objectives »» Identification of trends that indicate how an additional investment may be beneficial Transactional data Transactional data are the insights gleaned from your customer transactions. If your organization has digitized its client records or if you sell products via an e-commerce platform, then transactional data will be very useful to you. Perhaps the most notable reason why you’ll want to leverage transactional data is for the purpose of improving the buyer journey, thereby shortening the path to conversion and decreasing your internal costs that go into the customer experience and marketing timeline. 324 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Transactional data can also be extremely useful to you when allocating your marketing budget. Within a transaction, assuming that your tracking has been properly developed and implemented, you can monitor each touchpoint reached by your customer. Identifying the most valuable touchpoints across hundreds or even thousands of transactions will allow you to optimize the resources to which your budgets are allocated. Pinpointing Key Indicators in Your Data Although data comes in many different types, all data exhibits certain universal indicators. By monitoring these indicators, you can get a better sense of what your data is telling you and how to use it. The following sections describe some of the more common indicators. Outliers are data points that sit outside of the normal range that you may expect to see when looking at a particular performance indicator, such as engagement. For example, if you generally expect to see 10 clicks on a link and a specific post receives 50 clicks, then that data point would be an outlier as it falls far outside the range that you normally see with regards to clicks and engagement. Outliers are perhaps the most valuable indicator of importance within your data sets. You can see a graphical representation of this phenomenon in Figure 3-10. FIGURE 3-10: An example of an outlier in a data set. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 325 Pursuing a Data Strategy Outliers When extracting raw data, running a simple linear regression and analyzing your data for outliers, generally within a 5 to 10 percent margin of error, will give you some great insights into what is working and what is not. A linear regression is a statistical analysis whereby a curve, expressed in this case by the formula y=ax+b is calculated and placed to fit over a given data set. This straight line is the closest representation of a linear progression through the data, and the proximity of your data point to this line — or curve — indicates how well a particular point fits the average. The points that fall far outside this curve are your outliers. You can find the steps for running a linear regression using a source like Statistics Solutions (www.statisticssolutions.com). You can also use a free analytic tool like Plotly (www.plot.ly), which is shown in Figure 3-11. The data used for these kinds of analyses can range from engagement metrics to conversions to clicks. You can analyze virtually any isolated data set using this extremely powerful method. FIGURE 3-11: Plotly is a ­ owerful free p tool that makes data analysis simple. Peaks and valleys As with outliers, you’re looking for anomalies (things that are unusual) in your data when identifying peaks and valleys (highs and lows) within a given set. Run through highs and lows with specific performance indicators, such as traffic from a particular social network, and determine what commonalities exist at each high point and each low point. You can compare periods of analysis — for example, a week or a month. Take what you’ve found and integrate those findings in your everyday strategy. For example, if you see on the first of every month that an unusually high amount of traffic comes from Facebook, and upon further analysis, you see that on the first you tend to share a particularly inspiring quote 326 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience accompanied by a link to a landing page, use those findings to expand on this strategy and use it more frequently. Repeat this process for all your identified peaks and valleys, where it is applicable. Correlations When analyzing data of a particular type (whether it’s audience data or post-level data), you want to pay close attention to any correlations, either positive or negative, that exist. Your Facebook Page’s post-level data are the insights gathered and exported about your individual posts, rather than general data about your Page and audience. The value in analyzing post-level data is that it aggregates insights about the most valuable kinds of engagement, such as clicks to your website or shares on Facebook. It provides you with the necessary information to build a robust content strategy. Industry trends Using an industry monitoring technology has several benefits. One of the greatest is undoubtedly the ability to spot conversational trends within your industry before the competition does. When using an industry monitoring tool, pay close attention to upward-trending conversation topics within your audience segments. Identifying these trends can be extremely beneficial when developing your next campaign or creating new, relevant content. Here are some competitive data tools to consider: »» https://www.similarweb.com/ »» https://www.kompyte.com/ »» https://www.brandwatch.com/ CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 327 Pursuing a Data Strategy For example, if you analyze high-performing posts shared on Facebook, ask yourself whether these posts share similarities such as the time they were posted, an abundance of a certain color, or length. You can then use these indicators to develop new content that will ensure a significantly higher engagement rate. Waste When you want to optimize your budget and improve operational efficiency, waste is a powerful indicator. In this case, waste refers to ad spends put toward ads that yield little to no results. You know you have waste if you find these two primary indicators: »» A higher than average number of touchpoints in a particular sales cycle, which may indicate inefficiencies with the cycle flow. »» A significantly greater cost-per-conversion or cost-per-action, which may indicate flaws or discrepancies between the product and the Millennial audience you’ve targeted. Essentially, as with outliers, you want to take the time to analyze certain outstanding data points. Determine whether they’re indicative of some form of budgetary or time waste. Then make the necessary adjustments to optimize your processes. Using Your Data as the Foundation of Your Strategy Millennials, more so than any generation before them, have populated the web with a seemingly endless amount of data. As a result, everything you choose to do from building audiences to developing social ad campaigns will be completely rooted in data. For more information about building audiences and ad campaigns, see Book 1. Following are five steps you can take — before employing any strategy or starting any campaign — to ensure that you have data to justify every one of your decisions: 1. Review all the data sources to which you have access. The following section covers specific sources, but you’ll effectively review all your owned, earned, and paid media data sources in order to pinpoint all the data to which you have access. 2. Segment your data to focus entirely on Millennials. After you access all your data, filter anything that isn’t relevant to Millennials. Begin with age ranges and then expand to include those that possess the Millennial mindset. (See Book 4, Chapter 1 for more detail.) 328 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience 3. Establish your objectives. Of course, establishing objectives is a standard practice with every campaign you run. But in this case, you justify your objectives with actual data. 4. Refine your objectives through the use of your data. You can now analyze the information that you have filtered to elaborate or change some of the more universal objectives that you have outlined for a given campaign. 5. Set your benchmarks and key performance indicators. What is most important about this step is the fact that any one of your benchmarks and all your indicators should be measurable. That measurability will result from your ongoing data analysis. Data is agnostic. That means that for every campaign you run, you can implement these five simple steps. You support every one of your actions with numbers and justify every decision with the statistics needed to back it up. Implement this process each time you plan on launching something new, and the entire process will be simpler and more successful. Identifying Data Sources Data can come from virtually everywhere. Millennials leave small bits of information everywhere they go. To develop your Millennial marketing strategy, you use three types of data: »» Data from your owned media channels like your website »» Data from social media channels like Facebook, Twitter, and YouTube »» Data from public channels Data from your owned media Perhaps the richest center of owned data is available from the backend on your website. The vast majority of businesses track their web data using Google Analytics, shown in Figure 3-12. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 329 Pursuing a Data Strategy It’s crucial that before executing a campaign, every one of your objectives has measurement criteria. After all, how can you know whether your campaign is a success if you haven’t defined how it will be measured? For more information about creating measurable objective see, Book 1, Chapter 1. FIGURE 3-12: The Google ­Analytics ­audience dashboard. Within Google Analytics, you can segment data according to a variety of elements. One is the ability to segment by age. Creating a segmented dashboard in Google Analytics is simple and is useful when you want to isolate a specific cluster of data for deeper analysis. Simply follow these steps: 1. Create a new view to avoid filtering other data. A mistake that marketers often make is applying segments or filters to general Google Analytics data. Google doesn’t save data that it doesn’t collect, so when you filter data from your general dashboard, it’s gone forever. Instead, create a new view in your admin dashboard and title it something specific, such as Millennial Web Data. 2. Add a segment in your audience dashboard. Select the option to add a new segment in your audience dashboard, as shown in Figure 3-13. 3. Select a new segment and filter by age. You can also filter by other criteria, but for the purposes of Millennials, you need to add only an age filter, as shown in Figure 3-14. After you do this step, the data pulled into this segmented view will be only the data that fits the applied filters. Now, all the data you analyze in the backend of your website will relate specifically to the actions taken by Millennials visiting your website. 330 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience FIGURE 3-13: Pursuing a Data Strategy Create a new segment from your audience dashboard. FIGURE 3-14: Select the age range filter. You can utilize the information you collect to develop new strategies for content and marketing. For example, in the analysis of your website’s content, you can identify what posts and pages Millennials are most attracted to. Using this information, you can develop Millennial-oriented content strategies. If you’re working in an e-commerce space, you can analyze the products that are most frequently viewed or purchased by Millennials. Then you can allocate more of your marketing dollars to these high performers and eliminate some of the waste that might go to ad dollars spent on less popular products. Another area of focus in the backend of Google Analytics will be your acquisition dashboard. Here, you can identify the channels and campaigns that have driven the most Millennial engagement. This information allows you to optimize ad dollar spending and marketing budget allocation for the different networks. You don’t want to be spending money on a channel that isn’t sending viable Millennial traffic. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 331 Data from social media When it comes to publicly available, accessible data on Millennial consumers’ habits and interests, you can’t find many places with such a comprehensive amount of information as social media. Millennials share everything, and you can access that data on several media platforms, such as Facebook, Twitter, and YouTube, to leverage it: Though you can extract profile and user data from many other platforms, these three sources cover the most valuable social media platforms and provide the most insightful information about your users. Facebook The backend of your Facebook Page contains a world of information about your audience. Simply clicking the Insights tab, as shown in Figure 3-15, reveals an abundance of data about your overall audience on the Page. FIGURE 3-15: Access free Page insights on Facebook. While you may not be able to segment your audience specifically by age on ­Facebook, like you can on your website, your audience will largely fall into the category of users that fit the Millennial mindset. This means that the observed habits that you identify in the back end and the content you analyze will be largely applicable to your Facebook content strategy. 332 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Within Facebook, you can also export page and post-level data for further, more in-depth, analysis. This data is exported pseudo-raw, which means that it’s segmented but not manipulated. You can manipulate this information using a variety of tactics or tools to discover new opportunities. Twitter Twitter also offers a fairly robust backend to gather insights, shown in Figure 3-16. This dashboard is available when you create an ad account, and can be found by visiting https://analytics.twitter.com, though you don’t need to be running any ads to access this data. Pursuing a Data Strategy Using Twitter, you can gather many valuable insights about audience interests, engagement rates, and details about your content. By aggregating this Twitter insight data, your content strategies can become significantly more refined, and you can develop content that leads to action. FIGURE 3-16: Twitter provides some good insight into both content and audiences. YouTube Much like Google Analytics age and user data, YouTube links your content with profiles of the users watching your videos. This powerful approach provides you with a better understanding of your audience’s viewing habits so that you can develop even more successful video content. It also helps you create channel and content strategies that appeal to the Millennials watching your videos. Some of the details of YouTube view data include Watch time, Average view duration, and Views, as shown in Figure 3-17. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 333 FIGURE 3-17: User viewing habits data in YouTube. Data from public channels You can find plenty of publicly available databases related to Millennials across the web. To manually sift through billions of public posts and bits of information would be impossible, so you’ll want to use tools that are designed to do that. Many of these products peruse tens if not hundreds of millions of online sources including blogs, forums, social networks, and e-commerce websites. These tools are designed to scour any readily available data on the web for ­keywords, phrases, and brand names to provide you with the most accurate view of what the conversation looks like. These data are then visualized in an easy-toanalyze format, which allows you to quickly and efficiently identify opportunities so that you can statistically justify your strategies. The following list of tools have some of the highest user satisfaction reviews on the market. Each has the ability to filter your user data by age range, which will allow for the analysis of all publicly available information about Millennials across your industry. »» AgoraPulse (www.agorapulse.com): AgoraPulse offers a fairly broad range of services within its platform, from insights to management to engagement. Reporting with AgoraPulse is top quality, and it’s very affordable. (As of this writing, prices start at $49 per month.) A free trial is available. »» Brandwatch (www.brandwatch.com): Brandwatch falls on the more costly side of the spectrum of data analysis tools, but the detailed data reports make it worthwhile. You can quickly analyze your brand from all angles and measure your performance across the web compared to your competitors. 334 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience You can also drill down pretty deep into the data, which can be particularly useful when it comes to identifying new campaign opportunities. A free demo is available. »» Mention (https://mention.com): Mention is a simple yet powerful listening tool that offers some great insights into the conversations taking place within your industry and around your brand. You can analyze trends at the keyword level and use that data to exploit new opportunities. A free demo is available. A high user satisfaction rate for a tool or technology is a good starting point, but the key is to find the tool that’s right for you. Do your research and make sure that the investment in technology pays off for your company. When you’re ready, use the free trial or hands-on demo to determine whether it’s right for you. A keyword in this case is a particular term with significance related to the subject matter of your audience’s conversations. If, for example, you’re analyzing conversations in the technology sector, a keyword of interest may be “machine learning,” while another term, such as “real estate,” may not be as important, depending on what it is you’re trying to analyze. After you look at the key indicators that you need to analyze to get the most out of your data, you need to determine what steps to take to maximize the benefits from the strategic use of your data. Following is a step-by-step auditing process that you can easily implement on a regular basis using the tools and processes discussed earlier in this chapter: 1. Establish an auditing schedule. At the outset of your auditing process, you need to develop a schedule to ensure that you’re regularly keeping up-to-date with your process review. Generally, for smaller organizations, a monthly review is all you need. If, however, you’re a very data-driven organization, then you’ll want to review your data, benchmarks, and objectives either every two weeks or even weekly. 2. Pinpoint the factors that indicate an opportunity. Outliers and correlations can be indicative of opportunities within your Millennial audience. In addition, look at things like upward trending conversation topics or spikes in audience segment participation. CHAPTER 3 Pursuing a Data Strategy 335 Pursuing a Data Strategy Analyzing Your Data on a Regular Basis 3. Establish benchmarks for the newly created opportunities and review benchmarks for ongoing initiatives. You may need to establish new benchmarks each time you conduct an audit. Remember, Millennial habits may shift from one period to the next; they don’t necessarily have long attention spans when it comes to content and campaigns. 4. Review your key indicators to identify new opportunities. Just as you review your key indicators to establish benchmarks and make the necessary adjustments, you need to review your data’s key indicators to discover new opportunities. When looking for new opportunities, keep an open mind and look for anything out of the ordinary. These data points occur organically, so no road map can necessarily detail exactly what you should be looking for. Anything that seems new or interesting is worth investigating, because you never know what you may find. 336 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience IN THIS CHAPTER »» Leveraging the power and reach of television »» Recognizing opportunities in print media »» Using email to connect with Millennials Chapter 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media T elevision and other traditional media has had a great impact on prior generations. With the advent of new media technology comes new uses for these traditional channels. While they no longer function in the same way that they once did, traditional channels can still be valuable assets in your outreach strategy. This is particularly true when you leverage the ways that Millennials use these channels to enhance your new media strategies. In this chapter, you get a better understanding of where traditional media fits when it comes to reaching Millennials. At first glance, traditional media doesn’t seem like something that is of much interest or readily accessible to a Millennial demographic. After all, this audience lives online and engages with brands primarily through more conversational channels, like Twitter and Facebook. Even though this is true, traditional media still has a place in your Millennial outreach and engagement strategy. CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 337 Taking Advantage of Television (With or Without the Budget) For most marketers, television is far out of reach of their budget. Advertising on this once-prized medium and, to be fair, still prized medium, remains important for a lot of reasons. Television is just valued today in a different way. The barriers are significant, and for small- and medium-sized brands, the risks of potential overspending and undermeasurement generally outweigh the benefits. What’s more, when you compare the metrics associated with television and social media, television is far more limited. If your goal is to reach and convert Millennials, then your natural inclination will be to invest your money online so that you can track it from start to finish. However, you can still track your investment if you leverage television strategically. The following sections look at how you can do so. Looking at Millennial TV viewing habits It’s hardly a secret that Millennials are watching less traditional TV than any generation that has come before it. MarketingCharts (http://marketingcharts. com), a company that provides insights and charts related to the world of marketing, has analyzed Nielsen television viewing data, and aggregated the information shown in Figure 4-1. You see that since 2011, the amount of weekly time that ­Millennials have devoted to watching traditional TV has steadily decreased. FIGURE 4-1: Millennial ­viewing habits have decreased. MarketingCharts.com. 338 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience The term traditional TV takes the average of live TV viewing with recorded or timeshifted viewing. It doesn’t take into account new media, such as streaming, and doesn’t factor in connected devices. If you compare television viewing among other generations, Nielsen reported that in 2017–2018 »» The number of GenY and Millennials (ages 18 to 34) TV watching has dropped 15 percent from 2014. »» Compare this with a 2 percent drop in 2017 among Baby Boomers (people 55 and above). You can see that Millennials are definitely not the most engaged when it comes to television, so marketers need to take some creative measures, such as the use of the second screen, covered in the next section, to effectively leverage TV. Reaching viewers with the second screen Have you ever watched your favorite team play your favorite sport, while all the while you’re tweeting about a play or reading tweets about that last missed call by the ref? If you have, then you’ve engaged in what’s referred to as second screen viewing. According to research from Accenture (www.accenture.com/us-en/insightdigital-video-connected-consumer), a global professional services company, 87 percent of consumers use a second device while watching television. For ­Millennials, that second device often means a smartphone. Essentially, you can take advantage of second screen viewing through three ­primary methods: Finding Millennials on Traditional Media »» Scheduled events, such as a national election or the Olympics: Considering the nature of scheduled events or times of year, planning your second-screen strategy around this kind of an event is pretty easy. You know when the event takes place, so you can develop and prepare your content well ahead of time. Of course, because scheduled events are often live, you need to leave room for adjustments and modifications. However, you can lay out your content strategy in pretty robust detail before these kinds of events begin. »» Spontaneous events, such as breaking news: When breaking news strikes, members of all generations tend to be glued to the television. For Millennials, this fascination is largely accompanied by ongoing updates on social media, CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 339 particularly Twitter. With a proper strategy in place, your organic reach and engagement can skyrocket, thanks to the second screen viewing during these events. »» Regular programming: While Millennials may not be watching as much television as the generations that have come before them, they still watch about 20 hours of television every week. By identifying the tastes and preferences of your audience through a data analysis, you can effectively reach these viewers while they’re engaged with specific programming. You can significantly leverage organic reach and engagement by using two types of second screen viewing: scheduled and spontaneous events. Capitalizing on planned events To see how you can capitalize on planned events, take the Olympics as an example. The Olympics consistently draw significant online engagement from Millennials around the world. The games provide an ideal setting in which you can leverage the second screen for both conversions and brand awareness. Users regularly share thoughts about the events across a multitude of social platforms. The development of a comprehensive content strategy that plays into the popularity of this conversation can lead to strong results. When it comes to scheduled events, you can take a series of actions that will help ensure that your campaign generates the kind of success you want to achieve: »» Identify an event or series of events that significantly engages your audience. In the example of the Olympics, it can be something as small as identifying the events and sports that are talked about most. »» Establish main conversational topics around which to base your content strategy. Several conversations will undoubtedly be taking place during these major events. While some of these conversations may be spontaneous, you can certainly predict others. Do your best to figure out these probable conversations and draft a content strategy outline that hits on these main topics. »» Determine the channels on which your target audience of Millennials are most likely to have these discussions. Generally, when it comes to the second screen, the most popular conversations will be on platforms like Twitter that they can access from their mobile devices. That said, there is always a chance that your audience is engaging on Snapchat, Instagram, or Facebook while watching an event on television. It will be up to you to determine the best platforms on which to execute your strategy and invest most of your effort and resources. 340 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience »» Determine the tone that you’ll adopt during engagement. Everyone participating in the conversation has at least the event in common. This means that it truly is a conversation with a common theme. That means that you need to predetermine the level of familiarity you use and maintain it throughout the event. Capitalizing on unforeseen events Unforeseen circumstances are always a factor during live events. However, you can use some strategies to capitalize on the second screen. Here are a few tips to keep top of mind: »» Build a list for absolutely every scenario you can think of. That way, you can limit surprises as much as possible. »» Determine the kinds of stories that you want to engage with and those that may be too sensitive. Too many marketers and brands have made the mistake of inappropriately weighing in. One such story, for example, took place in 2015 when, for International Women’s Day, Bic South Africa shared an ad that stated, “Look like a girl. Act like a lady. Think like a man. Work like a boss.” The ad drew international criticism, and Bic was forced to rethink its strategy. »» Develop an easily revisable content template that you can use in most of the cases that you expect to encounter. Again, creating content for an event that hasn’t taken place yet is fairly difficult, but in the meantime, you can work on image files, video templates, and other basic design work so that you can react quickly to big news. For centuries, print media was the primary way to reach the masses. Most people got their news from newspapers and magazines. The development of new low-cost and readily available technologies means that print media has suffered. Nowhere is this truer than with the Millennial audience. Now Millennials use real-time mobile apps. In fact, Pew Research (www. pewinternet.org) has reported that more than 80 percent of Millennials say that they use social media as their primary source for news. However, you can still use some tactics to leverage print media to attract Millennials. CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 341 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media Targeting Millennials with Print Media Reaching Millennials in magazines Of the various types of print marketing and advertising that exist, leveraging the content in magazines can be the most readily accessible type for Millennials. ­Surprisingly, the level that Millennials read magazines falls very closely in line with those of Gen Xers and Baby Boomers, according to research from JWT (www. jwt.com), an advertising company based in New York. This means that there is a real opportunity to capitalize on the popularity of magazines, particularly when you know which magazines your audience is reading. One benefit of using Facebook Insights is that you can identify some of the print publications that your Millennial audience is reading. You can find this information in the section of liked pages in your audience analysis, where print publications populate as distinct pages. Identifying the magazines that are of interest to your Millennial audience will initially help you narrow the avenues to consider leveraging on print magazines. For more about Facebook Insights, see Book 7, Chapter 2. After you determine the publications you want to target, you have a few options worth considering: »» Advertorials: Consider writing an advertorial to showcase your brand through written content. Unlike an ad, an advertorial is a sponsored piece of written content that highlights a product or service, but in the form of an editorial. Of course, advertorials aren’t free, but in some cases, they can be very cost-effective. They offer you more space to truly define your product or service and showcase why it’s better than the competition. In some smaller industry or trade publications, an advertorial may only cost a nominal amount, if anything at all. Some trade publications are more concerned with gathering as much content as they can for a given issue and will forgo the cost to place one. If you can find a magazine that will offer you this option, it can provide you with a pseudo-advertorial, which isn’t an explicit sales-focused advertorial but still has a self-promotional subtext. Inquire whether this option is available. It may not run you anything more than the time it takes to draft the article. But don’t approach this tactic with the assumption that it will be free; if it is, think of it more as a pleasant surprise. »» Inclusion in an article: Reach out to existing publication editors and staff writers in an effort to have your product or service included in an article about the topic. Unlike advertorials, your relationship with specific writers and editors largely influences your success. Reaching a point where a writer will be willing to feature your brand in her next article may take some time. 342 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience But the fact that this mention is entirely organic, and therefore genuine, means that the audience reading about it will be much more receptive to what the writer is saying. »» Display ads: Opt for display ads in smaller publications. Large, internationally distributed publications will simply be too expensive. Smaller publications will be more affordable and receptive to your business. In these more local or targeted publications, the audience you reach may be exactly the audience that you’ve defined — rather than a very large audience that also includes your targets. Connecting with Millennials through the use of newspapers According to the Newspaper Association of America (www.newsmediaalliance. org), 68 percent of Millennials ages 18 to 24 react to advertisements in print newspapers. This is especially true of coupons. So, while newspaper readership among Millennials may be down, engagement and responsiveness to sponsored content is still strong. So how can your brand leverage sponsored content? When working with a coupon that connects to your online store or online offer, make sure to use a specific code that tells you the link is from a newspaper. This will come in handy when measuring the results of your various marketing efforts and will help you determine the return on your newspaper investment. You need to evaluate whether you’re willing to even make an investment in newspapers. Yes, you have ways of measuring return when using the coupon offer strategy, but there is still risk involved. Some Millennials are simply not reading newspapers at all. With that in mind, you need to carefully consider the decision to invest in newspapers. If you can measure all aspects of the campaign and you can justify the investment based on the potential you identified in your research, then go for it! CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 343 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media Effectively leveraging newspapers in print form can be a little trickier, but one area with potential is in the use of coupons in place of your ads. Advertising in local publications can be much more affordable, and the data surrounding Millennials highlights the fact that they do respond well to coupons in newspapers. While the volume may not be significant, there is potential in small markets. If your coupon also has an online tie-in as opposed to something that people can only redeem in-store, then the potential is even greater. The case for investing in print media Print media still holds an important place in the world of marketing to Millennials. While online media has become a Millennial hotspot, this audience is still active on a variety of print platforms. This means that investing in a presence in print media is a viable option for several reasons: »» You can increase your exposure on an ongoing basis to a Millennial audience. »» You can tie your offline efforts to your online efforts. »» You can reach new prospects that your brand may not have reached online. The case for abandoning print media While Millennials are still using a variety of print media, it’s not their preferred set of channels. Millennials have grown up with the technology they use. They have evolved as consumers at the same rate as their technology. With this in mind, you need to ask yourself, “Do I want to invest in a channel that may not be viable for Millennials in a few years’ time?” For brands and organizations that have larger marketing and advertising budgets, the question is an easier one to answer. When a large budget is readily available, the decision to invest in all viable media options is clear: It has to be done. But for smaller organizations, it may not be as simple a decision. For small- and medium-sized operations, where budget allocations are made sparingly, cutting print media out of the equation is often all too easy. Print media can be cost prohibitive, difficult to measure, and hard to predict. Those problems don’t exist nearly to the same extent when it comes to social and new media. Essentially, you need to run an analysis on your available budgets and determine whether you have additional budget to allocate to traditional media. Your priority should be to choose the more cost-effective channels of new media, where you have significantly more control over the specifics of a campaign. Incorporating Email into Your Strategy It may seem a little strange at first, but as far as Millennials are concerned, email isn’t considered a new media. Email is the digital side of what is now categorized as traditional media. Millennials, therefore, use email very differently when communicating with brands. Knowing what these idiosyncrasies are and tailoring 344 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience your Millennial email marketing strategy to them will help you maximize the potential of this platform. Creating messages specifically for email Email messages targeted to Millennials won’t necessarily align with the content you create for Millennials on other channels. Instead, you need to pay close attention to the responsiveness of Millennials to specific types of emails and build your content strategy around them. Research from email marketing company Adestra (www.adestra.com) found that the most popular reason a Millennial wants to receive an email from a brand is to receive a coupon or a discount. This preference mirrors what was seen regarding newspapers. Millennials are extremely price sensitive. (See more about the ­Millennial mindset in Book 4, Chapter 2.) With this in mind, you need to ask yourself how to capture the attention of ­Millennials to both justify your investment in email and keep your Millennial audience engaged. These two tips may help you capture their attention: »» Leverage email as a component of your overall strategy as opposed to thinking about email in a silo. »» Build subject lines and headings that capture the attention of your audience right away. Receiving an email or an email address from an audience member is often the first indication that he wants to take the relationship with your brand a step further. While someone may like your Facebook Page or follow you on Twitter, nothing is quite as intimate as signing up for your newsletter or providing you with an email address. Personal information is seen as a form of currency by Millennials. Email can and should tie into your Millennial marketing efforts in several ways: »» Segment your Millennial email lists as narrowly as possible. To target your messaging to the specific behaviors and tastes of Millennials, narrow your segments. Millennials respond to personalization, and the best way to drive conversion rates is to keep your lists segmented, and your messaging highly targeted. CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 345 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media Tying email into your traditional and new media strategies »» Leverage diverse types of email campaigns. Of course, Millennials respond to coupons and discount offers, but email list-building tools like Constant Contact (www.constantcontact.com) provide many variations of email campaign types, as shown in Figure 4-2. Run a campaign that collects survey data or asks for some sort of action that Millennials can take within the email. You may even sell tickets or products directly from the email. These examples are both readily available and mobile-friendly, which is most likely where Millennials will be checking their email. »» Cross-match email addresses on Facebook and Twitter. You can cross- match email addresses on different platforms to better target your ads. Improving the targeting of your ads by performing this task leads to higher click-through rates, lower cost-per-click, and ultimately, increased conversion rates. FIGURE 4-2: Different types of campaigns available in ­ onstant Contact. C Building subject lines and headings that generate opens When you consider how much content Millennials are bombarded with on a daily basis, it’s easy to understand why Millennial email open and click-through rates have been steadily declining. (Open and click-through rates are defined as the number of your total audience that opens your emails and then clicks through to the URL they find.) Increasing open and click-through rates starts with the subject line. That is the first thing your audience is going to see, and it can really be a make-or-break moment. 346 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience To see your open rates shoot up among Millennials, here are a few tips worth keeping top of mind when crafting your next subject line: »» Keep your subject line as short as possible. The majority of your Millennial audience is checking email on a mobile device, which means less screen space for your subject. It also means that a novel-length subject line will be cut off before you even hit the main point. »» Personalize your subject line with personalization tokens. A common theme across all marketing channels is the desire for a personalized experience. Personalization goes for email as well. If you have an option to personalize the subject line using a token in your email software, take advantage of it. Personalization tokens are small bits of code found within your email software that automatically populates a designated space either in your subject line or the email body itself. It pulls out certain personal elements from the profile of the user receiving the email. So, John’s subject line will read something like “Hey, John! Collect Your Reward Now!” and Mary’s subject line will swap out John’s name for her own. »» Be clear about what recipients will see in their email. Don’t be vague or mysterious about email content and don’t send emails to people with which you have no prior relationship. This is a quick way to get your email sent to the trash. This technique of enticing opens and clicks from your audience may have worked when email was in its infancy, but smarter, busier, and often passive Millennial users aren’t interested in mystery email. Everything they need to encourage them to open the email should be in the subject line. »» Use action or intent-oriented verbs in your subject line. Much like the Finding Millennials on Traditional Media subject of clarity noted in the previous tip, use an active verb, such as buy or register, in your subject line to highlight what your audience members will need to do after they open the email. CHAPTER 4 Finding Millennials on Traditional Media 347 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Identifying opportunities to leverage the share economy »» Creating a communications strategy around sharing »» Building campaigns with a share economy focus Chapter 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy M illennials are patient. That statement may seem ironic to anyone who sees the on-demand nature of the web as proof that Millennials embrace immediacy. But, the truth is that while immediacy and short-term gain are favored by Millennials, the share economy highlights the patience that Millennials possess. For example, the explosive growth of services like Airbnb and Uber demonstrate that sharing has trumped the importance of ownership. Millennials would rather share a car than buy one they can’t afford. This chapter highlights the importance of the share economy and presents strategies you can use to participate in the sharing of goods, services, or even content. Leveraging the share economy is a great way to drive familiarity with your brand and build lasting relationships with these new consumers. Positioning Your Brand Around Sharing Leveraging the share economy isn’t going to be a strategy that suits every brand. For some, there simply isn’t going to be a way to organically integrate a sharing component into a product or marketing strategy. To effectively leverage the share CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 349 economy, you can run through a checklist that will help you determine whether your brand is capable of utilizing the strategy. See how many of the following items you can check off: »» You have an active community forum. »» You have a peer-to-peer opportunity. »» You can afford short-term opportunity costs. »» Your product or service has an online component. If you find that your brand, product, or service meets these criteria, then you’re in a great position to take advantage of the share economy by capitalizing on the Millennial’s desire for access over ownership. The following sections look at each item in turn. You have an active community forum You need to have a community focus if you want to participate in the share economy. If your customer experience doesn’t include engaging with a larger community about your brand, product, or even your industry, then taking full advantage of the share economy may be difficult. A community forum can take different shapes. It can be owned by your brand, where the majority of participants are either customers or hot prospects, or it can be industry-based. If you manufacture power tools, for example, the community forum may include a topic like home improvement with an audience made up of general contractors or builders. The key is to have an online discussion that engages your specific audience. You have a peer-to-peer opportunity The ability to share content has been a pain point for many industries that rely on individual consumption, as opposed to community use of a limitless, digital product, such as software accessed via a cloud service. As brands have recognized that fighting market demand has no value, they have made adjustments. Instead of adjusting to this demand, your aim should be to create supply for it. Your digital content should be shareable and possess certain qualities that actually encourage users to share your information with one another. 350 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Being able to afford short-term opportunity costs is likely going to be the hardest point to check off on your share economy campaign checklist. Service-based organizations that provide a platform for sharing, such as Uber or Airbnb, don’t have the same opportunity cost as other brands because they own their platform. Leveraging the share economy may mean providing your product for free or for a single fee to several users. In the past, you may have individually charged each user. The benefit of this kind of sharing with Millennials produces short-term brand exposure and long-term loyalty. The question most marketers or business owners need to ask themselves is whether these benefits outweigh the opportunity costs involved in this strategy. Your product or service has an online component The online component serves two purposes. For brands that have online content or logins, an online component makes sharing simpler and can lead to a rapid rise in adoption. For all brands, both those with an online product or service and those that operate offline, the online discussion serves to heighten awareness of the campaign and mitigate the short-term opportunity cost. Establishing a Voice Your involvement in the share economy doesn’t mean you need to change the way your business operates. The share economy, like any strategic tool, is something that you apply to a particular segment of your audience. Creating a voice for these users is an important part of your strategy. Creating your brand’s voice specifically for the share economy means focusing on two priorities: »» Mapping out your target audience: Target a very specific segment of your audience with the content you create. »» Creating a content strategy: Focus on the sharing element of your business. CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 351 Experimenting with the Share Economy You can afford short-term opportunity costs Mapping your target audience The first step to launching a campaign that leverages the share economy is the identification of a viable audience. This audience may consist of existing customers, or it may be an audience affiliated with your industry. Regardless of where the audience comes from, you need to identify certain traits to ensure that the audience you target with your offers is a viable one. As you put together a targeted campaign, you’ll find that the majority of the audience identification process will take place on your new media ad platforms. The most valuable of these platforms related to narrowing the audience will undoubtedly be Facebook. The following steps help you narrow your audience: 1. Select a general audience of Millennials that is either saved or segmented based on a particular age range. Start with a broad focus and then narrow it. In this particular case, you should either begin with your general Millennial audience, or select an age range, as shown in Figure 5-1. 2. Start targeting a specific set of share-based interests. Figure 5-2 shows a few examples of share-based interests, but you should expand on these interests so that they include any share economy-associated interests. 3. Target interests and behaviors affiliated with your brand or industry. After you complete the general share economy targeting, you should include interest categories associated with your brand or industry. 4. Select specific placements to develop segmented content strategies. Content will vary from one medium to the next. Segment your efforts to reach users with your share economy campaign on all current media. Creating a content strategy At this point in the development of your share economy campaign, you hopefully have accomplished three crucial tasks: »» You identified your brand as having the right characteristics and the potential to leverage the popularity and value of the share economy. »» You developed a target audience that is likely to engage with your brand in this share-focused campaign. »» You developed content specifically geared toward the traits that define the share economy. 352 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Experimenting with the Share Economy FIGURE 5-1: Begin by ­choosing a broad audience of ­Millennial users on Facebook. FIGURE 5-2: Initially n ­ arrow your user ­selection by targeting general share economyassociated interests. Several standardized elements of your share economy-focused initiative includes your objectives, target audience, and KPIs. The content is going to be particularly important because its structure, layout, and calls to action are the driving force behind the framing of a share-based campaign. Consider the following to help you communicate that the focal point of your content is sharing: »» Create standalone landing pages. Your landing pages should remain separate from your other campaigns. One of the fastest ways to lose your audience’s interest is to bait them with content that highlights some CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 353 information and then sends them to a landing page that doesn’t feature anything matching that content. »» Highlight the share aspect. Use keywords like “share,” “participate,” or “join” to encourage users you sent to your landing page to take part in the shareoriented environment you created for them. »» Integrate a community conversation or activity feature. Your audience may be reluctant to join your community if they don’t have enough information to make a decision. To avoid this issue, highlight topics that are popular right on your landing page. Also, offer prospective participants a glimpse into the community to allow them to see what’s being discussed. »» Provide detailed instructions. Millennials are intuitive, but you shouldn’t take their tech-savvy abilities for granted. If you provide a platform where people upload information about how to do something better, walk them through the process to display it. The upload or communication process may be straightforward and familiar, but don’t assume that they can figure everything out on their own. Your share economy campaign relies on user-generated information and content. You want your audience to participate as much and as frequently as possible. So, if detailed instructions are one way of encouraging participation, make them as detailed as possible, even if you consider it overkill. »» Highlight the benefits of sharing. You need to demonstrate to your target audience that sharing provides value. You also have to highlight the value of your target audience’s specific participation. Audience members are going to ask why they should spend their time sharing your brand. You have to answer that question before they’ll take the time and effort to engage. »» Consider an incentive-based initiative. One of the fastest ways to drive participation in any campaign, including a share economy-focused initiative, is to provide your Millennial audience with some sort of incentive or acknowledgment. It doesn’t have to be anything grand, but it should be something that highlights the individual user, like a leaderboard or a Contributor of the Month program. »» Communicate with your audience as a peer. You want your community to establish a real relationship with your brand. To build the community as quickly as possible, communicate with participants on a peer level. If you hide behind a corporate persona, you can’t encourage real relationships. 354 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Your share economy campaigns leverage unique segments of your Millennial audience, which means that the objectives you create will relate to a particular audience construct (niche) and may not necessarily focus on long-term goals. Your goals can relate to universal objectives, such as driving brand awareness, engagement, or conversions, but they must target a particular segment. If the campaign has the share economy as its focus and your goals relate to the audience that you cultivated for the share economy, then your objectives will work. Ask yourself the following series of questions to simplify the process of developing your niche goals. They can help you construct readily achievable objectives. »» What are you going to measure? To create your objectives, you need to determine what you want to measure. For example, if you’re providing a learning exchange where participants are sharing knowledge with one another, are you going to measure the amount of data collected or the size of your growing user base of experts? These are two separate objectives, and while you can aim to achieve both, you need to have a different objective plan for each one. »» Does the share economy campaign operate in a vacuum? You need to decide just how connected your share economy initiatives will be to your overall objectives. The share economy has some unique aspects to it that may not fit in with the rest of your program, but this isn’t to say that it will be different from your online brand. Branding attributes and your brand persona will be consistent wherever you have a presence, so ask yourself this question: How much of your brand and the brand experience (see Book 4, Chapter 6) will you incorporate into your share economy campaign? »» What universal elements of your marketing strategy tie into the share economy campaign? You shouldn’t run the risk of conducting an effective share economy campaign only to find that several members of the community aren’t familiar with your brand outside of your share economy platform. For this reason, you need to identify those elements and ensure that they’re present and represent your brand well. »» Does the campaign end with the share economy, or are secondary actions important? You’re targeting a unique segment of your Millennial audience that is particularly attracted to the concept of sharing. However, CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 355 Experimenting with the Share Economy Running a Niche Campaign for the Share Economy you should also include incentives that push your audience to take another step beyond the share economy. It can be a download or an incentive-based signup, such as a discount code that encourages share economy participants to become customers. Millennials want access over ownership, at least at first. Providing them with an option to participate in the share economy aspect of your business can mean giving them the desired access until a fraction is eventually ready to buy. Encouraging Audience Participation After you establish the objectives of your share economy campaign, you’re ready to provide your audience with incentives to participate. For example, you can create a place for your community to share access to online subscription services, such as creative software, instead of requiring them to buy access to each individual product. This incentive can be a very powerful way of pulling users to your brand over a competitor. However, it’s important to create barriers to prevent this kind of service from being abused. Some ways to prevent abuse include »» Making sure that shared passwords work only with a certain level of subscription »» Putting a limit on how many documents third parties can save These methods allow users to access the product until the desire for ownership comes into play, and they move away from simply needing access. The following sections look at some marketing tactics you can employ to encourage adoption of your newly launched share economy platform. Reaching out to your existing database Current customers are the easiest ones to get on the share bandwagon. Your existing database of Millennial customers is sure to include some users that fall into the share economy group. Go through the same audience development process outlined earlier in this chapter, in the section “Mapping out your target audience,” but focus on existing customers and fans. Encourage them to participate and push them to check out the new offer. 356 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Mobile is where Millennials spend their time, and the success of share economy mobile applications like Uber and Lyft show that this audience is partial to the mobile platform. Develop your ads and push them to your selected media on mobile devices. Highlight the benefits of the share concept for your product or industry and provide some incentive to get Millennials to try it. Targeting ads to the share economy audience After you segment the audience that fits into the share economy, create content that focuses exclusively on the sharing aspect. Touch on the fact that your audience may have a pain point that this feature addresses — for example, not needing the full service or product or not being able to afford the full option. The model you should use in the case of these ads and pieces of content is the problem-solution model. This model involves presenting your target audience with a problem they may or may not know they have and then offering them the solution to that problem all within the ad itself. Developing incentivized adoption schemes Incentivizing adoption is your best bet to get the ball rolling. Every one of the models you implement should include some sort of incentive. Incentives will generate the fastest adoption by users in all categories. The incentive can be something simple like a free sample, gift card, or offer redemption. It can also be something more complicated, like a tiered offer based on subscription level, subscription length, or frequency the product is used. Measuring Results When you set out to measure the success of your share economy campaign, what you measure depends to a large extent on your objectives. If your goal is to drive brand awareness, then your focus is going to be on the increase of your reach, share of voice, and other brand-affiliated key performance indicators (KPIs). If your goal is to get new customers then the KPIs you analyze will relate to acquisition. CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 357 Experimenting with the Share Economy Leveraging native video ads You’ll want to watch for some telltale signs when you determine how to measure your share economy campaign success. Those signs will be evident when you ask yourself a few questions related to measurement: »» Is the goal to build a new community? »» Are there secondary goals that extend beyond the share economy? »» Should you place a timeline on secondary goals, or should you measure those actions in perpetuity? For more information about analyzing campaign success, see Book 9. Is the goal to build a new community? A simple, one-dimensional goal may be to build a new community of share economy–oriented Millennials. You can analyze this community for insights and opportunities and leverage it for growth. Ultimately, however, if your primary goal is to build a new audience, your measurement criteria will relate to the size and engagement of your new audience. Are there secondary goals that extend beyond the share economy? If your goal goes beyond simply building a new community, then you need to identify how those goals are measured. You may want to include secondary goals, such as conversions that result from an initial introduction to the customer by way of the share economy. You can measure community participation through either touchpoint attribution measurement, or you can directly link conversions or specific actions to the share economy in their entirety. Whatever the case may be, you need to clearly outline how the share economy will factor into these secondary conversions. A touchpoint attribution measurement model looks at a specific touchpoint, or point of contact between the brand and customer, in the buying journey and allocates a specific weighted ratio to that touchpoint. For example, if, over the course of the buying process, a customer engages with your brand five times, then a touchpoint attribution measurement model would assign each of those five touchpoints a specific weight regarding its contribution to the final conversion. Attribution models can vary significantly in terms of the value given to different touchpoints in the buying journey. In some cases, touchpoints are given equal ratios, and in others, some touchpoints can be weighted more heavily. There are also attribution models where attributed contribution ratios can decay over time, 358 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Figure 5-3 shows an example of a touchpoint attribution model whereby each touchpoint along the buyer journey is given equal weight, as well as one where touchpoints are given variable weights. In these two examples of Google Analytics models, touchpoints are given a value regarding how much they have contributed to the conversion. FIGURE 5-3: Attribution models can weigh each touchpoint in Google Analytics. To find more detailed information on the use and customization of attribution models in Google Analytics, visit https://support.google.com/analytics/ topic/3205717. Should you place a timeline on secondary goals? If you plan to measure secondary objectives that extend beyond simply building a new community and watching it grow, placing a cap on the amount of time that you measure these secondary conversions is worthwhile. For example, if you measure the number of ebooks downloaded during a campaign, you want to know that the activity took place during the campaign and not a year later. Setting a time limit, perhaps no more than about 30 to 90 days, is a good approach. CHAPTER 5 Experimenting with the Share Economy 359 Experimenting with the Share Economy whereby a touchpoint that had a high value when it first occurred becomes less and less relevant as time goes by and other touchpoints come into play. In the case of the share economy conversion that might arise, you may want to consider focusing entirely on the engagement within the share economy and then attributing any subsequent engagement to the activity that has taken place within the share economy. This focus ensures that you’ll be able to closely monitor activity within the share economy and with your share economy audience. IN THIS CHAPTER »» Developing an experience for your Millennial audience »» Linking experience to each touchpoint »» Creating experience-centric campaigns Chapter 6 Developing the Brand Experience M illennials are price sensitive and willing to delay purchases. But when they’re ready to spend, a priority for those expenditures will be on experience-oriented purchases. Their desire for brand experiences ties in closely with their pursuit of brand relationships. A brand experience doesn’t necessarily need to be some grandiose gesture. It can be subtle. Millennials are observers who appreciate subtleties and look for relationships with companies that don’t blast them with overt corporate messages. This chapter focuses on the creation of a brand experience for Millennials that extends beyond the simple transaction. You concentrate on integrating the experience into every campaign and look at the tools you need to integrate the brand experience into your larger marketing strategy. For more information about the structure of the buyer journey, see Book 2, Chapter 3. Creating a Brand Experience Strategy One of the most important things to remember is that during any customer interaction, on any media type, your brand should be instantly recognizable. Instantly recognizable means that everything from your voice to your branding to elements as basic as your color scheme should be consistent. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 361 When developing your brand experience strategy, begin by outlining how you’d like your Millennial prospect to interact with your brand at each point of engagement throughout the buyer journey.The buyer journey is the path your prospects take when they interact with your brand across web channels. For example, a buyer journey can begin with an initial introduction to the brand on social media. That exposure may be followed by an educational interaction with your website, blog, or other social network. Then it may end with a conversion in your online store, completing the initial buyer journey. This journey continues after the conversion is made, strengthening the brand relationship and encouraging ongoing business. To craft the buyer journey for Millennials, start by answering a few important questions: »» What is the ideal medium for a first interaction? »» Where will your efforts to educate switch to efforts to sell? »» Will you invest in establishing multiple entry points? »» How does the experience differ from prospects to customers? What is the ideal medium for a first interaction? Millennials move from one medium to another very easily, so predicting where their first interaction will take place is hard. But you can make an educated guess as to where new prospects will have their first interaction based on two criteria: »» Media platform: When you run an audience analysis you can identify the place where your largest audience exists. Then you can put content of interest to new prospects there. »» Industry conversations: You can look at data analyses (see Book 4, Chapter 3) to see where the conversation in your industry is taking place. Then you can start there. These two points help you determine where you meet new prospects. This location is where you want to establish the brand experience and introduce the audience to your voice. 362 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Where will your efforts to educate switch to efforts to sell? The first goal of any brand experience is education. To begin developing a relationship, you need to tell prospects »» Who you are (so that you familiarize your target audience with your brand »» What products and services you offer »» Why you’re the best option on the market compared to your competitors After you educate your Millennial users, the second goal is to develop a relationship to drive conversions. More often than not, this relationship-building takes place on owned media where you have complete control of the content and the process. This owned media can be your website, your mobile app, your blog, or any other medium that you own. There are three kinds of media: »» Owned media are the channels that you control completely. An example can be your website. You control the content, the engagement, and the brand representation. This is different from social media that is controlled by the company that owns it. If they change on a whim, you have no control. »» Paid media are media where your brand’s presence is a result of an invest- ment. For example, Google AdWords ad space is an example of paid media, where the media representing your brand is found as a result of your paid efforts. »» Earned media are your most valuable types of content. Third parties that reference your brand have created these pieces of content. While you may not have control of wha’s being said in some cases, earned media are the most trusted sources of material about your brand because Millennials trust their peers more than they do brands themselves. For a more detailed look at owned, paid, and earned media, see Book 5, Chapter 1. Will you invest in establishing multiple entry points? The more robust you make the brand experience, the more likely your target Millennial audience will first encounter your brand in one of several different places. For this reason, you need to carefully plan where these entry points will occur. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 363 Developing the Brand Experience personality) Any potential entry point that a customer may come across should be designed to funnel users to your most active and valuable assets, such as your website or landing pages. How does the experience differ from prospects to customers? After a Millennial prospect becomes a customer, the brand experience changes. There are significant differences in the type of engagement a prospect will have with your brand compared to the experiences of an existing customer. These differences can include, for example, the media on which you most commonly engage with a user. While social media may have been the driving force in the brand experience with your prospects, it may change to email or a messaging platform such as Facebook Messenger after that individual becomes a customer. You need to establish separate strategies for each of these user types. For more about Facebook Messenger see Book 7, Chapter 6. An example road map After you select a starting point for the brand experience, develop a sales strategy, and identify the differences between initial contact and nurturing existing customers, you can get into the process of designing the brand experience. It can be difficult to envision what your brand experience road map may look like when you’ve never encountered one before. The following steps highlight an example of a brand experience with a consumer product. You can use this example as a guideline when creating your own brand experience road map: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 364 You make an initial connection when a prospect sees your Facebook Ad. The prospect visits your blog to read an article relevant to your industry. The prospect makes contact with your company and a conversation takes place. The prospect buys something based on a special or promotion offered via email. You re-engage with the customer shortly after the initial purchase to build loyalty. You demonstrate your thanks by delivering private offers or gifts for the existing customer base. BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience While every buyer journey is going to be different, this example shows how the brand experience works in action. It demonstrates a process that you can use to establish a connection and build a relationship with prospects. Identifying Touchpoints for Your Audience »» You don’t need to have a robust presence on every network you choose. »» Every network where you have a touchpoint doesn’t need to heavily factor into your brand experience strategy. Your branding and personality should be evident wherever you have a presence. But with regard to the customer experience, you’re the one who should determine which media and touchpoints should be emphasized for Millennials. Consider using the following touchpoints for your brand experience strategy. »» Social networks: Social networks should be the driving force in your brand experience strategy. Social media have become the unstoppable juggernauts they are thanks to Millennials. Therefore, most interactions that take place with your brand occur on some social network. These networks are ideally suited for first encounters and for relationship and loyalty development. »» Your website/blog: When you have complete control over every aspect of a medium, like your website or a blog, it becomes a very powerful tool. These platforms provide an effective way to build on an initial contact. Millennials may not stumble on your website as a first contact, but when they do click through to your site, you know that you can provide more detailed information because you have their full attention. »» Your mobile application: If you’ve invested in developing a mobile application, then it’s a perfect place to build a relationship and extend the brand engagement experience after you’ve converted a prospect into a customer. »» Mobile messaging applications: Millennials engage on mobile, which is where they spend the majority of their time. You can further the brand experience on a very personal level by creating an engagement strategy for mobile messaging platforms like Facebook Messenger, WhatsApp, and, of course, text messaging. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 365 Developing the Brand Experience Before you choose touchpoints, you need to keep in mind two things: »» Email: You may think that email is a forgotten platform by Millennials. But after a consumer has been converted into a client, it can be a valuable asset. You can cultivate the relationship and deepen the brand experience. Millennials may ignore cold emails, but when information from a trusted brand comes into their inbox, they’re receptive to what’s being offered. Cold emails are emails that have come from a sender with which the receiver doesn’t have a previous relationship. Sending emails to rented lists, for example, where you buy addresses for an email campaign, will be ignored by Millennials who will consider it to be spam. Email is widely regarded as one of the last personal spaces where a user has complete control over the content he or she sees and ignores. An email from an unknown sender will either be automatically placed in the Junk folder, or the recipient will ignore it and throw it in the Trash. The CAN-SPAM act of 2003 was created to protect consumers and businesses from unwanted electronic communications. Don’t be guilty of violating someone’s email and possible getting blocked by your email provider. It serves no purpose to annoy your readers. Checking Off Elements for Each Touchpoint Every touchpoint where your audience encounters your brand should add value to both the consumer and to your organization and push the customer toward conversion. To get the most from your brand experience touchpoints, you’ll want to include certain elements at each one. These elements help move the journey along and make it a more cohesive experience. A consistent experience encourages the prospect to stay the course and increases your chances of successfully converting your prospect to a customer. In the initial stages of the brand experience when the consumer is just beginning to become acquainted with your brand, you may want to consider incorporating the following elements: »» Clear branding: You need clear branding that is visible throughout your creative design and copy. In this early stage of the experience, you’re introducing the user to your brand, so it’s crucial that it’s clearly marked — perhaps even overstated, such as a logo or company name that takes up the majority or entirety of an image you share. 366 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience »» Rich media: Rich media like images and videos immediately attract the attention of users. When used in an ad campaign on a social network like Facebook, a video automatically begins playing in the user’s feed. Millennials are visual consumers, so if you can use rich media to capture their attention, take advantage of it. prospects right in your copy. In fact, one of the most effective forms of communicating your message to Millennials is to present your product or service as a solution to a problem they may or may not know they have. Think about the classic infomercial structure, where a voiceover begins by asking, “Has this ever happened to you?” You present a problem and then offer a brand solution. In your first interaction with your target audience, you need to clearly spell out the problem to engage the user. »» A call to action: In this first step, you’re trying to educate the user, not necessarily sell your product. A call to action should simply offer the prospect the opportunity to learn more about you. Your call to action shouldn’t be an aggressive sales pitch, but rather an invitation to learn a little bit more about your brand or solution. Developing a Customer Relationship After you make the initial introduction of your brand to your target Millennial audience, you can begin to develop the brand relationship. In this stage of the experience, you can use some sales-oriented content to encourage users to take the next step. The following sections describe some of the most useful techniques for building a relationship. Engaging users with conversational content At the relationship-building stage, it’s important not to solely focus on selling to your Millennial prospects. One of the qualities that Millennials seek is value in the content brands share. They’re looking for content that gives them a reason to engage. This content can be in the form of a conversation. Ask questions or conduct pools, surveys, or ongoing industry discussions. For more information about types of content, see Book 3, Chapter 2. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 367 Developing the Brand Experience »» Solutions: It’s a good idea to include the solution to a problem faced by your When something relevant to your industry is being discussed, it’s appropriate for your brand to participate in the conversation. For example, suppose that you sell a particular tech gadget, and Apple announces a shift in the way some aspect of its devices work. This announcement gives you an opportunity to share your opinion either on your owned channels or on a public forum where a conversation is already taking place. Sharing useful information that highlights your expertise By sharing tips and insights that demonstrate your expertise in the industry, you’re providing value. You’re also highlighting why you’re the best of all the options on the market. Offering first-time customers specials, freebies, or deals You want to ease the potentially awkward scenario of overtly selling a product or service on a medium like a social network, which is intended to be conversational. One strategy you can apply in the hopes of avoiding that awkward situation is to offer users a special discount or a deal to first-time customers. Special deals create an incentive for the customer to convert and help you decrease the conversion time. Building trust by sharing third-party content that mentions your brand When you find that third parties, like influential bloggers, discuss your product, you want to make sure that your audience sees it. This content further cements your status as an industry leader and keep your brand top of mind when your prospect is ready to make a purchase. For more in-depth information about working with influencers, see Book 6. After a user becomes a customer, the brand content should shift from pursuit to relationship growth. This stage is where ongoing, personalized communication becomes your most valuable asset for long-run expansion and survival in the market. 368 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience To get the most from the touchpoints in this stage of the consumer cycle, you should consider using one-on-one communication, either in real time in a messaging application or via email. You also should consider incorporating the following elements into these communications. »» Personalization: It may seem like a small detail, but personalization goes a long way with Millennials. When you can add their name to correspondence — for example, in an email subject or body text — you increase the likelihood that they’ll engage with the content. Developing the Brand Experience »» Appreciation: Little things go a long way. That is particularly true when it comes to showing your appreciation for your customers and your audience. Sharing content that communicates your gratitude helps solidify the relationship you’re building with Millennials. It also enhances the brand experience after a conversion and increases the chances of repeat business. An example is when Cadbury, a UK-based candy maker, shared a video thanking its fans on Facebook after it hit one million fans (see Figure 6-1). »» Community: Making your content more about the community, the industry, and, most importantly, the audience after they’ve converted goes a long way toward solidifying the relationship. It also enhances the brand experience and adds value to your content. »» Regular communications: It’s hard to build a relationship with a brand that has gone dark after a conversion. Keep up regular contact with your audience, both new and old. Segmenting Your Content Of course, you’ll regularly share general content designed to appeal to your broad audience. But to optimize the effectiveness of your campaigns and extract the greatest benefit from each target audience, you need to develop content that tells a story. (Book 3, Chapter 5 covers storytelling.) You need to craft your brand content in such a way that it guides your target audience through the journey from prospect to customer. You want to gently move them from one step to the next. Be careful, though; you don’t want to come across as insistent. You want to ease your audience down a conversion path so that when a prospect is ready, the next step is perfectly clear and easy to make. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 369 FIGURE 6-1: Cadbury built a giant chocolate thumbs-up to show its thanks for one million fans. Creating experience-specific content When you create experience-specific campaigns, you want to create a narrative that helps prospects move from prospect to customer. As you develop this experience, you can do a few things to help your audience progress in the right order: »» Maintain a structured narrative »» Ensure the fluid connection of your channels »» Establish a timeline that you can easily follow »» Connect each stage of the process »» Gradually blend the experience with standard content Maintaining a structured narrative When running a brand experience campaign, you need to think of each initiative as having a complete narrative — with a beginning, middle, and end. You may create a story with the long-term goal of building an ongoing relationship or a short-term goal like getting your audience to participate in a new initiative. Regardless of whether you’re focusing on the brand experience or trying to generate interest in a new product launch, a narrative needs to exist. 370 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Ensuring the fluid connection of your channels You should also build a cross-channel referral component into your content. A cross-channel referral means that you refer your audience from one channel to another from within your content. This strategy helps you create a more robust presence for your brand and highlights the versatility of your communication. Establishing a timeline that you can easily follow Consistency and timing are two keys to success when conducting a brand experience campaign. You need to create a strategic timeline that outlines when you’ll share particular types of content and at what rate you’d like your audience to move through the various stages of the experience. Connecting each stage of the process It should be clear at every touchpoint where your customer should be going next. Remember that the campaign is structured as a narrative. At no point in this process should your audience be confused about where to go or what to do. Leverage a call to action whenever you can to move users from one step to the next. Also, consider presenting complete instructions when appropriate, like during the conversion stage when your audience is highly engaged and willing to follow instructions. Don’t give your audience outlined instructions in the early, education stage of the process. In the case of the initial phases, a simple “Learn More” call to action should suffice. The pushy approach may be a little bit too much for new prospects to handle and could turn off those Millennial users who dislike aggressive sales tactics. Gradually blending the experience with standard content As you build a relationship with your customers, you should gradually blend the brand experience narrative into your day-to-day content. This slow, calculated transition will allow you to maintain a relationship with users and possibly transition them into brand loyalists. Initially, you want to continue sharing segmented content that relates to the brand experience initiative. Then you can slowly work CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 371 Developing the Brand Experience When you’re building your campaign, it’s crucial that you link all your media channels. It should be entirely clear to your prospects that they’re engaging with the same brand and the same campaign. This fluid connection requires you to pay close attention to the consistency of your message, rhetoric, branding, and creative elements of the campaign. your way toward integrating these users into the general audience and sharing more generalized content with them. As you engage your new, experience-oriented audience with campaigns, note the level of engagement users exhibit. As this engagement rate increases, you can see that these users are engaged in what you have to say as a brand. This advice is particularly true as time passes after the end of a campaign. At this point, you can begin integrating this audience with your general audience in ad campaigns. This easy integration will help maintain engagement with your new audience and allow you to build your general audience of engaged users. Unifying your content across every channel Unifying your content across all current media is an important part of the brand experience initiative. Your audience will differ from one channel to the next, and — perhaps more importantly — the personalities of these users won’t necessarily be the same on one medium as they are on another. In spite of this difference, you can use the following tactics to connect your content and maintain a degree of consistency across all channels in a brand experience campaign: »» Create a unique message »» Deploy remarketing »» Develop unique assets Creating a unique message Your audience can easily get lost across various media, even if you’ve carefully planned each stage of the brand experience campaign. The reality is that so much content is out there that you can easily lose sight of the next step when following a buyer’s journey. Try to create a standout, segmented message and maintain consistency in your branding across all media. This consistency helps your content clearly stand out from your other content and from other brands online. Deploying remarketing Remarketing displays ads to users who have arrived at a particular product or page on your website. Essentially, it sends a reminder about a product or page the user 372 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience has previously shown interest in by clicking it, giving them a second opportunity to visit the page or buy the product. Developing unique assets A great way to connect all your brand experience assets and ensure a degree of continuity from one asset to another is by creating standalone landing pages, either on mobile or the web. These landing pages allow your audience to easily identify the brand conducting the campaign. It also makes it easier for you to track the data directly from these pages to gauge audience interest. Integrating the Experience for an Omni-Channel Strategy After you create your narrative and develop some of the content you plan to use for your brand experience initiative, you should start thinking about how the brand experience will fit into your overall omni-channel strategy. One of the key features of a omni-channel strategy is the fluidity with which all aspects of your communications operate across channels. This feature is important to focus on to capture and retain the attention of Millennials. The same holds true for your brand experience. You run the risk of losing your audience along the way because your messages or instructions across the channels were unclear. You can use several methods to avoid audience attrition, including the following: »» Creating an identifiable theme »» Using a tracking mechanism »» Repeating the campaign title or slogan on all media CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 373 Developing the Brand Experience The strategic use of remarketing can make it easier to unify your content efforts. Remarketing allows you to place targeted, customized, and, in some cases, even personalized ads in front of select users on a variety of media. These ads can push users to return to a website and complete a purchase, remind them of an item or piece of content that they were viewing at one time or another, or present offers and deals from the website in question. Ultimately, the goal is to use the ads to keep the brand top of mind for prospects and offer reminders or even incentives to the user to return to the brand’s website or store. »» Facilitating movement in any direction »» Ensuring that all assets are easily discoverable Creating an identifiable theme A theme is a powerful tool that helps your audience follow the campaign experience from one channel to the next. While your branding always needs to be consistent, a particular theme or stylistic identifier can be exactly what your audience needs to ensure that it follows the campaign content from one channel to the next without encountering any hurdles. An example of one such theme or identifier may be a campaign-specific mascot or the use of unique imagery in all creative assets associated with a campaign. Using a tracking mechanism Another useful option may be the creation and use of a hashtag on all active media to track a particular campaign. Hashtags may be more common and useful on networks like Twitter or Tumblr, but when it comes to tracking your audience and your audience tracking your campaign, a hashtag is a simple identifier that any Millennial will understand and be able to follow. Repeating the campaign title or slogan on all media Simple branding is all you need to display in your day-to-day content to let your audience know that the content belongs to you. But when it comes to cultivating an experience, reminding your audience of the existence of the campaign becomes more important. For example, showcasing the title or highlighting a particular initiative using a hashtag is an effective way to retain your audience along the entire campaign path. Facilitating movement in any direction Your audience doesn’t move through your content in a linear fashion. While you may have designed a narrative path that you want your audience to follow, you need to prepare for its divergence from this route. 374 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience You need to create links and buttons in your content that allow users to move in any direction they choose to throughout the journey. If they opt to go back to an original touchpoint or visit another touchpoint in the educational stage despite having already visited it, they should be able to do so. When it comes to reactivating dormant prospects, discoverability is key. The brand experience campaign is one that won’t necessarily occur in one sitting or on one medium. These kinds of campaigns take time. For this reason, you need to ensure that the content on all channels is easily discoverable. Sending frequent reminders about a campaign or content related to an offer to prospects keeps even the most passive of prospects somewhat engaged. Then, when they’re ready, it’s easy for them to pick up where they left off. Tracking the Brand Experience Across Different Media Tracking your data across all your channels enables you to learn from every action you take. It improves your efforts to optimize your budget and increase your conversion rate. Because brand experience-specific campaigns take place on multiple media, tracking that data requires a little bit of know-how and the occasional assistance of technology. It may also mean that you need to get a little creative about how you track your campaigns and which conversions you measure. You can use several strategies to track your brand experience campaigns. These strategies may differ from one objective to the next based on the key performance indicators (KPIs) you choose. (Book 1, Chapter 1 covers KPIs in detail.) You can use the following common tracking methods to track the impact your brand experience campaigns have on things like conversion and retention of new customers and the cultivation of brand advocates: »» A tag management system »» Trackable links »» Segmentation of data CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 375 Developing the Brand Experience Ensuring that all assets are easily discoverable A tag management system A tag management system allows marketers to place a small piece of code on the pages of a website to track data. A tag management system lets you track data from each of your active sources to help you effectively tie together all your campaign efforts. If you use Google Analytics, the most logical choice of a tag management system is Google Tag Manager. Figure 6-2 shows the dashboard for Google Tag Manager. FIGURE 6-2: Google Tag ­Manager can help you more ­precisely track data. Trackable links Whether or not you’re using a tag management system, you need to create trackable links. If you’re using Google Analytics, you can use Google’s URL building ­ service available at https://ga-dev-tools.appspot.com/campaignurl-builder, shown in Figure 6-3, to create these links, or you can use an online tracking service like Bitly (http://bit.ly), shown in Figure 6-4. Link tracking allows you to both segment data in your site tracking dashboard and monitor the effectiveness of different media and content individually. Segmentation of data As with any campaign, you should be segmenting your brand experience campaign data in your tracking dashboards to get a full, unadulterated picture of how the campaign is working. Using link-shortening tools like Bitly or Google, you can segment your data in an analytics dashboard, such as Google Analytics. Then, from within this dashboard, you can look only at campaign data and analyze how 376 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Developing the Brand Experience it’ performing on its own. You can then compare the solo performance of a campaign with the performance of other initiatives and the benchmarks you’ve set for your campaigns in terms of key performance indicators. Keeping your data segmented is an important practice that will help you get an isolated picture of the campaign you’re running. FIGURE 6-3: Google offers a free service where you can add customized parameters to an existing URL to track more data. FIGURE 6-4: Bitly allows users to shorten and track custom links to content. Running Brand Experience Campaigns One of the fundamental differences between a traditional objective-oriented campaign and a brand experience campaign is the seamlessness with which a brand experience campaign is executed. Users can move from one piece of content to CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 377 another and from one channel to the next without becoming confused about the path designed for the process. While elements of your brand experience strategy may factor into your standard objective campaigns, the focus of the brand experience campaign is on the immersion of the audience in the story you’re telling across various media. As with any campaign, you need to start by developing either a single or a series of objectives that you’d like to achieve by building a brand experience for your Millennial prospects. Objectives, such as your KPIs can be both tangible and intangible. You can collect tangible customer data, which is concrete and measurable, by having customers fill out a form or submit their information. Alternatively, you can try to build loyalty, which can often be an intangible objective as it’s not necessarily measured by a concrete statistic but rather a concept that relies much more on observation. When it comes to the brand experience, some of the most common objectives you should consider when building your campaigns for Millennials include »» Increasing brand engagement »» Driving brand awareness »» Building a new segmented audience »» Selling more product »» Garnering customer loyalty »» Fostering relationships »» Launching a well-rounded campaign Increasing brand engagement Continuous engagement helps build your brand awareness. A brand experience campaign is about building that engagement across multiple media. By creating an experience in which your prospects and target Millennial audience can participate, you’re driving increased interactions with a broad variety of users on several digital channels. Considering that this increased engagement is going to be an essential component of any brand experience initiative, you need to decide whether engagement is a primary or secondary objective of your campaign. 378 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience Your primary objective is the one that you’re most interested in achieving. All the work you do and everything you include in your strategy is going to aim to achieve this primary goal. A secondary objective is one that may be less of a focus or even just a byproduct of your primary objective. While you may track this objective and even implement a few components that work toward its success, it won’t be your primary focus during the campaign. Although brand awareness isn’t a tangible objective in the traditional sense. it’s an objective that you can work toward through the strategic use of a brand experience campaign. As you drive engagement with your target audience, the conversation around your brand will increase. As that conversation increases, the discoverability of your brand by your target prospects and by new prospects who come across this public discussion will rise. While there may not be a concrete way to determine brand awareness, one measurement that may be helpful is share of voice. Share of voice measures how much industry conversation pertains to your brand as compared to your competitors. As share of voice increases, so does your brand awareness. Creating a brand experience that focuses on intrigue can help you garner the attention of new audiences and users. An intrigue-focused campaign may have something to do with a series of clues or references that participants need to follow to reach the incentive-fueled end — perhaps a discount or special offer. This kind of campaign is a useful way to drive brand awareness. Building a new, segmented audience One of the benefits of brand experience campaigns is that they can entice new fans. These viewers make it clear that they’re willing to engage with brands that provide them with valuable content. (For more detail about content creation, see Book 3.) Selling more product Of course, one of the goals that you’ll work toward is increasing sales. Just remember that when it comes to brand experience, the sales cycle may be a bit longer than what you’re used to because the timeline isn’t necessarily fixed and the majority of the audience will be focused on getting the most from the experience presented. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 379 Developing the Brand Experience Driving brand awareness You most likely will want to consider increased sales as a secondary objective in your brand experience campaigns. Unlike some of your more sales-oriented objectives, such as an ad campaign with a clear goal at its core, the brand experience is primarily about building relationships. You may find that over time, these relationships lead to conversions, but the concept of building your brand experience means that you want to encourage the organic growth of a relationship with your prospects. A conversion may take place at any point in the process after the prospect in question feels comfortable enough to buy. Increasing sales, however, is still a viable objective worth monitoring. Garnering customer loyalty One of the most valuable byproducts of an experience-oriented campaign is the garnering of audience loyalty. Creating a noteworthy experience for your audience shows that you care about them. This attention goes a long way in building loyalty among your existing or newly converted audiences. Fostering relationships Brand experience campaigns are reliable tools to use when you’re trying to deepen the relationships you created with your audience. Though the growth of relationships isn’t necessarily the easiest thing to measure, it’s a worthwhile objective to monitor. Launching a well-rounded campaign To get the most from your campaign, you should follow a series of steps leading to your launch. The following steps can help ensure that your narrative is clear, your tracking is established, and that you’re working toward achieving exactly what you set out to do: 1. Build a slightly generalized Millennial audience. With a brand experience campaign, you’ll find some Millennial audience members that you wouldn’t have necessarily thought to consider. Often, current campaigns drive engagement from previously dormant users. To encourage the discovery of new audiences, keep your target audience a little bit more general than usual to expose the brand experience campaign to new prospects. 380 BOOK 4 Reaching Your Millennial Audience 2. Establish your objectives. Determine exactly what you’re trying to achieve by creating a brand experience initiative for your audience and selecting objectives that measure their interest. 3. Construct a narrative. 4. Determine tracking methods and KPIs. Before launching, identify exactly how you plan to track your progress and pick the key indicators you’ll use to measure your success. 5. Set initial benchmarks. Your benchmarks may change after your brand experience program gets underway, but start with a few benchmarks that you’d like to improve. 6. Develop your content. This step connects closely to the narrative you structured for your brand experience. Create content that helps your audience move from one stage of the story to the next. Also, consider how the content will help you build a closer ongoing relationship with your audience. 7. Launch your campaign. Measure your results to see whether your audience is following the linear path that you created for them. You may need to make some changes to guide them along the path you constructed. You also may need to incorporate a new narrative that your audience is organically following. 8. Make needed changes. Be proactive and make necessary changes right away. CHAPTER 6 Developing the Brand Experience 381 Developing the Brand Experience The narrative is the driving force behind the entire brand experience, so it’s a critical stage. Spend time outlining the ideal path you’d like users to take and then consider all the variations that you might present. You need to integrate your brand experience, so spend time thinking about all the ways your narrative’s pieces are linked. 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 Understanding Types of Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Utilizing Paid Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 Championing Earned Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Enhancing Shared Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 Amplifying Owned Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 Creating a Framework for Achieving the Right Mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 CHAPTER 2: Using Search Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Knowing the Three Key Players in Search Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . 402 Targeting Search Queries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 Optimizing Your Assets for Specific Channels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Earning Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 CHAPTER 3: Making Content Shareable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Embracing Shareability as a Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Uncovering the Five Ws and One H of Online Sharing. . . . . . . . . . . 429 Adding Social Bookmarking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435 Making SEO a Priority. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436 Deploying Hashtags to Encourage Sharing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 CHAPTER 4: Considering Email Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 Understanding Marketing Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444 Sending Broadcast and Triggered Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447 Building a Promotional Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 Creating Email Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453 Writing and Designing Effective Emails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459 Getting More Clicks and Opens. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463 Ensuring Email Deliverability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 466 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Considering when to use paid media »» Discovering the value of retargeting »» Understanding why owned media is important Chapter 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media H ave you struggled with the concepts of paid, earned, shared, and owned media? It’s no wonder. Within each of these categories is a rotating variety of options that could confuse even the most seasoned online marketer. Also, because the allocations for each type vary widely, the stakes can be high. Getting it wrong isn’t an option. Content marketing has added another layer to the promotion puzzle. Now marketers have to decide the budget mix as well as what to market. Should they pay for product, service, or content promotions, or a mix of all three? In this chapter, you look at each type of media to understand the pros and cons of each. You also see how to put together a strategy that fits your specific needs. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 385 Understanding Types of Media The notion of paid, owned, and earned media has been the accepted model for several years. In 2014, Mashable reported on a new version of the model in the article, “Why PR is embracing the PESO Model” (http://mashable.com/2014/12/05/ public-relations-industry/) as shown in Figure 1-1. FIGURE 1-1: The PESO model. The article discusses the PESO model (Paid, Earned, Shared, Owned) suggested by Gini Dietrich, founder of the nontraditional PR firm Arment Dietrich (http://spin sucks.com). The PESO model blog post (http://spinsucks.com/communication/ pr-pros-must-embrace-the-peso-model/) adds shared media to the traditional mix of earned, owned, and paid. Previously, the media model didn’t specifically segment out shared media but instead included it as part of earned media. It’s now segmented as a separate media type because of its importance to the mix. When you break out shared media from earned media, you can evaluate how you will specifically deal with your shared media strategy. Shared media is not under your control, whereas earned media can be influenced by your relationships with traditional PR sources such as influencers and publishers. 386 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Reviewing each media type To help you understand the PESO model, each of the four media types are »» Paid media: This type of media refers to the advertising promotions that you pay for. When choosing these options, you need a budget and a conviction that you will get a return on the money you spend. Examples: Facebook Ads, promoted tweets, traditional and native advertising, print ads, paid search, mobile ads, app ads, and Amazon ads »» Earned media: This is the media that you get when other sources recognize and promote your content for you. Your brand or your content is deemed valuable and is showcased in some way or reshared. Examples: Influencer reviews, traditional PR, and media relations »» Shared media: This refers to the shares you get from others on the various social media platforms. Examples: Shares on Facebook, Twitter, Google+, Tumblr, and others »» Owned media: This type of media is controlled by you and is becoming more Examples: Website, blogs, emails, micro sites, apps, collateral, user-generated content With shared media, you’re part of the conversation without having to specifically buy your way in. That’s a great place to be. Control is a big factor when choosing the media you want to use. When you have a major campaign coming up, you want to know to what extent you can impact the outcome. Table 1-1 shows the amount of control you have over each type of media and the audience target. When making decisions, be aware of these factors. TABLE 1-1 Attributes of Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media Type Control of Distribution by Brand Audience Targeted Paid Medium to high Potential customers Earned Low Potential and current customers (fans) Shared Low Potential and current customers Owned High Current customers CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 387 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media and more important as time goes on. Determining your needs So how do you determine how much of each media type you should use? You have to strike a careful balance, and this is a question you should frequently revisit. You don’t want to spend on ads when your content is effectively being shared organically. Revisions to the mix depend on »» How well your current mix is doing. Are you satisfied with the recognition and traffic you’re getting? If not, you need to take action. But even if you are satisfied, you should plan to check back monthly (or weekly, if you see significant changes) to see whether you’re still satisfied with your results. »» How often you launch promotions. If you frequently launch new campaigns for your products or services, you’ll want to prepare special targeted campaigns to get the word out. These could include emails or mini sites. After you’ve launched a timed campaign, don’t let it sit online past its prime. Make sure you’ve assigned someone the job of monitoring the promotion site. When the promotion is over, revise the site to send visitors to something new. You never know when someone will find the link and go there. Disappointing a new visitor is lazy marketing and bad for your brand. Ending up at dead campaign links annoys peopleor makes them feel forgotten. Don’t be guilty of ignoring old links. You’re wasting the effort and money you put into getting someone to notice your brand. »» How and where you want your customers to encounter you in their daily online travels. If you’re targeting customers on a particular platform, you need to buy the ads that will reach that specific audience. It can be money well spent. It will also feed your organic traffic. If you’re unsure whether your audience is on that platform, you’ll want to test first. Don’t guess. Utilizing Paid Media Of all the categories in the PESO model, paid media is the easiest to understand. It includes traditional advertising such as paid search as well as forms of advertising such as retargeting and native advertising. Discovering retargeting Over the last few years, banner advertising has had a bumpy ride. Because of the constant barrage of these ads, online customers developed what is known as banner blindness (also know as ad fatigue), the ability of users to ignore (subconsciously or otherwise) banner ads on websites. 388 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions For this reason, companies had to figure out how to make their ads visible again. Enter retargeting. You’ve probably heard the term retargeting but may not be sure what it’s about. Retargeting refers to the ad tactic that allows a brand to anonymously place a bit of code (called a pixel) on a user’s site when she clicks items on her website but doesn’t buy. Then when the user is browsing around the web and hits one of the ad servers purchased by the marketer, the product is displayed again. This gives the marketer “a second bite at the apple.” The marketer is paying to offer the customer another chance to buy its product. This tactic has proven to be very effective. One obvious reason is that you’re showing people things they expressed an interest in. Suddenly you’re not an anonymous advertiser but rather someone showing them an item that got their attention. Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media Retargeting also works well to retrieve abandoned carts on your websites. According to JeremySaid.com (http://www.jeremysaid.com/turn-shopping-cartabandonment-secret-weapon-creating-sales/) up to 72 percent of visitors may return to purchase something within 12–24 hours. By sending an email that is triggered by an abandoned cart, you can significantly increase your sales. Figure 1-2 shows an example of a retargeted ad in a Facebook feed. FIGURE 1-2: A retargeted ad. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 389 According to AdRoll’s 2015 “State of the Industry” report, more than 90 percent of marketers say that retargeting converts better than search, email, and display advertising. Dealing with native advertising Another method marketers use to overcome banner blindness is native advertising (NA). NA refers to advertising that is made to match the editorial content on its respective platform. A 2018 article from Ingnite Visibility, (https://ignite visibility.com/native-advertising-why-it-is-the-next-big-thing-formarketing), found that 70% of individuals prefer learning about products through content rather than traditional advertising. NA is often more effective because the reader can learn something from the ad they’re reading, so it doesn’t feel like an ad. Native advertising has raised the hackles of journalists who feel that this practice can be deceptive. Readers, on the other hand, haven’t voiced a major concern and these ads are performing well. Both sides of the controversy have their defenders. Some journalists feel that readers won’t recognize the content as an ad. Publishers say that as long as the ad says “sponsored” or “advertisement,” no confusion should ensue. You have to decide for yourself whether this type of media should be included in your ad buy. Considering programmatic buying The ability to make ad decisions in real time is another important development for advertisers. It’s called programmatic buying (PG) and allows brands to send ads to their potential customers via such things as emails or mobile phone numbers based on their current website behavior. The use of PG requires that brands put automated functions in place on their owned channels. The customer data that’s collected triggers the buying of specific ads that are directly responsive to users’ behaviors. This is different from realtime bidding (RTB), which is associated with inexpensive inventory. Proponents of programmatic buying emphasize that their ads are linked to quality interactions from buyers. This type of paid advertising has several benefits, which include the following: »» Ads can be seen across the consumer’s devices — mobile devices as well as laptops. They don’t have to be in one place. »» Advertisers have greater control over what their customers see, and when. They don’t have to wait until the customer triggers the ad online. 390 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions »» Real-time customer interactions can be measured to provide valuable insights and help advertisers make predictive decisions. »» This type of advertising replaces the tediousness of making individual buying decisions manually. Here’s a great example: PG was used by the Amanda Foundation, a pet rescue organization that partnered with ad agency Saatchi and Saatchi to help people find the right pet waiting for them at the shelter (https://adage.com/article/ digital/saatchi-launches-pet-matching-effort-nonprofit-group/ 301106/). By targeting its location data and browsing behavior, the campaign was able to help people find the real-life pet that was right for them. Programmatic buying continues to evolve, so do your homework. Knowing your budget is not the only thing you need to concern yourself with when you’re spending money to advertise. Because of all the decisions you have to make, you want to make sure that you have all the facts about the platform on which your ad will be placed. Here are some items you want to consider when making choices: »» Demographics: Who is the audience that receives these native ads? How do the platform owners slice and dice their measures? »» Geographics: What kind of geographical information does the native advertising platform collect and how granular can it get? »» Reporting functions: What and when are analytics available to you? Can you get custom reports? »» Creative materials necessary: What do you need to supply your advertising platform, and in what time frame? »» Special sauce: What does this platform offer that you can’t get elsewhere? Championing Earned Media Earned media is prized because it gives you the boost that you hoped for when you planned your content. You and your team dreamed of hitting the front pages of digital magazines and the local news with the content you carefully crafted. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 391 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media Finding out what you need to know from advertisers Unfortunately, in today’s crowded market, garnering headlines takes a lot more effort. Want to capture the media’s attention for your content? According to the Statistic Brain Research Institute website, the average human’s attention span in is 8.25 seconds. The average goldfish’s attention span is nine seconds. That’s why your job is so hard. In Book 6, you delve into the role of influencers who are crucial to making your earned media campaign a success. In this section, you look at the role that journalists play in spreading your message. Several groups have suggested that hiring a journalist to work on your content marketing efforts is a good idea. Journalists know the lay of the land and are familiar with what will get you the right kind of attention. So how do you reach out directly if you want to make contact with journalists who cover your subject? Several tools can make this outreach easier: HOW MUCH DOES YOUR CEO MAKE? One the best examples of earned media is Gravity Payments (http://gravitypay ments.com/), a credit card payment company. Dan Price, then 30, CEO of Gravity Payments, announced in April of 2015 that he was going to take a pay cut and raise the lowest salary in his company to $70,000 over a three-year period. He decided to sacrifice his own million-dollar salary to improve the lives of people in his company. He read that people who had a baseline salary of $70,000 would be able to lead fulfilling lives without having to worry about paying their bills. After this announcement, Dan was featured on multiple news shows, and articles about him appeared in all the major media outlets, including the New York Times and Money magazine. Social media was ablaze with information. He was thrust into the spotlight and hailed as a hero. His company got more publicity in one day than it did in all ten years of its existence. His plan was to do something worthwhile for his employees rather than get free publicity. However, he got both, because overnight Gravity Payments became a company that cared about its employees and, by extension, their customers. Even if your company can’t make such a generous contribution, it’s worth the effort to look at how you can contribute to the improvement of your community. See updates about the effect of Price’s efforts at https://gravitypayments.com/dan-price/. 392 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions »» Help a Reporter Out (HARO) (http://www.helpareporter.com): This service was started as a small business by Peter Shankman and is now owned by Cision, a leading global media intelligence company. It helps reporters find sources for their stories and helps marketers find journalists who want to write about them. »» Media Kitty, now called Kiti (https://thekiti.com/): This service lets journalists and marketers contact each other via the online platform. You can access the journalist database or connect with reporters who have a specific story they’re researching. »» Muck Rack (http://muckrack.com/): This service keeps you in touch with the stories that reporters are interested in, and much more. You can sign up as a marketer and get in touch with journalists who are interested in your specific topic. You’d be hard pressed to find an online business today that doesn’t try to make the most of its social media efforts. Whether it succeeds is another question. Businesses know that shared media is low cost and packs a powerful punch. You’ve heard that friends and other customers make up the most powerful and credible sales force for any product. But are you maximizing the effects of shared media? Some marketers focus their attention solely on shared media. You could be making a big mistake if you do that, however. Why? Isn’t social media sharing the best way to reach new customers? Yes, but not having a balanced mix puts your media plan in jeopardy. The problem with focusing all your attention on social media is that the platform your content is on is “rented,” so to speak. That is, you don’t own the land on which your content is sitting. The community you have built is not really your own. If one of those social platforms decided to limit the amount of content you can share about a specific topic, you’d be hard pressed to get that platform to reverse its decision. It cares about its business model, not yours. In addition, the attention given to content on social platforms is unpredictable. If you want to participate in a topic that’s trending, social platforms are the best place. If you want to develop in-depth content, be sure to balance your mix. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 393 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media Enhancing Shared Media Amplifying Owned Media As the creator and distributor of your content, you’re free to publish as much and as often as you like. You don’t have to worry that Facebook or Twitter will change their policies and wipe out your best content. Owned media is becoming ever more important because of the control it provides the marketer. Owned media is not free media. You have to budget for the creation and development of it. So when you’re planning your media mix, bear in mind that it may cost as much to create it as it does to use paid media with something you can repurpose. Looking at the role of press releases You most likely believe that press releases are past their prime. But think again. Press releases have a place in your current media strategy. Just don’t consider them strictly owned media. Press releases have evolved along with all the other practices that marketers utilize. In addition, Google has changed its algorithm with regard to the value of press releases for SEO, so the game has changed. Throwing a bunch of keywords into the release doesn’t gain you any additional page rank. The dissemination of press releases is under your control, so that is partly why earned media is in the mix. But you also need to look at how press releases are received by customers. In today’s marketplace, a press release should be considered more of a paid advertorial. This means that people will consider the content of your release to be sponsored material. You can improve the value of your press release in three ways: »» If your press release is picked up by a major outlet like Forbes, link that on your website to drive traffic. »» In the press release, insert a call to action (CTA) to a landing page that has clear value to your customers (such as a free trial). »» In the press release, link to a piece of content on your site that has already garnered great publicity so that even more people can find it. The downside to press releases is that it’s difficult to determine the return on investment (ROI). In case you’re wondering what would be an effective topic for a press release today, these topics still carry enough weight to make it worth your while: 394 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions »» Significant financial news about your company »» A major shift in business model »» Corporate giving to charities »» A new product announcement »» Additions in staff and promotions Spreading the message Owned media refers to all the content online that you create and control. It includes your website, landing pages, podcasts, videos, and email, for example. For this reason, you can be as creative as you think is appropriate for your audience. It has the added benefit of letting you frame the context for your media. You can send an email that has the right personalized message or create an out-of-the box media piece that will get wide attention. 05/06/how-the-big-marketing-activity-coloring-book-fueled-marketosinsanely-lucrative-lead-gen-machine/). It recounts how Marketo (http:// marketo.com), a marketing software company, created a piece of content that generated more than $500,000. What was this marketing masterpiece? It’s a 30-page coloring book called “The Big Marketing Activity Coloring Book” (http://www. marketo.com/ebooks/the-big-marketing-activity-coloring-book), shown in Figure 1-3. At first blush the idea sounds a bit crazy. Do professional marketers want to spend time coloring and filling in puzzles? Perhaps. What is clear is they wanted to download and see the inventive marketing piece. The ebook was entertaining and educational. It was a creative break from the norm and garnered a great deal of attention. Most important is that when they go to the link, potential customers can see a demo, get a free trial, or contact the company. That’s a big win! The coloring book idea is inventive and fun. Couldn’t your company come up with a content piece that is fun and inviting? The landing page isn’t costly or difficult to construct. It just requires you to think about luring your visitors to a page that entertains and sells. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 395 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media One of the truly inspired examples of owned media was detailed by Contently in a blog post written by Aaron Taube (http://contently.com/strategist/2015/ FIGURE 1-3: Marketo’s Big Marketing Activity Coloring Book. Creating a Framework for Achieving the Right Mix Unfortunately, you have no sure-fire way to guarantee that your content will be seen and shared, so it becomes even more necessary to leverage paid, earned, shared, and owned tactics. The strategy of bringing the four types of media together is called converged media, a term coined by the research company Prophet/ Altimeter Group (https://www.prophet.com/altimeter/about/). Are you curious to know how other companies divide their spending? According to the Econsultancy Marketing Budgets Report, marketers are dividing their budgets as follows: »» Paid media: 39 percent »» Owned media: 35 percent »» Earned media (includes shared): 26 percent Are you surprised to see that paid media is leading the list? Don’t be. With all the new tools, such as native advertising and retargeting, marketers are spending 396 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions more on new technology to solve advertising problems. Also note that owned media is next. Both types give more control to the marketer. Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media The framework shown in Figure 1-4 and described in the following sections illustrates one way to think about putting a converged strategy together. You can use this framework as the catalyst for your own custom plan. Be aware that because of the cyclical nature of media, you won’t be able to assess each type in a vacuum. The ability to use the data you collect at each stage will improve the ongoing decisions you make. This section gives you one way to think about how this media can work together. FIGURE 1-4: Diagram of a framework for finding the right balance. Section 1: Owned channels Begin your plan in the upper-right section of the cycle called Owned Channels (refer to Figure 1-4). Remember that this includes both your original and curated content on the channels you own. Starting here to develop your strategy makes the most sense because it is controlled by you. These are your company’s assets, and improving the way you develop and distribute them can only make them more valuable. Some questions to ask: »» Do you know what topics your audience wants to learn about? »» Have you done an evaluation of the content you have so that you know what you can repurpose? CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 397 »» Do you have the people and technology in place to get your content out quickly? Owned content is the foundation of your strategy. Give careful consideration to how much of your budget to dedicate to this part of your strategy, because owned content is what gives your brand visibility. Don’t skimp on this. It’s the raw material you need to get results. Section 2: Shared media In Section 2 (refer to Figure 1-4), you need to look at the traction you’ve gained from the content you published. Some questions to ask: »» How much content was shared on all your social platforms? »» Did some topics resonate better than others? »» Did some formats get people’s attention? Shared media gives you an indication of what resonates with your current audience. Is your fan base sharing your content in large numbers? Use the information about how your content is being shared as a barometer to determine how your relationship with customers is faring. In this section, you see the traction you got from news outlets, influencers, and other high-value attention for your content. You evaluate the content you created and curated and determine what has garnered the most attention. The caveat here is that depending on how large your audience is, you may not have received the attention you expected. Section 3: Paid ads Based on the response you received to your new content, you need to decide what to promote, and which advertising methods to use. These methods can include such things as Facebook Ads or promoted tweets. Using this method at this stage helps you to leverage advertising to gain visibility for your content. Some questions to ask: »» Do you know how much you can spend on several pilot experiments to test what works best? »» Should you consider native advertising? 398 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Section 4: Earned media After you’ve paid to get your brand story out there into the world, you can push the story even further by connecting with influencers and others who might be interested in your content. Some questions to ask: »» Have you identified several influencers to whom you can reach out when you have content you want to promote? Do you have media relationships that you have developed over time? Section 5: Evaluate and revise In Section 5, you evaluate the results of your PESO strategy and make plans to revise your mix. You should alter your strategy to incorporate what you’ve learned in the first complete cycle. This is the time to consider whether you’re clear about your goals and perhaps revise them to incorporate what you’ve learned. As suggested in the preceding plan, many marketers are starting to see better results when they focus more directly on getting the content out into the world rather than just creating more and more content. If no one sees it, your efforts are wasted. You might mistakenly believe that your content doesn’t have value, when in reality, it just wasn’t seen by enough people to have an impact. CHAPTER 1 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media 399 Identifying Paid, Earned, Shared, and Owned Media Ask whether you have selected the metrics you will use to determine whether your efforts are successful. IN THIS CHAPTER »» Focusing on search marketing fundamentals »» Analyzing search queries »» Optimizing for search traffic on popular sites »» Attracting robots »» Earning links to your web pages Chapter 2 Using Search Marketing N o discipline in digital marketing has evolved over the years quite as dramatically as search marketing. In the early days of the Internet, search engines like Alta Vista, Lycos, and Yahoo! were fairly unsophisticated. Search marketers who understood the simple factors these sites used to rank websites could drive search engine traffic to a page regardless of its quality. Today, search engines like Google consider hundreds of factors in deciding which web page to display for a search. In the current search marketing landscape, the best web pages usually win. Sure, loopholes still exist, exploited by less-thanreputable search marketers, but the scales have tipped toward those who play by the rules. In this chapter, you discover those rules and put yourself in a great position to receive traffic from the billions of searches that take place each day. Search isn’t limited to big search engines like Google and Bing. Social media sites such as Facebook and Pinterest also have search capabilities. Also, Amazon, iTunes, TripAdvisor, and thousands of other sites provide search to their users. Depending on your business, it can be more valuable to understand how search operates on YouTube or Amazon than on Google or Bing. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 401 Knowing the Three Key Players in Search Marketing Three main players make up the search marketing landscape, each with a different motivation. Understanding who the players are and what they want gives you a better understanding of how to make search marketing work for your business. The important players in search marketing are »» Searchers: People who type search queries into search engines »» Search engines: Programs that searchers use to find products, services, content, and more on the Internet »» Marketers: The owners or managers of websites and other channels that publish content and make offers to people on the Internet As a marketer and business owner, you want to maximize the amount of traffic, leads, and sales you get from search marketing. To do this, you must give searchers and search engines what they want. Understanding searchers’ needs The key for both marketers and search engines is understanding the mindset of searchers. By understanding what motivates searchers, marketers and search engines can serve them better. People use search engines every day for everything from researching a school project to looking for reviews for a big-ticket purchase like a car or home. What motivates searchers is simple: They want to find the most relevant, highestquality web pages about anything and everything they’re searching for, and they want to find those pages now. If marketers and search engines can satisfy searchers, everyone wins. Searchers find what they want; marketers get traffic, leads, and sales; and search engines gain users. Knowing what search engines want A search engine company, such as Google, is a business, and like any other business, it must generate revenue to survive. As a result, it’s useful to understand how search engines generate that revenue. If you understand what motivates the search engine, you can plan your search strategy accordingly. 402 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Most search engines generate most of their revenue by selling advertising. Figure 2-1 shows a typical set of advertisements in a Google search results page. FIGURE 2-1: Google displays ads at the top and in the topright corners of search result pages. Source: www.google.com As a result, it’s in a search engine’s best interest to serve the best, most popular, most relevant content to searchers. Failure to deliver what searchers want sends those searchers elsewhere to find what they’re looking for, which means less opportunity to show ads, which reduces its ability to ask for high advertising rates. If you want to build a successful search marketing campaign, you need to stay within the borders of each search engine’s terms of service. Search marketing tactics that ­violate those terms of service are called black hat; those that play within the rules are called white hat. Black hat search marketing tactics are not only unethical (and sometimes illegal), but also bad for business. Violating the terms of a search engine may create short-term results, but those results won’t be sustainable. Search engines like Google continuously update the algorithms they use to rank websites in an effort to squash black hat methods such as link buying and keyword stuffing. Marketers who use white-hat search marketing strategies — those who follow the search engine’s terms of service and build a better user experience for searchers — are rewarded with higher rankings and more traffic, leads, and sales from search engines. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 403 Using Search Marketing BLACK HATS AND WHITE HATS Other search engines generate revenue by establishing affiliate relationships with the businesses to which they refer traffic. When a searcher visits one of these affiliate partners and makes a purchase, the search engine makes a commission on that sale. Targeting Search Queries One way that people discover your business, brands, products, and services is by using search queries typed in search engines. A searcher navigates to a search engine, types a keyword or phrase, and taps or clicks a search button, and the search engine returns popular, relevant results. The searcher clicks or taps one of those results, and he’s off to the races. To help make your brand discoverable and available to a searcher, marketers have two broad categories of search queries to keep in mind: »» Branded queries: Keywords or keyword phrases that searchers type in search engines when they’re looking for a specific business, brand, product, or service. The search query “Southwest Airlines,” for example, is a branded query that Southwest Airlines should target. »» Nonbranded queries: Keywords or keyword phrases that searchers type in to search engines when they’re not looking for a specific business, brand, product, or service. The search query “fly to Chicago,” for example, is a nonbranded query that Southwest Airlines should target. By understanding the preceding two categories, marketers can target keywords or keyword phrases to help make their brand discoverable and available to searchers. Suppose that a searcher is looking for a bed-and-breakfast inn, and she types the search query “historic bed and breakfast near me” in Google (see Figure 2-2). This query is a nonbranded search query. The searcher isn’t looking for a ­particular bed-and-breakfast; she’s simply researching and discovering historic bed-andbreakfasts nearby. On the other hand, the searcher might be searching for a specific bed-andbreakfast, such as Austin’s Inn at Pearl Street, in which case she types a query such as “reviews of Austin’s Inn at Pearl Street.” This query is a branded search query (see Figure 2-3). 404 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions FIGURE 2-2: Using Search Marketing A discoverable search query for local bed-andbreakfast inns. FIGURE 2-3: A branded search query for Austin’s Inn at Pearl Street. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 405 Defining a search query Each of the billions of search queries entered in search engines each day contain the intent and context of an individual searcher. Intent, as it relates to search marketing, involves understanding what the searcher is looking for. The context of the query is made up of the reason why the searcher has that intent. In other words, intent is the “what” of a search query, and context is the “why.” Following are examples of intent and context of three people who might be searching the Internet: »» Person 1: I want to start a vegetable garden because I want to add organic food to my diet. • • Intent: Want to start a vegetable garden. Context: Add organic food to my diet. »» Person 2: I want to start a vegetable garden because I want to spend more time outdoors. • • Intent: Want to start a vegetable garden. Context: Spend more time outdoors. »» Person 3: I want to start a vegetable garden because I want to save money on grocery bills. • • Intent: Want to start a vegetable garden. Context: Save money on groceries. Each searcher in these examples has the same intent: start a vegetable garden. But each person has a slightly different reason for wanting to start that vegetable garden. In other words, the context behind the intent is different in each case. A search marketer should focus on satisfying both the intent and context of searchers. Each intent and context represents a query worth targeting. In the preceding examples, searchers might type any of the following queries in a search engine: »» “start a vegetable garden” (intent only) »» “add organic food to my diet” (context only) »» “start an organic vegetable garden” (intent and context) A business that sells vegetable gardening products or services would do well to target all these keywords based on the intent and context of its ideal customer. 406 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Choosing the right queries to target Each query typed in a search engine contains the searcher’s intent and context, or both. To determine the intent and context that your ideal customer is typing in search engines, you need to do keyword research, using tools such as Google AdWords Keyword Planner (https://adwords.google.com/KeywordPlanner). Coming up with keywords the “old-fashioned” way Before you start using keyword tools, one of the best ways to do keyword research is to brainstorm ideas with anyone who comes into contact with your customers. After all, you know your customers’ wants, needs, and pain points better than a keyword tool does. Gather the appropriate members of your team to answer questions about your customers. This will help you come up with relevant and specific keywords and keyword phrases to research with a keywords tool. After you have completed the brainstorming phase, move on to your respective keyword tool to see what keywords and phrases will work best for your search marketing campaign. To help with your brainstorming, answer questions like these in the subsequent example. Following are examples of how online shoe retailer Zappos might answer questions to sell shoes to people who plan to run a marathon: »» Q: What is our ideal customer researching before he buys our product or service? A: The ideal diet for a marathon runner. »» Q: What is our ideal customer interested in that’s related to our product or service? »» Q: What barriers does our ideal customer need to overcome before she buys our product or service? A: Finding time to train for a marathon. »» Q: What does our ideal customer hope to accomplish with our product or service? A: Running a marathon. »» Q: What information does our ideal customer need to evaluate our product or service against our competitors’ products or services? A: Compare the weight of Nike and Adidas running shoes to train for a marathon. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 407 Using Search Marketing A: Treating sore leg muscles. »» Q: What information does our customer need to buy our product or service? A: The shoe-return policy. Using keyword research tools After brainstorming, you move on to your chosen keyword research tool. Dozens of good keyword research tools are available for purchase, but the free Google AdWords Keyword Planner (https://adwords.google.com/KeywordPlanner) meets the needs of most search marketers. Google provides this free tool to allow advertisers to research the behavior of searchers who use its search engine. Advertisers use the information provided by this tool to choose keywords they bid on. The Keyword Planning tool is free, but you need to sign up for an Adwords account to use it. Typing a keyword phrase like “run a marathon” in the Keyword Planner tool (see Figure 2-4) returns several keywords to target: »» “running event” »» “marathon runner” »» “marathon tips” FIGURE 2-4: Planning keywords with Google AdWords Keyword Planner. Source: https://adwords.google.com/ko/KeywordPlanner/Home?_c=7275033004&_ u=6764193964&authuser=0&_o=cues#search 408 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions The Google AdWords Keyword Planner gives you the following information about each query: »» Average monthly searchers: The average number of times people have searched for this exact keyword based on the date range and targeting settings that you selected. »» Competition: The number of advertisers bidding on this keyword or keyword phrase for a paid traffic campaign (turn to Book 5, Chapter 1 for information about paid traffic). In the Competition column, you can see whether the competition for a keyword idea is low, medium, or high. Don’t be discouraged if you research keywords and find that the Google AdWords Keyword Planner has no information to report. The main reason to use this tool is to research keywords to target on Google’s advertising platform. Keywords that may be absolutely relevant to your business, and thus good keywords to target, may not appear in this tool, particularly for branded queries such as the names of your products, services, or brands. Satisfying searchers Much like bloodhounds on a hunt, people often search the web until they satisfy their intent, context, or both. To compete for a search query, a marketer needs to create a web page or asset that satisfies the searcher’s query. That web page or asset could be anything from a blog post to a product demonstration video. Other assets you might create to satisfy the intent of a searcher include podcasts, videos, and social media updates. The web page or asset needs to be discoverable by the search engine that the marketer is targeting. The Pinterest search engine, for example, discovers new Pinterest pins added to your Pinterest boards, and the Google search engine discovers new web pages and blog posts added to your website (assuming that you haven’t created any technical barriers for the search engine). You find more about technical barriers in the “Optimizing for search engine robots” section, later in this chapter. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 409 Using Search Marketing The web page shown in Figure 2-5 satisfies the intent of any searcher who enters the query “mojito recipe” in the Google search engine, and the web page shown in Figure 2-6 satisfies the intent of a searcher who enters the query “buy canon eos 70d” in the Amazon search engine. FIGURE 2-5: Allrecipes. com satisfies a ­searcher’s intent for a mojito recipe. Source: http://allrecipes.com/recipe/147363/the-real-mojito/ FIGURE 2-6: A search query in Amazon satisfies a search for the Canon EOS 70D. Source: https://www.amazon.com/s/ref=nb_sb_noss?url=search-alias%3Daps&field- keywords=buy+canon+eos+70d If the web page or asset you create satisfies the intent, context, or both of a searcher, it has a chance to be shown to that searcher. That said, many factors determine which web pages and assets are shown for any given query. The following sections go into more detail about these factors and how to optimize your assets so that they’re more likely to appear in front of your ideal searcher. 410 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions CONVERTING PROSPECTS TO CUSTOMERS Don’t fall into the trap of thinking that the goal of your search marketing is to get better rankings in search engines. Also, don’t make the mistake of thinking that search marketing is just about getting traffic. The goal of search marketing, as with all marketing, is to move your customer from one stage of the customer journey to the next. For every searcher who visits your blog, YouTube channel, or Pinterest home page, you need to provide a call to action to take the next step. Suppose that a searcher types a query indicating that he’s looking for a demonstration of your product. He lands on your product page and finds a product-demonstration video. Great job! You anticipated the intent of your ideal customer and created a page that satisfies that intent on an appropriate channel. Don’t squander this visit by failing to make a call to action to the next logical step in the buyer journey. In this case, the appropriate next step is to buy the product. Failing to make a clear call to action to this logical next step isn’t just bad marketing but also a bad user experience. This person is looking for a demonstration of your product, which means he may also be looking to buy it. Provide a call to action that will help to move him to the next step in his customer journey with you. After you’ve built a web page or asset that targets a specific intent, context, or both, you need to determine where that asset will “live.” The various places you can house your web pages or assets are channels. Starting with a searcher’s intent and context helps you determine the correct channel to use to deliver the web page or asset. If you want to satisfy searchers with the intent of understanding how your product works, for example, you might create a product-demonstration video, so it would make sense to choose YouTube as the channel for this asset. In this section, you find strategies to use in optimizing your assets for several popular channels. You may have the urge to overfill your pages with your chosen keywords (called keyword stuffing) to make sure they’re noticed by search engines. Don’t do this. Search engine providers have built-in algorithms to penalize you for it. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 411 Using Search Marketing Optimizing Your Assets for Specific Channels Optimizing for Google Your website is a channel that can get traffic from search engines such as Google. This section lays out the steps for optimizing a web page for Google. Step 1: Write the <title> tag The <title> tag is the most critical search ranking element on any web page. This tag is displayed on search engine results pages and is meant to be an accurate and concise description of a page’s content, telling search engines and searchers what the page is about. The <title> tag appears in blue on search engine results pages and is the link that users click to access the related content (see Figure 2-7). FIGURE 2-7: Examples of <title> tags. Keywords are essential for <title> tags, so start those tags with your most important keywords for that page. Using the keywords you’ve chosen for the page you’re optimizing, create a title for your piece that’s no more than 70 characters long; otherwise, the search engine may truncate it. The <title> tag should read well because it’s displayed prominently on the search results page. Step 2: Write a meta description The meta description, often displayed directly below the <title> tag, further describes the content of the page. Typically, searched keywords appear in boldface in the meta description. Although search engines don’t use your meta descriptions to determine your ranking for a search query, searchers read these descriptions to determine whether they want to click your results. 412 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions The meta description is the elevator pitch for your page, so make it compelling. Include words that describe the content of the page in a way that entices searchers to click your result. Keep your meta description shorter than 150 characters; otherwise, it’s likely to be truncated on the search result page. Consider using a call to action in your meta description, such as “Shop now!,” “Click here for free shipping,” or “Browse the latest trends.” Figure 2-8 shows some examples of meta descriptions. FIGURE 2-8: Examples of meta descriptions. A URL (Uniform Resource Locator) describes a site or page to visitors and search engines, so it’s important to keep the URL relevant and accurate so that the content ranks well. A URL (also referred to as a slug) is set up like this: www.YourSiteNameHere.com/keywords-that-describe-this-page Include your keywords in the URL after the forward slash (/). Search engines use the keywords in this section of the URL to further determine what the page is about and where it should rank. Although the keywords in your URL don’t play as big of a role in your search rankings as your title tag does, keywords are still important elements to optimize. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 413 Using Search Marketing Step 3: Optimize the URL Step 4: Write body copy Text on a page, also called content or copy, gives the search engine information about what search queries your page will satisfy, so it’s important for every page on your site to have text. Having content on a web page is also very helpful in getting the page to rank in search. Aim for 500 words or more on each page, but don’t fill your web pages with low-quality content just to get words on the page. On video- or image-heavy pages, of course, you may have very few words on a page, and that’s okay. Always err on the side of satisfying the intent of searchers by giving them enough information to make sense of the page. Throughout the body, use relevant keywords or keyword phrases that describe the page. Include your keywords and variations on those keywords in the body titles or headings. In short, use the keywords you’re targeting and variations on those keywords anywhere it seems natural to do so. Step 5: Optimize the <alt> tag The <alt> tag provides alternative information for an image on your page, in the form of text, for users who can’t view the image (because of a slow Internet connection or an image error, for example). In the <alt> tag, describe the image while using the keyword phrase you’ve chosen for your piece. Optimizing for YouTube YouTube is a search engine and, therefore, is interested in keeping searchers within its network so that it can show those searchers ads. As a result, YouTube sends traffic to videos that are keeping YouTube visitors engaged on its site. Here’s how to get more search traffic to your videos on YouTube. Step 1: Create engaging thumbnails The YouTube search engine measures how many people see your video in their search results against the number who play your video. If your videos get played often, YouTube rewards them with higher rankings. The most important factor in increasing the number of plays that a video gets is the video thumbnail, which is the image searchers see for the video (see Figure 2-9) in the YouTube search results. A compelling thumbnail can have a big effect on your click-through rate and, thus, your rankings in YouTube. 414 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions FIGURE 2-9: Each video image is a thumbnail. Source: https://www.youtube.com/ To engage your audience, make sure that your thumbnails are bright, vibrant, and crisp. Include compelling text for each thumbnail to tell viewers about the content and to entice them to click or tap it. If you don’t have a graphic designer, you can create professional-looking thumbnails with a tool called Canva (https://www.canva.com/). This tool offers many free and paid templates you can use. Also, you can import your own images into Canva to create thumbnails that set your videos apart. YouTube’s goal is to keep searchers within the confines of YouTube so that it can show ads to those searchers. The number of shares, views, and comments your videos receive indicates to YouTube how well your videos are keeping searchers engaged. In addition, a video with lots of views, more likes than dislikes, and favorable comments proves to new viewers the quality of the content. Good quality leads to more likes and shares. In the description and in the video itself, be sure to ask viewers to like, comment, share, and check out more of your videos. Step 3: Optimize content for keywords Like your website, your YouTube videos need to be optimized for keywords. Make sure you include the keyword(s) or keyword phrase(s) in the video’s title, the description, the tags, the filename of the video file you upload, and the video you CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 415 Using Search Marketing Step 2: Ask for engagement create. This practice helps users find your video and improves your rankings and relevancy on the YouTube platform. To gain more insight into your score, as well as other metrics, you can use a tool like vidIQ (http://vidiq.com/) to track and manage your channel. Step 4: Look at retention How long people watch your video is known as audience retention, which is an important metric to measure. The YouTube reporting suite allows you to view retention metrics, as shown in Figure 2-10. FIGURE 2-10: Examining video retention in YouTube. Source: https://www.youtube.com/analytics?o=U#r=retention It’s normal for a video to gradually lose viewers; not everyone watches a video the whole way through. That said, pay attention to audience retention on outlier videos that do very well or very poorly. Attempt to determine why some videos have high retention while others have trouble holding people’s attention. Then optimize and change your video content accordingly. 416 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Optimizing for Pinterest Believe it or not, Pinterest is a search engine. In fact, it’s an important search engine to understand if you sell physical products. Follow three steps to optimize search for your Pinterest channel. Step 1: Enhance your images Pinterest is all about the pictures. You want big, beautiful, crisp pictures to grab people’s attention. Next, include a text overlay on your image. The text overlay serves as the pin’s headline, providing context and further describing the pin. The size and shape of your images matter on Pinterest. The platform is vertically oriented, so make sure that the images you use are vertical with an aspect ratio of 2:3 to 1:3.5 and a minimum width of 600 pixels. You can use horizontal images for your pins, of course, but vertical images tend to do better. Pins with an aspect ratio greater than 1:3.5 are truncated. As mentioned in the YouTube section, you can use Canva (https://www.canva. com/) to craft engaging pins with professional images and eye-catching fonts. Step 2: Optimize board covers Pinterest pins are categorized and housed in boards. You can find your boards on your profile page. Like the images you use for your pins, your board covers should be optimized with engaging, professional pictures that have clear titles to further describe the board. Creativity is important in Pinterest, but avoid being cute, creative, or punny. The Pinterest search engine is less sophisticated than search engines such as Google, so your search results will improve if you use your target keywords verbatim when naming pins and boards and when adding descriptions. To discover the best keywords for your pin, board, or description, use the Pinterest platform to research your keywords, as follows: 1. 2. Type a keyword or keyword phrase in the Pinterest search engine. Make note of the suggested keywords Pinterest provides below the keyword. When you search in Pinterest, it gives prompts for keyword and keyword phrases related to what you’re searching for. This can be used to provide CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 417 Using Search Marketing Step 3: Target keywords inspiration for keywords and phrases to optimize for in Pinterest. See Figure 2-11 for an example of searching for “DIY ready projects” in the Pinterest platform. 3. Create new pins and boards for any relevant keywords suggested by Pinterest, and include these keywords in the descriptions of those pins and boards. FIGURE 2-11: An example of prompts ­Pinterest gives when searching the platform. Source: https://www.pinterest.com/ Optimizing for Amazon If you’re selling on Amazon, you need to understand how its search engine operates. To get a product page to rank on Amazon, follow these four steps. Step 1: Build sales with promotions and launches To Amazon, lots of sales in a short amount of time indicate that a product is hot and that it should be moved up in the search rankings. Use periodic promotions, sales, and launches to increase sales velocity, and watch your rankings soar. Step 2: Increase reviews Reviews are extremely important on the Amazon platform, and lots of positive reviews indicate to Amazon that your product should be moved up in the search rankings. Even if people love your product, they may not take the time to review it. Remind and encourage people who have bought your product to write a review 418 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions with tools such as Feedback Genius (https://www.sellerlabs.com/feedbackgenius/), which helps you message customers while staying within Amazon’s terms of use. Step 3: Create a compelling product name If you want people to click your product, you need to have a compelling product name. A cute or clever name may sound cool, but it can be vague, causing people to overlook it because they don’t know what the product is. To increase the click-through rate, make sure that your product’s name accurately describes what the product is and does. Look to your competitors for inspiration; see how they ­present their names on Amazon. People don’t buy products on Amazon; they buy pictures of products. Include as many clear, crisp product images as necessary to satisfy the needs of a prospective customer. When buying on Amazon, your buyer can’t hold your product in his hand or examine it, so you need to include quality pictures that demonstrate exactly what the buyer will get. The more expensive or complex the product, the more images you’re likely to need. Step 4: Create keyword-targeted product pages Your Amazon product page contains text, and every one of those words helps determine your rankings. Include the keyword or phrase you’re targeting in the title of the page and throughout the product description. Aim for a product description of 250 words or more. Don’t stuff the description with keywords, though, and keep user experience in mind. Favor quality over quantity. As with product images, the more expensive or complex a product is, the more detailed a product description you need. Podcasting is an effective and affordable way to distribute content on the Internet. If you’re podcasting, you need to understand how iTunes ranks podcasts so that you can get more exposure to iTunes users. Take three steps to improve your search rankings within iTunes. Step 1: Solicit reviews Positive reviews tell iTunes that your podcast is worthwhile and should be rewarded with high search rankings. To generate reviews, use the podcast itself to ask people to leave reviews. At least once per episode, have a call to action to remind people to review your podcast. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 419 Using Search Marketing Optimizing for iTunes Step 2: Create a clear title and a clean cover design You want a specific title and a sharp cover design not only to describe your podcast, but also to attract an audience. A cute title is likely to get lost or passed over because people won’t know what your show is about. Therefore, be precise in your title, and include keywords that improve your rankings and help searchers find you. In that same vein, include keywords within the episode’s title and description. Next, include a sleek cover design for your podcast — one that demonstrates the theme of your podcast but isn’t too busy. Keep in mind that your podcast cover is the size of a thumbnail. Keep the cover simple; otherwise, your message is likely to get lost. Step 3: Grow downloads Like reviews, the number of downloads your podcast receives indicates the quality of that podcast. As a result, download velocity has a direct effect on your search results in iTunes. Steady, consistent increases in downloads improve your rankings. To increase downloads as you launch your podcast, publish three to five episodes at the same time, because the more times you publish in the beginning, the more episodes people have access to and the more downloads you’re going to see as people subscribe. As you gain subscribers after the first couple of weeks, you can publish on a consistent date, such as one episode every Tuesday, to let your audience know when to expect your latest episode. Optimizing for review sites If you’re marketing a local business such as a restaurant, hotel, or retail store, you need to focus some of your search optimization efforts on review sites such as Yelp and TripAdvisor. Following are two steps to take to optimize for those sites. Step 1: Gain legitimate reviews You don’t want to “game” reviews; reviews that aren’t legitimate can result in backlash from both your customers and the review site. Instead, you want to encourage honest reviews by making sure that the customer experience is topnotch and deserving of a good review. That said, you can certainly encourage your customers to submit legitimate reviews with tools such as TripAdvisor’s Review Express. A second method is to 420 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions ask customers for their email addresses and for product or service reviews at the point of sale. Later, you can follow up with people and remind them to review by sending them an email, and you can entice people to review by offering giveaways or contests. After someone gives you a review, respond by thanking the person for his time and letting him know that he’s been heard. If someone gives you a negative review, respond to that person with empathy so that she knows that she’s been heard. Explain your side of the story, and if the review requires more attention, move it to a private channel such as email or phone. It’s best to handle customer-service issues outside public channels like review sites. On most review sites, review scores outweigh the number of reviews. Focus on getting fantastic reviews from satisfied customers. Sure, the sheer number of reviews you receive is important, but only if those reviews indicate that your customers are happy with your business. Step 2: Claim your profile If you’ve been in business for a while, you’re likely listed on virtually every review site, whether you know it or not. Visit the relevant review sites, and search for your business. Then claim your business (or start a profile if needed) on the review site by answering questions and performing verification checks that prove the business is yours. By claiming your business, you can manage your profile, make edits, and add information to your profile on the review site. Optimizing for search engine robots Search engine robots are programs that visit web pages and “crawl” or index the content on those pages. However, if barriers have been placed, the robot can’t crawl the page, so that page doesn’t get indexed or served to searchers. One of your search marketing goals should be to make it as easy as possible for search robots to access and index your pages. At this point, search marketing can become extremely technical. If your website is unintentionally creating barriers and “speed bumps” for search engines, you may need to involve a search engine optimization (SEO) professional who understands the technical side of search marketing. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 421 Using Search Marketing Fix any inaccuracies in your profile, and add information that current and potential customers may find helpful, such as hours of operation, location, contact information, and company history. Within the description, include keywords wherever it makes sense to do so, and use categorization appropriately to improve your search rankings within the review site platform. To determine whether your website has robot optimization issues, install Google Search Console (https://www.google.com/webmasters/tools/home) on your website. Google Search Console (formerly Google Webmaster Tools) is a free tool that allows you to see your website as the Google search engine sees it. You can view important technical information about search robots’ capability to index your website, including the following: »» Index status: The total number of URLs from your site that have been added to Google’s index. If your website has 100 pages, for example, you should see that number of pages in the index-status report. »» URL errors: Pages that Google is having difficulty accessing. Investigate the reasons why pages have errors, and repair them. »» Security issues: If your site contains malware, it will appear in the Google Search Console. A site with security issues is very unlikely to be served traffic by search engines like Google. Address malware issues immediately. Earning Links A search marketer must create a website that earns links from external sources. Links are the Internet equivalent of positive word of mouth about your business. For instance, if a personal finance blog links to the personal finance site Quicken. com, that link from the blog is saying that Quicken has quality content that the blogger considers trustworthy and relevant; it’s the Internet equivalent of a referral in the physical world. Pages with more links pointing to them generally get better search results than pages with fewer links. Links that point to a web page are considered to be votes for that page. Search engines take into account the volume and, more important, the quality of the links to a page to determine which pages to serve in their results for a particular keyword search query. The following sections discuss how to earn links by using search marketing tactics that stay within the search engine’s terms of service and avoid black hat tactics, as stated in the “Black hats and white hats” sidebar, earlier in this chapter. Step 1: Cross-link your own content The method of building links that’s most under your control is cross-linking on your own site. If a financial planning website publishes a blog post titled “Ten Mistakes to Avoid When Planning for Retirement,” it would make sense, for both 422 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions the reader and the search engine, to find a cross-link from this blog post to a page explaining the company’s retirement-planning services. Linking within your own website improves user experience and sends signals to search engines about what pages are important on your website. Cross-link to important pages on your website wherever and whenever it makes sense to do so, while keeping user experience in mind. Step 2: Study your competitors’ links The next step is doing some competitive research. Using a tool such as Link Explorer (https://moz.com/link-explorer), you can research your major competitors to see what sites are linking to them. Then reach out to those sites to see whether they’re interested in linking to your site as well. Step 3: Create generous content You can earn links by creating so-called generous content: content that mentions other people, especially influential people who could link back to you or share your content on their social networks. One way to create generous content is to write an article about a specific person or brand and then link to the appropriate site. This article may take the form of a biography or an interview. The bottom line is that to earn links to your website, you need to start giving out some “link love” of your own. Be generous with your website by quoting others and referring your visitors to pages you like. Make sure that you let people know when you link to them. Step 4: Create content worthy of a link Great content provides assets that people want to share with their network. ­Create outstanding content, particularly on your blog, that people link to because it provides tremendous value. For example, a bank that wants to attract prospective homebuyers might build a free and easy-to-use monthly mortgage calculator. If others find this tool useful, they will link to it and improve that bank website’s standing in the search engines. CHAPTER 2 Using Search Marketing 423 Using Search Marketing Another way to build generous content is to create a crowdsourced post that asks experts to write 100 words or so on the same topic and then links to each expert’s site. Step 5: Publish primary research One powerful way to generate links is to publish primary research: new research that you collected yourself. Because primary research can be difficult and timeconsuming to create, it’s valuable and rare. Solid primary research is in great demand and often leads to high-quality links as people cite that research on their web pages. Step 6: Keep up with the news The last step is creating newsworthy content and publishing it as the topic in question is trending. To do this effectively, keep an eye on industry news. One of the best ways to do that is to use social media, particularly Twitter, because ­Twitter tends to be the nervous system of the Internet. Be ready to produce content about your industry at a moment’s notice or find ­creative ways to relate trending, newsworthy topics to your industry. This is tough work, but being one of the first people to create content can have a big payoff: You’ll be one of only a few sources of information about something, causing other people to link to you as the story develops. But before you jump the gun, make sure that you can verify the news story or risk the embarrassment and damage to your reputation for publishing inaccurate information. 424 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions IN THIS CHAPTER »» Understanding why people share »» Getting your message out on social platforms »» Examining the 5 Ws of sharing »» Trying out social bookmarking Chapter 3 Making Content Shareable W hen the web was still a novelty, getting people to read your online posts was easy. Well, those days are clearly over. The likelihood that someone will read something you wrote gets more remote all the time. Who knew that getting people to read and share what you create would be one of the biggest problems faced by content marketers in 2019? In this chapter, you examine how strategically sharing your content can make the difference between a wildly popular brand and one that is ignored. You also look at why people share content, as well as where and how they share it. Embracing Shareability as a Strategy One battle cry that can be heard throughout marketing departments today is the notion that sharing content should be everyone’s job. It used to be that only customer-facing employees were encouraged to share. Now everyone across all departments is expected to help the company gain a wider audience. CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 425 Understanding sharing patterns You can make content sharing a company-wide endeavor in two immediate ways: »» Focus some attention on your “employee channel.” The employee channel refers to the pipeline of company content that you supply to your employees so that they can champion the company. Your job is to help your employees share content and promote the company regardless of which department they’re in. By encouraging what the Prophet /Altimeter Group (https://www.prophet. com/altimeter/about/), a leading research and consulting company, calls the Culture of Content (CoC), you can develop a cycle of production and promotion that boosts the profile of all your content and makes your company smarter. The Altimeter report “The Culture of Content Best Practices,” by Rebecca Lieb and Jessica Groopman with Susan Etlinger includes the following recommendations: • • • Let an obsession with the customer guide content creation. Align content with your brand. Constantly evangelize your content among employees to maintain the CoC. Book 2, Chapter 4, deals with sales enablement. You learn about the need to give all employees who deal with customers the most up-to-date information. Having an employee channel takes that idea even further, requiring that you help all your employees participate in sharing content regardless of department. »» Be channel agnostic after developing content to share. The idea of being “channel agnostic” may seem counterintuitive. When you develop content, you want to pay attention to the audience demographics on that specific channel. Doing so is important, especially when you’re creating ads on that channel, such as through Facebook. What being channel agnostic means is that you shouldn’t be so channel focused after content is shared. For example, Copyblogger eliminated its Facebook account in 2014, yet still gets a lot of its content shared on that channel. Copyblogger understood that its audience would be sharing its content across all the social media platforms and didn’t want to expend energy directly on Facebook for what it found to be a minimal return. You don’t have to do the same — you know your audience best. But you should understand how content spreads before you create a sharing strategy. An article on Contently, a company that helps companies and freelancers deliver content (http://contently.com/strategist/2015/04/29/ 426 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions buzzfeed-just-cracked-the-code-on-how-social-content-spreadsand-its-a-big-deal/), detailed how BuzzFeed (http://buzzfeed.com) Making Content Shareable used a proprietary software technology called Pound to determine how content spreads on the web. Contently found that content spreads in clusters. Someone may share a post on Twitter, which in turn gets shared on Facebook, which then kicks off a flurry of activity on Google+. The most important takeaway from this is that you do everything you can to make your content shareable. Although Google+ is no longer a social media platform of choice, it still has value as a search engine. It currently has 100 million monthly users according to ­ebizmba. (http://www.ebizmba.com/articles/social-networking-websites). Sharing as a bottom-line issue Ratings, reviews, recommendations — doesn’t it seem that nothing can be sold without someone’s having first voiced an opinion? Actually, that is the case. If you see a product that doesn’t have reviews or ratings, you may be reluctant to be the first person to buy. Items such as books and movies have always been rated and discussed, but now every grocery product and children’s toy needs to have a host of opinions before it’s considered by a buyer. So you need to have your products and services reviewed, but should you care about getting that content shared? Does it really make that much of a difference to the bottom line? Two online companies — ShareThis and Canva — think so. A study done by ShareThis (http://sharethis.com; see Figure 3-1), a company that makes sharing tools, set out to determine the answer to the question, “Does sharing matter to the bottom line?” The study, called “The Return on a Share,” found that, indeed, a distinct business case can be made for sharing. Findings include: »» An excellent recommendation boosts the average value of a share by 9.5 percent over a neutral one »» Positive shares created a 9.6 percent increase in purchases »» Bad recommendations instigated lower purchases by 11 percent »» Recommendations exceed price and brand when considering purchases CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 427 FIGURE 3-1: ShareThis. If you need to convince your manager that sharing is key to your content marketing strategy, show her these statistics as part of your argument. Another interesting finding from the Return on Share study: “Mobile is considered two times as social as desktop.” Don’t forget your mobile audience! Another company that presents compelling evidence for the value of sharing content is Canva, a design company. Andrianes Pinantoan, formerly Head of Growth Marketing for Canva, details on the Convince & Convert blog (http://www.convinceand convert.com/content-marketing/how-to-increase-shareability/) how Canva increased the traffic to its design school blog (https://designschool.canva.com/; see Figure 3-2) by over 220 percent. Canva decided to focus on shareability by testing everything it posted to its blog, and then it developed its content strategy by doing the following: »» Looking at the content that was being successfully shared by its competitors »» Focusing on writing in-depth posts »» Using storytelling to make its content more interesting »» Developing great headlines »» Adding more visuals 428 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Making Content Shareable FIGURE 3-2: Canva Design School. In 60 days, Canva increased its traffic by 226 percent. Not bad for two months of effort! Can you apply some of these tactics? They are best practices that should help you make significant progress. To encourage more sharing, you can create an inline tweet that is irresistible to share by using Click to Tweet (http://coschedule.com/click-to-tweet). It’s a WordPress plug-in by CoSchedule. All the user has to do is click the ready-made box within the post, and off the tweet goes. Now that’s easy! Uncovering the Five Ws and One H of Online Sharing All journalism students are taught to cover the Five Ws and one H in their reporting — who, what, when, where, why, and how. This is a framework for asking questions that will uncover the most important information. Using this structure to understand online sharing works quite well. CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 429 Knowing who shares content, and why It’s important to know what motivates people to share content so that you can effectively appeal to your constituency. The Consumer Insight Group at the New York Times did a study to determine why people share online. The study’s methodology included in-person interviews, a quantitative survey, and a one-week sharing panel. Among the very interesting findings was the fact that they found six personas of online sharers. Table 3-1 lists these personas and how, what, and why they share. TABLE 3-1 Key Insights from the “Psychology of Sharing” Study Keywords Commonly Used Preferred Way to Share Content that serves the needs of friends and family, such as health and finance articles Helpful, reliable Email Careerists Content on business-related ideas to improve their company Valuable, network LinkedIn Hipsters Content that defines who they are Cutting edge, young Less likely to email; prefer to share on social networks Boomerangs Content that gets them noticed and provokes a reaction Validation, empowered Twitter and Facebook Connectors Deals and introductions to make everything better for friends and family Creative, thoughtful Facebook Selectives Careful about what they choose to share with individuals; they want to hit the mark Resourceful, informative Email Persona What/Why They Share Altruists This knowledge of personas and why and how they share content is very valuable when you’re putting your own personas together. (See Book 2, Chapter 2 for more about your own personas.) Look at personas through the sharing lens to help you determine the motivations of your specific audience. For example, if you are a health-related company, you know that you will have one group of sharers who want to educate people (altruists). A great illustration of this motivation, reported by the Sales Lion blog (http://www.thesaleslion. com/content-marketing-companies-b2b/), is Health Catalyst. Health Catalyst is a data warehousing and analytics company that was able to get its doctors and 430 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions FIGURE 3-3: Health ­Catalyst Knowledge Center. Want a really simple yet effective way to determine the shareability of your blog posts? Have your users take Guy Kawasaki’s “reshare test,” described in an interview on the Social Media Examiner blog at http://www.socialmediaexaminer. com/content-sharing-with-guy-kawasaki/. The test involves asking users “Are you sharing something that other people will share with their friends and followers?” Their answers give you information about how your readers view the value of your content. Considering what they share A valuable study was undertaken by BuzzStream (http://buzzstream.com), a company that provides link building and PR tools, and Fractl (http://frac.tl), a content-marketing agency, to find out what types of content was shared over a six-month period. These companies analyzed 220,000 pieces of content using BuzzSumo (http://buzzsumo.com), a content-analysis software company. CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 431 Making Content Shareable nurses to share information in the form of ebooks and blog posts and put them in a Knowledge Center, shown in Figure 3-3. Health Catalyst reports that this education effort was, in part, responsible for getting the company $50 million in investor funding. Even though its direct customers were hospitals, the company’s willingness to share its knowledge resulted in a high profile for a small-sized company. MarketingSherpa created a chart showing the types of shared content across eleven industries, as shown in Figure 3-4 (http://www.marketingsherpa.com/ article/chart/most-and-least-shared-social-content). FIGURE 3-4: A MarketingSherpa chart of the most and least shared social content. Most helpful to the question about what gets shared, Andrea Lehr, former Brand Relationship Strategist at Fractl,identified the content types: »» How-to: The standard problem — solution post »» Lists: A numbered or bulleted list about a specific topic »» What-if posts: Typically, comparisons of one thing to another »» Why posts: The author picks a topic and provides points that support the argument »» Video: An article with accompanying video that explains the topic Curious about what type of content made the “most shared” lists? Steve Rayson, formerly at BuzzSumo, looked at the data collected in the aforementioned study and had some additional findings: 432 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions »» List posts were the most shared content format; how-to articles were the second most shared. Making Content Shareable »» Long-form content performed best (articles over 3,000 words). »» Individual picture-list posts have the potential to go viral. These posts have pictures as their list items instead of text. Although text list posts did better overall, BuzzSumo found that picture lists were more likely to go viral if they were shared (http://buzzsumo.com/blog/buzzfeeds-most-sharedcontent-format-is-not-what-you-think/). Discovering when they share Several studies concerning the best time to share on social media have been done in recent years. Anyone interested in succeeding at content marketing pays some attention to timing. It makes sense that you’d want to at least attempt to share your content when people are likely to see it. In 2018, Sprout Social (https://sproutsocial.com/insights/best-times-topost-on-social-media/) reported on the best times to tweet and post on Twitter and Facebook: »» On Twitter: The best time to post on Twitter is Friday 9 to 10 a.m. »» On Facebook: The best times to post on Facebook to get the most engagement are Wednesday at noon and 2 p.m. and Thursday at 1 and 2 p.m. It’s great to be mindful of general times to get reshares, but you still want to test and experiment. Use these findings as guidelines when you’re testing your own social media campaigns. Audience preferences can change overnight. Observing where they share If you were asked in October of 2019 to list the five most popular social networking sites, you probably came up with the same list that ebizMBA (http://www. ebizmba.com/articles/social-networking-websites) did: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Facebook YouTube Twitter Instagram LinkedIn CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 433 These are the go-to sites for sharing that most companies (and users) turn to first. When it comes to your specific audience, some sites may place higher up or down, but these would be the likely choices. When looking at where your communities congregate, you also want to study niche sites that your audience frequents. For example, if you are a design company you might want to visit Stack Overflow, (http://stackoverflow.com), a Q&A site for developers, or SourceForge (http://sourceforge.net). If you sell electronics and gadgets, you should check out a site like Gizmodo (http://gizmodo.com). Looking at how people share content The biggest surprise about sharing is how data is shared. Josh Schwartz is head of Products, Engineering and Data at Chartbeat (https://chartbeat.com/), a ­company that measures real-time traffic (see Figure 3-5). Schwartz was asked by Farhad Manjoo at Slate to look at the scrolling and sharing behavior of Slate’s audience (www.slate.com/articles/technology/technology/2013/06/ how_people_read_online_why_you_won_t_finish_this_article.html ), and his findings were very disconcerting. He found that people frequently tweet links to articles they’ve only partially read. In Slate’s case, people scroll only 50 percent of the way before tweeting them. BuzzFeed and other online sites have found similar results. FIGURE 3-5: Chartbeat. 434 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Unfortunately, you can’t simply shorten your content if your audience responds to the longer format. You need to give your readers what they want and share. However, you might want to put the most important points and your call to action up higher in the content. In an attempt to more effectively evaluate audience interest, companies like Upworthy, a breaking news site, are looking at “attention minutes” (https:// blog.upworthy.com/what-uniques-and-pageviews-leave-out-and-whywere-measuring-attention-minutes-instead-d12c159d5c96). This means that companies consider the total amount of time spent on their sites and the total attention given to a specific piece of content. In this way, they can assess audience interest instead of just scrolling behavior. Adding Social Bookmarking When you’re looking at places where content is shared, don’t overlook bookmarking sites. Users on these sites share articles they find interesting, and others read them and vote on the ones they like. If your content shows up on one of these sites, it can »» Drive traffic to your site »» Help you rise in Google search results »» Give your content more visibility and brand recognition »» Increase your domain authority Being tagged on one of these sites doesn’t guarantee that the traffic that is generated will stick with you. Don’t be disappointed if the increase is a one-off. At least you got some recognition. The top two bookmarking sites you may want to consider are »» Digg (http://digg.com): Unlike some of the other sites, Digg has a curated front page. Its content is separated into articles and videos. Users vote by clicking a digg link to signal their approval. You can sort content by time or “most shared.” CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 435 Making Content Shareable Think about the implications of this behavior. When you read about how people respond to long-form content, it may mean that they like to share long-form content, but not necessarily read it through to the end. As Manjoo stated, “We’re in the age of the skim.” »» Reddit (http://reddit.com): On this site, you can create a community of your own called a subreddit. Each community has its own moderators and is separate from the others. Are you wondering whether you can do anything to make your content even more shareable? Former Wall Street Internet analyst Mary Meeker says that a post gets half of all its shares within 6.5 hours on Twitter and 9 hours on Facebook. So you need to take some actions to keep your content from disappearing. Making SEO a Priority When it comes to content marketing, the concept of search engine optimization (SEO) is often misunderstood. When SEO was fairly new, content writers were tasked with stuffing as many keywords as possible into a blog post to attract the search engines. This tactic is long gone along with the people who wanted to help you game the system. Google is aware of all the “black hat” techniques that people try to deploy and frequently changes its algorithm. At this point, Google’s clear directive is to have you produce quality content that employs keywords that help people find you. Your SEO strategy needs to be well thought out to ensure that your customers can find the content you so carefully planned to share. Rather than create a complex list of things you need to do, focus instead on a few SEO tasks that will have the biggest impact. You can »» Use long-tail keywords. You still need to use keywords to be found by the search engines. Long-tail keywords, which means keywords that are really phrases, work best. For example, in place of the broad phrase “red shoes,” narrow the phrase with “red sandals wedge discount womens.” In other words, make sure to be very descriptive so that when someone is searching for your specific shoe, she can find it. »» Pay attention to mobile. According to predictions, your mobile audience will soon make up approximately 50 percent of your total audience. Look at your site on all possible devices to ensure that it’s mobile ready. The Google Developers site has a “Mobile-Friendly Test” tool that you can use to test your site, as shown in Figure 3-6. 436 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Because you’re not going to “stuff” your site full of keywords anymore, put them in the places where they can do the most good, such as in your title tag. Google uses a limited number of characters (55) to display what your site is about. Make sure to use them wisely. See Book 5, Chapter 2 for more about the best place for keywords »» Evaluate results often. You should use analytics to measure what your users are clicking on. Don’t guess. »» Improve site load times. This is a boring task, but one that you should not overlook. People don’t have the patience to wait for your site to load. Ask your webmaster to check loading times and fix if necessary. »» Make sure to optimize for video. This one is similar to the preceding item about loading times. Even though users love video, they won’t wait for yours. »» Play the long game. The most important Google SEO rules don’t really change that much. You need quality content to drive your traffic. Optimization doesn’t happen overnight. Prepare to do the right thing year after year and you will be rewarded. FIGURE 3-6: A Google site test. CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 437 Making Content Shareable »» Make sure that your keywords are in the right places, such as in titles. You can always dig deeper into SEO when you have more time or want to engage a professional to work with you. Looking for some free SEO Tools to get started? Try these: »» Moz (https://moz.com/): This company, offers great free tools and a paid subscription. The free tools include Open Site Explorer, Followerwonk, MozBar, Moz Local, and MozCast. Using these tools, you can do keyword searches, analyze anchor text, and a lot more. »» Ubersuggest (http://ubersuggest.org): This free tool, is so easy to use that it’s perfect for beginners (and experienced users). »» SEMrush (http://www.semrush.com): This is a multifaceted set of tools that helps you develop your SEO, advertising, and link-building strategies. SEMrush also offers paid tools. Deploying Hashtags to Encourage Sharing Many people use hashtags on social platforms as an afterthought (or not at all). Don’t be one of them. Hashtags really do give your content more visibility and increase the likelihood that you’ll be reshared on places like Twitter, Pinterest, and Instagram. People set content alerts for brand names, products, and specific keywords. By using hashtags, you immediately get on people’s radar screen and encourage them to check you out. Understanding hashtags Although they may seem unfamiliar, hashtags are simply a way to categorize keywords. By adding the # symbol in front of the keyword, you’re telling the search engine to pull out and display content designated that way every time someone uses that term. So, if someone on Twitter or other social platform types the # before a term, that person will be able to see all the tweets that contain it. People can get right to the content that interests them most. Twitter recommends no more than two hashtags per tweet. The concept of “less is more” applies here. 438 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Using hashtag tools To search and use hashtags, you should consider using some of the hashtag tools created to make using them easier. Here are a few to consider. Do you want to: »» Participate in a high profile chat? If you’re hosting an online chat, it can get confusing when you try to follow responses in the stream. Using a tool like TweetChat (http://www.tweetchat.com), shown in Figure 3-7, you can isolate your specific tweets posted in real time during the chat. »» Determine which hashtag to use in real time? When you’re creating a tweet, you want to know what tag will most likely garner the highest visibility. A tool such as RiteTag (https://ritetag.com/), shown in Figure 3-8, can help you make the best choice. »» Understand how the tag is being used and who is using it? Hashtagify (http://hashtagify.me) can show you everything you ever wanted to know about a hashtag you may want to use as your own. »» Register or brand a hashtag? Using a tool such as http://twubs.com, shown in Figure 3-9, you can register a hashtag as your own. Still want more sharing tools for your blogs, landing pages, and websites? You can use such free tools as SumoMe (http://sumome.com/) or the WordPress Social Sharing Optimization (WPSSO SSB) tool (https://wordpress.org/plugins/ wpsso-ssb/). CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 439 Making Content Shareable It’s helpful to look at the usefulness of hashtags from two angles. The first is that a hashtag helps you find something; second, it helps you to be found. Sound simple? It really is. For example, if you want people from a specific area — for example, New York City — to find your content, you can add a hashtag like #nyc that makes it easy to spread your message locally. How about borrowing a hashtag that has a devoted group of followers? If you’re a writer, you can use #amwriting or #writing to speak to that community. FIGURE 3-7: TweetChat. FIGURE 3-8: RiteTag. 440 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Making Content Shareable FIGURE 3-9: Twubs. CHAPTER 3 Making Content Shareable 441 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Reviewing types of marketing email »» Building a promotional calendar »» Writing and designing marketing email »» Making your emails deliverable Chapter 4 Considering Email Marketing I magine that it’s seven o’clock on a Tuesday morning. You wake up to the beeping of your alarm, roll out of bed, and stumble to the kitchen, where the coffee that you programmed to brew last night is just finishing its drip cycle. You grab a mug, add some cream and a tiny sprinkle of sugar, and sit down at the kitchen table. Then you check your email. If you’re anything like most adult Americans, this routine may be familiar. Email is not only part of daily routines, but also one of theprimary sources of information. It probably isn’t a surprise to you that email has a higher return on investment than any other channel by far. In fact, email returns an average 4,300 percent return on investment for businesses in the United States. Email plays an important role in digital marketing because it helps move customers from one stage of the buyer journey (see Book 2, Chapter 3 for more on the buyer journey) to the next in a way that yields high return on investment. Because email is both cost effective and time effective, not to mention one of the first channels that most customers turn to, this channel often yields the best results. In this chapter, you see how to create an email plan that gives your customers a reason to come to you again and again as you grow your business through dynamic, relationship-based marketing. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 443 You can only send email to those people with whom you have a prior business relationship. For more information about the specifics, check out the CANSPAM act at https://www.ftc.gov/tips-advice/business-center/guidance/ can-spam-act-compliance-guide-business. Understanding Marketing Emails To start, it’s important to understand the types of marketing emails that ­businesses send. The key to success in email marketing is employing the right type of email at the right time. Figure 4-1 shows the goals of three types of emails — promotional, relational, and transactional — and how they’re used in marketing strategy. FIGURE 4-1: The primary goals of each email type. There are a host of email service providers for you to choose from. Depending on your needs you can choose a free supplier or a pricier one with lots of features. Free providers include Gmail and Outlook, which have both personal and business services. Promotional emails Promotional emails present the leads and customers on your email list with an offer. The offers could be promotional content, a gated offer like a whitepaper or webinar (see Book 3, Chapter 3 for more on gated offers), a brand announcement, product release, event announcements, or trial offers, just to name a few. 444 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Promotional emails are the most common marketing emails. This isn’t surprising. Because 66 percent of consumers have made a purchase as a direct result of an email marketing message, promotional emails work. Promotional emails provide value and help tee up sales. They’re great for lead generation, retention, loyalty, engagement, nurturing, sales, and upsells. They should be part of any email marketing strategy. The problem is that many companies use them as the only part of their email marketing strategy, so they miss out on opportunities to relate to customers in diverse ways that are often more effective. Relational emails deliver value to your customers by providing free content and information such as subscriber welcomes, newsletters, blog articles, webinar guides, surveys, social updates, contest announcements, and more. Relational emails may not sell a product or brand directly, but they build relationships with the customer by adding value upfront. For example, when your email subscriber receives a piece of high-quality content in an email newsletter, he or she is interacting with your brand in a deeper, more meaningful way. Transactional emails Transactional emails are sent in response to an action that a customer has taken with your brand. They include messages such as order confirmations, receipts, coupon codes, shipping notifications, account creation and product return confirmations, support tickets, password reminders, and unsubscribe confirmations. These emails reengage customers who have engaged with your business in some way (see “Reengagement campaigns,” later in this chapter) and give the customer an idea of the voice behind your brand. Do you follow up quickly and deliver what you promised? Do you have systems in place that give the customer true value? Do you respect your customers’ wishes? The leads and customers on your email list are observing how you conduct business, and your transactional email is a big part of that. Transactional emails meet all the primary goals of marketing. They offer a customer service experience, tell customers about your brand, generate leads, increase customer retention and loyalty, engage customers, and even help with sales. Yet most businesses rarely use transactional emails properly, mistakenly assuming that promotional and relational emails are more effective. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 445 Considering Email Marketing Relational emails THE CHEMISTRY OF TRANSACTIONAL EMAILS Think about the last time you purchased something you loved — a pair of boots you’d wanted for years, a new snowboard, a great bottle of wine, or dinner at your favorite restaurant. Now consider the way you felt when you made that purchase. You were excited, right? As you purchase a product that you’ve been wanting, your brain is flooded with feelgood endorphins. You’re happy about that product. Perhaps an hour later, you get a shipping confirmation with information about the key features of that snowboard or an email listing recipes for dishes that go with that wine. You’ve already made a feel-good purchase, and when the marketer reengages you when you’re still on that high, you move farther along on your buyer journey. Research shows, however, that transactional emails have the highest open rates of the three types and produce 2 percent to 5 percent more revenue than standard bulk email does. This produces a fascinating conclusion: Transactional emails are chemically more likely to be successful (see the nearby sidebar “The chemistry of transactional emails”). TURNING NEGATIVES TO POSITIVES Many businesses tend to minimize contact when a customer takes a negative action, such as returning a product or unsubscribing from an email list. Butthese events are perfect times to follow up with transactional emails, for these reasons: 446 • Product returns: Nordstrom, for example, allows customers to return any item at any time for any reason. This return policy is highly compelling and makes ­purchases feel less risky. When Nordstrom follows up with customers who make returns, it confirms the positive experience that those customers had with its return policy. • Unsubscriptions: When a customer unsubscribes from your email list, first respond to his negative action by unsubscribing him (give him what he wants). Then send him an unsubscribe confirmation that lists other ways he can engage with your brand, such as social media or bricks-and-mortar stores. Remind him that you’re happy to communicate with him in the place that best fits his needs. BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Sending Broadcast and Triggered Emails Email best practices say that you shouldn’t just send every email to every subscriber on your list, and time management best practices say you can’t spend every day manually sending emails to customers. For these reasons, your emails should be divided into two types: broadcast and triggered. Broadcast emails are emails that you manually send to your entire list at a given time. They aren’t responses to customer actions; you send them at a specific time and for a specific purpose. Overusing broadcast emails can hurt your customer relationships and cause customers to stop proceeding on the buyer journey. Broadcast emails should be used for only three purposes: »» Newsletters: You should send your regular daily, weekly, or monthly email newsletter to your entire list as promised when your subscribers subscribed. »» Promotions: Not all promotions should be broadcasted to your entire audience. Only major promotions that you feel deliver value to your entire customer base should be sent to everyone. The rest should be sent to a segmented list (see the next point). »» Segmentation: Send a broadcast email to your entire list to determine the specific interests of certain customers and then segment your email lists. Triggered emails Most of the emails that you send should be triggered emails, which are fully automated. After you get the content honed and ready, you can let your email service provider do the work for you. Triggered emails automatically go out after customers take a specific action. But there’s a catch: Just because you can trigger something doesn’t mean you should. In this day of detailed digital automation, you can probably get data to trigger an email every time your customer logs on to a computer or pours a cup of coffee. But that would just annoy your customers. Specific actions that trigger an automated email for each customer action might include »» New subscriber welcome email »» Gated offer email (see Book 3,Chapter 3 for more on gated offers) »» Registration confirmations CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 447 Considering Email Marketing Broadcast emails »» Purchase receipts »» Segmented promotion »» Referral requests after customers leave a review »» Abandonment of a shopping cart »» Reengagement after a subscriber has ignored your brand emails for a specific period Building a Promotional Calendar The first question many business owners ask is when to send email. This question is a good one because a great email campaign will engage customers like never before if it’s sent at the right time. Conversely, if an email is sent at the wrong time, it won’t be as effective as it could be. The first thing you should do as a business owner or marketer after you decide to start an email marketing strategy is come up with a promotional calendar. That way, you’ know when to send the messaging your customers need when they want to receive it. Using a promotional calendar gives you the opportunity to elicit action. It mobilizes your subscribers to do something that you want them to do — buy something, ask for information, call you, or come to a store, for example. The right message delivered at the right time elicits action. Cataloging your products and services Before you can build an accurate, all-encompassing promotional calendar, you have to know exactly what you’re promoting. Spend some time carefully cataloging every product and service that your business offers and taking some time to understand how to promote it best. DigitalMarketer, uses a promotional asset sheet (see Figure 4-2) to keep a detailed record of their assets. Every time they release a new asset, they add an asset sheet to their list. And every time they update their promotional calendar or run an email campaign, they spend some time updating their asset sheets. 448 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Considering Email Marketing FIGURE 4-2: A promotional asset sheet. Be sure that whatever record you keep of your promotional assets contains the following information: »» Name of the product or service »» Price (both full price and sale price) »» Where the transaction occurs »» Whether you’ve sold this product or service via email before »» Whether past marketing efforts worked (and why or why not) »» When you last promoted this product or service »» How many emails you sent about this product »» Whether the product is currently available to promote (and if not, why not) You may be wondering why you should spend so much time cataloging your marketing efforts. Wouldn’t that time be better spent, perhaps, marketing those assets? The truth is that by carefully tracking the sales of your products, as well as the marketing campaigns that correspond with your sales, the job of marketing those assets becomes much easier. When you know what you have available to sell and the results of the promotions you’ve employed in the past, you can simply do more of what’s working and less of what isn’t. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 449 The time you spend cataloging and analyzing these assets and the campaigns surrounding them is valuable marketing time. All marketers should gather the promotional assets from all the products and services they offered so that they know exactly what they can sell, how they can sell it, whom to sell it to, and (perhaps most important) when to sell it. Creating an annual promotional plan After you catalog your assets, create an annual promotional plan. This plan aligns your 12-month revenue goals with your annual promotions and marketing efforts to help you reach your goals. Figure 4-3 shows a sample worksheet. FIGURE 4-3: An annual ­promotional ­planning worksheet. 450 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions You can download your own 12-Month Promotional Planning Worksheet at http://www.digitalmarketer.com/email-planning. Developing a marketing plan Creating and developing an annual marketing plan takes some time, but after it’s done, you have a solid framework for building your promotional calendar. Follow these steps: 1. Write your 12-month revenue goals. 2. Considering Email Marketing Consider your target revenue goals, and figure out where you want to be each month to reach those goals. List your nonrevenue goals. This list could include nonrevenue growth opportunities such as the launch of a blog or podcast, the release of a book, or the opening of a new location. 3. Slot holiday promotions into the appropriate months. For many retail businesses, November and December are key sales times and thus require strategic marketing. Other businesses may have peak promotion at varying times, such as before a major conference or during a certain season. 4. Slot annual promotions into the appropriate months. These promotions may include major sales, product releases, or events. 5. Denote seasonality. Every business has slow and busy months, so note those months in your plan so that you can build appropriate promotion during those times. 6. Slot nonrevenue goals into the appropriate months. Are you planning to release a new book or launch a new blog in March? You need space on the promotional calendar for these nonrevenue initiatives. 7. Break your revenue goals into monthly allotments. Keep seasonality in mind (see Step 5). 8. Add your standard revenue projections. Include promotional efforts, major events, standard rebilling contracts, and subscriptions. 9. Subtract your expected revenue from the target revenue. After doing this, consider how you can fill in the remaining revenue needed. This step is where your marketing efforts come into play. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 451 10. Brainstorm additional promotional ideas that could generate the revenue you need to reach your goals. Will you need to add new products or services to promote to reach your target revenue? Can you find new ways to offer the existing products and services you already have? 11. Spot-check and adjust. Ask yourself whether your calendar helps you meet your goals in a way that will be both effective and practical. 12. List additional items that you need to meet your target. You may need to launch a new product or service, or to create a sales presentation, for example. Creating a 30-day calendar The next step is to get down into the nitty-gritty of what you’re going to do for the next 30 days. A promotional campaign should have three goals: »» Monetization: Making money or making a sale »» Activation: Moving your customer forward on the buyer journey »» Segmentation: Becoming more aware of customers’ needs and desires so you can segment your list and deliver value For your first 30 days, you set one of these promotional goals for each week and reserve the fourth week for a wildcard campaign. A wildcard campaign gives you the chance to try something new, get creative, test new ideas, or try to replicate your most successful campaigns. You can use a monthly planning worksheet (see Figure 4-4) so that you can easily track which promotions you’re running and how they do. You might also plan a backup promotion for each campaign in case the primary campaign falls, so that you still reach revenue goals regardless of how the campaigns perform. You can download your own monthly email planning worksheet at http://www. digitalmarketer.com/email-planning. 452 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions FIGURE 4-4: Considering Email Marketing A 30-day ­promotional ­planning worksheet. Creating a 90-day rolling calendar When your 30-day promotional plan is up and rolling, you can plan a bit farther in advance with a 90-day rolling calendar. This calendar is called a rolling calendar because by repeating similar promotions every 90 days or so, you keep your customers informed and engaged without making the same offers with the same campaign goals over and over again. Use a calendar application like Google Calendar or hang a dry-erase board with a 90-day calendar template on it in your office so that you and your team can routinely map a schedule that meets your revenue targets without repeating the same promotions too often. When viewing your 90-day calendar, you might find that you have three monetization campaigns in April, but none in May. Moving a monetization campaign or two to May will make it more likely that you hit your revenue targets in May and reduce the number of monetization offers you send to your email list in April. Creating Email Campaigns How do you create email campaigns that move your customers along the buyer journey in a way that creates long-term brand engagement? And how do you do so without spamming or annoying your customers the way so many brands can do? This section walks you through five types of email campaigns so that you know how to build email campaigns that will work for your business. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 453 A campaign structure page (like the one in Figure 4-5) will help you keep track of each campaign and the purpose of each email in the campaign. FIGURE 4-5: A sample c­ ampaign storyboard. Indoctrination campaigns An indoctrination campaign is a triggered campaign sent immediately following an initial subscription. This campaign is designed to teach new subscribers about your brand and convince them that they’ve made a good decision by joining your email list and, by extension, becoming a part of your community. See Figure 4-6 for an example of an indoctrination email. Customers don’t sign up for your email lists on a whim. Instead, they probably were introduced to your brand and then considered the value of your email list. Perhaps they were given the opportunity to get value in advance with a gated offer. (Learn more about gated offers in Book 3, Chapter 3.) Or perhaps they were signed up as they made a purchase or engaged with your website. In all cases, an indoctrination campaign reaffirms positive action and shows your customers that they made the right choice. The fact that customers made a positive choice to join your email list, however, doesn’t mean that they’re fully engaged with your brand. They don’t know you well enough to be anticipating your every word. They may not recognize your name in their inbox and are still unsure about the value they can expect from you. 454 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Considering Email Marketing FIGURE 4-6: An example ­indoctrination email that welcomes a new subscriber. A carefully crafted indoctrination campaign can help move customers down the path of their buyer journeys. (See Book 2, Chapter 3 for more on the buyer journey.) In the aggregate, when you add an indoctrination campaign, you see a positive effect on the open and click-through rates of the email you send to these subscribers in the future because they know, like, and trust you better. Indoctrination campaigns generally run one to three emails and introduce customers to the brand on a deeper level. These campaigns help you put your best foot forward with new subscribers, introducing them to who you are and what you stand for. Your indoctrination campaign should do the following things: »» Welcome and introduce new subscribers to your brand. »» Restate the benefits of being a subscriber. »» Tell subscribers what to expect. »» Tell subscribers what to do next. »» Introduce subscribers to your brand voice or personality. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 455 Engagement campaigns An engagement campaign is an interest-based, triggered campaign sent immediately following a subscriber action. It’s designed to make a relevant offer and potentially a sale to subscribers. The role of an engagement campaign is to turn subscribers into converts by prescribing the next logical step based on what you know those people are interested in. Before you craft an engagement campaign, ask yourself two questions: »» What next step do you want your customer to take? You may want her to make a purchase, opt in to a gated offer, or engage with your brand on your website. »» Do you believe that the customer is ready to take that next step? If the customer isn’t ready, you only annoy and alienate her if you push her to take that step. Sometimes it does hurt to ask — especially when you’re asking too much too soon from a valuable customer. Your engagement campaign should do the following things: »» Turn subscribers into converts. A conversion might be buying a product or service, scheduling an appointment, or registering for a webinar. »» Consider what the customer is interested in now and what will interest him next. Refer to your buyer journey and design your engagement campaigns to move the email subscriber to the next stage in that journey. »» Reference the previous positive action. »» Overcome or inoculate against known objections to converting. »» Prescribe the next logical step. »» Ask for an order or a next step. Ascension campaigns An ascension campaign is a triggered campaign sent immediately following a purchase to start the value loop designed to turn ordinary buyers into buyers who purchase from your brand again and again. 456 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions If a customer just bought a tent and four sleeping bags, for example, you could assume that she’s looking to head out to the campground, and you could send her a coupon code for a camp stove. If a customer just bought a subscription to a social media training event, you could offer him follow-up training on email marketing. An ascension campaign is a great way to move customers along the buyer journey and build a long-term relationship with them. In an ascension campaign, you give customers what they want and then a bit more. »» Overcome or inoculate against known objections. »» Prescribe the next logical step. »» Increase the average value of customers by selling more to them, more often. »» Increase customer trust. »» Make customers ascend to fans. Segmentation campaigns A segmentation campaign is a manual campaign sent to your entire database as a promotion designed to segment your subscribers by interest. Consider a small publishing company that sells high-interest nonfiction books to teachers and librarians. That company is releasing a series of science books on gardening and plant growth. The books have similar content, but some target early learners, others middle-school students, and still others high-school students. The marketing department, being wise and astute in the best practices of email marketing, decides to send a segmentation campaign. The department staff craft an email listing the books that are available, with clear guidance on what age level each book is appropriate for. Then the staff sends the email as a broadcast campaign to the company’s entire mailing list. This campaign makes the company’s entire list aware of the new product, and possibly more important, the resulting click data allows the company to segment the list by which subscribers are interested in early-learning content, which are interested in middle-school content, and which are interested in high-school content. Segmentation assures that each customer profile can be effectively targeted. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 457 Considering Email Marketing An ascension campaign should do the following things: The marketing department can create audience segments and send additional emails that meet tcustomers’ exact interests. Figure 4-7 shows a segmentation email from Home Depot. The email lists six categories in which subscribers can get savings. When a subscriber selects one of these categories, the marketing team knows that this person responded to this email and clicked a particular product category. That person would then be segmented, and Home Depot would likely send follow-up emails on the product the subscriber selected. FIGURE 4-7: Example of a segmentation campaign email. Reengagement campaigns A reengagement campaign is a triggered campaign sent to any subscriber who has not opened or clicked an email in the past 30 to 60 days. This campaign is designed to reengage those subscribers with the brand. Perhaps subscribers got extremely busy and didn’t check their email diligently. They may have gone through life changes and now have different interests. Or maybe they got frustrated with you and chose to disengage. A reengagement campaign can help those customers get back on the buyer journey. Figure 4-8 shows an effective reengagement email. Email deliverability is greatly affected by disengaged users. Best practices in email list management require that customers who aren’t engaged be reengaged or removed from the list. If you run a reengagement campaign and still don’t get a response from some customers, you can unsubscribe those customers and protect your email list from deliverability issues. See the section “Ensuring Email Deliverability” to find more must-do’s and tips on keeping your emails landing in customers inboxes. 458 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Considering Email Marketing FIGURE 4-8: An example reengagement campaign. Writing and Designing Effective Emails If you want people to read your emails, you have to write and design emails that they want to read. But with thousands of companies writing and sending emails every day, you have to make your emails stand out. Although email writing and design are art and not formula, this section lists a few tips to hone your copywriting and email design skills so that your messages stand out. Harvesting proven email copy Go into your own email account and check the last ten messages that you opened. Look at the copy and the design. Then ask yourself the following questions: »» Did the headline grab your attention? »» What hooks and leads did the copywriter use? »» What benefits of the product or service are mentioned? CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 459 »» What proof or stories grabbed your attention? »» What was the call to action? When you’ve read the emails that grabbed your attention, see whether you can use them as templates for emails that meet your own business goals. There’s no need to reinvent the wheel if it’s already been invented for you. Answering four questions To write great email copy, you have to figure out why a customer would engage with the promotion. Answer these four questions: »» Why now? Consider whether the promotion you have should offer new or on-sale items. Also consider whether it’s seasonal or timely; that is, whether it’s something that customers want or need now more than at another time. »» Who cares? Decide who in your target audience is most affected by having (or not having) what you’re selling. »» Why should they care? You need to let customers know how their lives will be different if they have your product or service. »» Can you prove it? Provide case studies, testimonials, or news stories to prove that your customers’ lives will be changed if they engage with your product or service. Great email copy answers these questions in the body of the email in a way that clearly demonstrates to the customer the value of your promotion. Knowing why people buy People always buy things for a reason. By considering the reasons why people make purchases as you write email copy, you can hone in on what makes a customer click Buy. People generally buy things for four reasons: »» Personal gain: A product or service will help them reach personal goals or desires. »» Logic and research: Customers have done their research, and this product seems like a logical fit to meet a particular need. »» Social proof or third-party influence: Customers’ friends have told them that the product or service is great, and they want to be part of it, or they see 460 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions a large number of people doing something and want to do it, too. Nothing attracts a crowd like a crowd. »» Fear of missing out: People have a genuine fear of missing an opportunity or of being the only person not to have something important. Consider which of these motivations you think will drive your customers and then address that reason in your email copy. Because most people spend only three to four seconds deciding whether to open an email, the subject line is the most important piece of email copy you can write. A good subject line piques interest and entices a customer to open the email. Then your email body copy can do the rest to drive engagement. Subject lines can be tough nuts to crack. One company has its marketing team write 25 subject lines for each email and then choose a favorite to use in the email campaign. This operation may be time consuming, but the company continually receives higher-than-average open rates for its industry and higher-thanaverage email engagement. You may not have the resources to write 25 full subject lines for each email, but it’s a good idea to consider several options for each send, especially triggered sends that you’ll use over time. You can use three types of subject lines to give people different reasons to open an email. Curiosity subject lines Curiosity subject lines pique the interest of subscribers and encourage them to click to find out more. For example, Kate Spade, a clothing retailer, sent an email to its subscriber list with the subject line, Ready for your close up? That email contained an offer for Kate Spade’s jewelry products and used a curious subject line to increase the number of people opening the email. Benefit subject lines Benefit subject lines clearly state the reason why subscribers should open the email and the benefits they receive for doing so. For example, OfficeVibe, a Software as a Service (Saas) company that helps managers measure the engagement and satisfaction of their employees, sent an email to their subscribers with the subject line, 38 Employee Engagement Ideas, which clearly states the benefit the subscriber will get by opening the email. The opposite of a benefit subject line is a warning subject line. For example, OfficeVibe also sent an email to its subscribers with the CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 461 Considering Email Marketing Writing effective email subject lines subject line, 11 Statistics That Will Scare Every Manager. This subject line type should be used sparingly, but, when appropriate, it can be very effective. Scarcity subject lines Scarcity subject lines cause subscribers to feel that they may miss out on something important if they don’t open the email and engage with it. For example, Home Depot sent an email to its subscribers with the subject line, Hurry! Labor Day Savings End Tonight to encourage subscribers to take advantage of its Labor Day sale before it was over. Writing body copy Copywriting isn’t a formula, but an art. It’s also true that through some formulaic chunking, you can create email copy quickly and effectively. This chunking method is based on the answers to the questions in the “Answering four questions” section earlier in this chapter. By breaking your copy into four major chunks and allowing each chunk to answer one of the questions, you can ensure that your copy addresses the major points you’re trying to cover. Each chunk of copy should have one link. That way, by the time customers read the entire email, they’ve had all their questions answered and have been given multiple opportunities to find out more by clicking a link. Here’s how you chunk your email: »» Introduction: In this section, answer the question “Who cares?” by showing customers that they should care about this promotion and why. »» Body: Next, help your reader to answer the question “Why should they care?” by explaining the proven benefits or results of the product or service. »» Close: The close of your email is a great time to answer the question “Why now?” Tell customers, if it applies, that they have a limited time to engage with the promotion. »» P.S.: A postscript is a fantastic place to answer the question “Can you prove it?” by sharing social proof such as a testimonial, positive review, or story of a customer whose life has been changed by the product or service. Include a link to a relevant place on your website in each chunk of the email. It’s okay if multiple links go to the same location. Just make sure that customers are given ample opportunity to engage further. 462 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions Cuing the click You’ve written a killer subject line. You’ve chunked up your copy beautifully, and each chunk contains a relevant link. You have a product or service that you believe in. You’re 99.4 percent of the way to your goal. But you still have one more thing to do: You have to cue the click by asking people very clearly to perform the action of clicking. Here are a few methods that may be effective for you: »» Pose a benefit-driven question. Example: “Would you like to learn to grow »» Connect proof with product. Example: “Our customers are able to grow 20% more winter tomatoes using our Indoor Tomato Trellis! See how it works here: <link>” »» Show the “After.” Example: “When you have the Indoor Tomato Trellis, you’ll enjoy ripe tomatoes picked from the vine even in the coldest winter months. Get the Indoor Tomato Trellis here: <link>” »» Present a takeaway. Example: “This is your last chance to get the Indoor Tomato Trellis at 35% off: <link>” Getting More Clicks and Opens When you go through your inbox, you probably pay close attention to only a few emails — maybe 10 percent. What went wrong with the 90 percent of emails that you didn’t engage with? Maybe they didn’t have great copy or design, or you didn’t like the sender’s products or services. Maybe you don’t have a trusted relationship with the senders, and those emails just got lost in the sea of emails in your inbox. You have about three to four seconds to grab your reader’s attention, so a great subject line, perfect copy and design, and an awesome promotion aren’t always enough. That may seem a bit unfair. To get you over this final hump, here are some tips to give your emails an extra boost: »» Get the timing right. Send your emails at times when others aren’t sending email. Then your emails will stand out in people’s inboxes and get a higher CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 463 Considering Email Marketing tomatoes indoors? Click <link> to find out.” open rate. DigitalMarketer found that the best times to send emails are from 8:30 to 10 a.m., 2:30 to 3:30 p.m., and 8 p.m. to midnight. »» Call people by name. Research shows that emails with a first name in the subject line garner a 23 percent higher open rate. That’s an amazing boost, but don’t use this trick too often. It loses its effectiveness if overused. »» Be positive in the morning and negative at night. We all wake up bright- eyed and excited to face the new day (okay, after coffee). Take advantage of that fact by sending positive email messages during the morning hours. In the evenings, negative messages are better accepted. If you’re going to send a negative message — perhaps about a declining market or an urgent need — make sure that you offer a solution to the problem as part of your email. No one likes to be made to feel hopeless. »» Be controversial or relevant. Stand out in the inbox by bringing up controversial topics (even if you worry that some of your subscribers won’t agree with you) or relevant content. »» Use odd or specific numbers. Everyone has ten tips for doing just about everything. Try using different numbers: “6 ways to change your business tonight,” “14 simple ideas to teach your child math,” or “The $234,423 idea that changed everything,” for example. Never round up your numbers. Doing that makes you sound like a liar. If you have only nine amazing ideas for holiday décor, say you have nine amazing ideas. Saying that you have ten and then delivering only nine makes you look dishonest. »» Keep your subject line short. The best subject lines have six to ten words, or 25 characters. Short subject lines are easy to read and view on a smartphone while still piquing customer interest. »» Use a second subject line. Most email providers have a second area of displayed content on every email. In many email systems, this area is referred to as the description, but if it’s left blank, it defaults to the first line of copy. Instead of accepting the default, write a second, short, strong subject line and place it in the description section to tell your customers more about your email’s content. »» Press Play. Instead of including a link, embed a still image of a video with a Play button superimposed on top. This technique can dramatically increase click-through rates in email campaigns. »» Ask customers for their thoughts. This strategy results in the highest click-through rate of all campaign types. This strategy involves asking a question and listing four to five answers, each with a link (see Figure 4-9). 464 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions All the links go to the same place, where customers can find answers to the questions. »» Combine video and questions. Video consistently yields high click-through rates and high customer engagement. Include a video and a “your thoughts” question in an email, and have subscribers watch the video to get the answer. Many marketers worry that they don’t have the charisma or budget to make highly professional video. Don’t be afraid! Because email is about relationships, a simple conversational video can show your personality and voice to your subscribers, and allow you to connect with them in a new way. “You’ll never get this deal again!” increase the urgency of the promotion. You can increase the urgency even more by adding a countdown clock or timer to show customers exactly how much time they have. »» Use animated GIFs. Pretty or funny moving images in an inbox catch people’s attention. If you have access to a designer who can make custom animated GIFs, have that person create some for you. If not, sites like Giphy (http:// giphy.com) offer free GIFs that you can use to give your emails an extra edge. FIGURE 4-9: An example of a “Your Thoughts?” email that engages the audience. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 465 Considering Email Marketing »» Add a countdown. Phrases like “Four days until this sale is over forever!” and Ensuring Email Deliverability Everything discussed so far is moot if your emails aren’t reaching your subscribers’ inboxes. Did you know that 21 percent of emails worldwide never reach the desired recipients? A whole lot of work, effort, and brilliance are being wasted on emails that end up floating around in cyberspace. How do you make sure that all your work isn’t wasted? It comes down to one simple thing: You have to prove that you aren’t a spammer and that you have no intention of being one. Sadly, the Internet service providers responsible for determining whether you’re sending spam consider bulk mailers to be guilty until proven innocent. They assume that emails are spam from the outset, and until you can show them that you don’t act like a spammer, your email deliverability will be affected. The following sections provide some methods for improving deliverability. Most of these methods are very technical. If you’re a tech wizard, go forth and set up your infrastructure to ensure deliverability. If you need help with technical stuff, find a local tech person or call your email service provider, and get some systems in place to ensure that your emails reach the people you want to reach. Monitoring your reputation To ensure deliverability, you have to keep track of how you’re interacting with your list. Do the following things: »» Monitor the complaint rates and the volume of complaints you’re receiving. Your email service provider should provide reporting capabilities on the number and rate of complaints your emails are receiving. »» Respond to complaints in a timely manner. »» Make sure that you unsubscribe and stop sending email to anyone who unsubscribes. Your email service provider should provide a path to unsubscribe from every email and automatically remove those that unsubscribe from your email list. »» Keep your message volume steady. Don’t send a million emails one month and then none for six months. 466 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions »» Check your blacklist status on the major blacklist sites including Spamhaus (https://www.spamhaus.org/) and Spamcop (https://www.spamcop. net/). These major blacklist sites are referenced by mailbox providers like Google’s Gmail to help them determine whether your email should be delivered to the inbox. Each blacklist has its own process for removal from its blacklist; you can find this information on its website. The best way to assure the Internet service providers that you’re not a spammer is to prove that you engage your subscribers with every single email you send. If people are opening your emails, reading what you have to say, and then clicking relevant links, you aren’t a spammer. Subscriber engagement rates are based on the following factors: »» Your open rate: This rate isn’t the number of emails that are opened, but the percentage. »» Your lateral scroll rate: This rate is how far recipients scroll down on your emails. »» Your hard and soft bounce rate: A bad email address is considered to be a hard bounce. A soft bounce can happen for many reasons, including a full inbox or accidental flagging as spam. If you continue to send emails to addresses that reject your mail, you look like a spammer. TOOLS THAT ENSURE EMAIL DELIVERABILITY Several applications can help you ensure a high percentage of email deliverability. Two of them to try are • Mail Monitor (http://mailmonitor.com): Mail Monitor breaks down delivery per IP address, message, and email service. • Return Path (https://senderscore.org): If you have your own IP address, Return Path allows you to monitor your reputation and set up alerts. You get a baseline email deliverability score. CHAPTER 4 Considering Email Marketing 467 Considering Email Marketing Proving subscriber engagement Export your entire list and send it to a company called BriteVerify (www. briteverify.com/). This company runs an analysis of your list and tells you which addresses are definitively good, which ones are questionable, and which are bad. If you expunge the questionable and bad emails from your list, you’re practicing good list hygiene and increasing deliverability. »» Unsubscription and complaint rates: If you receive high numbers of unsubscriptions or complaints, examine your campaigns to see whether you’re doing something to upset subscribers. 468 BOOK 5 Implementing Channel Promotions 6 Connecting with Influencers Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Communicating with Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 Defining Influencer Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472 Identifying the Primary Influencer Platforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473 Engaging Stellar Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477 Making Influencer Marketing Work for You . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482 CHAPTER 2: Collaborating to Win. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489 Discovering the Evolving Role of Influencers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489 Recognizing Influencer Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494 Finding the Right Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 Uncovering New Influencers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501 Influencing with Customer Advocacy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501 Enhancing Word of Mouth (WOM) with Advertising. . . . . . . . . . . . . 504 Paid Influencer Programs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505 CHAPTER 3: Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” . . . . . . 509 Communicating Like a Pro. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 Upping Your Game: Creating an Influencer Contract . . . . . . . . . . . 514 Compensating Influencers Fairly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517 CHAPTER 4: Succeeding with Influencer Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . 523 Secret #1: Set Realistic Campaign Goals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 Secret #2: Know Your Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 Secret #3: Stay on Message. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528 Secret #4: Be Agile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529 Secret #5: Recognize the Power of Emotional Stories. . . . . . . . . . . 530 Secret #6: You Get What You Measure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 CHAPTER 5: Getting Creative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533 Getting Creative and Letting Go . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533 What If It All Goes Wrong? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538 CHAPTER 6: Working with an Agency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 So, You Want to Hire an Influencer Marketing Agency . . . . . . . . . . 543 Deciding Which Type of Agency Is Right for You. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547 One-Off Events versus Continuity Campaigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Getting the lay of the land »» Approaching social media platforms like a pro »» Redefining “influence” »» Knowing what your business needs to launch successful programs Chapter 1 Communicating with Influencers C ongratulations! You’ve arrived at the era of influencer marketing: an ­exciting, interesting, fresh, ever-changing, and seriously fun time to be a marketer! You’re gonna love it here. What makes influencer marketing so compelling? For one thing, it simply ­couldn’t have existed before now. Influencer marketing brings together age-old concepts but gives them a modern, social media twist, and then distributes them across platforms that change almost daily. And the results are stunning. Influencer marketing is unprecedented and truly differentiates itself from the old marketing practices. In fact, it challenges most of them. This new medium pushes traditional boundaries — and that’s a good thing! Consumers (the folks you’re marketing to) are savvier than ever. It’s your job to keep up. In this chapter, you get an overview of what influencer marketing is and why it should matter to you — whether you know it or not! CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 471 Defining Influencer Marketing So, what is influencer marketing exactly, and why are marketers so darn excited about it? Influencer marketing is the art and science of engaging people who are influential online to share brand messaging with their audiences in the form of sponsored content. Advertisers have always used celebrity endorsements as a way to increase awareness and improve perception of a brand, because people tend to trust celebrities they admire, and sometimes aspire to be like them. Influencer marketing is similar in concept, but it has ushered in a new way to define celebrity. In addition to TV and movie stars, pro athletes, and musicians, celebrities of the social media world exist now, too. People can build big, engaged audiences on social media, such as through blogs or Instagram. And those social media influencers wield influence over their audiences, akin to celebrity influence. Brands then work with these social media influencers to create a new kind of celebrity endorsement. For example, maybe a new energy drink has just come out, and they want to market themselves as a “perfect boost for busy women.” They decide that — in addition to email blasts, online display ads, and in-person events — they’re going to reach out to influential female bloggers who write about their busy lives (and include information about the new energy drink). To engage these influencers, the energy drink’s marketing team will »» Find bloggers who meet their target demographic. »» Reach out to the bloggers in an effective and professional way so that both parties are happy with and clear about their upcoming partnership. »» Send the bloggers samples of the drink. »» Enjoy the results of a fantastic social media campaign! The bloggers’ readers are thrilled to have learned about their favorite online friend’s good experiences with this energy drink, and they comment that they’re going to try it themselves. Of course, influencer marketing is not quite that simple, and these are actually quite time-consuming and involved, but the idea is sound. So why influencer marketing? What makes it so impossible to have done before and so hot right now? »» Social media today gives access to anyone to become an influencer; anyone who builds an audience can influence that audience. This means there’s a huge pool of influencers available for brands to work with. 472 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» More tools than ever before exist to help brands find and engage with influencers. There are resources for turnkey influencer programs now that simply didn’t exist. »» Influencers exist on any channel or platform; they aren’t limited to one format or another. »» Consumers have little trust in advertising. No one clicks banner ads anymore! But consumers do trust their friends and family when it comes to product recommendations and purchasing decisions — and consumers consider social media acquaintances to be friends. »» When executed well, influencer marketing programs have proven to be one of the most cost-effective and powerful tools in a marketer’s arsenal. A slew of social media platforms are out there, but this part of the book, focuses on the six big ones: »» The most established: Programs on these platforms are replicable and scalable based on years of data and case studies. »» The most marketing-friendly: Marketers know they can expect good results from programs on these platforms. The Snapchats of the world are fun, but they haven’t yet proven to yield demonstrable results for most businesses. Regardless of how many new tools emerge, when you’ve mastered the basics of these six platforms, you can manage influencers anywhere. Blogs Blogs were arguably the first form of user-generated content that attracted advertisers. When the web evolved from top-down editorial content (content that was published on websites, much like magazines and newspapers were published, without any way for audiences to interact or respond to that content), bloggers were the first people to attract true, measurable, engaged audiences. Blogs allowed for commenters, which meant bloggers (publishers) were interacting with their audiences. This two-way communication was revolutionary, and entire communities formed around blogs. Advertisers followed. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 473 Communicating with Influencers Identifying the Primary Influencer Platforms Since 2000, blogs have evolved from being primarily text-heavy outlets for sharing opinion and personal stories, to a dizzying world of highly visual, readily shared content. Blogs are still a mainstay of influencer programs. Here’s why: »» There are popular blogs for every topic under the sun. »» Traffic and activity from blogs (page views, visits, time on site, and so on) are easy to measure. »» Influential bloggers can create gorgeous content and tell beautiful, true stories in a way that brands simply can’t. »» The evergreen nature of blog content means sponsored posts will be discovered long after programs have been completed. For more about evergreen and other types of content, see Book 3, Chapter 2. Instagram No other social media tool has enjoyed Instagram’s meteoric rise to prominence. People of all ages (especially under the age of 34) love perusing and sharing snapshots and short videos called Instastories of people’s lives, whether they know them IRL (in real life) or not. Instagram is fun and easy to use, and though marketers were once hesitant to believe that fleeting photos on Instagram could do much for brands, nearly 95 percent of retailers are now on Instagram! Working with influencers on Instagram is fabulous because »» Users want visual content that’s easy to digest, which is why Instagram is so popular. Engaging Instagram influencers to ensure that brand content is prominent on Instagram is a no-brainer! »» Simple photos and videos are a great way to bring your product to life, for others to see it in action. A picture really is worth a thousand words. »» Many tools are available to track Instagram programs simply by using a unique hashtag, so measuring program success is easy (and some of these tools are even free!). »» Instagram’s audience is broad, and often different from the audiences who are reading story-based blogs. Instagram offers a fantastic additional channel to get sponsored content in front of as many people as possible. 474 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers For more about digital marketing on Instagram, see Book 7, Chapter 5. Twitter Twitter has changed the news cycle, and the way social media-savvy users consume news. Any event will be discussed and shared as it unfolds in real time on Twitter. Twitter is the platform for the world’s social commentary, whether it’s serving as a political megaphone for citizens reporting live from the trenches, or a humorous collection of ongoing reactions to this season’s Bachelor finale. Facebook is where social media users check in and check up on family and friends (mostly people they know in real life). Twitter is where users go to find out — or share — what’s happening in the world at large with thousands of users they (mostly) don’t know. Therefore, Twitter is great for »» Hosting chats or “parties” with a wide cross-section of people who have a common interest. »» Disseminating information about a new product launch or anything newsworthy. »» Brands that are interested in actively engaging with users. Facebook is more Communicating with Influencers passive — comments may go unanswered for long periods of time, for example. Twitter users expect responses quickly. As a brand, if you can’t engage in near real-time conversations with followers, working with influencers who can do it on your behalf is a fantastic option. For more about digital marketing on Twitter, see Book 8, Chapter 1. Facebook Although Facebook isn’t quite as popular as it once was among the under-25 crowd, millions of Americans check Facebook daily. Marketers have to be there! But being there can be tricky. Facebook changes its algorithms, policies, and ad serving regularly — what worked today may not work tomorrow. It’s tough — but critical — to keep up. For that reason, when it comes to Facebook, working with influencers is fantastic. Here’s why: »» People who are popular on Facebook know how to navigate the tool to ensure that their posts are seen as widely as possible. Working with influencers means working with experts. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 475 »» If you’ve already created branded content and you just want to disseminate it, engaging Facebook influencers is your perfect solution. Facebook is incredibly powerful for sharing brief, to-the-point messages, such as coupons, in-store sale info, or branded images or videos. Running a company Facebook Page is completely different from engaging influencers to post sponsored content to Facebook. For more details about digital marketing on Facebook, see Book 7. Pinterest After soaring onto the scene, fueled by users who couldn’t get enough of the beautiful, educational, and aspirational tool, Pinterest has established itself as an absolute must for any product-based brand. Pinterest drives more traffic to online retailers than any other site. Here’s why Pinterest is great for influencer marketing: »» Influencers love to create beautiful content and post it to Pinterest. The more beautiful the content, the more extensive the pin’s reach will be. »» Working Pinterest into an influencer marketing program means thinking about the brand in a visual way, which ultimately makes the program more successful. For example, how do you make a child’s plastic bucket visually beautiful and pinworthy? By adjusting the program content to work for Pinterest — for example, images of sand castles that influencers made with the plastic bucket or by posting a list of 13 outdoor activities for kids under 5 (and all you need is a bucket!). »» Unlike other platforms, pins tend to live on and on and on, because they’re pinned and repinned in perpetuity. For more about digital marketing on Pinterest see Book 8, Chapter 4. Video Video influencers are, in some ways, the holy grail of social media influencers. In some cases, their videos reach millions of adoring viewers who can’t wait for the next installment — and to be told what products to try. A popular beauty expert who makes a video about the perfect bronzer will directly affect sales of that bronzer. 476 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers In the influencer marketing world, video is its own special entity. The most popular video influencers are often quickly scooped up by agents or agencies, which makes it difficult for brands to work directly with them. Popular video influencers can also command much higher compensation than other types of influencers, especially if they have six- and seven-figure followings. The good news is, as video production tools continue to become more ubiquitous, more affordable, and easier to use, there are more up-and-coming video influencers than ever before. Now that you can film nearly theater-quality movies with your camera, more and more people are entering the video influencer world and amassing thousands of viewers who aren’t necessarily reading blogs, checking Pinterest, or using Twitter or Facebook. And when done well, a sponsored video can be as beautiful as a TV ad, while being more authentic and compelling to viewers. To make the most of video influencer programs, »» Don’t focus too narrowly on YouTube stars. There is video talent everywhere! For example, there are thousands of Snapchat users, who have tremendous followings even though their videos are only seconds long. the masses, she’s less likely to work one-on-one with brands or marketers. »» Allow influencers great creative freedom. Building a video audience isn’t easy to do, and the influencer knows her audience best. If you want her to incorporate brand product or messaging into her work, you have to be willing to allow her the flexibility to do it her way. If you’re working with highly inexperienced and less popular video influencers, be willing to offer help — from editing resources to script ideas — and expect more back-and-forth communication throughout the process. For more about digital marketing on YouTube, see Book 8, Chapter 3. Engaging Stellar Influencers You may have the most creative, most stupendous ideas for an influencer program. Hooray! But your fabulous ideas won’t make a lick of difference if you don’t know which influencers to engage or how to engage them. This section gives you six keys to engaging stellar influencers. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 477 Communicating with Influencers »» Keep your eyes open for new talent. When a video talent is discovered by Starting with women Women influence up to 90 percent of purchasing decisions in U.S. households. So, it almost doesn’t matter what you’re selling — appealing to women simply makes sense. This doesn’t mean you should ignore male influencers in favor of working with female ones. It just means that it makes sense to start by identifying female influencers. The good news here is that women use every social media platform as much as (if not more than) men, share more product information online than men, and make a greater number of purchases as a direct result of social sharing than men do. Finding people who create great content Search for influencers who create great content that is (at least somewhat) related to your brand and who demonstrate engagement with their audiences — as evidenced by comments; followers on Facebook, Instagram, YouTube or Twitter; and social shares per post. Beyond engagement, relevancy is critical. It seems perfectly reasonable and logical for a marketer to want to go after the “biggest” influencers they can find, but big doesn’t mean relevant. For instance, say you have a client who is launching a new gluten-free protein bar, ideal for people who are fit and athletically inclined. At the outset, it might seem like a great idea to try to work with a prominent gluten-free food blogger on this program. But what if that blogger never writes about fitness and never recommends packaged products? She may have 300,000 monthly blog visitors, but it’s not likely that any of them care about prepackaged fitness foods, even if they’re gluten-free. Compare that to a blogger who may only have 25,000 monthly visitors, but whose stories focuse on her new gluten-free lifestyle as she trains for a marathon. In this case, you’d be better off working with the smaller blog. Even if the numbers won’t look as great in some reports, the program can gain more traction with the smaller blog’s audience. If you’re tempted to find the biggest influencers, keep this in mind: »» Relevancy of a blog or influencer content is more important than size. »» Prominent influencers often command much higher compensation. 478 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» Popular influencers are routinely inundated with brand offers. Your offer needs to be compelling. Even then, you must be willing to be treated as though you’re doing the influencer a favor. (This isn’t always true, but it happens often!) »» The audience of prominent influencers who do a lot of sponsored work get fatigued by sponsored messages and start tuning them out. If you’re a marketer and you need to show impressive numbers in your program report, keep in mind that there’s a lot of ways to make a dollar. If your program goal is to meet a million social impressions, you can get there with one prominent influencer whose blog garners a million monthly visitors. But you could also get there with four bloggers, each of whom gets 250,000 visitors a month — or, better yet, with 100 bloggers, each of whom has 25,000 visitors per month. At the end of the program, the 1 million number would look the same, but you’d have 100 different pieces of content from 100 different perspectives and 100 different audiences. Influencers are human beings. You want to approach working with influencers professionally, but not so professionally that you come across as a robot (or worse, a spambot). As Chapter 3 explains, reaching out to influencers to ask them to work with you isn’t as simple as sending a mass PR mailing. Outreach should be personal, thoughtful, and tell the influencer what’s in it for them. Putting in the time to craft customized outreach is time-consuming, but it always yields better results than a spray-and-pray approach. Signing a contract This may sound like a small, tactical concern, but it’s not. Bringing a contract into your influencer relationship makes sense for myriad reasons: »» You’re emphasizing that this is a professional relationship between the influencer and your brand. »» You want the influencer to create authentic content that will resonate with her audience, but you don’t have to lose complete control of the entire creative process. Use a contract to provide some rulesfor the influencer about what she can and can’t say, do, or post with respect to your brand. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 479 Communicating with Influencers Perfecting your pickup »» You’re not leaving deliverables up to chance. The “old” influencer model — where, say, a company would send product to influencers with no note at all, in the hopes that the influencer would write, well, anything about the product — is dead. As a brand you have every right to spell out exactly what coverage you expect (a blog post, a Facebook post, three Instagram images, and so on) and by a set deadline. »» A contract ensures there is no ambiguity about compensation. Include what the compensation is, how it will be delivered, and by what date. One of the most important functions of a contract is to spell out how a relationship is terminated if one of the parties doesn’t live up to the deal. Paying influencers for their time and effort When influencer marketing was still a new phenomenon in the social media sphere, brands that compensated influencers for their work were considered shady. By the old public relations standards, that’s not how things were supposed to work., Brands would simply send publications information or products in the hopes that the publications would feature them. PR folks applied the same approach with bloggers. The industry has moved past this. Influencers expect to receive compensation in return for their work. Plus, compensation should reflect that the influencers are doing work on behalf of brands regardless of how the content “performs.” If an influencer goes to the store, buys a new salad dressing, creates a beautiful dinner featuring that salad and salad dressing, blogs her salad recipe, and features gorgeous photos of the salad, all her work deserves compensation regardless of how many comments her blog post receives. For more information about creating compelling offers, see Book 1, Chapter 5. When it comes to compensation, cash is almost always preferred by influencers. It may be acceptable for a brand to offer products or services instead of cash, as long as those products or services have a monetary value equal to or greater than the cash equivalent; even then, some influencers may take offense at being offered “payment” that won’t actually pay the bills. “Paying” influencers in “blog traffic” by featuring them on a brand site is not acceptable. The Federal Trade Commission (FTC) requires that anyone who is being paid for their opinion must disclose this fact to readers. Make sure you abide by this requirement. 480 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Measuring the right stuff Measuring the right stuff doesn’t just help your influencer marketing programs; it helps you recruit the right kind of influencers. Never, ever begin an influencer program before you can answer the question, “What will success look like?” If you don’t know how you’ll measure success, how will you know if you got there? And if you don’t know what your goals are, how will you know what to measure? For more information about how to measure campaign effectiveness, see Book 9. Here are some guidelines to consider: »» You can only truly measure return on investment (ROI) if you take the cost of your entire marketing program and its effect on sales into consideration. What percentage of budget that was allocated for influencer marketing? How does that budget compare to sales results? series of blog posts is incredibly difficult. How can you track someone who saw a tweet about a new mascara, went to the blog post about it, took down the name of the mascara in her phone, and then purchased it the next time she was in her corner drugstore weeks later? The ability to use technology to track these purchase paths is improving, but it’s not there yet. (This is why you have to estimate ROI as a percentage of sales compared to percentage of budget.) »» “Success” can be measured in ways other than sales results, including the amount of content created, increases in a brand’s social followings (Facebook, Instagram, and so on), site traffic, coupon downloads, engagement (comments, shares, and so on), overall share of voice before and after a program, overall social mentions, and brand sentiment. An effective approach to measuring a program’s efficacy matters to influencers because it guides what they need to do. If you’re clear on what you’re trying to achieve, you can be clear about which influencers you need, and what you ask them to produce. (Influencers don’t want to create useless content any more than you want it created!) Being upfront with influencers about what you’re trying to achieve makes your offer more compelling, and helps the influencers feel that they’re in a true partnership with you. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 481 Communicating with Influencers »» “Success” can be measured in sales results, but linking purchases back to a Making Influencer Marketing Work for You No matter what size business you have or what kind of marketing or PR background you come from, you can make influencer marketing work for your business — as long as you keep in mind what influencer marketing can and ­cannot do! The various approaches outlined in this section can serve as the foundation for the influencer programs you’ll build. If you’re an established consumer brand If you represent a large, established brand and you’re looking to launch or enhance your influencer marketing programs, you likely have the experience, resources, and budget to regularly run large-scale programs. Leveraging your advantages If you’re an established brand, you’ve obviously been successful with your marketing and PR programs. Way to go! You have systems and processes in place for your marketing efforts, you know what works, and you have a budget in place for ensuring your campaigns are successful. You should be able to implement all the tips and tricks in your influencer marketing efforts. Use your scale and experience to your advantage! You probably already have access to more data and metrics for influencer marketing than you realize. Many social media metrics tools — the ones you’re already using to monitor your social media programs — have add-ons for measuring influencer activity. Research what your current tools can already do to help save budget while ensuring you’re measuring your programs’ successes. Speaking of measuring success, according to a 2015 study performed by influencer marketing agency Tomason, businesses are, on average, making $6.50 for each $1 spent on influencer marketing (https://www.adweek.com/digital/studyinfluencer-marketing-pays-6-50-for-every-dollar-spent/). That’s quite a statistic! Data like these support influencer marketing ROI figures and should make an easy case for diverting more marketing budget to influencer marketing. Given the demonstrable ROI, hiring a dedicated person to oversee influencer marketing makes sense. Just as businesses were once reluctant to hire full-time social media resources and now have entire social media teams and agencies, influencer marketing is deserving of full-time strategizing and implementation. 482 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Think of influencer marketing as an addition to your current programs, not a standalone effort. Start with your overall marketing plan: What are your goals? Your key messages? Your key milestones? Your social media efforts will be coordinated with your more traditional tactics (digital, print, TV, radio, and so on). There’s no reason for influencer marketing to be any different. Influencers should amplify your efforts, not compete with them! As an established brand, the best reason to use influencer marketing is to help give your brand a fresh perspective. Allowing influencers to tell your story lets other consumers see your brand through their eyes. Handing over the “­storytelling keys” to influencers breathes new life and personality into brands that may otherwise feel too staid to consumers. Avoiding common mistakes Larger brands with bigger budgets and teams can run into trouble with influencer marketing by taking too much of a “hands-off” approach. There are, of course, ways to scale influencer marketing programs, but avoid rushing to automation! Don’t fall into one of these traps: programs to an influencer agency, don’t underestimate the amount of work that goes into making influencer campaigns successful. The very reason influencer marketing works is because influencers are real, live human beings — not display ads. There are ways to scale your programs, but influencer marketing is not programmatic. Don’t approach it as though it were. »» Don’t under-budget! You’re working with individuals (not machines or ad exchanges). No matter how sophisticated your process or tools may be, every influencer campaign will be different, and each will require a larger investment of time and resources than a campaign that only involves “flipping a switch.” »» Don’t try to control everything. More established brands frequently have a more rigid way of doing things, and are often used to owning — and controlling — their own media. Yes, an influencer campaign would be more automated and controlled if a company simply provided the influencers the exact copy they were supposed to publish — except that’s not influencer marketing. Don’t try to control the messages in the name of efficiency or fear of losing control. Otherwise, you’re just forcing a different kind of display advertising into a medium where it will fall flat. (Bloggers’ audiences don’t want to read a prewritten press release!) CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 483 Communicating with Influencers »» Even if you build your own internal pool of influencers, or outsource your »» Don’t treat your influencers impersonally. The more impersonally you treat your influencers (something that’s easy to do when you’re a large organization), the less personal and less effective their work will be. Treat your influencers like individuals. Finding an approach that works for you As a large and sophisticated company, you have greater flexibility to really leverage influencer marketing and make it work for you. Here’s how: »» Your overall marketing initiatives can lay the foundation for hugely successful influencer marketing campaigns. You can use influencer marketing to supplement, enhance, and amplify your existing efforts. For example, say you’ve created a two-minute ad spot but only 30 seconds of it will air on TV. Use influencers to showcase the full video across social channels, while everyone uses the same hashtag. »» Don’t limit your perception of influencer marketing to “something someone else creates over there.” Use and repurpose the amazing content you worked so hard with your influencers to create! Spend the time, energy, and budget to create large, high-quality influencer programs. For example, the kind of programs where the writing and photos and captions and posts are striking, where influencers clearly can and do produce outstanding content for you. And then repurpose that content all day long! Use it in display ads, via social media channels, on your website, even on TV. Be sure to build content usage terms into your influencer contracts. Influencer marketing works in two directions: It’s easy to mostly focus on how influencers do a great job of introducing their readers to a new brand or product — to grow brand awareness, purchase intent, and (ultimately) purchase. But don’t forget that influencer marketing also works well for consumers who are already in the purchasing intent phase. For instance, a guy who’s looking to buy a new vacuum cleaner is going to start by searching online for something like “best family vacuum cleaners.” Imagine how compelling it would be for him to stumble upon a series of blog posts written about a specific vacuum cleaner, especially if those posts were balanced and visually attractive. He’s never heard of these bloggers before, but this demonstrates the long-term impact of influencer marketing programs. What’s more, this man may then further investigate the vacuum he’s read about by going to an online retailer and looking up the model to read reviews. It’s extra powerful to have influencers write reviews directly on retail sites (with full 484 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers disclosures that they’re being paid for their reviews) to help move the customer from intent to purchase. If you’re a small to midsize consumer brand You don’t have all the experience and budget of the major brands, but that doesn’t mean you can’t rock influencer marketing! In some ways, you’re actually more likely to be able to enjoy success with this new marketing medium because you’re more nimble and better able to try new things. You can absolutely use your size and lesser-known brand name to your advantage! Leveraging your advantages Instead of breadth of programs, focus on depth of relationships. In other words, do more with less. Spend time upfront identifying influencers who really embody your brand, and develop true, one-on-one working relationships with them. If you can’t pay them in cash, “pay” them with valuable products, insider information, and attention. Treat them as extensions of your workforce. Consider developing brand ambassador programs that span several months. If you have a lesser-known brand, you have more creative freedom. The social media influencer sphere is attracted to innovation and self-expression. The less forced influencer marketing is (that is, the less a brand insists on stringent brand and editorial guidelines when working with influencers), the more likely the program will be to garner users’ attention. Take chances and let your influencers get creative with their assignments! As you’re working to create more awareness of your brand, you’re building your social media presence. Influencer marketing is especially useful at helping companies build their social media followings on Twitter, Facebook, Pinterest, Instagram, and so on. Focusing your influencer marketing goals on shorter-term wins, such as building your social media following, means you can better track successes. “Brand awareness” is a good goal, but it’s tricky to measure and expensive to achieve on a broad, national scale. Influencer marketing goals need to be realistic and achievable, especially when your resources are constrained. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 485 Communicating with Influencers What you may lack in resources (budget and human capital) will impact the size and length of your influencer programs — you simply won’t have the ability to run giant programs again and again. Avoiding common mistakes Some approaches to influencer marketing simply won’t work, regardless of the size of the company trying to implement them. But there’s a disappointing pattern among small to midsize organizations trying to implement influencer marketing for the first time. Don’t fall into these traps: »» Don’t underestimate the cost of running influencer marketing programs. Too many companies turn to influencer marketing because they mistakenly think it’s a cheap, easy alternative to other marketing tactics. It’s not! Producing amazing and demonstrably valuable campaigns takes dedicated time and resources. That doesn’t mean you can’t get great bang for your buck, but don’t approach influencer marketing as though it’s a quick fix for marketing ails. »» Don’t let your influencer marketing take over your marketing budget. Allocate no more than 20 percent of your total marketing budget to your influence marketing programs. Remember: Influencer marketing amplifies traditional marketing efforts, but it doesn’t replace them. »» Don’t forget about how to measure success. Think about what your success metrics are going to be and how you’ll get there. Are you tracking sentiment, brand lift, coupon distribution, social media followers? With what tools and benchmarks? Whatever your goals, start with a small, in-house program with a handful of influencers and let them serve as your benchmark. Too many organizations throw together influencer programs with unrealistic expectations (“Our hashtag will go viral!”) and no way to measure success. Finding an approach that works for you You want to get the most out of your investment, especially because your marketing dollars are likely to be spread thin. Keep these tips in mind as you approach influencer marketing: »» Given your more limited resources, focus on influencer marketing programs that truly amplify your other marketing efforts rather than programs that operate completely independently from them. If you have a product promo code or sale, use influencers to get that code spread far and wide. If you’re launching a product in stores, coordinate your influencer efforts to launch at the same time. Do you have TV, YouTube, radio, or podcast content you’re proud of? Work with influencers to share that content with their audience. »» Use influencer marketing to increase awareness of and followers to your social media channels or to increase your email marketing list. This is easier to do if your influencers have one simple, clear, and consistent message. 486 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» Keep your goals realistic, measurable, and short term. »» Nurture the relationships you develop with your influencers. You want them to become vocal advocates for your brand — both online and off — even when they aren’t being paid to do so. »» Reuse the content that your influencers create! Their content can populate your other social channels and resonate with your audience because the content came from users and not just the brand. This is especially true for Facebook, where you’re constantly searching for new content that will engage your readers; posting images and blog links is fast, easy, and very relatable. If you’re a startup brand Being a startup is tough in every way. You’re struggling to build something great internally, while ensuring that potential customers know you exist. Often startups turn to influencer marketing because they think it’s a fast, cheap (read: free) way to get a lot of traction with brand awareness. And although that’s not exactly true, there are ways to make influencer marketing work for startups. The very best advantage you have as a startup is that you’re new and fresh. Maybe you want to be first to market with a cool new concept. Maybe you can do something no one has seen before! Find influencers who care about being trendy and who want to know, see, or do things before their peers, and appeal to this desire — you’ve got something no one else has. If you can’t pay them, offer them first looks, tours of your workspace, beta versions of products before they’re on the market, or stock/equity in your company. Be creative! As you’re trying to get your brand name out there, you have tons of freedom to try new things. PR “stunts” are safer to try. Consider collaborating with potential influencers to do something radical! You don’t have to limit your influencer activity to writing reviews of your product. Consider reaching out to influencers and using them as beta testers. Bloggers can make amazing virtual focus groups. Sometimes, early feedback makes all the difference between a startup succeeding or failing. If you don’t have the resources to pay an influencer to write a public-facing review, the influencer may still be willing to work with you to give you private feedback. CHAPTER 1 Communicating with Influencers 487 Communicating with Influencers Leveraging your advantages Avoiding common mistakes Startups tend to make the following mistakes when it comes to influencer marketing. Avoid doing the following: »» Assume influencer marketing is quick or cheap. Influencer marketing takes a lot of time and resources, two things most startups don’t often have. Unless there is a clear strategic marketing goal that influencers can help you achieve (such as beta testing), don’t waste your startup energy. »» Try influencer marketing if your product is an app. If you’re promoting an app, you may want to reconsider influencer marketing. Yes, it can be a fabulous tool for long-term boosts in searches — if you engage a handful of bloggers to include your app as part of a blog series on “perfect apps for kindergarteners,” you can be sure that parents who search for “kindergarten apps” will discover those posts. But you won’t see a surge of downloads directly from blog posts. Don’t max out your marketing budget hiring 50 bloggers to write about your app thinking you’ll see thousands and thousands of downloads as a result. Influencer marketing is not direct response — it will never convert at the rate a startup app needs. Finding an approach that works for you If you’re limited in resources and budget, be very deliberate in how to leverage influencers and know exactly what you’re going to get out of a program before you start one. 488 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers IN THIS CHAPTER »» Examining the changing role of influencers »» Measuring the value of influencers »» Looking at influencer types Chapter 2 Collaborating to Win I n today’s marketplace, many types of people make up the constellation of customer influencers. Sometimes a family friend can supersede any referral made by your hand-picked celebrity. It’s important to know your audience and understand what really matters to them. The key to using influence is putting the customer at the center of your content-marketing efforts. In this chapter, you look at how digital marketers can harness the role of influencers to satisfy a customer’s greatest needs and make their brand indispensable. You examine both the accepted industry expert and the influencer whose word of mouth (WOM) recommendations drive conversions. Discovering the Evolving Role of Influencers First, what is social influence? Pam Hughes (nee Dyer), Marketing Chief at Agile Alliance and one of Forbes Top 25 influencers the defines social influence as the following: Social influence occurs when a person’s thoughts, feelings, or actions are affected by others. Essentially, influence is the art of persuasion — the ability to cause a change in mindset or actions so someone thinks or behaves in a certain way. In the world of social media marketing, influence is currency. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 489 This quote clearly spells out the three principles that must be present to influence others. To have influence, something or someone must do the following: »» Impact the person’s feelings. Although most people believe otherwise, logic is not the way to influence someone. You must touch people to get their attention and allow them to focus on primitive emotions. Most information goes right by you unless it taps into your lizard brain (the part of the brain that controls such things as addiction, happiness, and the fear response.) »» Cause a change in mindset. Influence must cause movement that impacts your mindset. You may start as neutral or even negative. Persuasion causes you to move in the direction of the influencer. »» Rest on a trust relationship. Influencers have “emotional capital” with their audience. They are trusted, which keeps the lizard brain from invoking the “fight or flight” response and instead focuses on positive emotions. Persuasion is not trickery or deceit. The best types of persuasion help educate buyers to understand that your solution is the best. After you’ve done that, price is not an impediment to selling. You’ve allowed the buyer to persuade herself. Understanding the six principles of persuasion In his seminal book, Influence: The Psychology of Persuasion, Robert Cialdini identifies six principles at the heart of persuasion. (You might want to check out his blog, shown in Figure 2-1, at http://www.influenceatwork.com/. Also see the upcoming sidebar “Social proof and reciprocity: Better together?”) Cialdini’s principles are closely followed by marketers, and they can help you identify why your customers respond to some tactics more than others. Here’s a quick overview of these six principles: »» Reciprocity: This principle is about keeping a relationship in balance. You want to reciprocate to someone who gives you something. There is no stated contract, but people instinctively want to make sure that they don’t take more than they give. »» Social proof: This is another principle that remains unspoken but is ­ nderstood by most. People like to eliminate the amount of risk they take u in everyday life. One way to do this is to make sure that others have made the same decision you are about to make and have been pleased with the consequences. No one wants to be the first person to try something. Content marketers know that they need to show customers that others have used and raved about their products. 490 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» Liking: It’s well known that people want to do business with people they like. Dealing with likable people and brands is easy and certainly preferable to dealing with someone who is difficult. It is that simple. If your customers like you or your brand, they’re predisposed to do business with you. »» Authority: People believe in experts. If you have a title after your name or are an acknowledged authority in some field, people believe what you say. If an authority recommends you, you’re more likely to be chosen. »» Scarcity: This principle has been abused by marketers since the beginning of advertising. People hate the idea that they can’t have something because its quantity is limited. When something is scarce, people want it all the more. Content marketers have recently extended this principle and called it fear of missing out (FOMO), which includes the value of physical goods as well as the fear of losing out on an experience that can’t be repeated. The idea of FOMO is discussed further in Book 2, Chapter 2. The buyer journey is detailed in Book 2, Chapter 3. »» Commitment and consistency: People’s image of themselves dictates their Collaborating to Win behavior. For example, if they consider themselves to be generous, they would not like to find themselves acting in a miserly way. They want their behavior to be consistent with who they are. If they make a commitment, they want to believe that they will keep it. FIGURE 2-1: Influence at Work. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 491 SOCIAL PROOF AND RECIPROCITY: BETTER TOGETHER? Robert Cialdini’s well-known “Towel Reuse Study” has garnered much attention. He looked at the impact of changes he made to small signs left for patrons in their hotel rooms. In randomly assigned rooms, he left a sign that asked patrons to reuse towels because it was good for the environment. In the other rooms, he asked them to reuse towels and noted that other guests had recycled their towels at least once during their stay. Here you see social proof in action. Twenty-six percent more of the guests who received the second sign recycled their towels. The simple fact that other guests had recycled made it more likely that these guests would do so, too. Another study cited by the American Psychological Association (http://www.apa.org/ monitor/2011/02/persuasion.aspx) returned to the topic of towel recycling. This time, the topic related to the reciprocity principle. The sign referencing the environment was used, and another, randomly distributed sign said, “We already donated to an environmental cause in the name of our guests. Would you join us in this effort to cover our costs?” This sign testing the reciprocity principle achieved a 21 percent greater response than the first. Understanding why influencers ­matter more now A trusted friend or family member has always been a social influencer. But online, influencers matter even more than they used to because of the glut of information coming at your customer from all sides. No one can read and understand everything on the web that he wants to know. People need help in the form of customer reviews, recommendations, and communities united around common topics. According to Forbes, shoppers have completed 70–90 percent of their research before they ever speak to a salesperson. It’s both a blessing and a curse that users can investigate products or services they want to buy before ever talking to a salesperson. Rather than turning to a salesperson, they find trusted sources who can explain the benefits of a product without displaying a vested interest in making a sale. That’s where influencers come in. 492 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Influence marketing provides several benefits, including: »» Lending credibility: Customers give a sales page on a company’s website very little credence. It’s great to find out about specific product features, but most customers are too cynical to believe the hype. When an influencer recommends the product, it’s given much more weight. You can capture brand awareness through recommendations in a way that you can’t with your own ads. In a study by Dimensional Research, respondents found that 90 percent said that positive reviews impacted their buying decisions. Eighty-six percent said their buying decisions were influenced by negative online reviews (https:// marketingland.com/survey-customers-more-frustrated-by-howlong-it-takes-to-resolve-a-customer-service-issue-than-theresolution-38756). »» Cost-effective targeting: It’s easier to tap into a community of people interested in your topic than it is to create one from scratch. Influencers have already done the hard work. »» Positioning and copy: Many content marketers overlook the opportunity to learn from their audience’s influencers. How do they talk about the product? Are they tapping into specific emotions or using special language? They show you what content resonates with your audience. Paying attention to their appeal and what their audience wants to hear is an important takeaway for you. »» Finding out what channels are their favorites: Influencer audiences point the way to the channels your potential customers spend time on, thereby saving you a huge amount of time and pointing the way to the best advertising venues. »» Developing brand awareness: Having an influencer discuss your products »» Helping build your online community: Building an audience from scratch is difficult and time consuming. Anything that you can do to encourage selfselected members of the influencer’s group to join you as well is a great boost. »» Fronting a specific campaign: You know that some campaigns are more important than others. If you are a start-up and customers are seeing your product for the first time, collaborating with an industry insider can make all the difference. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 493 Collaborating to Win can develop enhanced brand awareness. Not only is the influencer discussing your product, she is implicitly endorsing your brand. Understanding how to measure expert influencers How can influence be measured? A lot of controversy exists among content marketers about how to measure influencer clout. Marketers dislike the way some clout-ranking companies give a high rating to an influencer based solely on the number of Twitter followers he has or the amount of attention he garners on Facebook. The key to measuring influence is by looking at a range of factors. An ebook called Identifying and Measuring Influencers in Social Marketing published by Klout (closed its doors) identified three attributes of influences: »» Reach: Does the influencer have your target audience as a subset of hers? Does she have the social followers and real-world influence to impact your potential customers? Is her audience large and responsive? »» Relevance: Do the influencer’s content topics align with yours? Does his content have the quality your audience expects? »» Resonance: Do the influencer’s authority and authenticity attract the audience you’re trying to reach? This is important to determine. You want to be sure that you don’t have more of a niche audience that doesn’t resonate with your influencer. Recognizing Influencer Types You may be surprised by the wide range of influencer types. When you say influencer, what usually comes to mind is a celebrity or family member. But influencers come in five types: »» Friends, family, and work colleagues: This category of influencer you’re most familiar with. These influencers make up the person’s social graph on social media platforms. They are known as positional influencers because they constitute the person’s inner circle. »» Subject experts: This group has demonstrated expertise in a particular topic or area of interest. They are thought leaders and others who work to gain recognition by virtue of their knowledge. When they recommend something, their audience listens. These people generally have titles such as trendsetter, thought leader, authority, or even analyst. A subset of this group is the gadfly. The gadfly is known for saying controversial things and disrupting the status quo. 494 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» Professionals in high positions: You recognize these influencers because they have jobs that confer expertise on them. They are the captains of industry, the politicians, and the local business leaders. Their credibility is measured by the size of the position they hold and the people over which they have power. Titles for these people include decision maker or industry leader. »» Celebrities: This group is easy to identify. Its members have high profiles and are written about in magazines and newspapers. Celebrity influence is very high and usually unpredictable. Fashion designers and others often give celebrities their merchandise free in the hopes that the celebrity will be photographed wearing it. That kind of publicity can’t be bought. The downside to using celebrity influencers is that you may be subject to criticism if their behavior doesn’t comport with your brand. A subset of this group is the professional brand. These people are stars in their specific industry. For example, they could be a YouTube star or Internet marketing star. What kind of influence do you think you could wield if you’re Taylor Swift. She told Apple in 2015 that she wasn’t going to allow her album 1989 to stream on Apple’s service because of its decision not to pay artists during Apple’s three-month trial period. Apple quickly relented and agreed to accommodate the artists in some way. Swift accomplished this concession by placing an open letter to Apple on her Tumblog (http://taylorswift. tumblr.com), demonstrating that influencers can impact even the world’s most valuable brand. Are you targeting millennials? If so, be careful who you choose as your celebrity. MediaPost, an online publishing resource for advertising professionals, reports that “Authenticity is most important among the very desirable youth market (ages 12–29)” (http://www.mediapost.com/publications/ connection to your brand to satisfy this group. For more about marketing to Millennials, see Book 4. »» Your raving fans: This group is the one you love to nourish. This group’s members are the people who chat up your brand and do the work of a citizen sales force. Their buzz is organic and never dies down. These people influence by being your best brand ambassadors. You can find out more about how to use your fans in the “Enhancing Word of Mouth (WOM) with Advertising” section, later in this chapter. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 495 Collaborating to Win article/251664/rethinking-celebrity-endorsements-authenticityan.html?edition=83523). Even the most popular celebrity must have a true Finding the Right Influencers If you’ve read the previous sections of this chapter, by now you’re probably convinced that influencers matter. But how do you find the influencers who are right for your audience? Assuming that you’re starting from scratch, the following sections look at how to find the right influencers and approach them. Discovering the influencers you need to target Say that you’ve considered the influencer types described in the preceding section, “Recognizing Influencer Types,” and have decided to focus on self-selected experts for now. These top thought leaders and bloggers are whom your target audience reads and follows. (At some point, you will also want to consider the other types, of course, such as raving fans.) Following are several immediate actions you can take to find influencers using three free online tools — BuzzSumo, Followerwonk, and Alltop: BuzzSumo To find influencers through the BuzzSumo tool, follow these steps: 1. Go to https://app.buzzsumo.com/influencers to use the influencer search. Look at the left side and select the filters you want to use, such as bloggers and influencers, as shown in Figure 2-2. 2. Type the topic of your niche. After typing your topic, you receive a list of results, as shown in Figure 2-3 that shows the results for pet food. (For a longer list, you need to sign up for the Pro version and pay a fee.) From this list, you can start to research influencers. 3. 496 Select the ones you want to research further and put them on a list in an Excel spreadsheet or Google Doc. BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers FIGURE 2-2: Collaborating to Win Filters on BuzzSumo for influencer types. FIGURE 2-3: Results of pet food search on BuzzSumo. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 497 Followerwonk Follow these steps to work with the tool on Followerwonk: 1. Go to http://followerwonk.com. On the page that opens, you see a tab called Search Bios on the upper left hand side. 2. Click the Search Bios tab and type in the topic of your choice, for example pet food. Followerwonk returns a list of all your Twitter followers who cite pet food in their profiles, as shown in Figure 2-4. Add the names you want to look at further to the list you created. FIGURE 2-4: The ­FollowerWonk homepage. Alltop Alltop provides a collection of the best blogs on various topics. To find those blogs, follow these steps: 1. Go to http://alltop.com/. You get the alltop homepage, as shown in Figure 2-5. 498 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers 2. On the list of blogs, look for duplicates and see which ones show up most often. Don’t forget to consider bloggers that aren’t at the top of the list. They may be more open to collaborating because they’re not bombarded daily with offers. FIGURE 2-5: Topics to search at the top of the Alltop home page. Don’t forget that you can also search Google using your terms as hashtags and keywords. Developing a system After you pick the influencer(s) you want to work with, you should establish a working system to define your roles. This step is important because you want to make sure that everything goes smoothly. You may feel a bit intimidated working with your influencer for the first time, but you want to ensure success. The last thing you want to do is alienate someone who is important to your audience. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 499 Collaborating to Win You can always do a simple search on Google for your topic, such as pet food influencers, and see which blogs are returned. You can also search related terms, such as “pet resources,” to see what you find. For this reason your system should have a documented plan. Working with your influencer includes documenting the following: »» The overall goal of the campaign or collaboration: Each of you will have different goals for participating. You should make sure that it’s clear what each of your goals are. »» Deliverables: Document what the campaign deliverables will be. Are you going to put on a webinar for the influencer’s audience? Who will take care of the promotion and the technical aspects? »» Roles: Some influencers may want to front the campaign, whereas others may want you to take the lead. If the influencer has to spend time preparing a presentation, you want her to know that up front. »» Decisions about editorial content: Will you have to get approval for all the content in your campaign? Does the influencer want to run through everything beforehand or is he leaving the details to you? »» Success measures: How will you know whether the collaboration was a success? Decide beforehand what measures will be used. Make this process as informal or formal as you think it warrants. The key is that you do it. It’s not uncommon for people to be disappointed by those with whom they’ve collaborated because they didn’t have clear parameters before they began. You also need to establish some predefined metrics that will let you know whether your association with an influencer is valuable. You may not have revenue returns immediately (unless you’re specifically selling a product or service). However, you do want to make sure that you have tangible results. Although the ROI is difficult to measure, here are some to consider: »» Increase in followers tied to that influencer »» Increase in requests for sales demos or leads or materials »» Increase in your mailing list tied to a specific landing page that you established for the campaign »» Increase in sales of the product or service if applicable »» Increased traffic of new visitors to your website right after the campaign 500 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Uncovering New Influencers Influencer marketing continues to change with the influx of new channels and technology. A relatively new phenomenon is the social media platform celebrity. That’s an influencer who becomes popular on a specific platform based on the content that influencer creates just for that platform. Musicians, beauty bloggers, and others have posted tutorials that have catapulted them to fame. Social media creates its own media stars. Two innovative ways that influencers are being discovered are »» On social platforms that have their own celebrities: Because social media platforms have no barrier to entry, anyone with a good story to tell and a pleasing personality has a shot at becoming famous. This fame can then be parlayed into a line of physical goods, such as makeup, or a gig with a brand that wants to appropriate your celebrity for its media campaign. »» By creating algorithms on social platforms to find more catalysts: Another way in which social platforms are using influencers is to uncover and target them for their own publicity purposes. Uncovering new influencers and using their clout is serious business. A case in point is Facebook’s being granted of an ad patent that would reportedly identify new influencers. The way it works is that Facebook can identify the people who share content and then get the most reshares. Every advertiser would be interested in knowing who they are and paying to advertise directly to them. Influencing with Customer Advocacy As most content marketers agree, getting WOM from happy customers is the best advertising of all. If you can encourage your own fans to be your de facto sales force, you can expect great results. By organizing your most ardent fans, you can multiply your brand’s profile. One type of advocacy is typically known as brand ambassadorship, which is a program that has a company’s most loyal customers provide testimonials and other positive information to prospects. The program can be as large or small as makes sense for your audience. When people join your ambassador program, you can offer them free stuff, discounts, or special group meetings. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 501 Collaborating to Win If you know the influencer’s website but not his specific email address, you may want to check out Email Hunter at (https://emailhunter.co/). This tool isn’t a license to spam someone, however. Be respectful. One key benefit of an ambassador program is that you will be privy to feedback that you probably wouldn’t get from other sources. Remember, these are your fans, so their criticisms are heartfelt. They want to make the program better. Consider them to be your most intense focus group. One example of brand ambassadorship is the Champions Program created by Brainshark, a sales enablement company that helps customers create high-end video sales presentations. Its case study was reported by Truman Tang on the Influitive blog (http://influitive.com/blog/brainshark-social-media-case-study/). Tang reported that Brainshark knew it had an avid group of fans who loved its products. The key was to figure out how to get those fans to increase their advocacy on social media. To this end, the company created an online community staffed by Brainshark’s star employees and called that community Brainshark Champions. The community invited customers who had given testimonials and case studies on the company’s website. Customers were categorized into four groups: (1) active users; (2) social content sharers; (3) customers nominated for their loyalty by employees; and (4) community leaders and influencers. To demonstrate its commitment, the company provided the community with exclusive training and networking about Brainshark products. Obviously, this offering served as a real incentive to raving fans. The program was very successful and won Brainshark the Forrester Groundswell Award for 2014. One success measure showed a 106 percent boost in Twitter activity. Clearly, a program like this would be worth considering for your fan base. Another example of a very active brand ambassador community is the one run by Evernote (https://evernote.com/community), the online content catcher. With more than one hundred million users, Evernote must be doing something right. It started its ambassador program in 2011 with an eye toward highlighting different use cases. Evernote picked users who were both passionate about Evernote and expert in their own field, and the company wanted to offer something valuable to these users. For example, a user who wantsto solve a particular problem with Evernote might find an ambassador who can offer tips and hints. Figure 2-6 shows a listing for Paperless Living Ambassador Jamie Todd Rubin. You can also see a link to Rubin’s website (http://Jamietoddrubin.com), shown in Figure 2-7, on which he mentions his ambassadorship in his blog heading along with his own considerable skills. Clearly, this is a win-win for both the ambassador and the company. 502 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers FIGURE 2-6: Collaborating to Win Example of Evernote listing for an ambassador. FIGURE 2-7: Jamie Todd Rubin’s website. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 503 Enhancing Word of Mouth (WOM) with Advertising As powerful as a collaboration with an industry influencer can be, word-of-mouth (WOM) recommendations are equally important. When you adopt WOM as a content marketing strategy, you can get results that are even more effective. The best way to deploy WOM as a strategy is to understand its power as an advertising tactic that is called Word of Mouth Advertising (WOMA). WOMA refers to actively using tactics to encourage WOM. Rather than use hope as a strategy to accelerate WOM, you proactively seed your campaigns with WOMA. A study at the University of Auckland Business School found that three major benefits accrue to companies when WOM is used. They are (1) greater enthusiasm for a company and its products; (2) increased brand awareness; and (3) greater customer loyalty. Connecting with your audience An article in Forbes reports that 64 percent of marketing executives believe that word of mouth is the most effective form of marketing. Only six percent say that they have mastered it. That’s an astounding number! So why is using word of mouth marketing (WOMM) so difficult? Suzanne Fanning, former President of the Word of Mouth Marketing Association (WOMMA), thinks she knows why. She believes that marketers have a hard time with WOMM because they use it to “collect rather than connect.” By this she means that marketers are focused on counting followers, tweets, and likes rather than actually connecting with the very audience who loves their products (http://www.forbes.com/sites/kimberlywhitler/2014/07/ 17/why-word-of-mouth-marketing-is-the-most-important-social-media/). (In 2018, the Association of National Advertisers (ANA) acquired WOMMA.) You can easily see how this lack of connection results in a failed strategy. Most marketers show off their social media numbers as though they directly translate into revenue. What’s missing is the knowledge of the level of advocacy behind those numbers. Many of your followers can have only a very casual interest in your brand and not be very effective ambassadors. 504 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Identifying factors for WOM It’s important to understand what factors must be present to trigger WOM. The conditions have to be right so that people feel comfortable sharing content with their trusted network. According to a study by consulting service McKinsey & Company (http://www.mckinsey.com/insights/marketing_sales/a_new_way_ to_measure_word-of-mouth_marketing), three factors are critical to triggering WOM, as explained in Table 2-1. TABLE 2-1 Three Critical Factors that Trigger WOM Factor Must Be Present to Trigger What’s said Important product or service features Identity of the messenger Trusted advisor Environment Trusted channel where the message seen Paid Influencer Programs If you want to go further and develop an ongoing influencer program for your company, you may want to consider paid influencer programs. A report called “2017 Influencer Marketing Benchmarks,” by RhythmOne (http://www. rhythmone.com/advertisers/influencer-marketing), found that “advertisers who implemented an Influencer Marketing campaign in 2017 received $12.21 in earned media value for every $1.00 of paid media.” Here are a few influencer programs you may want to investigate: »» GroupHigh (http://www.grouphigh.com): Shown in Figure 2-8, GroupHigh Collaborating to Win is a PR and marketing software provider that helps companies find influential bloggers. »» RhythmOne (http://www.rhythmone.com): RhythmOne is a company that provides influencer marketing and unites advertising across all devices. (See Figure 2-9.) »» Tapinfluence (http://www.tapinfluence.com/): Shown in Figure 2-10, Tapinfluence has a Software as Service (SAS) platform that helps brands find influencers and create co-branded content. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 505 FIGURE 2-8 GroupHigh. FIGURE 2-9 RhythmOne. 506 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers FIGURE 2-10 Collaborating to Win Tapinfluence. CHAPTER 2 Collaborating to Win 507 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Approaching influencers with irresistible offers »» Entering into mutually agreeable relationships »» Ensuring great results and happy influencers »» Compensating influencers the right way Chapter 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” T he overwhelming majority of influencers, especially the ones brands should be targeting, are not celebrities. They don’t have agents. They aren’t corporate entities. They may not have any corporate (let alone marketing or advertising) experience to speak of. They’re real, genuine people who have amassed an online following simply by being themselves. Reaching out to influencers, getting them to respond, and ultimately getting them to do what you want is possible . . . but it’s not as easy as automated transactions. You can’t “order” engaging, personal, and authentic sponsored content the way you can buy ad space or hire a celebrity endorser who will ultimately read from a script. And you can’t reach out to influencers as though they’re press or as though they understand (or care about) your corporate-ese. Mastering influencer outreach, relationship building, and program execution isn’t hard as long as you keep the three Cs in mind: communicating, contracting, and compensating. This chapter has you covered. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 509 Communicating Like a Pro When you’ve decided that you’re ready to work with social media influencers, you may spend quite a bit of time finding the right influencers for you. Don’t let it all fall apart by screwing up your communication. In this section, you find out how to reach out to influencers in a way that will reflect well on your brand, whether the influencers decide to work with you or not. Making your communication personal The number-one mistake marketers make is sending the same generic email to every influencer. How personal social media is can’t be stressed enough in this chapter. People connect through dozens of different channels every day to stay in touch with friends, family, their communities, and the world. Social media outreach needs to be personal, too. Each influencer is special in her own way. Each influencer has cultivated a unique audience and deserves to be recognized accordingly. If you want a successful influencer outreach program, start by contacting individuals (not mass email lists). Find an influencer you believe will do good work for you and tell her why — read her blog, understand what she blogs about and who her audience is, and tell her why you think she’d be the ideal influencer for your company. Approach influencers as you would potential partners — not as potential hires who didn’t even know you had a “help wanted” sign on your window! This means doing your research and putting in a lot of upfront work. But the time spent is worth it! To make your outreach personal, follow these tips: »» Remember that most influencers take their work personally. They consider their relationships with their readers personal as well. If you want to interrupt their regular flow of content to have them showcase your sponsored messaging, the very least you can do is recognize that’s what you’re asking of them. »» Don’t address your email to “blogger” or “writer of such-and-such blog.” Find the name of the person behind the account, or at least how he refers to himself. 510 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” »» Avoid marketing-speak. You’re reaching out to a person, not a corporation. Approach your target with respect and professionalism, but also as a human being. »» Don’t forget that you’re asking them to do something for you, not the other way around. Even if your product is the best, even if you’re only contacting the very top of the top-tier influencers, even if you’re planning to pay them well, never lose sight of the fact that you’re the one asking for their help. Making your offer compelling You want to leverage each influencer’s voice and brand and the influence she’s established among her community to further your brand message. Why would an influencer want to do that for you? Unless you can answer that question, you’re not likely to get very far, no matter how personal your message. As influencer marketing expands as a viable marketing approach, influencers are in higher and higher demand. As a brand, your offer needs to be compelling. Simply having a great product may not be enough. Never approach an influencer if you haven’t thought through a good response to the question, “What’s in it for the influencer?” In the following sections, you walk through several key ingredients you may be able to offer to sweeten the deal: stuff, status, and creative freedom. Offering free stuff The simplest and most obvious offer brands make to influencers is a quid pro quo: We’ll send you our product for free in exchange for your writing a review of the product on your blog. Makes sense, right? In many cases, this approach works well. For example, many beauty bloggers, Instagrammers, and YouTubers receive makeup samples in exchange for including those samples in their makeup photos and tutorials. If your product doesn’t have much retail value, or you don’t have enough product samples to send to every potential influencer, this approach isn’t the right one for you. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 511 Offering status Offering “insider” information about your company and products is a great way to engage fans on social media. Liking a brand page on Facebook may give someone access to behind-the-scenes information, advance notice of cool announcements, and even special discounts or coupons. A similar tactic can work well with influencers. If an influencer is someone who would likely use your product or like your company, you could offer her special “insider” status in return for writing about your brand. In fact, you could even offer her an ambassador role. A brand ambassador is an influencer who partners with a brand and works almost as an extension of the company. Her role is to promote a brand online over an agreed-upon amount of time (although it’s possible that she’ll be so enamored of your company that she’ll continue to promote it after her ambassadorship is over). Many influencers enjoy being brand ambassadors as long as the brands follow through on their end of the bargain — that is, they ensure the role of brand ambassador is actually compelling. Here are some tips for how to make a brand ambassador or “insider” offer compelling: »» Offer your ambassadors sneak peeks at upcoming products or announcements as you would with employees. »» Engage in regular communication with your ambassadors to share behind-the-scenes information, such as photos of the company or product that isn’t otherwise available to the public. »» Send your ambassadors product(s) to sample before the product is available in stores. »» Offer your ambassadors special coupons or discounts or (even better!) give your ambassadors codes that they can give away or pass on to their readers at their discretion. »» Cross-promote the content that your ambassadors create on your own social channels — you can repost her photos on Instagram, retweet her tweets, even feature her blog or images on your brand’s Facebook Page. Offering creative freedom You’re selecting your influencers because you like the content they produce. Unfortunately, too many companies make the mistake of engaging with an influencer only to tell her exactly what she is supposed to do — from the photos she should post, to the language she should tweet, to the features and benefits she should highlight. 512 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers You’re working with influencers so that they tell your brand’s story in their own unique way. The more you try to control their message, the more like an ignorable “ad” the message becomes. You also risk damaging the influencer’s reputation with her audience if you force her to use your marketing language while framing it as though it’s her own. In addition, consider brainstorming with the influencers about the kind of content they want to create! Don’t be afraid to invite your influencers to your company’s creative table and be part of the campaign planning from the beginning. After all, who knows what will resonate on your influencers’ social media channels better than the social media influencers themselves? Keeping it real: Do’s and don’ts When it comes to influencer outreach, put yourself in the mindset of the influencer. Social media is founded on authenticity, so as much as you’re able to, leave your jargon and marketing hype out of the equation. Online influencers are popular because their audience relates to them. They aren’t corporate entities — if you want these influencers to respond to you, you need to speak to them like the people they are. This may seem obvious, but it’s harder than it seems! Here are the do’s and don’ts of keeping it real in influencer outreach: »» Don’t make false claims about your brand or company. For example, don’t call a product “life-changing” if it isn’t (and let’s be honest, few products are). »» Do explain why your company, brand, or product is worthy of being promoted. »» Don’t make the message or request confusing. The influencer shouldn’t have to guess at what you’re asking them to do! Don’t send an email saying, “I thought you’d want to know about this product” with no call to action if what you really want them to do is write a blog post reviewing the product. »» Do keep your message clear and simple. Ask for what you’d like the influencer to do. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 513 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” Not giving an influencer her space to create an authentic-sounding, craftedby-her message dilutes the whole reason you want to use influencers in the first place. Brands that give the influencers gentle guidance but then let them “do their thing” are much happier with the results. »» Don’t expect your product, message, or social media campaign to go viral. Yes, influencers have caused virality but there’s no way to predict what, when, or how something — especially a sponsored piece — will hit it big. »» Do be realistic in what results you can expect from your influencer. There are many different ways to set goals for influencer marketing programs. Unfortunately, “We want it to go viral” is not a realistic or useful one. »» Don’t expect the influencer to create an ad. Influencer-generated content is not a glossy print ad, it’s not a press release, it’s not a graphically designed display ad. You’re asking the influencer to create a sponsored message in her own authentic way. If you want to control every aspect of what the influencer produces (her language, her post design, editing her photos), you’re no longer engaging in influencer marketing, you’re defaulting to a purely paid media model. »» Do provide clear editorial guidelines and standards (things the influencers should or should not do) and let them tell your story their way. »» Don’t ask your influencers to jump through hoops. The harder you make the program, the more room there is for errors and incomplete assignments. For instance, don’t require that your influencers download a coupon, print it, take it to a specific store miles and miles away from them, purchase the item, bring it home, demo it, write an extensive review, take tons of photos, and post everything to their blogs, Twitter, Facebook, and Instagram with only a few days’ notice. »» Do be considerate of your influencers. The easier your request, the better the odds that you’ll have a successful program. Upping Your Game: Creating an Influencer Contract One of the most important things you can do to ensure a successful influencer marketing program is to establish a contract with your influencers. This should be a simple but legally binding contract between the hiring entity (that’s you, or your marketing agency if you hired one) and each and every influencer that entity is engaging. Use an online service such as EchoSign (www.echosign.adobe.com) to send and sign contracts electronically with no need to print, fax, or mail anything. 514 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Nothing is preventing you from entering into a professional relationship with your influencers. You are, essentially, hiring them to function as an extension of your marketing team. You’d never hire someone (even a freelancer) without a written agreement, so contracting with influencers just makes good business sense. Setting expectations Don’t leave your influencer marketing program to chance. When you’ve reached out to your influencers and established mutual interest, it’s in all parties’ best interests to put in writing exactly what is expected, when, and for how much. Forget the idea of writing an influencer to say, “I thought you’d want to know about . . .” without actually asking them to do anything specific. Be as clear as possible, and don’t be afraid to ask for what you want. Controlling what you need to control Many brands harbor some fear of bloggers and influencers in general. For as far as social media has come, some companies still hate the loss of control that comes with engaging with the masses on platforms they don’t own and can’t completely steer. With one-way communication (where companies controlled everything about their brand image and messaging, before social media allowed consumers to “talk back”), companies didn’t have to worry about anything being “off-brand.” When you hire influencers to produce sponsored content, you’re walking a fine line. You want the message the influencers create to be on-point, but you can’t have the message seem too corporate or it’ll sound inauthentic (because it is!). But if you allow someone to produce brand content for you, you risk that influencer going “off-brand.” The entire point of influencer marketing is to let the influencers do what they do best: Craft your story in a way that’s best for their readers. Fortunately, this doesn’t mean giving the influencers carte blanche. With a contract, you can give your influencers express guidelines that should help them stay within the bounds you feel comfortable with. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 515 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” Setting up a simple contract can mean the difference between the “spray and pray” approach — where you reach out to dozens of influencers and hope they produce something of quality — and knowing exactly what results you can expect. Protecting yourself and your brand A contract doesn’t just help the influencers understand what’s expected of them, it helps protect you, your company, and your brand. From a simple legal standpoint, if the influencer you contract doesn’t fulfill her end of the deal, you’re under no obligation to compensate her. If the work she produces isn’t up to your standards, or is in violation of the guidelines you provided, you have recourse to ask her to change her work and bring it up to snuff. You may be wondering what happens if you hire a blogger and she hates your product. What if she writes terrible things about your company? Can you make her sign something that says she won’t say anything bad? The short answer is “no,” but the longer answer is “nor should you want to.” You can draft a contract that clearly states that the influencer may not post content that is false. However, it’s unethical to require a positive review. What’s more, if an influencer posts an unbalanced review of a product or company, it’ll come across as inauthentic. Her readers will know she’s not being genuine — especially because influencers are required to disclose that they’ve been sponsored to create brand content. This is mandated by the Federal Trade Commission (FTC) so don’t make the mistake of overlooking this. Avoiding problem influencers Not only is it unethical to require positivity in a contract, it’s largely unnecessary. Consider why an influencer may write something damaging to a brand so you can avoid putting yourself in harm’s way: »» The influencer genuinely doesn’t like or understand the product. Make sure you’re targeting the right influencers and that they’re a good match for your product before you enter into a contract, and you’ll likely avoid this problem. »» The influencer receives a shoddy product that doesn’t work, doesn’t meet claims, or doesn’t live up to its hype. If you don’t make claims about a product that it can’t live up to, you’ll prevent this problem. And if the product just isn’t very good (which sometimes happens), use another form of marketing instead of asking for honest feedback from influencers. »» The influencer feels frustrated, undervalued, or angry with how the program has been managed. Make sure your expectations have been communicated clearly and are outlined in a contract that both parties have 516 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Knowing what to include in a contract Have a lawyer create your contract with all the standard elements needed to ensure your contract is legally binding. your influencer contract should include these contract elements: »» The influencer’s legal name. »» The influencer’s social media addresses where you expect her to post (for example, her blog URL, Instagram handle, Twitter handle, and so on). »» Specific deliverables with deadlines. For example, “Write one blog post between July 6 and July 17, 2019, including what you enjoyed about the product, why other families might enjoy the product, three to five high-quality photos that complement your post, and top and bottom disclosures (provided separately) in compliance with FTC guidelines.” »» Language about who will own the sponsored content that the influencer creates for you. We recommend that you allow the influencer to always own her content, but that she grants you and your brand rights to use or repurpose her content. »» Professional standards. Here’s your opportunity to make sure the influencer doesn’t post anything illegal, false, or defamatory; doesn’t use profanities; doesn’t plagiarize; provides error-free work; and attributes photos properly. »» How you prefer to communicate and how you’ll confirm that the influencers’ work has been completed. »» What the influencer will be paid, dependent on what, by which means, and by when. Compensating Influencers Fairly Paying influencers is something of a controversial topic, but there are no two ways about it: You must compensate your influencers. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 517 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” signed. The more respect and professionalism you show the influencers, the better the quality of the work they’ll produce. Having a contract in place helps solidify your partnership and prevents influencers from retaliating — because they have nothing to retaliate against. Some PR and marketing professionals believe that the old, spray-and-pray method is the best way to approach influencers. They still believe that the best way to get “organic” (or “earned”) media placements is to send product samples or press releases to as many influencers and possible and just hope to get something good in return. But influencer marketing isn’t only about earned media, it’s about earned, owned, and paid-for media. There is no reason to limit how you approach influencers, and there should be no controversy about paying them. This section helps you know how to pay your influencers fairly. For more information on earned, owned, and paid media see Book 5, Chapter 1. Understanding why you need to pay influencers If you’re still not convinced that you need to pay your influencers, here’s why: »» Not compensating your influencers sends a clear message: “We don’t value your work.” You want influencers to produce good content in a timely manner that supports your brand goals. In other words, you’re asking them to work for you . . . for free. »» Some influencers may promote you out of the goodness of their hearts, but most will not. Influencers who do agree to promote a brand “for free” do so with the expectation that they’ll be compensated down the road. »» Brands that don’t compensate influencers fairly risk getting a bad rap among influencers. One of the most prominent bloggers in the country, Jenny Lawson (a.k.a., The Bloggess), has an entire section of her blog dedicated to PR people who pitch her poorly. For a great laugh, see www.thebloggess.com/ heres-a-picture-of-wil-wheaton-collating-papers. »» You get what you pay for. The less you’re willing to invest in your influencer marketing program, the less successful it will be. The best talent doesn’t work for free, so what level of talent are you engaging? »» Air and traffic don’t pay the bills. Brands sometimes promise that they’ll pay influencers by featuring them on their website or Facebook Page, explaining to the influencers that this will benefit them — it will boost their visibility and increase their traffic. Unfortunately, that is a rare outcome for the influencer, and almost never worth the amount of work the influencer put in. 518 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Several brands and agencies just entering the world of influencer marketing start off with this question: “How do I calculate what to pay influencers?” It’s a tough question. And it’s also the wrong one. Bloggers and marketers have been struggling to come up with a formula for calculating how much a blog post is worth for over a decade. The trouble is, formulas are necessarily dependent on numbers alone, such as how much traffic a post is likely to receive, how many comments it generates, or how much revenue it drives. But what you’re really asking influencers for is to create quality content — almost (but not completely) irrespective of numbers. How can you create and apply a single formula based on subjective, qualitative requirements? You can’t. The best way to figure out what to pay influencers is to understand what the going rates are in the influencer marketplace. That way, you avoid the two likely-to-fail approaches in the following sections. Calculating influencer payments with traffic and engagement metrics Some marketers try to quantify the success of a program (and associated influencer payments) using formulas based on an influencer’s reach and engagement, where engagement includes likes, comments, and shares of that influencer’s sponsored content. They do this by placing a dollar value on these things — deciding, for example, that a Facebook “like” is worth $100 and a comment left on a blog post is worth $250. At best, these numbers are arbitrary. At worst, they’re absurd. For one thing, these numbers suggest that all content and engagement is created equal. But some influencers have better content and more genuinely engaged fans. Someone who likes a brand’s Facebook Page to enter a contest is not as valuable as someone who likes a brand’s Facebook Page because they’re genuine fans of that brand. More important, if these numbers are used to calculate the value of an influencer program without taking into account the actual, measurable success of the program on the whole, the numbers are useless! How much money was invested in the program? What were the program’s main objectives? To what extent were the objectives met? Did an increase in sales revenue occur? Only when taking those factors into account can you truly know the value of your influencer marketing. Otherwise, your calculations are being done in a vacuum and the numbers aren’t tied to anything. CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 519 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” Avoiding compensation pitfalls Tying influencer payments to click performance or revenue Some brands prefer to pay influencers on a performance basis, such as how many clicks their posts generate, how many coupons someone downloads, how many sales are generated directly as a results of an influencer’s post. This is an unfair and impractical approach for several reasons: »» It devalues the work the influencer is doing. Sometimes a product, brand, or service is simply not very compelling to readers and doesn’t get traction through social media. But the influencer who has spent time, energy, and talent building good content for your brand should still be compensated for it. It’s up to you to make sure that you’re not working with an influencer who is willing to damage her brand by agreeing to promote something that her fans won’t respond to. »» Performance metrics don’t tell the whole story. Influencer marketing is primarily about building brand awareness, not delivering immediate conversions to sales. Paying influencers based solely on the sales they generate is affiliate marketing, not influencer marketing. Affiliate marketing is when a publisher (like someone who writes a blog or produces a website, not necessarily an “influencer”) gets a portion of a sale that is generated from her site. For example, if a blogger has a link to Amazon. com on her sidebar, and you click it and then make a purchase, the blogger will be paid a portion of that sale (essentially a commission). The upside for affiliate advertisers like Amazon is that they only have to pay their publishers if and when a sale is made, so there’s no risk for them. The upside for publishers or influencers is that they can make a fee simply for passively posting something on their site — they don’t have to create sponsored content. The downside for affiliate advertisers is that very few people click the links and purchase something. The downside for publishers/affiliates is that the fees they make are a tiny, tiny fraction of sales they generate, which are usually small to begin with. »» Performance metrics set up influencers for bad behavior. Over the years, too many brands offered influencers payment based on the number of clicks they drive (pay per click, pay per performance, and so on). This sets up influencers to try to “stuff the ballots” and find unscrupulous ways to inflate their numbers. The best influencers know better and shy away from these arrangements. 520 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers You’ll only be able to engage and contract with the best influencers out there if you’re willing to compensate them fairly based on market rates. You don’t have to pay your influencers in cash. You may offer to compensate influencers with product in addition to or in lieu of cash payments. However, the value of the product should be equivalent to what an influencer would command in cash. Of course, “value” may be calculated by retail value or by other intrinsic qualities of the offer: opportunities to meet celebrities, receive an indemand product before it’s available to the public, and so on. In addition to cash, the “Izea 2018 State of the Creator Economy” study indicates other incentives for influencers include: »» Free products »» Free services »» Discounts or coupons »» Gift cards »» Trips or travel Just be reasonable. Don’t offer an influencer a coupon for $30 worth of shoes if she can command $300 for her work. And remember, nothing says, “I love your work” more than cash. The Izea study (https://izea.com/2018/11/01/announcing-the-2018-stateof-the-creator-economy/) also presented some very interesting information about the difference between how marketers value content and the compensation creators expect to receive. Here are some examples: Type Creator (Influencer) Marketer Sponsored Facebook update $77 $1429 Sponsored blog post $329 $1129 Sponsored pin $75 $1061 Sponsored tweet $59 $910 CHAPTER 3 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” 521 Engaging Influencers Using the “Three Cs” Looking at the going rates for influencers Obviously creators are undervaluing their worth to marketers. However, it’s hard to determine how much more marketers would be willing to pay influencers when they have a host of other costs to run a campaign. Obviously, these market prices continues to evolve. But remember that according to this study, the most important criteria for a marketer when choosing a creator is quality of content. 522 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers IN THIS CHAPTER »» Setting realistic campaign goals »» Knowing your audience »» Staying on message »» Being agile »» Recognizing the power of emotional stories »» Measuring your progress Chapter 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing I n this chapter, you find six secrets to help you set up your influencer marketing programs for success. Secret #1: Set Realistic Campaign Goals Campaign goal setting is important. Why? Because influencer marketing without goals is a waste of time. And influencer marketing without being tied to business goals is an even bigger waste of time. Just as you wouldn’t make a capital expenditure without assessing your business need, you wouldn’t spend money on an influencer marketing campaign unless your end goal was to move your business forward. This section walks you through a series of questions to ask yourself to set realist goals for your campaign. CHAPTER 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing 523 “GOING VIRAL” IS NOT A GOAL “We need a viral video!” “Make it go viral!” Companies, influenced by the constant barrage of viral videos shared via social media, want all their social media programs to “go viral” and think that virality is the key to brand marketing success. Wanting a campaign to “go viral” is not a viable campaign goal. Going viral isn’t realistic — and, besides, it often doesn’t map to business goals like engagements or sales. What you want to do is set practical, measurable campaign goals that will (maybe) set you up for virality, but more important, help you achieve your sales and/or marketing goals, whether you go viral or not. What are you trying to achieve? When preparing for an influencer marketing campaign, think about what the overall purpose is. For example, is your campaign: »» Launching your new company, product, or brand »» Sharing a charitable initiative »» Amplifying a special offer, like a coupon »» Promoting a contest or sweepstakes »» Advertising an event Your purpose might be one of these, a combination, or all of them. Whatever the case may be, start by thinking about what your marketing need is and how influencers will fit into that plan. How will you assess your achievements? After the purpose of your campaign is set, you need to decide how you’ll assess your achievements by selecting a few measurable targets. These targets can be anything you want — from the number of people who download a coupon to how many times a tweet is shared (tracking via your unique hashtag) — as long as they’re tied to sales or marketing goals. 524 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers If you’ve never done an influencer campaign before, set some metrics so that you can gather baseline data about your campaign, and then use that baseline data to gauge future campaign success. Here are some suggested targets to get you started: »» The number of visits to your website »» The number of increased Twitter, Pinterest, YouTube, and/or Facebook followers Succeeding with Influencer Marketing »» The number of likes, comments, and/or shares a Facebook post gets »» The percentage of increase in sales due to a coupon or promo code »» The number of tickets sold to an event based on a trackable URL »» Increase in foot traffic to your retail store »» Brand awareness (more people talking about you online) »» Better data on your customers One of the main reasons why it’s important to have business goals is so that you can track your return on investment (ROI). Influencer marketing isn’t free, and as with any marketing program you run, you want to make sure that the data you gather supports your spend. How will you achieve your goals? When you’ve decided on the purpose of your campaign and how you’ll measure your achievements, you need to think about how you’re going to git ’er done! Here are the main questions you need to answer: »» Do you have the time, expertise, and resources within your organization to not only create your influencer marketing campaign, but also find, vet, and hire the right influencers for the job? »» Are you familiar enough with social media analytics to gather and measure the data you’ll be collecting? »» Would you rather hire expert consultants and/or agencies to do the creative work, manage the influencers, and/or collect the data? How you answer these questions probably depends on the timing of your influencer marketing campaign, your marketing needs, and your budget. If you’re in a hurry, you may want to hire outside help — but keep in mind that most agencies CHAPTER 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing 525 require several weeks of lead time and may charge a quick turnaround fee if you need a campaign to run sooner. If you aren’t on a timeline, you may want to budget to hire a creative team, which includes a staffer who is knowledgeable about influencer or content marketing or an analytics expert. Think about what’s best for your company and your needs, and go from there. When will the campaign run? The timing of your influencer campaign is very important. Think about when you’d like your campaign to run. Is it seasonal? Does it correspond to a holiday? Is it tied to an event you’re promoting? Let’s take a month-long holiday campaign as an example. You have a product that would make a fabulous holiday gift. Ideally, you want to start promoting that product in November, having your influencers marketing your product all month long in advance of the holiday shopping rush. If you’re in the United States, you may want to launch your campaign around Thanksgiving and capitalize on the Black Friday or Cyber Monday shopper mindset. Working backward from there, this means your influencers should be familiar with your product and know what their scope of work is (exactly what’s expected of them and what they’ll be sharing) and have all assets and materials needed (product photos, videos, and/or descriptions) by the date of your program launch. This means that the creative for your campaign — including goals, assets, and influencer scope of work — needs to be completed at least three to four weeks in advance of influencer selection, vetting, and hiring (including getting all employment contracts signed). Depending on the number of influencers you’re hiring, that process alone can take two additional weeks even with experienced professionals doing the selection and vetting. Six weeks in advance of your November campaign launch puts you in midSeptember, which means you should already be thinking about plans to lock down your influencer marketing holiday promotion in the summer. Even if your influencer marketing campaign isn’t tied to a holiday, you should give yourself at least two months to come up with a plan, set goals, figure out how you’re going to achieve them, and begin gathering your data. When you’ve done all that, you’re ready to launch your influencer marketing campaign. 526 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Secret #2: Know Your Audience The second secret to setting your influencer marketing campaign up for success is knowing who is talking about you and where your potential customers are. If your company has a social media presence, you need to know where your ­audience — fans and potential customers — is talking about you. Do you have a product or service that people tweet about or share about on blogs? Or are lively conversations happening on your Facebook Page? Before starting any influencer program, take the time to investigate and listen in on conversations already happening about your company, product, industry, and/or competitors on social media and focus on who’s doing the talking. HOW TO INTRODUCE YOURSELF TO AN INFLUENCER WITHOUT SEEMING LIKE A SPAMMER It’s easier than ever to reach out to the influencers you want to work with, but doing it without coming off as a spammer . . . now that’s another story. Here are some suggestions for contacting influencers without turning them off: • Research the influencer’s blog or social media account to see if she does sponsored posts. If she doesn’t, that doesn’t necessarily mean she’s not interested in starting, but it might be a sign she’s not interested. • Use the influencer’s real name (not her social media handle). Don’t start emails with “Dear Fashion Blogger.” • Show that you’re deeply familiar with the influencer’s content, interests, and values. The more specific you can make your message — and the less generic — the better. • Show that a real person is reaching out. Infuse your outreach with humor and personality. Don’t send a generic tweet or email that makes it seem as if you send 100 notes per day. CHAPTER 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing 527 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing Who’s talking about you? Grassroots conversations may already be happening about your brand. Get to know those influencers. Introduce yourself to them, whether via a hello tweet or by leaving a comment on a blog post, as a way to begin a relationship (see the nearby sidebar). People who are already talking about your brand on social media are your organic influencers. They have the power to affect your brand in positive or negative ways. Establishing an authentic relationship with them — where you engage their opinions and ideas — is a way to keep their view of your company or brand positive. And when you’re ready to start your influencer marketing campaign, you can contact these influencers first to see if they’d like to participate. Where are they talking about you? It’s not just who is talking about you, but where. When you see where the most engaged social media interactions are happening, you can target your influencer marketing campaign to those particular channels. For example, if you’re a fashion or beauty brand, you may want to focus your influencer marketing on Instagram, like Jimmy Choo (www.instagram.com/jimmychoo), Motives Cosmetics (www.instagram.com/motivescosmetics), Flash Tattoos (www. instagram.com/flashtattoos), or Christian Siriano (www.instagram.com/csi riano). All those brands leverage Instagrammers to share their content. It makes no sense, for example, to focus on Pinterest for an influencer campaign if you sell cloud services. Pinterest is a visual channel, so it lends itself to sharing visual content like recipes, workout ideas, decorating tips, and fashion inspiration. Know where your audience lives. If no one is talking about fundraising on Instagram, you’re wasting your time doing your campaign there. Secret #3: Stay on Message Sometimes the first question seems to be when starting any influencer marketing campaign is, “What’s the hashtag?” The key message is just as important as the goal, and making sure that everything you do drives activity back to your key message matters. If your marketing plan is a rocket ship, your messaging is the flight plan and social media is the rocket fuel. 528 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Marketing plan = Rocket ship The rocket ship analogy is useful when talking about influencer marketing. Just as you wouldn’t attempt to explore space without a rocket ship, you shouldn’t engage in influencer marketing without a plan. With your rocket ship in place, you need a flight plan to get to space, and that’s exactly the purpose of your message. What will you be asking your influencers to do? Share a coupon code? Tweet a link for a charitable donation? Post a photo? Whatever it is, your influencer marketing flight plan needs to have one clear, consistent message. Pick one call to action so you don’t confuse your influencers and/ or your potential customers. Social media = Rocket fuel You’ve built your rocket ship and your flight plan is solid. Now it’s time to take off! The social media channels where your influencer marketing campaign will live are the rocket fuel you need to send your campaign into outer space. By tracking where your influencer conversations are already happening, and by leveraging those channels, you can give your influencer marketing campaign the fuel it needs to take off. Influencers will be sharing your content in the channels where it makes the most sense, and you can leverage the influencers’ audiences or communities within those channels to spread your message far and wide. A marketing plan is your rocket ship, and social media is the rocket fuel that sends it to outer space or somewhere amazing. Without a plan, without a ship, you just have a bunch of liquid that can catch fire and burn down your launcher. Secret #4: Be Agile It’s important to have an influencer marketing plan in place, but be sure to build in contingencies just in case Plan A doesn’t work as planned. Say you have two dozen influencers contracted to write blog posts, but what happens if three of them get sick, one person’s laptop dies, and another has a family emergency and can’t complete her work by your deadline? Hopefully, you’ve also identified five backup influencers who can step in and take their places to get your job done. Even with the best laid plans, anything that can go wrong often will go wrong, but it doesn’t have to be a disaster if you’re prepared. CHAPTER 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing 529 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing Messaging = Flight plan DON’T FEED THE TROLLS: HOW TO HANDLE DAMAGE CONTROL Companies sometimes fear that, once their messaging is in the hands of influencers, they won’t be able to control it anymore. The message is sent into the social mediasphere where it has the potential to engage people who aren’t fans of the brand or message. You can help protect your product, initiative, or service from trolls (Internet bad guys — or just really loud critics) in several ways: • Make sure your company hasn’t had any bad press recently. Has your product been the subject of a recall? Are you in the middle of a sticky lawsuit? Did your product have a glitch or virus that left lots of people unhappy? Maybe you should postpone your influencer marketing campaign until your brand isn’t so exposed. • Hire exactly the right influencers for your campaign. Influencers who are fans or potential fans of your brand are professional and will often be your best cheerleaders, evangelists, and/or explainers if their posts encounter negative ­attention from trolls. Make sure they’re armed with correct information, and let them do their job. • Don’t feed the trolls with emotional responses. Engage carefully and respectfully with trolls — even and especially if they aren’t being respectful. Your audience is watching, and they’re paying attention to how your brand conducts itself on social media. If a troll is spreading untrue information, state the correct information (or a link to the correct information) across social media. You don’t have to have the last word; you just have to have the correct word. Secret #5: Recognize the Power of Emotional Stories Emotions — from awe and anger to sadness and joy — make content go viral. You want to set up your influencer marketing campaign to go viral, but Psy is busy making another video (plus you can’t afford to pay him) and your cat is camera shy. How to create a compelling story that people will want to share? Start with a story people will care about! If you want your influencer marketing campaign to be set up for virality, you must create an emotional angle for your story. What emotion will your brand story elicit? Will it play on humor? Or will you aim to inspire? Brands have spent ­millions of dollars on creative concepts and marketing plans to ensure virality. 530 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers If you don’t have millions of dollars to spend, you have to come up with a compelling story, formulate a solid plan, and identify the right influencers to help spread your message. Then hope for the best. Beyond the emotions of virality, two other factors are at play: »» Good viral content tugs at the heartstrings or makes people feel something, and that’s not necessarily tied to any of the emotions we mention earlier. feel a part of the story and then share it not only because they relate, but because something about the sharing is a reflection on them as well. Secret #6: You Get What You Measure Marketing — especially in new spaces and platforms — is iterative, which means you make changes and adjust as you go. What worked? How do you do it more? How do you scale? You can answer all these questions by setting goals for your campaigns and tracking those goals. In that sense, you get data from what you measure (see “How will you assess your achievements?” earlier in this chapter). Let’s say the goal for your month-long holiday influencer marketing campaign was to track the number of visits to your website and to sell more of your product by sharing a coupon code across social media. Your influencer marketing plan should focus on having influencers share a link to your website where people can then find a coupon code to use toward a purchase. Before you start your monthlong influencer marketing campaign, gather some baseline information about your website traffic and know your typical sales numbers for your product. At the end of the your month-long promotion,check your site traffic and look at your sales numbers. You get what you measure — and hopefully the results are what you were expecting! CHAPTER 4 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing 531 Succeeding with Influencer Marketing »» Good viral content is relatable. Content is contagious when people want to IN THIS CHAPTER »» Exercising your creativity »» Making magic with your personal insights »» Avoiding the controversial »» Managing “crazy” Chapter 5 Getting Creative N ow you’re ready to tackle your influencer marketing programs with gusto! Time to have some fun! Of course, no one will care if your marketing efforts are “fun” if they don’t produce real results. But the best part about social media marketing is that fun tends to equal effective. Think you’re ready to have some fun? Of course, you are! Getting Creative and Letting Go Social media is a loud, crowded space full of millions of people talking over each other. Standing out isn’t easy! Engaging influencers to create content that resonates with their audience is a great first step — you know their audiences are receptive. But even the most loyal influencer fan will click or tap to something else if the content they’re seeing is something they’ve seen a million times before. No one wants content that is stale, boring, corporate, or lame. CHAPTER 5 Getting Creative 533 As with all social media advertising, creating great content is tricky because users are savvy. They don’t want to be sold to. They don’t want advertising that feels like advertising. At the same time, they don’t want to feel “tricked” into reading or engaging with content that is sponsored but tries too hard to pass itself off as non-sponsored. FTC guidelines require disclosure of sponsored content! Be sure to visit www. ftc.gov for the most recent guidelines on how to properly disclose influencer endorsements on social media. The happy medium with influencer marketing is in developing a great campaign outline and then letting influencers take over, doing what they do best. Walking the walk To be successful at influencer marketing — or social media marketing of any kind — you must stay on top of Internet trends. (Many marketers outsource influencer marketing for this very reason!) You wouldn’t hire someone to produce a TV commercial if that person had never seen a TV commercial before, would you? Similarly, you can’t run an influencer marketing campaign if you’ve never seen one, and you can’t just guess at what kind of influencers and content will work on social media platforms if you aren’t paying attention to them. Start by expanding your own social networks. How many people follow you is far less important than how many people you follow. Listen, post, and interact on Twitter and Facebook. Use Instagram every day. Find some Tumblr accounts you enjoy and follow them. Join Reddit. Spend time researching trending topics. If you don’t understand a hashtag, click it and find out what the story is. Start using the language yourself. While you’re poking around social media, you’ll run into countless “gurus” and experts and people whose only job online is to offer advice. You may benefit from following them, but you’ll likely benefit more simply by becoming a savvy social media participant yourself. It’s about a million times easier to answer the question “What would make this blog post interesting for readers?” if you’re a blog reader yourself! You don’t have to be an expert, but you should at least try to understand what’s happening in social media by downloading popular apps (for example, Snapchat, Whatsapp, and Tinder) and/or talking to people who use them regularly to become versed in what’s cool. 534 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Yes, you have to know what’s cool. Cool is critical to social media and influencer marketing success. If you’re not trendy, you’re not relevant. Are you having fun yet? For some reason, marketers seem to completely forget how they behave online, and end up creating content they’d never pay attention to themselves. Social media is, above all, social. It’s about connecting, reaching out to people you know in real life and online, and sharing human experiences through stories and photos. The only way to interject brand stories among all the nonbranded ones is to make them as real and unbrandlike as possible. This doesn’t mean you should create programs that are so far from your brand or brand message that no one will notice (or remember!) what your brand even is. But there are definitely ways to get out of “corporate box” thinking. »» What content do you click each day? »» Which headlines spark your interest most often? »» What content do you actually share? »» What content do you ignore? »» What’s the last piece of sponsored content you read? When you can answer those questions, you’re on your way to building influencer marketing programs that will pass the cool test! The following sectionswalk you through an example of taking an everyday ­product and transforming an influencer marketing campaign from “boring” (irrelevant) to “fun” (relevant and engaging). Dental floss is boring Say you’ve been tasked with engaging influencers as part of a new product launch for dental floss. Assuming that the program goals and success metrics have already been mapped, your job is to guide influencers into creating content. About dental floss. CHAPTER 5 Getting Creative 535 Getting Creative When you’re immersed in social media culture, pay attention to your personal trends and preferences: You’re probably hard-pressed to think of a more boring blog post than one that outlines the features and benefits of dental floss. A product review of dental floss? Not only would you, as a reader, never click that post, but what kind of influencer would be happy to write it? If you secretly think dental floss is boring, everyone else will think it’s boring, too. So, how do you create an influencer marketing program around dental floss that’s fun? Making dental floss fun Start by considering what you find fun about social media, and what type of content you share. You can then transfer those ideas to a dental floss program. Now, your ideas won’t be all good, but they’re a jumping off point to get creative and fun with even the most mundane of topics. Here are some ideas on how to make dental floss fun: »» Share DIY content/ Ask influencers to showcase other uses for floss, encouraging them to take a creative, DIY spin on a product usually relegated to the bathroom: weaving, making jewelry, dipping floss in paints and decorating jars, dangling cat toys, and so on. »» Recipes are always popular. Why make a special trip to the store for cook- ing twine when dental floss works just as well for trussing roasted chicken or turkey? There are many ways dental floss can be used in cooking techniques that influencers could illustrate, encouraging new ways for consumers to keep dental floss top-of-mind. »» Getting kids to floss regularly can be really tough. Ask influencers to share their best tips and tricks to getting their kids to floss regularly, sharing their secret bathroom charts or incentives, plus lots of pictures of really cute kids! »» Create completely unscientific “flosser profiles” and then develop a “What Kind of Flosser Are You?” type of quiz that people love to fill out. »» Maybe the goal is to make dental floss a more prominent aspect of everyday grooming among consumers. Ask influencers to showcase new ways in which they’re willing to display their floss. Why do soaps and toothbrushes get all the fancy bathroom display tools? Why can’t floss be proudly displayed on the bathroom sink as well? »» Best songs to floss to? Ask influencers to name, or even come up with alternate lyrics to, their favorite songs — songs that they sing to themselves in their heads while flossing so they know they’re spending enough time on the job. You could even host a contest for the best song/lyrics for flossing your teeth to! 536 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Go for it! Not to get too philosophical, but when it comes down to it, the real reason brands don’t do a better job of embracing influencer marketing is because they’re scared. They’re afraid of losing control of their brand’s message. What the brands don’t realize, however, is that people are using social media to talk about them — whether the brands are participating or not. Still, this fear of loss of control compromises influencer campaigns that could otherwise be great. To those brands and marketers: Let it go! Don’t be afraid to be real In the earlier dental floss example, influencers needed to think of and post creative uses for dental floss. This isn’t a traditional approach to promoting dental floss, and probably the brand’s manager expects the entire marketing campaign to focus on bathroom-only messaging. But that’s so corporate! And everyone knows what dental floss is for. No one will pay attention to a boring bathroomonly program. Not on social media, anyway. But using dental floss for crafts? That’s unexpected. That’s something people would be interested in. That’s a reallife hack and something people on social media are likely to find useful. So what’s “real”? Think of it this way: Would you tell your friend about it? You probably won’t tell anyone about a new dental floss just because there’s a new dental floss on the market. (In truth, that would be weird! “Hey, buddy! Did you hear about this new dental floss?”) But you might share a fun craft you did with your kid that turned out great and that you photographed and that, oh, hey, happened to use dental floss. Let the influencers influence If you’re all tapped out of “real” or “cool” ideas but you really want a fantastically successful influencer marketing program, ask the influencers what kind of posts they’d like to create! No one knows an influencer’s audience better than the influencer does. Influencers are successful because they create great content. Don’t be afraid to let them take the lead! Tell them what your program goals are and ask them how they think they could best achieve your objective. CHAPTER 5 Getting Creative 537 Getting Creative If you’re paying attention, you’re immersing yourself in social media. You’re following and interacting with influencers you want to engage professionally. You see what they’re posting. The influencers care just as much about their posts as you do. They have a reputation to uphold, and they can’t come across as inauthentic to their readers. They are (presumably) being paid for the work that they’re doing for you. They want to please you because they want to work with you — and other brands — again. Giving minimal guidance to the influencers and letting them do their thing often results in diverse, interesting, compelling programs that truly engage audiences. What If It All Goes Wrong? Brands still worry about handing their precious brand messaging keys over to influencers. What happens if the bloggers go crazy on us? Horror stories abound of brands failing to use social media correctly, and having the Internet come after them like an angry mob. It does happen from time to time. The good news is that avoiding Internet disasters isn’t difficult! Brands that find themselves in hot water usually do so because they aren’t paying attention, or because they forget that social media is a live medium, which means if you put something out there you need to be prepared to respond. Social media and social media marketing isn’t a one-way street — you need to be prepared to engage with your consumers as soon as they offer you feedback, even if it’s not positive. Preventing a crisis No form of social media marketing, including influencer marketing, can be 100 percent brand-safe. Even the most carefully selected influencers following guidelines to a completely innocuous program may have a commenter who says something unkind about the brand. That’s okay! This is what makes the medium so real. And truly, a few negative comments here and there aren’t a big issue. Internet backlash from influencer marketing programs occurs for a finite number of reasons. Here’s how to prevent this kind of backlash: »» Don’t try to hide the fact that you’re working with influencers, or that the influencers are being compensated. Always be transparent! Besides, the FTC requires that you be honest about this stuff — whether you get backlash or not from consumers, you don’t want to be fined by the FTC. 538 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers »» Don’t underestimate the intelligence of your influencers’ audiences. If your brand or service is controversial, even just among a small group of people, the influencers’ audiences may bring this controversy to light. Don’t use influencers to try to “spin” something negative into a positive if the positive spin is disingenuous. If you do have a product or service that is known to draw Internet ire, do your best to warn the influencers ahead of time. »» Don’t hop on social media memes — like using trending hashtags on Twitter — without doing research! Too many brands use hashtags without researching their origins. Don’t ask your influencers to participate in trendy memes or use hashtags if they’re appropriating or “hijacking” them from meaningful conversations. »» Be careful, courteous, honest, and professional in all your communica- tions with influencers. Not all influencers will show you the same respect, but it’s always worth it to err on the side of caution. Ask yourself, “What if this blogger decided to post the content of my email to her site?” »» Don’t engage influencers in programs that encourage “bad” behavior Getting Creative on the influencers’ part or their audiences’ part. For instance, programs where the influencer who get the most votes wins can get downright ugly. In an attempt to get votes, some influencers may start spamming their networks, or find creative ways to get people to vote for them. Meanwhile, influencers who don’t get enough votes may feel jealous and/or make accusations of their fellow influencers, and the whole program can end poorly, overshadowed by the angst and anger of the participants. »» If you’re asking influencers to review your product and you’re afraid of what they’ll write if they don’t like it, know your options. If the product isn’t great, influencer marketing is probably not the best way to go. If you don’t really want influencers to share their honest opinions, don’t engage them. You’d basically be asking them to lie for you, and that damages everyone’s reputation. This is where a contract becomes important. Spell out what your expectations are and be sure your influencer is on board. If the product is good but you worry about influencer feedback, be upfront about how you would like them to handle it. Don’t say, “You may only post your opinion about our product if you like it.” Remember: You aren’t compensating people to write good things. Instead, say, “If you were unhappy with this product for any reason, we’d love to hear your feedback directly. We want to know how we can improve it! You’re welcome to share your balanced feedback in your post, or you may choose not to post at all.” Give them the option of not posting. Consider compensating them regardless. CHAPTER 5 Getting Creative 539 »» Cease all influencer marketing activity across social channels when there is a national or international crisis. From a brand management standpoint, you don’t want influencers touting a product amid sensitive posts about a national tragedy. You don’t want your “Fun, flirty looks for spring” mascara tweets next to a tweet from someone who’s openly mourning. It’s important to make sure you do your due diligence and research the reputation of any influencer you’re planning to engage. Managing a crisis (if it happens anyway) If you follow the guidelines, you’ll deftly avoid any real controversies online. However, on the slim chance that something does go off-kilter with your influencers, here’s what you can do: »» Respond immediately. The longer you remain silent, the worse the situation can get. Don’t launch an influencer marketing campaign (or any social media campaign) if you don’t have the resources to monitor it in real time. If someone or something goes off the rails, you need to have someone on hand to respond right away. If the crisis is big and requires more executive-level response than you can give immediately, at least acknowledge that there is a problem and you’re looking into it. »» Respond with honesty. Don’t lie about how long the issue will take to resolve, or say that the issue was unforeseen if it wasn’t. That will only make matters worse. »» Apologize. The Internet has a terrible memory! The faster you apologize for whatever started the negativity in the first place, the faster the audience will move on to something else. Negative situations usually get worse when a brand argues with its customers, and the same holds true for influencers and their audiences. Make sure your apologies are sincere and actual apologies. Don’t use words like if and but. For instance, saying “We’re sorry if we offended anyone” is troublesome for two reasons: • If you’re making an apology because people were offended, there is no need to say “if.” • Phrases like this suggest that the blame lies with the people who are offended as opposed to the offender. This may seem like splitting hairs, but bad apologies can add fuel to Internet firestorms. 540 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Try to make your apologies personal. If a program somehow offended many people, do your best to apologize to those people directly, not just in a single blanket statement they may not see. If your influencers are the ones fending off negativity, support them publicly and privately. Publicly, defend your influencers on their posts (by acknowledging the negative comments and apologizing on behalf of the influencer). Privately, email the influencers and offer them support. Getting Creative None of these steps should be necessary if you’ve taken the proper care to avoid risky programs in the first place. Remember: The influencers want their programs to be as successful as you do. You’re in this together! CHAPTER 5 Getting Creative 541 IN THIS CHAPTER »» Hiring a social influencer agency »» Deciding which kind of agency to hire »» Doing one big campaign versus multiple activations Chapter 6 Working with an Agency A day comes in every marketer’s career when you realize you need help. When the program is bigger than your internal resources or expertise can handle, you’re smart enough to bring in the cavalry. Especially when you’re working on something as specialized and dynamic as influencer marketing, it helps to have an experienced guide on the inside to help you navigate. In this chapter, you walk through the process of finding and hiring the right agency for your needs. So, You Want to Hire an Influencer Marketing Agency The fact that influencer marketing is a rapidly evolving practice can make it hard to evaluate and pick one agency over another. Like any other kind of outsourcing, it helps to start by understanding your budget, and what you want to accomplish, including the following: »» Who you want to reach. »» Where and how they already interact on social media channels, so you know which type of specialist to hire. You don’t go to a Twitter agency if your target is active on YouTube. CHAPTER 6 Working with an Agency 543 »» What type of message you want to share and have the influencers share in turn. Having a clear picture of what you want your program to be will help you set ­specific and actionable goals for your agency partner, and make it easier to measure the success of your program. You want to be sure that any and all activity supports your business goals. Because if it doesn’t, you’re wasting your time and money! May I borrow your relationships? Managing relationships with influencers is hard work. Coming up with a ­concept, theme, and hashtag is just the beginning! Someone also has to manage the communication and administrative tasks, including identifying and recruiting the right people, setting up a contractual agreement, administering payment, and even dealing with typos. Setting up this infrastructure with each individual influencer at any kind of scale is costly and time-consuming, and around every corner is another opportunity to get it wrong and offend the very people you’re trying to convince. Perhaps most important, very few brands (Disney is the exception that proves the rule) have enough content or interesting reasons to interact with any one influencer more than two or three times a year. Influencers don’t want to write about a brand more than that, and their audiences certainly don’t want to read that much content about any one brand! Unless you can come up with diverse, creative angles from which to approach your brand’s messaging (for example, a recipe one month, a post about a vacation the next, favorite pets the next, and so on), while still somehow staying relevant, content will get repetitive and boring. This is where outsourcing to an agency, especially one with a network of influencers, is so valuable. A capable agency will have a comprehensive database with information that helps identify and vet the best candidates to work on your project. They’ll have processes in place for quality control, systems to pay the influencers, and measurement and reporting methodologies. A great agency will even offer first-hand qualitative data about its influencers as well — that is, who is reliable, whose posts produce consistent engagement, who creates the most original/ creative content, and which influencers can’t be counted on to meet a deadline! This knowledge can’t be found in a database or by simply looking at statistics. An agency that works on behalf of multiple brands has multiple reasons to contact influencers, building credibility and a relationship over time. In practical terms, this means they have already weeded out the crazies and earned the respect of the good ones. 544 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Consider the value of the influencers’ desire to stay in the good graces of an agency that provides them with multiple opportunities to work on prestigious programs — they have more at stake than a single gig paying $150, which means they’re motivated to behave professionally. A strong relationship with an influencer is extra valuable when consumers say they hate your product. The influencer will be more likely to reach out privately with negative feedback, and less likely to take cheap — and brand damaging — shots on a public forum if she sees a long-term value to the relationship. How it works: Self-service versus full-service Approaches to managing influencer marketing programs range from fully automated and self-service, to highly personalized, high-touch, custom solutions. Most agencies skew more one way than the other. Each approach has value, and it’s smart to let your needs, rather than a philosophical preference, dictate your selection. Think of it as a choice between an all-you-can-eat buffet in a casino in Las Vegas, or having a personal chef come to your home and make a perfectly designed three-course meal for an intimate dinner date. They both can be delicious, but when you’re in the mood for one, the other choice definitely won’t satisfy you! I <3 control: When self-service platforms rock Many systems let you go in and sort their influencer database according to a set of desired characteristics. This can include demographic factors like household income, education, gender, and number of children, as well as information about their social channel presence like number of followers or monthly blog page views. Automated solutions are usually a cost-effective way to get a general message to a broad audience at scale. Some platforms allow you to review posts before they’re published, which is appealing to brands that are in highly regulated industries like financial services or have a desire to tightly control the messaging. However, the quality of the content tends to be fairly generic, and the engagement of the influencers audiences is often low. Also, there are usually few vetting or validating processes to join these automated platforms, so anyone with an email address can sign up. CHAPTER 6 Working with an Agency 545 Working with an Agency Often considered the “technology solution,” self-service, automated platforms put the bulk of the control — and responsibility — in your hands. You log in to the vendor’s system and have access to a variety of program components. This approach is fine if you can reach your goals with the lowest common denominator. For example, if you’re trying to sell gift-wrapping supplies during the December holiday season, you can afford to be very general in your targeting and selection of influencers. It’s a safe bet that pretty much every influencer out there has someone in their community of followers who needs a gift bag. Automated solutions also make control freaks happy. Do you want, or even have a pressing business need, to check your results daily or even hourly? Great! Log on and watch the impressions roll in. Just remember that most platform solutions don’t provide very much customer service, so you need to have internal staffing resources, who are trained and available to do most or even all of the program setup, project management, and reporting. Just make it happen: Getting someone else to do the heavy lifting At the other end of the continuum is the full-service influencer agency that manually (or mostly manually — everyone uses some kind of contact management system, even if they don’t give clients access to it!) sets up the program. This gives you great flexibility, starting by allowing you to be very specific in your influencer selection. Need military moms in Florida, with three kids and a family history of diabetes? They can be found and recruited! But it’ll be expensive, it’ll take time, and your program size will be limited by the actual number of people who match your requirements and are also willing to participate in the program. Speaking of participants, the members of this type of network usually meet minimum membership requirements and consequently are of a higher caliber, with better content and higher audience numbers, as well as being more reliable. These more expensive services come with a full suite of benefits for you the marketer, including an expert project manager, who runs the programs, manages influencer communications, and provides you with reporting that can be highly customized. This type of service is great when you really just want to outsource it all. If you want to hand over your list of requirements and goals, and go take care of something else, you’ll be happier with a full-service agency. 546 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers Deciding Which Type of Agency Is Right for You Realistically, your program probably needs a little bit of both. And few agencies are purely one or the other, although their pricing and standard service models will start at one point or the other. See Table 6-1 for a helpful chart on when to use a self-service agency versus a full-service agency. TABLE 6-1 When to Use a Self-Service Agency versus a FullService Agency Self-Service You have a small budget. Full-Service X You have a bigger budget. X You have few demographic requirements. X You have very specific demographic requirements. X You have a highly engaged, skilled, and/or dedicated internal staff. X You have limited internal resources to manage the project. X You need real-time, frequent reporting. X You have a broad topic that is applicable to most of the population. X You have a very specific or sensitive topic. X As part of a broad marketing plan, influencer marketing activations can be a powerful tactic to get a spike in awareness or generate buzz around a specific event or launch. On the other hand, influencer marketing can be a powerful ongoing tool to engage with your customers over the lifecycle of a product, supporting market research and customer service, as well as contributing to overall branding efforts. CHAPTER 6 Working with an Agency 547 Working with an Agency One-Off Events versus Continuity Campaigns Matching your program goals to the bigger business goals helps you decide which kind of program to design. Making a big splash for maximum effect Sometimes marketing goals are time sensitive. You need to get everyone’s attention at the same time, for a product launch, a fundraising deadline, or a special event, like the Grammys. In these situations, you want to use tactics and channels that are effective in real time and in the moment, such as Twitter. Using attention-getting techniques, like bringing in a celebrity or high-profile influencer, can help you generate a spike in attention and awareness. Although they aren’t sustainable over a longer timeframe, these high-intensity activations can be a spark that gets a fire burning for your brand. Putting in the hours for a long-term relationship Every marketers wants to have those big awareness spikes on a daily basis, but that’s simply not feasible. And it’s not even desirable — people get sick of seeing the same thing every day, and that’s a good way to generate a backlash. Taking the approach of multiple activations, over time, with modest but increasing goals, allows you to test and learn as you go. You can modify program elements to add more of what works, and eliminate problematic elements. This approach is great if you’re in beta with a product, are doing regional rollout, or have any kind of phased program to support. In these cases, activations with more evergreen content, such as blog posts or Pinterest boards, can be very effective. By creating content that is discoverable over time, you can gradually build your library in a more organic and authenticfeeling manner. Long-term programs may have the same overall budget, but because they happen over an extended period, they may also be more cost-effective if you’re budget sensitive. 548 BOOK 6 Connecting with Influencers 7 Facebook Marketing Contents at a Glance CHAPTER 1: Delving into Facebook Marketing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551 What Is Facebook, and Why Is It So Popular? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552 Understanding the Marketing Potential of Facebook . . . . . . . . . . . 553 Understanding Why Your Business Needs a Facebook Page. . . . . 557 CHAPTER 2: Creating a Facebook Marketing Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 Understanding the Power of Word of Mouth on Facebook . . . . . . 562 Understanding Your Facebook Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563 Defining Your Marketing Goals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565 Developing Your Content Strategy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570 Encouraging Audience Engagement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572 Monitoring and Reporting Page Activity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575 Integrating Your Online and Offline Campaigns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579 CHAPTER 3: Selling Products and Services Using Facebook Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583 Understanding Facebook Offers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584 Creating an Offer for Your Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585 Getting the Most from Your Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587 Promoting Your Offer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588 CHAPTER 4: Uniting Facebook with Other Social Media. . . . . . 591 Making Facebook Part of Your Marketing Mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592 Promoting Your Facebook Presence Offline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597 Optimizing Your Page for Search Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598 Integrating Instagram into Your Other Marketing Channels . . . . . 601 Getting Inside Your Customers’ Heads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604 CHAPTER 5: Getting into Instagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607 Promoting Your Brand on Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608 Using Your Instagram Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609 Determining What Is Photo-Worthy for Your Brand . . . . . . . . . . . . 612 Using Hashtags in Your Instagram Posts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613 Finding Friends and Fans on Instagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614 Using Instastories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61